LG 32LD333H User Manual Owner's SAC34026009 8 Eng
32LD340H Owner's Manual SAC34026009_8_eng Most comprehensive of product setup and usage. (English)
37LD333H Owner's Manual File?fileId=KROWM000401873 Most comprehensive of product setup and usage. (English)
32LD333H Owner's Manual File?fileId=KROWM000397034 Most comprehensive of product setup and usage. (English)
32LD333H Owner's Manual File?fileId=KROWM000397033 Most comprehensive of product setup and usage. (Spanish)
32LD340H Owner's Manual File?fileId=KROWM000369154 Most comprehensive of product setup and usage. (English)
2012-07-27
User Manual: LG 32LD333H Owner's Manual Most comprehensive of product setup and usage. (Spanish)
Open the PDF directly: View PDF .
Page Count: 317
Download | ![]() |
Open PDF In Browser | View PDF |
OWNER’S MANUAL LCD TV Please read this manual carefully before operating your set and retain it for future reference. The model and serial number of the TV is located on the back and one side of the TV. Record it below should you ever need service. 32LD310H 37LD310H 32LD325H 37LD325H 26LD320H 32LD320H 37LD320H 42LD320H 32LD330H 37LD330H 32LD333H 37LD333H 26LD340H 32LD340H 37LD340H 42LD340H 26LD343H 32LD343H 37LD343H 42LD343H 26LD345H 32LD345H 37LD345H 42LD345H MODEL SERIAL P/NO : SAC34026009 (1203-REV08) www.lg.com WARNING / CAUTION WARNING To prevent fire or shock hazards, do not expose this product to rain or moisture. TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK). NO USER SERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE. REFER TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL. The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral triangle, is intended to alert the user to the presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to persons. The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert the user to the presence of important operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the appliance. WARNING TO REDUCE THE RISK OF FIRE AND ELECTRIC SHOCK, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS PRODUCT TO RAIN OR MOISTURE. NOTE TO CABLE/TV INSTALLER This reminder is provided to call the CATV system installer’s attention to Article 820-40 of the National Electric Code (U.S.A.). The code provides guidelines for proper grounding and, in particular, specifies that the cable ground shall be connected to the grounding system of the building, as close to the point of the cable entry as practical. 2 FCC Notice Class B digital device This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: - Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna. - Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver. - Connect the equipment to an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. - Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help. This device complies with part 15 of the FCC Rules. Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause (harmful) interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference received, including interference that may cause undesired operation (of the device). Any changes or modifications in construction of this device which are not expressly approved by the party responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to operate the equipment. CAUTION Do not attempt to modify this product in any way without written authorization from LG Electronics. Unauthorized modification could void the user’s authority to operate this product. SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS Read these instructions. Keep these instructions. 10 Heed all warnings. Follow all instructions. 1 Do not use this apparatus near water. 2 Clean only with dry cloth. 3 Do not block any ventilation openings. Install in accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions. 4 Do not install near any heat sources such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus (including amplifiers) that produce heat. 5 Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or grounding-type plug. A polarized plug has two blades with one wider than the other. A grounding type plug has two blades and a third grounding prong, The wide blade or the third prong are provided for your safety. If the provided plug does not fit into your outlet, consult an electrician for replacement of the obsolete outlet. (Can differ by country) 6 Protect the power cord from being walked on or pinched particularly at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the point where they exit from the apparatus. 7 Only use attachments/accessories specified by the manufacturer. 8 Use only with the cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table specified by the manufacturer, or sold with the apparatus. When a cart is used, use caution when moving the cart/apparatus combination to avoid injury from tip-over. 9 Unplug this apparatus during lighting storms or when unused for long periods of time. Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel. Servicing is required when the apparatus has been damaged in any way, such as power-supply cord or plug is damaged, liquid has been spilled or objects have fallen into the apparatus, the apparatus has been exposed to rain or moisture, does not operate normally, or has been dropped. 11 Never touch this apparatus or antenna during a thunder or lighting storm. 12 When mounting a TV on the wall, make sure not to install the TV by the hanging power and signal cables on the back of the TV. 13 Do not allow an impact shock or any objects to fall into the product, and do not drop onto the screen with something. 14 CAUTION concerning the Power Cord: It is recommend that appliances be placed upon a dedicated circuit; that is, a single outlet circuit which powers only that appliance and has no additional outlets or branch circuits. Check the specification page of this owner's manual to be certain. Do n ot connect too many appliances to the same AC power outlet as this could result in fire or electric shock. Do not overload wall outlets. Overloaded wall outlets, loose or damaged wall outlets, extension cords, frayed power cords, or damaged or cracked wire insulation are dangerous . Any of these conditions could result in electric shock or fire. Periodically examine the cord of your appliance, and if its appearance indicates damage or deterioration, unplug it, discontinue use of the appliance, and have the cord replaced with an exact replacement part by an authorized servicer. Protect the power cord from physical or mechanical abuse, such as being twisted, kinked, pinched, closed in a door, or walked upon. Pay particular attention to plugs, wall outlets, and the point where the cord exits the appliance. Do not make the TV with the power cord plugged in. Do not use a damaged or loose power cord. Be sure do grasp the plug when unplugging the power cord. Do not pull on the power cord to unplug the TV. 3 SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS 15 WARNING - To reduce the risk of fire or electrical shock, do not expose this product to rain, moisture or other liquids. Do not touch the TV with wet hands. Do not install this product near flammable objects such as gasoline or candles or expose the TV to direct air conditioning. 16 Do not expose to dripping or splashing and do not place objects filled with liquids, such as vases, cups, etc. on or over the apparatus (e.g. on shelves above the unit). 17 GROUNDING Ensure that you connect the earth ground wire to prevent possible electric shock (i.e. a TV with a three-prong grounded AC plug must be connected to a three-prong grounded AC outlet). If grounding methods are not possible, have a qualified electrician install a separate circuit breaker. Do not try to ground the unit by connecting it to telephone wires, lightening rods, or gas pipes. 22 Ground Clamp DISCONNECTING DEVICE FROM MAINS Mains plug is the disconnecting device. The plug must remain readily operable. 19 As long as this unit is connected to the AC wall outlet, it is not disconnected from the AC power source even if you turn off this unit by SWITCH. 20 Cleaning When cleaning, unplug the power cord and scrub gently with a soft cloth to prevent scratching. Do not spray water or other liquids directly on the TV as electric shock may occur. Do not clean with chemicals such as alcohol, thinners or benzene. 21 4 Moving Make sure the product is turned off, unplugged and all cables have been removed. It may take 2 or more people to carry larger TVs. Do not press against or put stress on the front panel of the TV. Antenna Lead in Wire Antenna Discharge Unit (NEC Section 810-20) Electric Service Equipment Power Supply Short-circuit Breaker 18 ANTENNAS Outdoor antenna grounding (Can differ by country) If an outdoor antenna is installed, follow the precautions below. An outdoor antenna system should not be located in the vicinity of overhead power lines or other electric light or power circuits, or where it can come in contact with such power lines or circuits as death or serious injury can occur. Be sure the antenna system is grounded so as to provide some protection against voltage surges and built-up static charges. Section 810 of the National Electrical Code (NEC) in the U.S.A. provides information with respect to proper grounding of the mast and supporting structure, grounding of the lead-in wire to an antenna discharge unit, size of grounding conductors, location of antenna discharge unit, connection to grounding electrodes and requirements for the grounding electrode. Antenna grounding according to the National Electrical Code, ANSI/NFPA 70 Grounding Conductor (NEC Section 810-21) Ground Clamps Power Service Grounding Electrode System (NEC Art 250, Part H) NEC: National Electrical Code 23 Ventilation Install your TV where there is proper ventilation. Do not install in a confined space such as a bookcase. Do not cover the product with cloth or other materials (e.g.) plastic while plugged in. Do not install in excessively dusty places. 24 Take care not to touch the ventilation openings. When watching the TV for a long period, the ventilation openings may become hot. This does not affect the performance of the product or cause defects in the product. 25 If you smell smoke or other odors coming from the TV, unplug the power cord contact and authorized service center. 26 Do not press strongly upon the panel with hand or sharp object such as nail, pencil or pen, or make a scratch on it. 27 Keep the product away from direct sunlight. 28 Dot Defect The Plasma or LCD panel is a high technology product with resolution of two million to six million pixels. In a very few cases, you could see fine dots on the screen while you’re viewing the TV. Those dots are deactivated pixels and do not affect the performance and reliability of the TV. 29 Generated Sound “Cracking” noise: A cracking noise that occurs when watching or turning off the TV is generated by plastic thermal contraction due to temperature and humidity. This noise is common for products where thermal deformation is required. Electrical circuit humming/panel buzzing: A low level noise is generated from a high-speed switching circuit, which supplies a large amount of current to operate a product. It varies depending on the product. This generated sound does not affect the performance and reliability of the product. 30 For LED LCD TV/ LCD TV If the TV feels cold to the touch, there may be a small “flicker” when it is turned on. This is normal, there is nothing wrong with TV. Some minute dot defects may be visible on the screen, appearing as tiny red, green, or blue spots. However, they have no adverse effect on the monitor’s performance. Avoid touching the LCD screen or holding your finger(s) against it for long periods of time. Doing so may produce some temporary distortion effects on the screen. ON DISPOSAL (Only Hg lamp used LCD TV) The fluorescent lamp used in this product contains a small amount of mercury. Do not dispose of this product with general household waste. Disposal of this product must be carried out in accordance to the regulations of your local authority. 5 CONTENTS WARNING / CAUTION...............................2 SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS......................... 3 FEATURE OF THIS TV...............................8 PREPARATION Accessories..............................................................9 Front Panel Information.....................................10 Back Panel Information....................................... 11 Stand Instructions................................................ 14 VESA wall mounting...........................................16 Cable Management............................................ 17 Desktop Pedestal Installation...........................18 Swivel Stand ..........................................................18 Kensington Security System............................18 Attaching the TV to a Desk..............................19 Securing the TV to the Wall to Prevent Falling when the TV is used on a stand..................... 21 Antenna or Cable Connection........................22 EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP HD Receiver setup..............................................23 DVD setup.............................................................26 VCR SETUP..........................................................28 Other A/V Source Setup..................................29 USB Connection.................................................30 PC Setup................................................................ 31 WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL Remote Control Functions...............................38 Turning on the TV...............................................40 Channel Selection..............................................40 Volume Adjustment...........................................40 On-Screen Menus Selection............................ 41 Customer Support - Picture Test / Sound Test..............................43 - Product/Service Info.......................................44 6 Channel Setup - Auto Scan (Auto Tuning)...............................45 - Add/Delete Channel (Manual Tuning)......46 - Channel Editing................................................ 47 Input List...............................................................48 Example Electronic Program Guide..............49 Channel Label......................................................50 Demo Mode..........................................................51 MY MEDIA Connection Method...........................................52 Entry Mode...........................................................54 Photo List..............................................................55 Music List............................................................... 61 Extra Contents.....................................................65 PICTURE CONTROL Picture Size (Aspect Ratio) Control...............66 Preset Picture Settings (Picture mode).......68 Manual Picture Adjustment - User Mode... 69 Picture Improvement Technology (Advanced Control).................................................................. 70 Picture Reset........................................................ 73 SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL Auto Volume......................................................... 74 Clear Voice II........................................................ 75 Balance.................................................................. 76 Preset Sound Settings (Sound Mode)......... 77 Sound Setting Adjustment - User Mode.... 78 Audio Reset.......................................................... 79 TV Speakers On/Off.......................................... 79 Audio Language ............................................... 80 On-screen Menus Language Selection........ 81 Caption Mode - Analog Broadcasting System Captions....82 - Digital Broadcasting System Captions......83 - Caption Option.................................................84 TIME SETTING Clock Setting - Auto Clock Setup............................................85 - Manual Clock Setup.......................................86 Auto On/Off Time Setting............................... 87 Sleep Timer Setting...........................................88 Auto Shut-Off Setting.......................................88 PARENTAL CONTROL / RATINGS Set Password & Lock System - Setting up Your Password.............................89 - Set Password....................................................90 - Lock System....................................................... 91 Channel Blocking................................................92 Movie & TV Rating.............................................93 Downloadable Rating.........................................96 External Input Blocking..................................... 97 APPENDIX Troubleshooting...................................................98 Maintenance.......................................................100 Product Specifications....................................100 IR Code................................................................ 102 Open Source License...................................... 103 7 FEATURE OF THIS TV ꔛ Some of these features are not available on all models. High-definition television. Highresolution digital television broadcast and playback system composed of roughly a million or more pixels, 16:9 aspect-ratio screens, and AC3 digital audio. A subset of digital television, HDTV formats include 1080i and 720p resolutions. A unique invisible speaker system tuned by renowned audio expert, Mr. Mark Levinson. Speakers are embedded in strategic spots behind the front cabinet and use minute vibrations to turn the entire front bezel into the speaker system. The result s a clean, polished look, and enhanced audio by increasing the “sweet spot”, giving a wider and richer sound field. Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. “Dolby “and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories. HDMI, the HDMI logo and HighDefinition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC." View videos and photos and listen to music on your TV through USB 2.0 (‘videos’ dependent on model). Automatically enhances and amplifies the sound of human voice frequency range to help keep dialogue audible when background noise swells. IMPORTANT INFORMATION TO PREVENT “IMAGE BURN / BURN-IN” ON YOUR TV SCREEN ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ 8 When a fixed image (e.g. logos, screen menus, video game, and computer display) is displayed on the TV for an extended period, it can become permanently imprinted on the screen. This phenomenon is known as “image burn” or “burn-in.” Image burn is not covered under the manufacturer’s warranty. In order to prevent image burn, avoid displaying a fixed image on your TV screen for a prolonged period (2 or more hours for LCD, 1 or more hours for Plasma). Image burn can also occur on the letterboxed areas of your TV if you use the 4:3 aspect ratio setting for an extended period. PREPARATION ACCESSORIES Ensure that the following accessories are included with your TV. If an accessory is missing, please contact the dealer where you purchased the TV. The accessories included may differ from the images below. Owner’s Manual 1,5Vcc 1,5Vcc 1.5V 1.5V CD Manual PREPARATION 1.5V 1.5V 1,5Vcc 1,5Vcc Remote Control, Batteries (AAA) Protection Cover (Refer to P.15) Screw for stand fixing (Refer to P.19) Protective Bracket and 1.5V 1.5V Screw for Power Cord (Refer to P.17) x2 Power Cord Torx plus Star head screw (Refer to P.14) Option Extras Not included with all models * Wipe spots on the exterior only with the polishing cloth. Polishing Cloth * Do not wipe roughly when removing stains. Excessive pressure may cause scratches or discoloration. D-sub 15 pin Cable x4 (Other models) x4 (Except 26LD320H, 26LD340H, 26LD343H, 26LD345H) x8 x2 (M4 x 24) (M4 x 14) (M4 x 24) Screws for stand assembly (Refer to P.14) x2 x2 Screws for stand fixing (Refer to P.19) When using the VGA (D-sub 15 pin cable) PC connection, the user must use shielded signal interface cables with ferrite cores to maintain standards compliance. x2 LD320H, LD325H, LD333H, LD340H, LD343H, LD345H Series (For LD333H, LD343H series) 1,5Vcc 1,5Vcc (Except 26LD320H, 26LD340H, 26LD343H, 26LD345H) x2 Power Cord Holder (Refer to P.17) Cable Holder x2 x2 x2 x2 Washers for stand fixing (Refer to P.19) x2 LD310H, LD330H Series x4 x2 Nuts for stand fixing (Refer to P.19) x2 Rubbers for stand fixing (Refer to P.19) x4 x2 (M4 x 24) Screws for stand assembly (Refer to P.14) Cable Holder Power Cord Holder (Refer to P.17) 9 PREPARATION FRONT PANEL INFORMATION ꔛ Image shown may differ from your TV. PREPARATION CH VOL CH ENTER CHANNEL (▲,▼) Buttons MENU INPUT VOL SPEAKER Remote Control Sensor Power/Standby Indicator ENTER VOLUME (+, -) Buttons ENTER Button MENU MENU Button INPUT INPUT Button POWER Button 10 BACK PANEL INFORMATION AC IN Image shown may differ from your TV. PREPARATION USB IN ꔛ 8 2 AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) AC IN AV IN 1 L/MONO AUDIO R VIDEO GAME CONTROL RGB IN (PC) /DVI IN 1 SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y PB VIDEO 6 2 12 L AUDIO (CONTROL & SERVICE) AV IN 1 RGB IN (PC) 4VIDEO 5 11 L/MONO AUDIO R 2 AV IN 2 1 RS-232C IN UPDATE /DVI IN RJP AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) REMOTE CONTROL OUT 2 AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) /DVIIN 1 (SERVICE ONLY) Y PB PR VIDEO Y AUDIO COMPONENT IN R ANTENNA/ CABLE IN AV IN 1 VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R GAME CONTROL RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) L VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R RESET AV IN 2 R COMPONENT INRS-232C IN OPTICAL DIGITAL 32/37/42LD320H, 32/37LD325H AUDIO OUT 1 PR TV - LINK CFG 5 IN 3 REMOTE CONTROL OUT VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R UPDATE H/P (SERVICE ONLY) USB IN RESET VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R RS-232C IN RJP USB IN 10 PB L PR VIDEO AUDIO TV - LINK CFG M.P.I. 14 15 AV IN 2 R COMPONENT IN 7 3 ANTENNA IN 9 13 AC IN 6 2 12 4 5 11 RS-232C IN RESET UPDATE (SERVICE ONLY) RJP REMOTE CONTROL OUT 2 AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) /DVIIN 1 AV IN 1 VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO GAME CONTROL/ TV - LINK M.P.I. CFG 7 ANTENNA IN AV IN 2 R COMPONENT IN 3 VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R 1 USB IN 32/37/42LD340H, 32/37/42LD343H, 32/37/42LD345H 14 9 15 13 11 PREPARATION 32/37LD310H PREPARATION 1 6 2 4 5 11 RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE REMOTE CONTROL OUT 2 AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) /DVIIN 1 AV IN 1 VIDEO ANTENNA IN M.P.I. 14 15 L/MONO AUDIO R RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y PB L PR VIDEO AUDIO R COMPONENT IN 7 3 32/37LD330H, 32/37LD333H 1 6 2 4 5 11 RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE REMOTE CONTROL OUT 2 AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) /DVIIN 1 ANTENNA IN AV IN 1 VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R M.P.I. RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO R 14 COMPONENT IN 3 12 7 15 AC IN 2 12 5 11 14 4 RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE RJP REMOTE CONTROL OUT 2 /DVIIN 1 AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) ANTENNA IN AV IN 1 VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R GAME CONTROL/ TV - LINK M.P.I. CFG RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R 6 PREPARATION 1 USB IN 26LD320H, 26LD340H, 26LD343H, 26LD345H AV IN 2 R COMPONENT IN 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 HDMI/DVI IN, HDMI IN Digital Connection. Supports HD video and Digital audio. Doesn’t support 480i. Accepts DVI video using an adapter or HDMI to DVI cable (not included). RGB IN (PC) Analog PC Connection. Uses a D-sub 15 pin cable (VGA cable). AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) 0.32 cm (1/8 inch) headphone jack for analog PC audio input. SPEAKER OUT (8Ω) Connect to external speaker input. RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) Used by third party devices. This port is used for service or Hotel mode. AV (Audio/Video) IN Analog composite connection. Supports standard definition video only (480i). UPDATE Enables/disables software downloads and debug mode. RESET Performs a hardware reset. 9 15 7 8 13 COMPONENT IN Analog Connection. Supports HD. Uses a red, green, and blue cable for video & red and white for audio. USB INPUT Used for viewing videos, photos and listening to MP3s. 9 GAME CONTROL Control port 10 Power Cord Socket For operation with AC power. Caution: Never attempt to operate the TV on DC pwer. 11 REMOTE CONTROL OUT IR output for controlling an auxiliary device. RJP (REMOTE JACK PACK PORT) Connect to remote jack pack control output port. 12 13 TV - LINK CFG Used for FTG Configuration 14 ANTENNA IN Connect over the air signals th this jack. 15 M. P. I. Control port. 13 PREPARATION STAND INSTRUCTIONS ꔛ Image shown may differ from your TV. PREPARATION INSTALLATION 1 Carefully place the TV screen side down on a cushioned surface to protect the screen from damage. AC IN CABLE MANAGEMENT AC IN CABLE MANAGEMENT 2 Assemble the parts of the STAND BODY with the STAND BASE of the TV. (Except LD310H, LD330H series) (For LD333H, LD343H series) M4X20 (Other models) x4 x4 M4 x 24 M4 x 14 3 STAND BODY STAND BASE Assemble the TV as shown. AC IN CABLE MANAGEMENT AC IN CABLE MANAGEMENT AC IN CABLE MANAGEMENT 4 x4 M4 x 24 Tighten the stand with the four screws (provided as parts of the TV). or Tighten the two of these four screws and the two Torx plus star head screws (provided as parts of the TV) to secure the TV. Tighten the two Torx plus star head screws with a star head driver bit (not provided as parts of the TV). x2 ! ? 14 x2 ! NOTE ► When assembling the desk type stand, make sure the screws are fully tightened (If not tightened fully, the TV can tilt forward after the product installation). Do not over tighten. ? ꔛ Image shown may differ from your TV. PREPARATION DETACHMENT Carefully place the TV screen side down on a cushioned surface to protect the screen from damage. 1 AC IN CABLE MANAGEMENT AC IN 2 Remove the screws from the TV. AC IN AC IN CABLE MANAGEMENT AC IN CABLE MANAGEMENT CABLE MANAGEMENT 3 Detach the stand from TV. AC IN AC IN CABLE MANAGEMENT AC IN CABLE MANAGEMENT CABLE MANAGEMENT PROTECTION COVER After removing the stand, install the included PROTECTION COVER over the hole for the stand. Press the PROTECTION COVER into the TV until you hear it click. When installing the wall mounting bracket, use the PROTECTION COVER. 15 PREPARATION VESA WALL MOUNTING PREPARATION Install your wall mount on a solid wall perpendicular to the floor. When attaching to other building materials, please contact your nearest installer. If installed on a ceiling or slanted wall, it may fall and result in severe personal injury. We recommend that you use an LG brand wall mount when mounting the TV to a wall. LG recommends that wall mounting be performed by a qualified professional installer. VESA (A * B) Model 32LD310H, 26LD320H, 32LD320H, 32LD325H, 32LD330H, 32LD333H, 26LD340H, 32LD340H, 26LD343H, 32LD343H, 26LD345H, 32LD345H 37LD310H, 37LD320H, 42LD320H, 37LD325H, 37LD330H, 37LD333H, 37LD340H, 42LD340H, 37LD343H, 42LD343H, 37LD345H, 42LD345H ! ? ! ? B A Standard Screw Quantity Wall Mounting Bracket (sold separately) LSW100B, LSW100BG 200 * 100 M4 4 LSW200B, LSW200BG 200 * 200 M6 4 ! NOTE ► Screw length needed depends on the wall mount used. For further information, refer to the instructions included with the mount. ? Standard dimensions for wall mount kits are ► shown in the table. ► When purchasing our wall mount kit, a detailed installation manual and all parts necessary for ! assembly are provided. ► Do not use screws longer than the standard dimension, as they may cause damage to the inside to the TV. ► For wall mounts that do not comply with the ? VESA standard screw specifications, the length of the screws may differ depending on their specifications. ► Do not use screws that do not comply with the VESA standard screw specifications. Do not use fasten the screws too strongly, this may damage the TV or cause the TV to a fall, leading to personal injury. LG is not liable for these kinds of accidents. ► LG is not liable for TV damage or personal injury when a non-VESA or non specified wall mount is used or the consumer fails to follow the TV installation instructions. CAUTION ► Do not install your wall mount kit while your TV is turned on. It may result in personal injury due to electric shock. 16 CABLE MANAGEMENT ꔛ Image shown may differ from your TV. Connect the cables as necessary. To connect additional equipment, see the EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP section. Secure the power cord with the PROTECTIVE BRACKET/SCREW or the POWER CORD HOLDER. It will help prevent the power cable from being removed by accident. PREPARATION 1 or PROTECTIVE BRACKET/SCREW 2 POWER CORD HOLDER Install the CABLE MANAGEMENT CLIP as shown. If your TV has the CABLE HORDER, install it as shown and bundle the cables. CABLE HORDER CABLE MANAGEMENT CLIP 3 Put the cables inside the CABLE MANAGEMENT CLIP and snap it closed. 17 PREPARATION DESKTOP PEDESTAL INSTALLATION ꔛ Image shown may differ from your TV. For proper ventilation, allow a clearance of 10.1 cm (4 inch) on all four sides from the wall. PREPARATION 10.1 cm (4 inch) ! ! ? ? 10.1 cm (4 inch) 10.1 cm (4 inch) 10.1 cm (4 inch) CAUTION ► Ensure adequate ventilation by following the clearance recommendations. ► Do not mount near or above any type of heat source. SWIVEL STAND After installing the TV, you can adjust the TV set manually to the left or right direction by 90 º to suit your viewing position. KENSINGTON SECURITY SYSTEM ꔛ This feature is not available for all models. -T he TV is equipped with a Kensington Security System connector on the back panel. Connect the Kensington Security System cable as shown below. - For the detailed installation and use of the Kensington Security System, refer to the user’s guide provided with the Kensington Security System. For further information, contact http://www.kensington.com, the internet homepage of the Kensington company. Kensington sells security systems for expensive electronic equipment such as notebook PCs and LCD projectors. NOTE: The Kensington Security System is an optional accessory. 18 ATTACHING THE TV TO A DESK ꔛ Image shown may differ from your TV. Stand PREPARATION The TV must be attached to a desk so it cannot be pulled in a forward/backward direction, potentially causing injury or damaging the product. 1-Screw (provided as parts of the product) Desk LD320H, LD325H, LD333H, LD340H, LD343H, LD345H Series TYPE 1 or 4-Screws (not provided as parts of the product) 2 SCREW SET (SCREW/ WASHER/ NUT INCLUDED) 4-Screws (not provided as parts of the product) ► Screw: M5 x L (*L: Table depth + 8~10 mm) ex) Table depth: 15mm, Screw: M5 x 25 Stand Desk 19 PREPARATION TYPE 2 or PREPARATION 2 SCREW SET (SCREW/ WASHER/ NUT INCLUDED) 2-Washers, 2-Nuts, 2-Screws, 4-Rubbers (provided as parts of the product) 2-Screws, 2-Washers, 2-Nuts, 4-Rubbers (provided as parts of the product) Stand Desk ! ! NOTE ► You can select any type of attachment (Type 1 or Type 2). ? ► Do not over tighten. ? LD310H, LD330H Series Stand ! ! ? ? 4-Screws (not provided as parts of the product) Desk ► Screw: M5 x L (*L: Table depth + 8~10 mm) ex) Table depth: 15mm, Screw: M5 x 25 WARNING ► To prevent TV from falling over, the TV should be securely attached to the floor/wall per installation instructions. Tipping, shaking, or rocking the machine may cause injury. 20 SECURING THE TV TO THE WALL TO PREVENT FALLING WHEN THE TV IS USED ON A STAND ꔛ We recommend that you set up the TV close to a wall so it cannot fall over if pushed backwards. Additionally, we recommend that the TV be attached to a wall so it cannot be pulled in a forward direction, potentially causing injury or damaging the product. Caution: Please make sure that children don’t climb on or hang from the TV. ꔛ Insert the eye-bolts (or TV brackets and bolts) to tighten the product to the wall as shown in the picture. * If your product has the bolts in the eye-bolts position before inserting the eye-bolts, loosen the bolts. * Insert the eye-bolts or TV brackets/bolts and tighten them securely in the upper holes. Secure the wall brackets with the bolts (sold separately) to the wall. Match the height of the bracket that is mounted on the wall to the holes in the product. Ensure the eye-bolts or brackets are tightened securely. ꔛ ! ? PREPARATION ꔛ You should purchase necessary components to prevent the TV from tipping over (when not using a wall mount). Image shown may differ from your TV. Use a sturdy rope (sold separately) to tie the product. It is safer to tie the rope so it becomes horizontal between the wall and the product. ! NOTE ► Use a platform or cabinet strong enough and large enough to support the size and weight of the TV. ► To ? use the TV safely make sure that the height of the bracket on the wall and the one on the TV are the same. 21 IN 4 ꔛ ANTENNA OR CABLE CONNECTION Multi-family Dwellings/Apartments ꔡ (Connect to wall antenna socket) WIRELESS 1 RS-232C IN IN 4 IN (PC) Wall Antenna Socket or Outdoor Antenna without a Cable RGB Box Connections. 3 LAN RGB/DVI OPTICAL DIGITAL For optimum picture quality, adjust antenna direction if2 needed. (SERVICE ONLY) VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R AUDIO IN AUDIO OUT AC IN 2 /DVI IN Y CONTROL CABLE MANAGEMENT PB PR R L 1 AUDIO VIDEO AV IN 1 COMPONENT IN PREPARATION USB IN 1 AV IN 2 1. Antenna (Analog or Digital) Wall Antenna Socket L/MONO AUDIO R CABLE MANAGEMENT USB INVIDEO 2 AC IN To prevent damage do not connect to the power outlet until all connections are made between the devices. Image shown may differ from your TV. ANTENNA/ CABLE IN VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R H/P ꔛ H/P PREPARATION AV IN 2 Outdoor Antenna (VHF, UHF) RF Coaxial Wire (75 Ω) Single-family Dwellings /Houses (Connect to wall jack for outdoor antenna) LAN WIRELESS CONTROL (SERVICE ONLY) RGB/DVI OPTICAL DIGITAL VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R AUDIO IN AUDIO OUT 2 /DVI IN Y PB PR L R 1 VIDEO AUDIO AV IN 1 COMPONENT IN 2. Cable 1 RS-232C IN Be careful not to bend the copper wire when connecting the antenna. 3 2 ꔡ Copper Wire RGB IN (PC) ANTENNA/ CABLE IN Cable TV Wall Jack RF Coaxial Wire (75 Ω) ꔛ ꔛ 22 If the antenna needs to be split for two TV’s, install a 2-Way Signal Splitter. For much more information about antennas visit our Knowledgebase at http://lgknowledgebase. com. Search for antenna. EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP ꔛ To prevent the equipment damage, never plug in any power cords until you have finished connecting all equipment. ꔛ This part of EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP mainly use picture of for 32/37/42LD320H. HD RECEIVER SETUP This TV can receive digital over-the-air/digital cable signals without an external digital set-top box. However, if you do receive digital signals from a digital set-top box or other digital external device. Component Connection EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP 1. How to connect 1 Connect the video outputs (Y, PB, PR) of the digital set-top box to the COMPONENT IN VIDEO jacks on the TV. Match the jack colors (Y = green, PB = blue, and PR = red). 2 Connect the audio output of the digital set-top box to the COMPONENT IN AUDIO jacks on RESET the TV. Y 2. How to use ꔛ ꔛ UPDATE RJP PR 1 1 RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) L R 2 IN RS-232C (SERVICE ONLY) REMOTE CONTROL OUT 2 /DVI IN Turn on the digital set-top box. (Refer to the owner’s manual for the digital settop box operation.) Select the Component input source on the TV using the INPUT button on the remote control. PB AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) Y PB PR VIDEO L AUDIO R COMPONENT IN Y, CB/PB, CR/PR Resolution Horizontal Frequency(kHz) Vertical Frequency(Hz) 15.73 59.94 15.73 60.00 31.47 59.94 31.50 60.00 720x480i 720x480p RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) 1280x720p EMOTE ONTROL UT UDIO IN RGB/DVI) PB VIDEO AV IN 1 VIDEO 1920x1080i L/MONO AUDIO R GAME CONTROL PR L AUDIO R 1920x1080p COMPONENT IN 44.96 59.94 45.00 60.00 33.72 59.94 33.75 60.00 TV - LINK 26.97 23.976 27.00 24.00 33.71 29.97 33.75 30.00 67.432 59.94 67.50 60.00 CFG RJP RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE /DVIIN 2 REMOTE CONTROL OUT 1 AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO R COMPONENT IN HDMI OUTPUT RJP RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) 23 RESET UPDATE REMOTE CONTROL OUT 2 1 RGB IN (PC) AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R RESET UPDATE EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP RJP RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) REMOTE CONTROL OUT 2 /DVI IN 1 AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y PB PR VIDEO L AUDIO R COMPONENT IN HDMI Connection 1. How to connect 1 EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP RJP RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE No separate audio connection is necessary. HDMI supports both audio and video. 2 /DVIIN 2 REMOTE CONTROL OUT 1 AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y 2. How to use RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RJP ꔛ ! ? AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R PB Turn on the digital set-top box. L AUDIO R 1 to AV the IN 1owner’s manual for the digital setVIDEO ) L/MONO AUDIO R top box. AUDIO IN ꔛ Select the HDMI1 or HDMI2 GAME input source on the (RGB/DVI) CONTROL TV - LINK TV using the INPUT button on CFG the remote control. Y PB VIDEO PR L ! NOTE COMPONENT IN AUDIO HDMI OUTPUT R ► If an HDMI cable doesn’t support High Speed HDMI, it can cause flickers or no screen display. In this case ? use the latest cables that support High Speed HDMI. ► HDMI Audio Supported Format: Dolby Digital (32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz), Linear PCM (32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz) RJP RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE REMOTE CONTROL OUT AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R 2 /DVIIN HDMI-DTV Resolution 720x480p 1280x720p 1920x1080i 1920x1080p 24 PR VIDEO COMPONENT IN REMOTE (Refer CONTROL OUT RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT(8 ) Connect the digital set-top box to HDMI/DVI IN 1 or HDMI 2 jack on the TV. Horizontal Frequency(kHz) Vertical Frequency(Hz) 31.47 59.94 31.50 60.00 44.96 59.94 45.00 60.00 33.72 59.94 33.75 60.00 26.97 23.976 27.00 24.00 33.71 29.97 33.75 30.00 67.432 59.939 67.50 60.00 AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) RGB IN (PC) 1 SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO COMPONENT IN DVI OUTPUT L AUDIO R R OUT (8 ) Y RS-232C IN REMOTE CONTROL OUT AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) Y L AUDIO R AV IN 1 VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R GAME CONTROL RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT(8 ) PR COMPONENT IN (SERVICE ONLY) RJP PB VIDEO PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO TV - LINK CFG HDMI OUTPUT R COMPONENT IN DVI to HDMI Connection 1. How to connect RJP RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE 2 Connect the DVI output of the digital set-top box to the HDMI/DVI IN 1 jack on the TV. REMOTE CONTROL OUT /DVIIN AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) RGB IN (PC) 1 SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y Connect the digital set-top box audio output to the AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) jack on the TV. Turn on the digital set-top box. 1 2 (Refer to the owner’s manual for the digital ꔛ set-top box.) Select the HDMI1 input source on the TV using the INPUT button on the remote control. ! ! NOTE ? ► A DVI to HDMI cable or adapter is required for this connection. DVI doesn't support audio, so a separate ? audio connection is necessary. PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO COMPONENT IN 2. How to use ꔛ AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R 2 DVI OUTPUT L AUDIO R R EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP 1 25 EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP DVD SETUP Component Connection 1. How to connect EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP 1 Connect the video outputs (Y, PB, PR) of the DVD to the COMPONENT IN VIDEO jacks on the TV. Match the jack colors (Y = green, PB = blue, and PR = red). 2 Connect the audio outputs of the DVD to the COMPONENT IN AUDIO jacks on the TV. RESET UPDATE 2. How to use ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ Turn on the DVD player, insert a DVD. /DVI IN Select the Component input source on the TV using the INPUT button on the remote control. Refer to the DVD player’s manual for operating instructions. Component Input ports Component ports on the TV RS-232C IN Y Y PB PR Video output ports AV IN 1 on DVD player L/MONO AUDIO R Y B-Y R-Y Y Cb Cr Y Pb Pr (SERVICE ONLY) AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) Y PB VIDEO VIDEO GAME CONTROL PR L AUDIO PB RJP PR 1 1 RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) Y PB PR VIDEO PB L AUDIO R COMPONENT IN RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE /DVIIN R (SERVICE ONLY) REMOTE CONTROL OUT 2 L 2 IN RS-232C RJP To get better picture quality, connect a DVD player to the component input ports as shown below. REMOTE CONTROL OUT Y 2 REMOTE CONTROL OUT 1 AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) PR RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R PB PR VIDEO L AUDIO R COMPONENT IN TV - LINK CFG HDMI OUTPUT R COMPONENT IN RJP RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE REMOTE CONTROL OUT AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R 2 /DVIIN 26 1 RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) Y PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO COMPONENT IN R OPTICAL AUDIO IN DIGITAL RGB/DVI AUDIO OUT RGB IN (PC) Y PB PR VIDEO L AUDIO R ANTENNA/ CABLE IN COMPONENT IN Composite (RCA) Connection RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) TE ROL IN VI) DEO HDMI OUTPUT 1. How to connect AV IN 1 VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R 1 L PR COMPONENT IN AUDIO GAME Connect the AUDIO/VIDEO jacks between TV CONTROL TV - LINK CFG and DVD. Match the jack colors (Video = yellow, Audio Left = white, and Audio Right = red) R 2. How to use ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ Y RJP REMOTE CONTROL OUT 2 /DVI IN 1 PR L (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE Turn on the DVD player, insert a DVD. Select the AV1 or AV2 input source on the TV using the INPUT button on the remote control. Refer to the DVD player's manual for operating instructions. PB RS-232C IN AV IN 1 L/MONO AUDIO R VIDEO AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y GAME CONTROL PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO TV - LINK CFG R COMPONENT IN RJP RS-232C IN RESET UPDATE 1 /DVI IN 1 RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) VIDEO HDMI Connection (SERVICE ONLY) REMOTE CONTROL OUT 2 L R EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP B AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) Y PB PR VIDEO L AUDIO COMPONENT IN R R AUDIO 1. How to connect 1 Connect the HDMI output of the DVD to the HDMI/DVI IN 1 or HDMI 2 jack on the TV. RJP RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE No separate audio connection is necessary. HDMI supports both audio and video. 2 /DVIIN 2 REMOTE CONTROL OUT 1 AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) 2. How to use RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RJP Select the HDMI1 or HDMI2 input source on the TV the INPUT button on the remote control. AV IN 1 L/MONO AUDIO Refer VIDEO to the DVD player's manual for operating R AUDIO IN instructions. GAME (RGB/DVI) CONTROL RGB IN (PC) ! ? PB VIDEO PR COMPONENT IN ! NOTE L AUDIO PR L AUDIO R 1 REMOTE using CONTROL OUT ꔛ Y PB VIDEO COMPONENT IN ꔛ SPEAKER OUT(8 ) Y AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R TV - LINK CFG HDMI OUTPUT R ► If an HDMI cable doesn’t support High Speed HDMI, it can cause flickers or no screen display. In this case ? use the latest cables that support High Speed HDMI. ► HDMI Audio Supported Format: Dolby Digital (32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz), Linear PCM (32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz) RJP RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE REMOTE CONTROL OUT AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R 2 /DVIIN 1 RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) 27 Y PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO COMPONENT IN R EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP VCR SETUP 1 (DVI) DC-IN 2 /DVI IN DC-IN /DVI IN Antenna Connection 1 (DVI) 1. How to connect EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP 1 2 RS-232C IN RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE) (CONTROL&SERVICE) OPTICAL OPTICAL AV IN AUDIO IN DIGITAL AUDIO IN DIGITAL AV IN RGB/DVI AUDIO OUTRGB/DVI L(MONO) VIDEOAUDIO OUT AUDIO VIDEOR L(MONO) AUDIO R Connect the RF antenna out socket RGB IN (PC) RGB IN (PC) of the VCR to the ANTENNA/ CABLE Y P VIDEO IN socket on the TV. B M. P. I IN ANTENNA IN ANTENNA YPR PBL PRR AUDIO VIDEO M. P. I 1 L AUDIO R ANT OUT COMPONENTCOMPONENT IN IN 2 ANT IN Connect the antenna cable to the RF antenna in socket of the VCR. ꔛ OUTPUT ANT IN SWITCH L AUDIO R OUTPUT SWITCH Wall Jack 2 2. How to use ꔛ S-VIDEO S-VIDEOL VIDEOR ANT OUTVIDEO AUDIO Set VCR output switch to 3 or 4 and then tune TV to the same channel number. Insert a video tape into the VCR and press PLAY on the VCR (Refer to the VCR owner’s manual). Antenna Composite (RCA) Connection 1. How to connect 1 RJP Connect the AUDIO/VIDEO jacks between TV RESET UPDATE RESET UPDATE and VCR. Match the jack colors (Video = yellow, Audio Left = white, and Audio Right = red) 2 2 2. How to use ꔛ ꔛ ! ? 28 /DVI IN 1 /DVI IN 1 REMOTE CONTROL OUT AUDIO IN RGB/DVI VIDEO SPEAKER ANT IN ANT OUT RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) REMOTE CONTROL AV IN 1 L/MONO AUDIO R OUT VIDEO AV IN 1 L/MONO AUDIO R AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) SPEAKER Y OUTP(8 B ) PR ►If you have a mono VCR, connect the audio cable from the VCR to the AUDIO L(MONO) jack of the TV. ? RS-232C IN (CONTROL&SERVICE) RGB IN (PC) RGB IN (PC) ) Insert a video tape into the VCR and pressOUT(8 PLAY on the VCR. (Refer to the VCR owner’s manual.) Select the AV1 or AV2 input source on the TV using the INPUT button on the remote control. ! NOTE RJP L AUDIO VIDEO COMPONENT IN R Y GAME CONTROL ANTENNA/ PB PR L AUDIO CABLE IN VIDEO R COMPONENT IN 1 S-VIDEO OUTPUT SWITCH VIDEO L R S-VIDEO ANT IN AUDIO ANT OUT OUTPUT SWITCH VIDEO L R AUDIO TV - LINK CFG OTHER A/V SOURCE SETUP 1. How to connect 1 2. How to use ꔛ ꔛ RJP RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE REMOTE CONTROL OUT 2 /DVI IN 1 RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) AV IN 1 L/MONO AUDIO R VIDEO AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) Y GAME CONTROL PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO TV - LINK CFG R COMPONENT IN Select the AV1 or AV2 input source on the TV using the INPUT button on the remote control. Operate the corresponding external equipment. 1 VIDEO L R Video Game Set EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP Connect the AUDIO/VIDEO jacks between TV and external equipment. Match the jack colors. (Video = yellow, Audio Left = white, and Audio Right = red) Camcorder 29 EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP USB CONNECTION 1. How to connect EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP 30 Connect the USB device to the USB IN jack on the side of TV. 2. How to use ꔛ After connecting the USB IN jack, you use the USB function. USB IN 1 or Memory Key PC SETUP VGA (D-Sub 15 Pin) Connection RS-232C IN RJP 1. How to connect RESET (SERVICE ONLY) UPDATE REMOTE CONTROL OUT 2 Connect the VGA output of the PC to the RGB IN (PC) jack on the TV. /DVI IN AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y GAME CONTROL PB PR VIDEO L AUDIO R COMPONENT IN 2 Connect PC audio output to the AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) jack on the TV. 2. How to use ꔛ ꔛ 1 2 RGB OUTPUT AUDIO Turn on the PC and the TV. Select the RGB-PC input source on the TV using the INPUT button on the remote control. EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP 1 1 TV - LINK CFG RS-232C IN RESET (CONTROL&SERVICE) UPDATE REMOTE CONTROL OUT 2 /DVI IN AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R AUDIO IN RGB/DVI RGB IN (PC) 1 Y SPEAKER OUT(8 ) DVI OUTPUT PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO COMPONENT IN R ANTENNA/ CABLE IN AUDIO 31 UPDATE SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y RS-232C IN PR L AUDIO R COMPONENT IN (SERVICE ONLY) RJP PB VIDEO EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP REMOTE CONTROL OUT AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) AV IN 1 VIDEO L/MONO AUDIO R GAME CONTROL RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT(8 ) Y PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO TV - LINK CFG HDMI OUTPUT R COMPONENT IN DVI to HDMI Connection 1. How to connect EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP 32 1 2 Connect the DVI output of the PC to the HDMI/DVI IN 1 jack on the TV. ꔛ RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) REMOTE CONTROL OUT AV IN VIDEO L(MONO) AUDIO R 2 /DVIIN AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) RGB IN (PC) 1 SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO COMPONENT IN Connect the PC audio output to the AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) jack on the TV. 2. How to use ꔛ RJP RESET UPDATE 1 2 Turn on the PC and the TV. Select the HDMI1 input source on the TV using the INPUT button on the remote control. DVI OUTPUT L AUDIO R R ! ! NOTE ? ►To get the the best picture quality, adjust the PC graphics card to 1920 x 1080 (Other models), 1360 x 768 (32LD310H, 26/32LD320H, 32LD325H, 32LD330H, 32LD333H, 26/32LD340H, 26/32LD343H, 26/32LD345H). ? ►In PC mode, there may be noise associated with the resolution, vertical pattern, contrast or brightness. If noise is present, change the PC output to another resolution, change the refresh rate to another rate or adjust the brightness and contrast on the PICTURE menu until the picture is clear. ►Avoid keeping a fixed image on the screen for a long period of time. The fixed image may become permanently imprinted on the screen. ►The synchronization input form for Horizontal and Vertical frequencies is separate. ►Depending on the graphics card, some resolution settings may not allow the image to be positioned on the screen properly. ►When selecting HDMI-PC, set the “Input Label - PC” in the OPTION menu. EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP ►Depending on the graphics card, DOS mode may not work if a HDMI to DVI Cable is in use. Supported Display Specifications (RGB-PC, HDMI-PC) Resolution Horizontal Frequency(kHz) Vertical Frequency(Hz) 640x350 31.468 70.09 720x400 31.469 70.08 640x480 31.469 59.94 800x600 37.879 60.31 1024x768 48.363 60.00 1280x768 47.776 59.87 1360x768 47.712 60.015 1280x1024 63.981 60.02 1600x1200 75.00 60.00 1920x1080 RGB-PC 66.587 59.934 1920x1080 HDMI-PC 67.50 60.00 Except 32LD310H, 26/32LD320H, 32LD325H, 32LD330H, 32LD333H, 26/32LD340H, 26/32LD343H, 26/32LD345H 33 EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP Screen Setup for PC mode Selecting Resolution EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP You can choose the resolution in RGB-PC mode. The Position, Phase, and Size can also be adjusted. You can choose this option only when the PC resolution is set to 1024X768, 1280X768 or 1360X768. PICTURE ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter SCREEN Resolution • Brightness 50 • Sharpness 70 • Color 60 • Tint 0 R G • Color Temp. 0 W C • Advanced Control • Picture Reset Auto Config. • Screen (RGB-PC) Position Size ꔠ ꔉ Phase Reset 1 2 3 4 5 34 MENU Select PICTURE. ENTER Select Screen (RGB-PC). ENTER Select Resolution. ENTER Select the desired resolution. ENTER ꔂ Move ꔑ 1024 x 768 □ 1280 x 768 □ 1360 x 768 � Prev. Auto Configure Automatically adjusts picture position and minimizes image instability. After adjustment, if the image is still not correct, try using the manual settings or a different resolution or refresh rate on the PC. ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Brightness 50 Resolution • Sharpness 70 Auto Config. • Color 60 • Tint 0 R G • Color Temp. 0 W C • Advanced Control • Picture Reset • Screen (RGB-PC) Position Size ꔂ Move � Prev. Auto Config. Yes No Phase ꔠ ꔉ Reset 1 2 3 4 5 MENU Select PICTURE. ꔛ ꔛ ENTER Select Screen (RGB-PC). ENTER Select Auto Config.. ENTER Select Yes. ENTER EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP SCREEN PICTURE If the position of the image is still not correct, try Auto adjustment again. If picture needs to be adjusted again after Auto adjustment in RGB-PC, you can adjust the Position, Size or Phase. Start Auto Configuration. 35 EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP Adjustment for screen Position, Size, and Phase If the picture is not clear after auto adjustment or if text is shaking, adjust the picture phase manually. This feature operates only in RGB-PC mode. EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP PICTURE ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter SCREEN ꔂ Move � Prev. Resolution • Brightness 50 • Sharpness 70 • Color 60 • Tint 0 R G • Color Temp. 0 W C • Advanced Control • Picture Reset Auto Config. • Screen (RGB-PC) Position ◀ ▲ ▼ ▶ Size ꔠ ꔉ Phase Reset 1 2 3 MENU Select PICTURE. ENTER Select Screen (RGB-PC). ENTER Select Position, Size, or Phase. ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ 4 5 36 ENTER ENTER Make appropriate adjustments. Position: This function is to adjust picture to left/right and up/down as you prefer. Size: This function is to minimize any vertical bars or stripes visible on the screen background. And the horizontal screen size will also change. Phase: This function allows you to remove any horizontal noise and clear or sharpen the image of characters. Screen Reset (Reset to original initial values) Returns Position, Size, and Phase to the default initial settings. This feature operates only in RGB-PC mode. ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter ꔂ Move � Prev. Resolution • Brightness 50 • Sharpness 70 • Color 60 • Tint 0 R G • Color Temp. 0 W C • Advanced Control • Picture Reset Auto Config. • Screen (RGB-PC) Position Size ꔠ ꔉ Phase To Set Yes No EXTERNAL EQUIPMENT SETUP SCREEN PICTURE Reset 1 2 3 4 5 MENU Select PICTURE. ENTER Select Screen (RGB-PC). ENTER Select Reset. ENTER Select Yes. ENTER Start Reset. 37 WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL REMOTE CONTROL FUNCTIONS When using the remote control, aim it at the remote control sensor on the TV. The remote control may differ from the images below. POWER ALARM WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL TIMER INPUT TV Set the time that the TV will automatically turn itself on.. Select the amount of time before your TV turns off automatically. Rotates through inputs. Also switches the TV on from standby. Returns to the last TV channel. ALARM TIMER — (DASH) FLASHBK 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 FLASHBK INFO Used to enter a program number for multiple program channels such as 2-1, 2-2, etc. Tunes to the last channel viewed. MENU Displays the main menu or clears all on-screen displays and return to TV viewing. SAP Analog mode: Selects MTS sound (Mono, Stereo, or a SAP) DTV mode: Changes the audio language. Navigates the on-screen menus and adjusts the system settings to your preference. RETURN Allows the user to move return one step in an interactive application or other user interaction function. EXIT VOL PORTAL CH MUTE MENU GUIDE CC ENTER RETURN SAP EXIT Select a closed caption. THUMBSTICK (Up/Down/Left Right/ENTER) GUIDE INPUT TV NUMBER button CC 38 Turns the TV on from standby or off to standby. EJECT RATIO Show Channel schedule. Clears all on-screen displays and return to TV viewing. P A G E INFO PORTAL MUTE Adjusts the volume. Displays channel information at the bottom of the screen. Displays and removes the hotel interactive menu. Switches the sound on or off. CHANNEL UP/DOWN Changes the channel. PAGE UP/DOWN Moves from one full set of screen information to the next one. COLOR BUTTON VCR/DVD control buttons Access special functions in some menus. WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL VOLUME UP/DOWN Control video cassette recorders or DVD players. EJECT Eject the USB device. RATIO Change the aspect ratio. Installing Batteries ꔛ Open the battery compartment cover on the back side and install the batteries matching correct polarity. ꔛ Install two 1.5V AAA batteries. Don’t mix old or used batteries with new ones. ꔛ Close cover. 39 WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL TURNING ON THE TV 1 WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL ! First, connect power cord correctly. At this moment, the TV switches to standby mode. ꔛ In standby mode to turn TV on, press the / I button on the TV or press the button on the remote control. 2 Select the viewing source by using the INPUT button on the remote control. 3 When finished using the TV, press the reverts to standby mode. (POWER) button on the remote control. The TV ! NOTE ► If you intend to be away on vacation, disconnect the power plug from the wall power outlet. ? ? CHANNEL SELECTION 1 Press the CH (ꕌor ꕍ) or NUMBER buttons to select a channel number. VOLUME ADJUSTMENT Adjust the volume to suit your personal preference. 40 (POWER) 1 Press the VOL (+ or -) button to adjust the volume. 2 If you want to switch the sound off, press the MUTE button. 3 You can cancel the Mute function by pressing the MUTE or VOL (+ or -) button. ON-SCREEN MENUS SELECTION Your TV's OSD (On Screen Display) may differ slightly from that shown in this manual. 1 2 3 MENU Display each menu. ENTER Select a menu item. CHANNEL EXIT ꔂ Move PICTURE ꔉ Enter ꔂ Move • Aspect Ratio : 16:9 • Manual Tuning • Picture Mode : Standard • Channel Edit • Backlight 70 • Contrast 100 • Brightness • Sharpness 70 • Color 50 • Tint 60 PICTURE • Channel Label ꔂ Move • Auto Volume : Off • Clear Voice II : Off �3 TIME ꔉ Enter ꔉ Enter 50 ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Clock • Balance 0 • Sound Mode : Standard • Infinite Sound: Off • Treble 50 • Bass 50 • Reset LOCK L ꔂ Move R TIME • Off Time : Off • On TIme : Off • Sleep Timer : Off • Auto Off : On OPTION ꔉ Enter • Demo Mode • Set Password LOCK Return to TV viewing. • Auto Tuning AUDIO AUDIO 4 Accept the current selection. • Lock System : On • Block Channel • Movie Rating • TV Rating-Children • TV Rating-General • Downloadable Rating • Input Block WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL CHANNEL ENTER : Off • Language • Caption OPTION : Off • Eject 41 WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL i.e) Input List ꔂ Move WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL TV AV 1 HDMI2 USB AV 2 Component RGB-PC HDMI1 INPUT ꕉ Exit For LD310H, LD320H, LD325H series MY MEDIA MY MEDIA Fl Photo List Music List Extra Contents For LD330H, LD333H, LD340H, LD343H, LD345H series MY MEDIA Photo List 42 Music List Extra Contents ꔉ Enter CUSTOMER SUPPORT Picture Test / Sound Test This function is a customer support function that can execute picture and sound tests. ꔑ Picture Test □ Sound Test ? Do you have a problem in this test screen? □ Product/Service Info. No □ Picture Test ꔑ Sound Test ? Do you have a sound problem in this screen? □ Product/Service Info. Close 1 MENU 2 3 4 RETURN EXIT RED Select Customer Support. ENTER Select Picture Test or Sound Test. ENTER Select Yes. Yes No WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL Yes Close Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. 43 WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL Product/Service Info. This function shows support and product information. Customer Service Center can differ by country. □ Picture Test □ Sound Test WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL ꔑ Product/Service Info. Close 1 MENU 2 3 RETURN EXIT 44 RED Select Customer Support. ENTER Select Product/Service Info.. You can check the various product/Service infomation based on your model. Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. CHANNEL SETUP Auto Scan (Auto Tuning) Automatically finds all channels available through antenna or cable inputs, and stores them in memory on the channel list. Run this function if you change your residence or move the TV. Auto Tuning memorizes only the channels available at the time. ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Auto Tuning • Manual Tuning ꔉ ꔡ CHANNEL ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Auto Tuning • Manual Tuning • Channel Edit • Channel Edit • Channel Label • Channel Label Antenna Cable Check your antenna connection. The previous channel information will be updated during Auto Tuning. Start Close 1 2 3 4 MENU Select CHANNEL. ENTER Select Auto Tuning. ENTER Select Start. ENTER 5 RETURN EXIT WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL CHANNEL Run Auto tuning. Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. 45 WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL Add/Delete Channel (Manual Tuning) When selecting DTV or Cable DTV input signal in Manual Tuning, you can view the on-screen signal strength monitor to see the quality of the signal being received. CHANNEL ꔉ Enter WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL • Auto Tuning • Manual Tuning • Channel Edit CHANNEL ꔂ Move • Auto Tuning ꔉ ꔀ • Channel Label • Manual Tuning • Channel Edit • Channel Label ꔉ Enter ◀ ▶ DIGITAL Select channel type and RF-channel number. Channel 2 DTV 2-1 • Signal Strength • Signal Quality 88% 88% Add Close 1 2 3 MENU Select CHANNEL. ENTER Select Manual Tuning. ꔛ ꔛ Select DIGITAL, or ANALOG. ENTER 4 Select channel you want to add or delete. 5 ENTER 6 RETURN EXIT 46 ꔂ Move Select Add or Delete. Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. The TV will ask for a password if parental control has been activated (LOCK Menu). Use the password you set up in the LOCK Menu to allow a channel search. The maximum number of channels the TV can store is 900. Channel Editing The channels in the Channel Edit List are displayed in black and the channels deleted from the Channel Edit List are displayed in blue. When a channel number is deleted, it means that you will be unable to select it using CH∧∨button during TV viewing. If you wish to select the deleted channel, directly enter the channel number with the NUMBER buttons or select it in the Channel Edit menu. Channel Edit ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Auto Tuning • Channel Edit • Channel Label DIGITAL • Manual Tuning 2 3 MENU Select CHANNEL. ENTER Select Channel Edit. ENTER Select a channel. 4 BLUE YELLOW ENTER CH P A G E 5 RETURN EXIT ꔉ ꔀ ꔉ CH.Change 1 Page 1/1 ANALOG ꔂ Navigation ꘃ Page Change ꕉ Return ꔅ Block/Unblock ꔅ Add/Delete WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL CHANNEL Add or delete a channel. Block or unblock the channel. You can block/unblock channels even if you select “Lock system-Off” in the LOCK menu. Switch to the chosen channel number. Move the pages when the channel list is too long. Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. 47 WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL INPUT LIST Only these input signals which are connected to a TV can be activated and selected. ie) Input List WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL TV AV 1 HDMI2 USB AV 2 Component RGB-PC ꔉ Enter HDMI1 ꕉ Exit 1 ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ 48 ꔂ Move INPUT ENTER Select the desired input source. TV: Select it to watch over-the-air, cable and digital cable broadcasts. AV: Select them to watch a VCR or other external equipment. Component: Select them to watch DVD or a Digital set-top box. RGB-PC: Select it to view PC input. HDMI: Select them to watch high definition devices. EXAMPLE ELECTRONIC PROGRAM GUIDE This is an example of a typical TV electronic program guide showing available programming. CHANNEL INDICATOR Currently tuned channel and program. PROGRAMMING GRID Program listings arranged in time slots. DATE/TIME OSD Shows current Date/Time. TV PROGRAM Current program on selected channel. K&M Kids Movies Channel 01:30 AM Mon. 29 May 2009 11:07 2:30 AM 17 XYZ On The Political Scene 18 K&M Kids Movies 19 PQX Top Fashions 20 WBD World Events Today 2:45 AM 3:00 AM Kids ... Kids ... WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL Kids New Release Greatest Hits EVENT CHANNEL SELECTION PORTAL INFO ENTER CHANNEL LIST Shows available channels in numerical order. 1 2 GUIDE PROGRAM TITLES Highlight a title and press Enter to display additional program information. FEATURED ATTRACTION Highlight and click to get expanded information. Select GUIDE button to shows available TV programs. ENTER Select a Channel. 49 WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL CHANNEL LABEL Choose preset labels for your channels. If a channel label is provided on the signal from the broadcasting station, the TV displays a short name for a channel even if you didn’t preset a label for the channel. CHANNEL ꔉ Enter CHANNEL • Auto Tuning • Auto Tuning • Manual Tuning • Manual Tuning WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL • Channel Edit • Channel Label ꔠ ꔉ • Channel Edit • Channel Label ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter Channel Logo ◀ DIGITAL 15-3 No Logo Close 1 2 3 MENU Select CHANNEL. ENTER Select Channel Label. ENTER Select a Channel. 4 Select a channel to set logo. 5 Select the appropriate logo for the channel. 6 RETURN EXIT 50 ꔂ Move Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. ▶ DEMO MODE Displays a slide show to explain the various feature of this TV. OPTION • Demo Mode ꔂ Move : ꔉ Enter OPTION ꔉ ꔡ • Language • Caption 3 • Eject MENU Select OPTION. ENTER Select Demo Mode. ENTER Select On to show the various feature of the TV. 4 EXIT • Caption : Off ꔉ Enter □ Off ꔑ On WATCHING TV / CHANNEL CONTROL 2 ꔂ Move : Off • Language : Off • Eject 1 • Demo Mode Return to TV viewing. After a while, Demo Mode. starts. If you want to stop the demo, press any button (Except VOL +, - and MUTE button). 51 MY MY MEDIA MEDIA CONNECTION METHOD USB Connection USB IN 1 Connect the USB device to the USB IN jack on the side of TV. IN 3 Memory Key H/P MY MEDIA 52 or Precautions when using the USB device MY MEDIA ►Only a USB storage device is recognizable. ►Connecting a USB storage device through a USB hub is not supported. ►A USB storage device which uses its own driver may not be recognized. ►The recognition speed of a USB storage device may depend on each device. ► Please do not turn off the TV or unplug the USB device when the connected USB storage device is working. When such device is suddenly separated or unplugged, the stored files or the USB storage device may be damaged. ►Only use a USB storage device which has normal music files, image files, or movie files. ►Please use only a USB storage device which was formatted as a FAT 32 or NTFS file system provided with the Windows operating system. Others may not be recognized. ►Some USB storage devices require a power adapter. The power adapter must be connected in order to be seen by the TV. ►If a device is not recognized by the TV, try a different cable. Excessively long cables are not supported. ►Some USB storage devices may not be supported or operate properly. ►Please backup important files because data on USB device could be damaged. Data management is consumer's responsibility and as a result, the manufacturer does not cover data damage. ►If your USB memory device has multiple partitions, or if you use a USB multi-card reader, you can use up to 4 partitions or USB memory devices. ►In case of USB storage devices formatted as NTFS, deletion is not supported. ►File alignment method of USB storage device is similar to Window XP and file names can be up to 100 English characters. ►The recommended capacity is 1TB or less for a USB external hard disk and 32 GB or less for USB memory. ►If a USB external hard disk with a “Energy Saving” function doesn’t work, turn the hard disk off and on again to make it work properly. Refer to the user manual of the USB external hard disk. ►USB storage devices below USB 2.0 are supported as well. But they may not work properly in the movie list. 53 MY MEDIA ENTRY MODE The My Media menu will open automatically when you insert a USB drive. My Media can also be accessed by choosing My Media in the user menu. On USB device, you can not add a new folder or delete the existing folder. For LD310H, LD320H, LD325H series For LD330H, LD333H, LD340H, LD343H, LD345H series MY MEDIA MY MEDIA Fl Photo List MY MEDIA 1 2 3 54 Music List Extra Contents MENU Select MY MEDIA. ENTER Select Photo List, Music List, or Extra Contents. ENTER Photo List ꔛ Music List Extra Contents This TV can view JPG image files or play MP3 audio files. PHOTO LIST The On-Screen Display on your model may be slightly different. Supported photo file: *.JPG ꔛ Baseline: 64 pixel (width) x 64 pixel (height) to 15360 pixel (width) x 8640 pixel (height) ꔛ Progressive: 64 pixel (width) x 64 pixel (height) to 1920 pixel (width) x 1440 pixel (height) ꔛ You can play JPEG files only. ꔛ Non-supported files are displayed in the form of predefined icon. Screen Components 1 2 3 4 5 2 Select MY MEDIA. MENU Moves to upper level folder. Current page/total pages. Corresponding buttons on the remote control. Contents under the folder focused on 1 . Current page/total pages of contents. ENTER Select Photo List. ENTER 1 2 Page 1/1 Photo List USB 1 XTICK Drive1 P1 P2 P3 P4 Page 1/1 P5 P6 1 To Music List 2 3 Change Numbers1 2 3 Mark Mode 4 5 6 4 5 6 7 8 9 7 8 9 1 0 4 11 44 2 77 5 7 8 1 22 55 3 88 60 0 9 P7 P8 5 P9 4 � Move 1 MY MEDIA 1 1 2 3 7 8 9 �4 View � Page Change 5 6 0 Exit 0 3 Move to Music List. 33Change Numbers: Changes the number or thumbnails displayed at a time. 66 Allows you to mark certain files. 99 Return to TV viewing. 0 55 MY MEDIA Photo Selection 1 Page 1/1 Photo List USB 1 XTICK Drive1 Page 1/1 � Move MY MEDIA 1 To Music List 1 2 3 Change Numbers1 2 3 4 5 6 4 5 6 7 8 9 7 8 9 0 Mark Mode 1 2 7 8 2 ENTER 3 ENTER 3 �4 View 5 6 � Page Change 0 Select the target folder or drive. ꔛ 9 Exit Select the desired photos. Photo file is displayed. Use the CH (ꕌꕍ) button to navigate in the photo page. 0 Mark Mode 1 Page 1/1 Photo List Mark Mode Drive1 USB 1 XTICK Select the target folder or drive. Page 1/1 2 3 � Move 1 View Marked 1 2 3 Mark All 1 2 3 4 5 6 4 5 6 7 8 9 7 8 9 0 1 Unmark All � Mark 4 Exit Mark Mode 1 2 3 8 9 �5 Page Change 6 4 7 View Marked: Display the selected photo. 2 3Mark All: Mark all photos on the screen. 7 8 35 68 4 90 6Unmark All: Deselect all marked photos. 4 24 57 0 56 9 ENTER 1 Select the desired photo files. Mark your desired photo files. View the marked photo files. 0 1 1 4 0 Exit ENTER Exit the Mark Mode. ꔛ When one or more photos are marked, you can view individual photos or a slide show of the marked photos. If no photos are marked, you can view all photos individually or all photos in the folder in a slide show. Full Screen Menu More operations are available in full screen mode. Page 1/1 Photo List USB 1 XTICK Drive1 Page 1/1 � Move 1 Numbers 1 2 Change 3 2 3 Mark Mode 4 5 6 4 5 6 7 8 9 7 8 9 0 2 7 8 0 3 6� Page Change 9 MY MEDIA 1 To Music List 1 � View 4 5 Exit 0 01_a.jpg 2008/12/10 1920 x 1080 479 KB ◀ ▶ ◀ Slideshow � 1 BGM � � � 2/13 ▶ Option Hide 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 Select the target folder or drive. 2 ENTER 3 ENTER 0 The aspect ratio of a photo may change the size of the photo displayed on the screen in full size. 9 Exit ꔛ Use the CH (ꕌꕍ) button to navigate in the photo page. Select the desired photos. The selected photo is displayed in full size. 57 4 01_a.jpg 2008/12/10 1920 x 1080 479 KB ENTER Select the Slideshow, ◀ BGM, � (Rotate), ▶ � (Zoom In), Option, or Hide. ꔛ ◀ MY MEDIA ▶ MY MEDIA Slideshow � BGM � � � 2/13 Option 1 ▶ Hide 2 4 5 7 8 0 3 6 Use < > button to select the previous or next photo. 9 Exit ► Slideshow: Selected photos are displayed during the slide show. If no photo is selected, all photos in the current folder are displayed during slide show. ꔛ Set the time interval of the slide show in Option-Set Photo View. menu. ► BGM (Background Music): Listen to music while viewing photos in full size. ꔛ Set the BGM device and album in Option-Set Photo View. menu. ► � (Rotate): Rotate photos. ꔛ Rotates the photo 90 °, 180 °, 270 °, 360 ° clockwise. ꔛ Photos cannot be rotated if its width is greater than the available supported resolution height. ► � (Zoom In): View the photo by zoom in 2, 4 times by using 1 key button. ► Option: Set values for Slide Speed and Music Album. ꔛ You cannot change Music Album while BGM is playing. ꔛ You can only select the MP3 folder saved on the device that currently displays the photo. ► Hide: Hide the menu on the full-sized screen. ꔛ To see the menu again on the full-sized screen, press ENTER button to display. ► Exit: Move to the previous menu screen. 58 Using the Photo List Function 01_a.jpg 2008/12/10 1920 x 1080 479 KB Choose options. Set Photo View. ◀ ▶ Set Video. Set Audio. Close Slideshow � 1 BGM � � 2/13 � 1 ▶ Option Hide 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ENTER Show the Option menu. 2 ENTER Select Set Photo View, Set Video, or Set Audio. 0 MY MEDIA ◀ Exit ! ? ! NOTE ► Option values changed in Photo List do not affect Music List. ? Set Photo View Menu Options Set Photo View. Slide Speed ◀ BGM Fast ▶ Drive1 • Repeat ◀ On ▶ • Random ◀ Off ▶ � Previous 1 2 Select Slide Speed or BGM. Make appropriate adjustments. 59 MY MEDIA ꔛ Image shown may differ from your TV. Set Video Menu Options Set Video. ◀ Picture Mode 1 MY MEDIA 2 ▶ • Backlight 70 ◀ ▶ • Contrast 100 ◀ ▶ • Brightness 50 ◀ ▶ • Color 60 ◀ ▶ • Dynamic Contrast ◀ Medium ▶ • Edge Enhancer ◀ High ▶ • Noise Reduction ◀ Medium ▶ 2 4 5 7 8 0 1 Standard 3 6 9 Picture Reset � Previous Select Picture Mode. Make appropriate adjustments. Set Audio Menu Options Set Audio. Sound Mode ◀ Standard ▶ Auto Volume ◀ Off ▶ Clear Voice II ◀ Off ▶ Balance 0 ◀ L R ▶ � Previous 1 2 60 Select Sound Mode, Auto Volume, Clear Voice II, or Balance. Make appropriate adjustments. MUSIC LIST This TV cannot play back copy-protected files. The On-Screen Display on your model may be slightly different. MUSIC (*.MP3) supporting file Bit rate 32 Kbps - 320 Kbps • Sampling rate MPEG1 Layer3: 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz, 48 kHz • Sampling rate MPEG2 Layer3: 16 kHz, 22.05 kHz, 24 kHz • Sampling rate MPEG2.5 Layer3: 8 kHz, 11.025 kHz, 12 kHz 1 Select MY MEDIA. MENU 2 ENTER Select Music List. ENTER 1 1 2 3 4 5 6 Preview: If any album jacket for the file (Album Art Image) exists, this picture is displayed. Moves to upper level folder. Current page/Total pages. Corresponding buttons on the remote control. Contents under the folder focused on 1 . Current page/total pages of contents. 4 1 4 2 7 5 7 8 1 2 5 3 8 6 0 9 2 Page 1/1 Music List Drive1 USB 1 XTICK 001. - B01.mp3 00:00 Page 1/1 002. - B02.mp3 00:00 003. - B03.mp3 00:00 4 � Move 1 To Photo List 5 004. - B04.mp3 00:00 005. - B05.mp3 00:00 2 3 Mark Mode 4 5 6 4 5 6 7 8 9 7 8 9 1 Numbers 1 2 Change 3 0 1 MY MEDIA Screen Components 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 8 9 � Play � Page Change 0 Exit 0 3 Move to Photo List. 3Change Numbers: Changes the number or thumbnails displayed at a time. 6 Allows you to mark certain files. 9 Return to TV viewing. 0 61 MY MEDIA Music Selection Page 1/1 Music List Drive1 USB 1 XTICK 001. - B01.mp3 00:00 Page 1/1 002. - B02.mp3 00:00 003. - B03.mp3 00:00 004. - B04.mp3 00:00 005. - B05.mp3 00:00 � Move 1 To Photo List Numbers1 2 Change 3 4 5 6 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 7 8 9 1 9 1 2 7 8 1 2 ENTER 3 ENTER Select the desired music file. Music files are played. 3 � Play � Page Change 4 5 6 Mark Mode 0 9 Exit ꔛ 0 MY MEDIA 0 Select the target folder or drive. Use the CH (ꕌꕍ) button to navigate in the music page. Mark Mode 1 Page 1/1 Music List Mark Mode Drive1 USB 1 XTICK 001. - B01.mp3 00:00 002. - B02.mp3 00:00 Page 1/1 003. - B03.mp3 00:00 004. - B04.mp3 00:00 005. - B05.mp3 00:00 � Move 1 Play Marked 1 2 1 2 3 Unmark All 4 5 6 4 5 6 7 8 9 7 8 9 0 1 3 Mark All � Mark 4 Exit Mark Mode 1 2 3 7 8 9 �4 Page 5 6Change Play Marked: Play the selected songs. Once a song finishes playing, the next selected one will be played automatically. 3 Mark All: Mark all songs in the folder. 7 8 35 684 90 6 Unmark All: Deselect all marked song. 4 24 57 62 ENTER 3 ENTER 4 1 Select the desired music file. Mark your desired music file. Play the marked music file. 0 2 0 2 0 Exit 1 1 Select the target folder or drive. 9 Exit the Mark Mode. ꔛ When one or more music files are marked, the marked music files will be played in sequence. Using the Music List Function Page 1/1 Music List 3 file(s) Marked Drive1 Choose options. Page 1/1 Set Audio Play. � 001. - B01.mp3 00:00 002. - B02.mp3 00:00 002. - B02.mp3 � � � 004. - B04 .mp3 00:00 �� � � 003. - B03.mp3 00:00 � Play with Photo � 005. - B05 .mp3 00:00 02:30 / 03:25 Option Hide ENTER Show the Option menu. 2 ENTER Select Set Audio Play or Set Audio. Close 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 0 9 Exit ! ? ! NOTE MY MEDIA 1 � Set Audio. � ► Option values changed in Music List does not affect Photo List. ? You can listen to the music only within ► the device currently played. Using the remote control Stop playback. Return to normal playback. Paused playback. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 0 Select the previous or next song. A cursor indicating the position can be played on the screen. Move to the previous menu screen. 63 MY MEDIA Set Audio Play Menu Options Set Audio Play. Repeat ◀ On ▶ Random ◀ Off ▶ � Previous MY MEDIA 1 2 Select Repeat or Random. Make appropriate adjustments. Set Audio Menu Options Set Audio. Sound Mode ◀ Standard ▶ Auto Volume ◀ Off ▶ Clear Voice II ◀ Off ▶ Balance 0 ◀ L R ▶ � Previous 1 2 64 Select Sound Mode, Auto Volume, Clear Voice II, or Balance. Make appropriate adjustments. If you don't press any buttons for a while, the play information box will float across the screen. This prevents screen pixel damage due to a fixed image remaining on the screen for a extended period of time. ꔛ 002. B02.mp3 � 00:31 / 04:04 ? ! NOTE MY MEDIA ! ► Music files with copy-protection will not play. ► Press ENTER or � button to stop the screen saver. ? EXTRA CONTENTS Extra Contents will be activated when Data Channel service is available. You can play application files from USB device. Application file on your USB device can be played by this TV. For LD310H, LD320H, LD325H series MY MEDIA For LD330H, LD333H, LD340H, LD343H, LD345H series MY MEDIA Fl Photo List 1 2 ! ? Music List Extra Contents MENU Select MY MEDIA. ENTER ENTER Select Extra Contents. Photo List Music List Extra Contents ! NOTE ► Pro: Centric contents in USB memory stick can be played. ► For more information, contact to Customer Support. (www.lgcommercial.com) ? 65 PICTURE PICTURECONTROL CONTROL PICTURE SIZE (ASPECT RATIO) CONTROL This feature lets you choose the way an analog picture with a 4:3 aspect ratio is displayed on your TV. You can select a different aspect ratio depending on input source (analog broadcasting, digital broadcasting, aux). PICTURE PICTURE CONTROL 1 2 3 • Aspect Ratio : 16:9 • Picture Mode : Standard • Backlight • Contrast • Brightness � Enter : 16:9 : Standard 70 • Backlight 100 • Contrast 50 • Brightness ꔉ Enter 70 100 ꔑ 16:9 50 □ Just Scan • Sharpness 70 • Sharpness 70 □ Set By Program • Color 50 • Color 50 □ 4:3 • Tint 0 • Tint R G ENTER Select Aspect Ratio. ENTER Select the desired picture format. EXIT ꔂ Move • Picture Mode Select PICTURE. RETURN PICTURE • Aspect Ratio ꔉ ꔡ MENU 4 66 � Move Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. 0 □ Zoom ꔉ ꔡ 4:3 Adjust the picture horizontally, in a linear proportion to fill the entire screen. Choose 4:3 when you want to view a picture with an original 4:3 aspect ratio. Just Scan Zoom Normally the edges of video signals are cropped 1-2%. Just Scan turns off this cropping and shows the complete video. Notes: If there is noise on the edges of the original signal, it will be visible when Just Scan is activated. Just Scan operates only in DTV/Cable DTV/ C o m p o n e n t / H D M I - DT V/ D V I - DT V (720p/1080i/1080p) input source. Choose Zoom when you want to view the picture without any alteration. However, the top and bottom portions of the picture will be cropped. PICTURE CONTROL 16:9 Just Scan Set By Program Selects the proper picture proportion to match the source’s image. (4:3 4:3) Set By Program (16:9 16:9) Set By Program 67 PICTURE CONTROL PRESET PICTURE SETTINGS (PICTURE MODE) There are factory presets for picture settings available in the user menus. You can use a preset, change each setting manually. PICTURE PICTURE CONTROL 1 2 3 ꔂ Move • Aspect Ratio : 16:9 • Picture Mode : Standard • Backlight 70 • Contrast 100 • Brightness 50 • Sharpness 70 • Color 50 • Tint 0 ꔉ Enter ꔉ ꔀ R G PICTURE : 16:9 • Picture Mode : Standard • Backlight 70 • Contrast 100 • Brightness 50 • Sharpness 70 • Color 50 • Tint 0 MENU Select PICTURE. ENTER Select Picture Mode. ENTER Select Vivid, Standard, Cinema, Sport, or Game. 4 RETURN EXIT Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. ꔂ Move • Aspect Ratio ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ 68 ꔉ Enter □ Vivid ꔑ Standard □ Cinema ꔉ ꔀ □ Sport □ Game R G Vivid, Standard, Cinema, Sport, and Game Settings are preset for the optimum picture quality at the factory. Vivid: This is the mode to maximize the effect of the video in the retail store. Strengthen the contrast, brightness, color and sharpness for vivid picture. Standard: This is the mode to realize optimum viewing condition for the general user. Cinema: This mode optimizes video for watching movies. Sport: This is the video mode to emphasize dynamic video and primary color (e.g, white, uniform, grass, sky blue etc.) by realizing the optimal screen for sports. Game: This is the mode to realize fast response speed in a fast gaming screen. MANUAL PICTURE ADJUSTMENT - USER MODE Adjust the picture appearance to suit your preference and viewing situations. PICTURE 2 3 4 5 • Aspect Ratio : 16:9 • Picture Mode : Standard • Backlight 70 • Contrast 100 • Brightness 50 • Sharpness 70 • Color 50 • Tint 0 ꔉ Enter ꔉ ꔀ R ENTER Select Picture Mode. ENTER Select Vivid, Standard, Cinema, Sport, or Game. ENTER Select Backlight, Contrast, Brightness, Sharpness, Color, Tint, Color Temp., or Advanced Control. ENTER Make appropriate adjustments. ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ Return to the previous menu. ꔛ EXIT ▶ ꔉ Enter G Select PICTURE. RETURN 70 ◀ ꔡ MENU 6 ꔠ • Backlight Return to TV viewing. ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ Backlight: This function adjusts the brightness of the backlight behind the LCD screen. Adjusting the backlight is recommended when setting the brightness of the TV. When decreasing the backlight, the brightness of the black becomes darker without any loss in video signal and the power consumption is reduced. Contrast: Increase or decrease the gradient of the video signal. You may use Contrast when the bright part of the picture is saturated. Brightness: Adjusts the base level of the signal in the picture. You may use Brightness when the dark part of the picture is saturated. Sharpness: Adjusts the level of crispness in the edges between the light and dark areas of the picture. The lower the level, the softer the image. Color: Adjusts intensity of all colors. Tint: Adjusts the balance between red and green levels. Color Temp.: Set to warm to enhance hotter colors such as red, or set to cool to enhance cooler colors such as blue. PICTURE CONTROL 1 ꔂ Move 69 PICTURE CONTROL PICTURE IMPROVEMENT TECHNOLOGY (ADVANCED CONTROL) Advanced Control allows you to adjust some of the advanced features of your LG display. To reset to the factory default after making adjustments to each input source, execute the Picture Reset function for each Picture Mode. PICTURE ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter ꔂ Move • Brightness • Sharpness • Brightness 70 • Sharpness 70 • Color 60 • Color • Tint 0 R G • Tint • Color Temp. 0 W C • Advanced Control • Picture Reset ꔉ ꔀ • Screen (RGB-PC) • Screen (RGB-PC) ꔉ Enter 70 Dynamic Contrast 70 Dynamic Color 60 R ◀ G 0 W White C Clear • Color Temp. 0 Skin Color • Advanced Control Noise Reduction • Picture Reset Off 0 Off Digital Noise Reduction PICTURE CONTROL Low Eye Care Low ꔍ Close 3 MENU Select PICTURE. ENTER Select Advanced Control. ENTER Select your desired menu option. 4 Make appropriate adjustments. 5 RETURN EXIT Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. Off Medium Black Level 1 Low Off Gamma 2 70 PICTURE ▶ *This feature is not available for all models. ꔛ Adjusts the contrast to keep it at the best level according to the brightness of the screen. The picture is improved by making bright parts brighter and dark parts darker. ꔛ Adjusts screen colors so that they look livelier, richer and clearer. This feature enhances hue, saturation and luminance so that red, blue and green white look more vivid. Skin Color ꔛ It detects the skin area of video and adjusts it to express a natural skin color. Noise Reduction ꔛ Reduces screen noise without compromising video quality. Digital Noise Reduction ꔛ Removes noise caused by compressing video. Dynamic Contrast Dynamic Color Gamma You can adjust brightness of dark areas and middle gray level areas of the picture. Low : Make brighter and middle gray level areas of the picture brighter. Medium : Express original picture levels. High: Make dark and middle gray level areas of the picture darker. Black Level Low: The reflection of the screen gets darker. High: The reflection of the screen gets brighter. Auto: Realizing the black level of the screen and set it to High or Low automatically. ꔛ Set black level of the screen to proper level. ꔛ This function is available in the following modes: AV (NTSC-M), HDMI or Component. Otherwise, “Black level” is set to “Auto”. Clear White ꔛ Make the white area of screen brighter and more white. ꔛ Adjust the brightness of the screen to prevent the screen from being too bright. Dims extremely bright pictures. This feature is enabled in “Picture Mode-Standard, Sports, Game”. ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ Real Cinema ꔛ PICTURE CONTROL Eye Care Makes video clips recorded in film look more natural by eliminating judder effect. DVD and Blu-ray movies are filmed at 24 frames per second (fps). With LG Real Cinema, every frame is consistently processed 5 times in 1/24 of a second producing 120 fps with TruMotion or 2 times in 1/24 of a second producing 48 fps without TruMotion, thus totally eliminating the judder effect. Advanced Control ꔛ Maximize the utilization of colors to increase color quality. Standard: Displays standard set of colors. Wide: Increase number of colors used. Color Gamut Expert Control ꔛ Displays color domain of the signal. Standard: Displays standard set of colors. Wide: Increase number of colors used. EBU: Mode to display EBU standard color area. SMPTE: Mode to display SMPTE standard color area. BT709: Mode to display BT709 standard color area. 71 PICTURE CONTROL ꔛ xvYCC PICTURE CONTROL 72 ꔛ ꔛ This is produces richer colors. This feature represents rich color as much as conventional video signal. This function is enabled in "Picture Mode - Cinema, Expert" when a xvYCC signal is inputted through HDMI. PICTURE RESET Settings of the selected picture modes return to the default factory settings. PICTURE ꔂ Move • Brightness 70 • Sharpness 70 picture settings ? • All Color 60 will be reset. Continue? • Tint 0 R G • Color Temp. 0 W Yes • Advanced Control • Picture Reset • Screen (RGB-PC) 2 3 4 MENU Select PICTURE. ENTER Select Picture Reset. ENTER Select Yes. ENTER EXIT C No ꔉ ꔀ PICTURE ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Brightness 70 • Sharpness 70 • Color 60 • Tint 0 R G • Color Temp. 0 W C • Advanced Control i Resetting video configuration... • Picture Reset • Screen (RGB-PC) PICTURE CONTROL 1 ꔉ Enter Initialize the adjusted value. Return to TV viewing. 73 SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL AUTO VOLUME Auto Volume makes sure that the volume level remains consistent whether you are watching a commercial or a regular TV program. Because each broadcasting station has its own signal conditions, volume adjustment may be needed every time the channel is changed. This feature allows users to enjoy stable volume levels by making automatic adjustments for each program. AUDIO ꔂ Move • Auto Volume : Off • Clear Voice II : Off � 3 • Balance SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL 74 1 2 3 ꔉ ꔡ 0 • Auto Volume : On • Clear Voice II : Off � 3 • Balance 0 ꔑ On • Sound Mode : Standard • Infinite Sound: Off • Infinite Sound: Off • Treble 50 • Treble 50 • Bass 50 • Bass 50 • Reset • Reset Select Auto Volume. ENTER Select On or Off. Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. ꔉ Enter □ Off : Standard ENTER EXIT R ꔂ Move Select AUDIO. RETURN L AUDIO • Sound Mode MENU 4 ꔉ Enter L R ꔠ ꔉ CLEAR VOICE II By differentiating the human sound range from others, it improves the sound quality of voices. AUDIO ꔂ Move • Auto Volume : Off • Clear Voice II : Off � 3 • Balance 1 3 : Standard ꔉ ꔀ 0 L R • Auto Volume : Off • Clear Voice II : Off � 3 • Balance • Infinite Sound: Off • Infinite Sound: Off • Treble 50 • Treble 50 • Bass 50 • Bass 50 • Reset • Reset ENTER Select Clear Voice II. ENTER Select On or Off. Adjustment for Clear Voice Level with selecting On Select Level. ꔉ Enter • Clear Voice II L 0• Level : Standard Select AUDIO. 5 ꔂ Move • Sound Mode MENU 4 AUDIO R ◀ �3 - Off ▶ + Close SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL 2 • Sound Mode ꔉ Enter Make appropriate adjustments. 6 RETURN EXIT Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. 75 SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL BALANCE Adjust the left/right sound of speaker to suit your taste and room situations. AUDIO ꔂ Move SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL 76 2 3 : Off • Auto Volume : Off : Off � 3 • Clear Voice II : Off � 3 0 L ꔀ R ꔉ : Standard • Sound Mode : Standard • Infinite Sound: Off • Infinite Sound: Off • Treble 50 • Treble 50 • Bass 50 • Bass 50 • Reset • Reset Select Balance. ENTER Make appropriate adjustments. Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. ꔉ Enter • Balance 0 ◀ L R 0 ꔉ ENTER EXIT • Balance • Sound Mode Select AUDIO. RETURN ꔂ Move • Clear Voice II MENU 4 AUDIO • Auto Volume • Balance 1 ꔉ Enter Close L R ▶ PRESET SOUND SETTINGS (SOUND MODE) Sound Mode lets you enjoy the best sound without any special adjustment using factory presets. AUDIO ꔂ Move 3 ꔂ Move : Off • Auto Volume : Off • Clear Voice II : Off � 3 • Clear Voice II : Off � 3 0 L R ꔉ ꔀ • Balance • Sound Mode : Standard • Infinite Sound: Off • Sound Mode : Standard • Treble 50 • Bass 50 • Bass • Reset • Reset • Treble Select AUDIO. ꔛ ENTER Select Sound Mode. ꔛ ENTER Select Standard, Music, Cinema, Sport, or Game. RETURN EXIT Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. ꔑ Standard L □0 Music ꔉ R ꔡ □ Cinema • Infinite Sound□ : Off Sport MENU 4 ꔉ Enter ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ 50 Game □ 50 Standard, Music, Cinema, Sport, and Game are preset for optimum sound quality at the factory. You can also adjust Sound Mode in the Q.MENU. Standard: Offers standard-quality sound. Music: Optimizes sound for listening to music. Cinema: Optimizes sound for watching movies. Sport: Optimizes sound for watching sports events. Game: Optimizes sound for playing games. SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL 2 AUDIO • Auto Volume • Balance 1 ꔉ Enter 77 SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL SOUND SETTING ADJUSTMENT - USER MODE Adjust the sound to suit your taste and room situations. AUDIO ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter AUDIO ꔂ Move • Auto Volume : Off • Auto Volume : Off • Clear Voice II : Off � 3 • Clear Voice II : Off � 3 • Balance 0 L R • Balance 0 ꔉ Enter L R • Sound Mode : Standard • Sound Mode • Infinite Sound: Off • Infinite Sound • Infinite Sound: Off • Treble 50 • Treble • Bass 50 • Bass • Reset • Reset ꔉ ꔀ : Standard 50 • Treble 50 • Bass Off 50 ◀ ▶ 50 Close 1 SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL 2 3 4 MENU ꔛ ENTER Select Sound Mode. ENTER Select Standard, Music, Cinema, Sport, or Game. ENTER ꔛ Select Infinite Sound, Treble, or Bass. ꔛ 5 ENTER 6 RETURN EXIT 78 Select AUDIO. Make appropriate adjustments. Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. If sound quality or volume is not at the level you want, it is recommended to use a separate home theater system or amp to cope with different user environments. If you select “Clear Voice II-On”, the Infinite Sound feature will not operate. Infinite Sound: Infinite Sound is a patented LG proprietary sound processing technology that strives immersive 5.1 surround sound with just two front speakers. AUDIO RESET Settings of the selected Sound Mode return to the default factory settings. AUDIO • Clear Voice II ꔂ Move : Off � 3 • Balance L • Balance R 0 : Standard • Infinite Sound:Off • Treble • Bassi • Reset • TV Speaker : On • Bass Yes 50 • Reset No ꔉ ꔀ : On MENU Select AUDIO. ENTER Select Reset. ENTER Select Yes. 4 ENTER EXIT L R 50 50 audio configuration... Resetting Initialize the adjusted value. Return to TV viewing. TV SPEAKERS ON/OFF SETUP If you wish to use an external Hi-Fi system, turn off the TV’s internal speakers. AUDIO • Clear Voice II ꔂ Move 2 3 AUDIO : Off � 3 • Balance 1 ꔉ Enter • Sound Mode : Standard ꔂ Move • Clear Voice II 0 L : Off � 3 • Balance R 0 • Sound Mode : Standard • Infinite Sound:Off • Infinite Sound:Off • Treble 50 • Treble 50 • Bass 50 • Bass 50 • Reset • Reset • TV Speaker : On • TV Speaker : On MENU Select AUDIO. ENTER Select TV Speaker. ENTER Select On or Off. ꔠ ꔉ 4 RETURN EXIT ꔉ Enter L R SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL 3 0 ꔉ Enter : Off � 3 • Sound Mode • TV Speaker 2 ꔂ Move • Clear Voice II • Sound Mode : Standard ? All audio settings will be resetted. • Infinite Sound:Off Continue? • Treble 50 1 AUDIO ꔉ Enter □ Off ꔑ On ꔠ ꔉ Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. 79 SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL AUDIO LANGUAGE This feature operates only in DTV/Cable DTV mode. OPTION • Demo Mode ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter : Off • Language • Caption : Off • Eject SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL 1 2 3 MENU Select OPTION. ENTER Select Language. ENTER Select Audio Language. 4 Select your desired language. 5 RETURN EXIT 80 Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. OPTION • Demo Mode ꔉ ꔀ ꔂ Move : Off • Language • Caption • Eject : Off ꔉ Enter Menu Language English Audio Language ◀ English ▶ Close ON-SCREEN MENUS LANGUAGE SELECTION The menus can be shown on the screen in the selected language. OPTION • Demo Mode ꔂ Move : Off : Off • Eject 2 3 MENU Select OPTION. ENTER Select Language. ENTER Select Menu Language. Select your desired language. From this point on, the on-screen menus will be shown in the selected language. 4 5 RETURN EXIT ꔂ Move : Off • Language • Caption • Eject : Off ꔉ Enter Menu Language ◀ English ▶ Audio Language English Close SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL 1 OPTION • Demo Mode ꔉ ꔀ • Language • Caption ꔉ Enter Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. 81 SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL CAPTION MODE Analog Broadcasting System Captions Captions are provided to help the hearing impaired watch TV. Select a caption mode for displaying captioning information if provided on a program. Analog caption displays information at any position on the screen and is usually the program's dialog. Caption/Text, if provided by the broadcaster, would be available for both digital and analog channels on the Antenna/Cable. This TV is programmed to memorize the caption/text mode which was last set when you turned the power off. This function is only available when Caption Mode is set On. OPTION • Demo Mode ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter : Off ꔂ Move • Demo Mode • Language • Caption OPTION : Off • Language : Off ꔉ ꔀ • Eject • Caption : Off • Eject ◀ ꔉ Enter On Mode ▶ CC1 Digital Option Close SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL 1 2 3 MENU Select OPTION. ENTER Select Caption. ENTER Select On. 4 Select CC1-4 or Text1-4. 5 RETURN EXIT 82 Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ When selecting Off, Sub-menus for Analog, DTV, and Digital Option become disabled. Caption The term for the words that scroll across the bottom of the TV screen; usually the audio portion of the program provided for the hearing impaired. Text The term for the words that appear in a large black frame and almost cover the entire screen; usually messages provided by the broadcaster. Digital Broadcasting System Captions Choose the language you want the DTV/Cable DTV Captions to appear in. Other Languages can be chosen for digital sources only if they are included on the program. This function in only available when Caption Mode is set On. OPTION • Demo Mode ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter : Off • Demo Mode • Language • Caption OPTION ꔂ Move : Off • Language : Off ꔉ ꔀ • Eject • Caption • Eject : Off ◀ ꔉ Enter On Mode ▶ CC1 Digital Option Close 2 3 MENU Select OPTION. ENTER Select Caption. ENTER Select On. 4 Select CC1-4, Text1-4, or Service1 - 6. 5 RETURN EXIT SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL 1 Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. 83 SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL Caption Option Customize the DTV/Cable DTV captions that appear on your screen. This function in only available when Caption Mode is set On. ◀ OPTION • Demo Mode ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter Font 1 Text Color : Off ◀ • Eject On Mode ■ White Text Opacity ▶ Solid Bg Color CC1 Digital Option Close ▶ A Standard Font : Off • Language • Caption Custom Size ■ Black Bg Opacity Solid Edge Type None Edge Color ■ Black Close SOUND & LANGUAGE CONTROL 1 MENU ꔛ ꔛ 2 3 ꔛ ENTER ENTER 4 5 Select Caption. ꔛ Select On. Select Digital Option. ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ ENTER Select Custom. Customize the Size, Font, etc., to your preference. A preview icon is provided at the bottom of the screen, use it to see the caption language. 6 7 RETURN EXIT 84 Select OPTION. Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. ꔛ Size: Set the word size. Font: Select a typeface for the text. Text Color: Choose a color for the text. Text Opacity: Specify the opacity for the text color. Bg (Background) Color: Select a background color. Bg (Background) Opacity: Select the opacity for the background color. Edge Type: Select an edge type. Edge Color: Select a color for the edges. TIME SETTING CLOCK SETTING Auto Clock Setup The time is set automatically from a digital channel signal. The digital channel signal includes information for the current time provided by the broadcasting station. Set the clock manually if the current time is set incorrectly by the auto clock function. TIME ꔂ Move • Clock ꔉ Enter ꔉ • Off Time : Off • On TIme • Sleep Timer • Auto Off ꔡ TIME ꔂ Move • Clock ꔉ Enter ◀ Auto ▶ • Off Time : Off : Off • On TIme : Off : Off • Sleep Timer : Off Date 21 : On • Auto Off : On Year 2010 Hour 10 AM Month 02 Minute 10 Time Zone Eastern Daylight Saving Auto Close 2 3 MENU Select TIME. ENTER Select Clock. ENTER Select Auto. 4 TIME SETTING 1 Select your viewing area time zone. 5 Select Auto, Off, or On (depending on whether or not your viewing area observes Daylight Saving time). 6 RETURN EXIT Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. 85 TIME SETTING Manual Clock Setup If the current time setting is wrong, reset the clock manually. TIME ꔂ Move • Clock ꔉ Enter ꔉ • Off Time : Off • On TIme • Sleep Timer • Auto Off ꔡ TIME ꔂ Move • Clock ꔉ Enter ◀ Manual : Off : Off • On TIme : Off : Off • Sleep Timer : Off Date 21 : On • Auto Off : On Year 2010 Hour 10 AM Month 02 Minute 10 Time Zone Eastern Daylight Saving Auto Close TIME SETTING 1 2 3 MENU Select TIME. ENTER Select Clock. ENTER Select Manual. 4 Select the Year, Month, Date, Hour, or Minute option. 5 Set the Year, Month, Date, Hour, or Minute option. 6 RETURN EXIT 86 ▶ • Off Time Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. AUTO ON/OFF TIME SETTING This function operates only if the current time has been set. The Off Time function overrides the On Time function if they are both set to the same time. The TV must be in standby mode for the On Time to work. TIME ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Clock TIME ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Clock • Off Time : Off • On TIme : Off • Sleep Timer : Off • Sleep Timer • Auto Off : On • Auto Off ꔉ ꔀ ꔎ Feb. 21, 2010 10:10 AM • Off Time : Off • On TIme : 6:30 AM (Once) ꔉ Repeat : Off Hour : On Minute ◀ Once ▶ 6 AM 30 Close 2 3 MENU Select TIME. ENTER Select Off Time or On Time. ENTER Select Repeat. 4 TIME SETTING 1 Select Off, Once, Daily, Mon.~Fri., Mon.~Sat., Sat.~ Sun., or Sun.. 5 Select and set Hour or Minute. 6 RETURN EXIT Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. 87 TIME SETTING SLEEP TIMER SETTING The Sleep Timer turns the TV off at the preset time. Note that this setting is cleared when the TV is turned off. TIME ꔂ Move TIME ꔉ Enter • Clock ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Clock • Off Time : Off • Off Time : Off • On TIme : Off • On TIme : Off • Sleep Timer : Off • Sleep Timer : Off • Auto Off : On • Auto Off : On ꔉ ꔀ ꔑ Off ꔉ ꔡ □ 10 min. □ 20 min. □ 30 min. □ 60 min. □ 90 min. □ 120 min. □ 180 min. □ 240 min. 1 2 3 4 MENU Select TIME. ENTER Select Sleep Timer. ENTER Make appropriate adjustments. RETURN EXIT Return to TV viewing. ꔛ To cancel the Sleep Timer, select Off. TIME SETTING AUTO SHUT-OFF SETTING If set to on and there is no input signal, the TV turns off automatically after 15 minutes. TIME ꔂ Move TIME ꔉ Enter • Clock 1 2 3 88 Return to the previous menu. ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Clock • Off Time : Off • Off Time : Off • On TIme : Off • On TIme : Off • Sleep Timer : Off • Sleep Timer : Off • Auto Off : On • Auto Off : On MENU Select TIME. ENTER Select Auto Off ENTER Select On or Off. ꔠ ꔉ 4 RETURN EXIT □ Off ꔉ ꔑ Onꔡ Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. ꔠ ꔉ PARENTAL CONTROL / RATINGS Parental Control can be used to block specific channels, ratings and other viewing sources. The Parental Control Function (V-Chip) is used to block program viewing based on the ratings sent by the broadcasting station. The default setting is to allow all programs to be viewed. Viewing can be blocked by choosing the type of the program and the categories. It is also possible to block all program viewing for a time period. To use this function, the following must be done : 1. Set ratings and categories to be blocked. 2. Specify a password 3. Enable the lock V-Chip rating and categories Rating guidelines are provided by broadcasting stations. Most television programs and television movies can be blocked by TV Rating and/or Individual Categories. Movies that have been shown at the theaters or direct-to-video movies use the Movie Rating System (MPAA) only. Ratings for Television programs including made-for-TV movies: TV-G (General audience) TV-PG (Parental guidance suggested) ꔛ TV-14 (Parents strongly cautioned) ꔛ TV-MA (Mature audience only) ꔛ TV-Y (All children) ꔛ TV-Y7 (Children 7 years older) ꔛ ꔛ SET PASSWORD & LOCK SYSTEM Set up blocking schemes to block specific channels, ratings, and external viewing sources. A password is required to gain access to this menu. LOCK ꔂ Move • Set Password 1 2 MENU 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 8 9 0 ꔉ • Lock System : On • Block Channel • Movie Rating • TV Rating-Children • TV Rating-General • Downloadable Rating • Input Block ENTER ꔉ Enter Select LOCK. Input the password. ꔡ Enter Password * * * * Close ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ PARENTAL CONTROL / RATING Setting up Your Password Enter the password as requested. The TV is set up with the initial password “0-0-0-0”. If you forget your password, press “0-3-2-5” on the remote control. 89 PARENTAL CONTROL / RATINGS Set Password Change the password by inputting a new password twice. LOCK ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Set Password 1 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 : On ꔡ PARENTAL CONTROL / RATING 90 4 • Block Channel Confirm • Movie Rating • Movie Rating • TV Rating-Children • TV Rating-Children • TV Rating-General • TV Rating-General • Downloadable Rating • Downloadable Rating • Input Block • Input Block Select LOCK. Input the password. 1 2 5 6 8 9 0 5 RETURN EXIT 3 4 7 New • Block Channel Select Set Password. ENTER • Set Password : On 0 3 ꔂ Move • Lock System ENTER MENU ꔉ • Lock System LOCK Choose any 4 digits for your new password. As soon as the 4 digits are entered, re-enter the same 4 digits on the Confirm. Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. ꔉ Enter * * * * * * * * Close Lock System Enables or disables the blocking scheme you set up previously. LOCK ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Set Password 1 2 MENU 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 LOCK • Set Password ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Lock System : On • Block Channel □ Off : On ꔉ ꔑ On • Block Channel • Movie Rating • Movie Rating • TV Rating-Children • TV Rating-Children • TV Rating-General • TV Rating-General • Downloadable Rating • Downloadable Rating • Input Block • Input Block ENTER Select LOCK. ꔉ ꔀ • Lock System ꔛ ꔠ ꔉ When you select On, the Lock System is enable. Input the password. 0 3 ENTER 5 RETURN EXIT Select On or Off. Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. PARENTAL CONTROL / RATING 4 Select Lock System. 91 PARENTAL CONTROL / RATINGS CHANNEL BLOCKING Blocks any channels that you do not want to watch or that you do not want your children to watch. Block Channel LOCK ꔂ Move DIGITAL ꔉ Enter • Set Password • Lock System : On • Block Channel • Movie Rating • TV Rating-Children • TV Rating-General • Downloadable Rating • Input Block page 1/1 ꔉ ꔀ ꔉ CH.Change ꔂ Navigation ꘃ Page Change ꕉ Return ꔅ Block/Unblock 1 MENU 2 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 ENTER Select LOCK. Input the password. 0 3 4 PARENTAL CONTROL / RATING 92 Select Block Channel. ENTER 5 YELLOW 6 RETURN EXIT Select a channel to block or unblock. Block or unblock a channel. Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. ꔛ If a channel is locked, enter the password to unlock it temporarily. MOVIE & TV RATING Movie Rating (MPAA) Blocks movies according to the movie ratings limits specified, so children cannot view certain movies. You can set the ratings limit by blocking out all the movies with the ratings above a specified level. Keep in mind that the movie ratings limit only applies to movies shown on TV, not TV programs, such as soap operas. LOCK ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Set Password LOCK ꔂ Move • Set Password • Lock System : On • Block Channel • Movie Rating • TV Rating-Children • TV Rating-General • Downloadable Rating • Input Block ꔉ ꔀ • Lock System : On • Block Channel • Movie Rating ꔉ Enter Blocking off : Permits all programs G PG • TV Rating-Children PG-13 • TV Rating-General R • Downloadable Rating NC-17 • Input Block X Blocking Off ꔓ 1 2 MENU 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 8 9 ENTER Select LOCK. Input the password. 0 4 ꔛ ꔛ Select Movie Rating. ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ ENTER 5 Select G, PG, PG-13, R, NC-17, X, or Blocking Off. ꔛ ꔛ RETURN EXIT Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. ꔛ If Movie Rating, TV Rating-Children or TV Rating-General is locked, enter the password to unlock it temporarily. G (General audience) PG (Parental guidance suggested) PG-13 (Parents strongly cautioned) R (Restricted) NC-17 (No one 17 and under admitted) X (Adult only) Blocking Off (Permits all programs) If you set PG-13: G and PG movies will be available, PG-13, R, NC-17 and X will be blocked. PARENTAL CONTROL / RATING 3 ꔛ 93 PARENTAL CONTROL / RATINGS TV Rating Children revents children from watching certain children's TV programs, according to the ratings limit set. The P children rating does not apply to other TV programs. Unless you block certain TV programs intended for mature audiences in the TV Rating - sub menu, your children can view those programs. LOCK ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Set Password 1 2 MENU • Lock System : On • Block Channel • Block Channel • Movie Rating • Movie Rating • TV Rating-Children • TV Rating-Children • TV Rating-General • TV Rating-General • Downloadable Rating • Downloadable Rating • Input Block • Input Block ENTER 1 2 3 4 5 6 8 9 PARENTAL CONTROL / RATING 94 3 5 ꔉ ꔀ Select LOCK. Input the password. Select TV Rating-Children. ENTER Select Age or Fantasy Violence. ENTER Select block options. 6 RETURN EXIT ꔉ Enter • Set Password : On ꔛ ꔛ 7 ꔂ Move • Lock System 0 4 LOCK Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. Age ꔉ Fantasy Violence Close Age (applies to TV-Y, TV-Y7) Fantasy Violence (applies to TV-Y7) TV Rating General Based on the ratings, blocks certain TV programs that you and your family do not want to view. LOCK ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Set Password 1 2 MENU 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 LOCK ꔂ Move • Set Password • Lock System : On • Lock System : On • Block Channel • Block Channel • Movie Rating • Movie Rating • TV Rating-Children • TV Rating-General • Downloadable Rating • TV Rating-General Violence • Downloadable Rating • Input Block • Input Block ENTER ꔉ ꔀ Select LOCK. Input the password. ꔛ ꔛ 5 ꔛ Select TV Rating-General. ꔛ ENTER Select Age, Dialogue, Language, Sex, or Violence. ENTER Select block options. 6 RETURN EXIT Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. ꔉ Dialogue ꔛ Close Age (applies to TV-G,T V-PG,T V14,TV-MA). Dialogue-sexual dialogue (applies to TV-PG,TV-14). Language-adult language (applies to TV-PG, TV-14, TV-MA). Sex-sexual situations (applies to TV-PG, TV-14, TV-MA). Violence (applies to TV-PG, TV-14, TV-MA). PARENTAL CONTROL / RATING 4 Age Language • TV Rating-Children Sex 0 3 ꔉ Enter 95 PARENTAL CONTROL / RATINGS DOWNLOADABLE RATING This function is available only for digital channels. This function operates only when TV has received Region5 Rating data. LOCK ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Set Password LOCK ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter • Set Password • Lock System : On • Lock System : On • Block Channel • Block Channel • Movie Rating • Movie Rating • TV Rating-Children • TV Rating-General • Downloadable Rating • Input Block ꔉ Sport Cruelty • TV Rating-Children Language • TV Rating-General Sadness • Downloadable Rating Genre • Input Block Age ꔉ ꔀ Humor ꔍ Close ꔛ 1 PARENTAL CONTROL / RATING 2 MENU 1 2 5 6 8 9 Select LOCK. Input the password. 0 3 4 5 Select Downloadable Rating. ENTER Select desired Downloadable Rating option. ENTER Select desired option and block it. 6 RETURN EXIT 96 3 4 7 ENTER Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. ꔛ Based on rating table, your TV's OSD (On Screen Display) may differ slightly from what is shown in this manual. If a Downloadable rating is locked, enter the password to unlock it temporarily. EXTERNAL INPUT BLOCKING Enables you to block an input. LOCK ꔂ Move ꔉ Enter LOCK ꔂ Move • Lock System : On • Lock System • Block Channel • AV1 • Block Channel • Movie Rating • AV2 • Movie Rating • TV Rating-Children • TV Rating-General • TV Rating-Children • Component • Downloadable Rating • Input Block ꔉ ꔀ ꔉ Enter : On ◀ Off ▶ Off • TV Rating-General • RGB-PC • Downloadable Rating • HDMI1 • Input Block • HDMI2 Off Off Off Off Close i.e) 1 2 MENU 2 3 4 5 6 7 1 8 9 ENTER Select LOCK. Input the password. 0 4 Select Input Block. ENTER 5 Select input source. Select On or Off. 6 RETURN EXIT Return to the previous menu. Return to TV viewing. PARENTAL CONTROL / RATING 3 97 APPENDIX APPENDIX TROUBLESHOOTING Abnormal Operation ꔛ The remote control doesn’t work ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ TV turns off suddenly ꔛ ꔛ Check to see if there is any object between the product and the remote control causing obstruction. Ensure you are pointing the remote control directly at the TV. Ensure that the batteries are installed with correct polarity (+ to +, - to -). Ensure that the correct remote operating mode is set: TV, VCR etc. *This feature is not available for all models. Install new batteries. Is the sleep timer set? Check the power control settings. Power interrupted. Video Problems ꔛ ꔛ No picture &No sound ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ Picture appears slowly after switching on APPENDIX No or poor color or poor picture Poor reception on some channels Lines or streaks in pictures No picture when connecting HDMI 98 ꔛ This is normal, the image is muted during the product startup process. Please contact your service center, if the picture has not appeared after five minutes. ꔛ Adjust Color in menu option. Keep a sufficient distance between the product and the VCR. Try another channel. The problem may be with the broadcast. Are the video cables installed properly? Activate any function to restore the brightness of the picture. ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ ꔛ Horizontal/vertical bars or picture shaking Check whether the product is turned on. Try another channel. The problem may be with the broadcast. Is the power cord inserted into wall power outlet? Check your antenna direction and/or location. Test the wall power outlet, plug another product’s power cord into the outlet where the product’s power cord was plugged in. ꔛ Check for local interference such as an electrical appliance or power tool. ꔛ ꔛ Station or cable product experiencing problems, tune to another station. Station signal is weak, reorient antenna to receive weaker station. Check for sources of possible interference. ꔛ Check antenna (Change the direction of the antenna). ꔛ If an HDMI cable doesn’t support High Speed HDMI, it can cause flickers or no screen display. In this case use the latest cables that support High Speed HDMI. ꔛ Audio Problems No output from one of the speakers Unusual sound from inside the product No sound when connecting HDMI/USB ꔛ Adjust Balance in menu option. ꔛ A change in ambient humidity or temperature may result in an unusual noise when the product is turned on or off and does not indicate a fault with the product. ꔛ Check High Speed HDMI cable. Check USB cable over version 2.0. Use normal MP3 file. *This feature is not available for all models. ꔛ ꔛ PC Mode Problems The signal is out of range Vertical bar or stripe on background & Horizontal Noise & Incorrect position Screen color is unstable or single color ꔛ Adjust resolution, horizontal frequency, or vertical frequency on the PC. Check the input source. ꔛ Activate the Auto configure feature or adjust size, phase, or H/V position. (Option) ꔛ Check the signal cable. Reinstall the PC video card. ꔛ ꔛ Check the manual for the video card in the PC to see if it supports HDMI audio and how to set it up properly. APPENDIX When connecting the HDMI cable to the PC, there is no audio. ꔛ 99 APPENDIX MAINTENANCE Early malfunctions can be prevented. Careful and regular cleaning can extend the amount of time you can enjoy your new TV. Caution: Be sure to turn the power off and unplug the power cord before you begin any cleaning. Cleaning the Screen 1 Here’s a great way to keep the dust off your screen for a while. Wet a soft cloth in a mixture of lukewarm water and a little fabric softener or dish washing detergent. Wring the cloth until it’s almost dry, and then use it to wipe the screen. 2 Make sure the excess water is off the screen, and then let it air-dry before you turn on your TV. the Cabinet ! Cleaning ! ꔛ ꔛ ? To remove dirt or dust, wipe the cabinet with a soft, dry, lint-free cloth. Please be sure not to use a wet cloth. ? Extended Absence CAUTION ► If you expect to leave your TV dormant for a long time (such as a vacation), it’s a good idea to unplug the power cord to protect against possible damage from lightning or power surges. PRODUCT SPECIFICATIONS Power Requirement AC 100-240 V ~ 50 / 60 Hz APPENDIX Television System NTSC-M, ATSC, 64 & 256 QAM Program Coverage VHF 2-13, UHF 14-69, CATV 1-135, DTV 2-69, CADTV 1-135 External Antenna Impedance Environment condition 75 Ω Operating Temperature 0 °C to 40 °C (32 °F to 104 °F) Operating Humidity Less than 80 % Storage Temperature -20 °C to 60 °C (-4 °F to 140 °F) Storage Humidity 26LD343H (26LD343H-UA) 32LD333H (32LD333H-UA), 32LD343H (32LD343H-UA) With stand 667.0 mm x 492.0 mm x 206.8 mm (26.2 inch x 19.3 inch x 8.1 inch) 805.0 mm x 574.3 mm x 206.8 mm (31.6 inch x 22.6 inch x 8.1 inch) Without stand 667.0 mm x 446.2 mm x 80.0 mm (26.2 inch x 17.5 inch x 3.1 inch) 805.0 mm x 528.2 mm x 108.9 mm (31.6 inch x 20.7 inch x 4.2 inch) With stand 8.8 kg (19.4 lbs) 12.5 kg (27.5 lbs) Without stand 7.7 kg (16.9 lbs) 11.4 kg (25.1 lbs) 1.0 A / 100 W 1.2 A / 120 W MODELS Dimensions (Width x Height x Depth) Weight Current Value / Power consumption 100 Less than 85 % 42LD343H (42LD343H-UA) Dimensions (Width x Height x Depth) 922.0 mm x 660.2 mm x 260.8 mm (36.2 inch x 25.9 inch x 10.2 inch) 1028.0 mm x 716.6 mm x 260.8 mm (40.4 inch x 28.2 inch x 10.2 inch) 922.0 mm x 595.0 mm x 88.0 mm (36.2 inch x 23.4 inch x 3.4 inch) 1028.0 mm x 655.0 mm x 88.7 mm (40.4 inch x 25.7 inch x 3.4 inch) Weight With stand 14.8 kg (32.6 lbs) 17.1 kg (37.6 lbs) Without stand 13.0 kg (28.6 lbs) 15.3 kg (33.7 lbs) 1.7 A / 170 W 2.1 A / 210 W 26LD320H (26LD320H-UA), 26LD340H (26LD340H-UA), 26LD345H (26LD345H-UA) 32LD320H (32LD320H-UA), 32LD325H (32LD325H-UA), 32LD340H (32LD340H-UA), 32LD345H (32LD345H-UA) With stand 667.0 mm x 502.7 mm x 206.8 mm (26.2 inch x 19.7 inch x 8.1 inch) 805.0 mm x 585.0 mm x 206.8 mm (31.6 inch x 23.0 inch x 8.1 inch) Without stand 667.0 mm x 446.2 mm x 80.0 mm (26.2 inch x 17.5 inch x 3.1 inch) 805.0 mm x 528.2 mm x 108.9 mm (31.6 inch x 20.7 inch x 4.2 inch) With stand 9.4 kg (20.7 lbs) 13.1 kg (28.8 lbs) Without stand 7.7 kg (16.9 lbs) 11.4 kg (25.1 lbs) 1.0 A / 100 W 1.2 A / 120 W 37LD320H (37LD320H-UA), 37LD325H (37LD325H-UA), 37LD340H (37LD340H-UA), 37LD345H (37LD345H-UA) 42LD320H (42LD320H-UA), 42LD340H (42LD340H-UA), 42LD345H (42LD345H-UA) 922.0 mm x 650.0 mm x 260.8 mm (36.2 inch x 25.5 inch x 10.2 inch) 1028.0 mm x 706.4 mm x 260.8 mm (40.4 inch x 27.8 inch x 10.2 inch) 922.0 mm x 595.0 mm x 88.0 mm (36.2 inch x 23.4 inch x 3.4 inch) 1028.0 mm x 655.0 mm x 88.7 mm (40.4 inch x 25.7 inch x 3.4 inch) With stand 15.6 kg (34.3 lbs) 17.9 kg (39.4 lbs) Without stand 13.0 kg (28.6 lbs) 15.3 kg (33.7 lbs) 1.7 A / 170 W 2.1 A / 210 W 32LD310H (32LD310H-UA), 32LD330H (32LD330H-UA), 37LD310H (37LD310H-UA), 37LD330H (37LD330H-UA), With stand 805.0 mm x 583.0 mm x 223.8 mm (31.6 inch x 22.9 inch x 8.8 inch) 922.0 mm x 659.0 mm x 297.0 mm (36.2 inch x 25.9 inch x 11.6 inch) Without stand 805.0 mm x 528.2 mm x 108.9 mm (31.6 inch x 20.7 inch x 4.2 inch) 922.0 mm x 595.0 mm x 88.0 mm (36.2 inch x 23.4 inch x 3.4 inch) With stand 12.6 kg (27.7 lbs) 15.0 kg (33.0 lbs) Without stand 11.4 kg (25.1 lbs) 13.2 kg (29.1 lbs) 1.2 A / 120 W 1.7 A / 170 W With stand Without stand Current Value / Power consumption MODELS Dimensions (Width x Height x Depth) Weight Current Value / Power consumption MODELS Dimensions (Width x Height x Depth) Weight With stand Without stand Current Value / Power consumption MODELS Dimensions (Width x Height x Depth) Weight Current Value / Power consumption ꔛ APPENDIX 37LD333H (37LD333H-UA), 37LD343H (37LD343H-UA) MODELS The specifications shown above may be changed without prior notice for quality improvement. 101 APPENDIX IR CODE Code (Hexa) Function Note 00 CH ꕌ Remote Control Button B0 01 CH ꕍ Remote Control Button B1 02 VOL + Remote Control Button BA ꕖ ꕗ ꕘ 03 VOL - Remote Control Button D6 TV 06 > Remote Control Button 07 < Remote Control Button C4 POWER ON (Power On/Off) 09 MUTE Remote Control Button 0B INPUT Remote Control Button 0F TV Remote Control Button 10-19 Number 0-9 Remote Control Button 1A FLASHBK Remote Control Button AA INFO Remote Control Button 28 RETURN Remote Control Button E8 ALAM Remote Control Button 41 ꕌ ꕍ 43 MENU Remote Control Button 44 ENTER Remote Control Button 0E TIMER Remote Control Button APPENDIX 4C - (Dash) Remote Control Button EXIT Remote Control Button C3 or 61 BLUE Remote Control Button C2 or 63 YELLOW Remote Control Button C0 or 71 GREEN Remote Control Button C1 or 72 RED Remote Control Button 79 RATIO Remote Control Button 0C PORTAL Remote Control Button 8F ꕙ ꕚ AB GUIDE Remote Control Button Remote Control Button Remote Control Button 39 CC Remote Control Button CA EJECT Remote Control Button 0A SAP Remote Control Button ꔛ 102 Remote Control Button Use this feature depending on your models. Note Remote Control Button Remote Control Button Remote Control Button Discrete IR Code (TV Input Selection) Discrete IR Code (Only Power On) C5 POWER OFF Discrete IR Code (Only Power Off) 5A AV or AV1 Discrete IR Code (AV1 Input Selection) D0 AV2 Discrete IR Code BF COMPONENT Discrete IR Code (AV2 Input Selection) (Component Input Selection) D5 RGB-PC CE HDMI1 Remote Control Button 5B 8E Function Remote Control Button 08 40 Code (Hexa) Discrete IR Code (RGB-PC Input Selection) Discrete IR Code (HDMI1 Input Selection) CC HDMI2 Discrete IR Code (HDMI2 Input Selection) E9 HDMI3 Discrete IR Code (HDMI3 Input Selection) DA HDMI4 Discrete IR Code (HDMI4 Input Selection) 76 Ratio 4:3 Discrete IR Code (Only 4:3 Mode) 77 Ratio 16:9 AF Ratio Zoom Discrete IR Code (Only 16:9 Mode) Discrete IR Code (Only Zoom Mode) OPEN SOURCE LICENSE GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE Version 2, June 1991 Copyright (C) 1989, 1991 Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. Preamble The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public License is intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free software - to make sure the software is free for all its users. This General Public License applies to most of the Free Software Foundation's software and to any other program whose authors commit to using it. (Some other free software foundation software is covered by the GNU Lesser General Public License instead.) You can apply it to your programs, too. When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom, not price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for this service if you wish), that you receive source code or can get it if you want it, that you can change the software or use pieces of it in new free programs; and that you know you can do these things. To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid anyone to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender the rights. These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the software, or if you modify it. We protect your rights with two steps: (1) copyright the software, and (2) offer you this license which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the software. Also, for each author's protection and ours, we want to make certain that everyone understands that there is no warranty for this free software. If the software is modified by someone else and passed on, we want its recipients to know that what they have is not the original, so that any problems introduced by others will not reflect on the original authors' reputations. Finally, any free program is threatened constantly by software patents. We wish to avoid the danger that redistributors of a free program will individually obtain patent licenses, in effect making the program proprietary. To prevent this, we have made it clear that any patent must be The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow. GNU GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION 0. This license applies to any program or other work which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder saying it may be distributed under the terms of this General Public License. The "Program", below, refers to any such program or work, and a "work based on the Program" means either the Program or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the Program or a portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in the term "modification".) Each licensee is addressed as "you". Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this license; they are outside its scope. The act of running the Program is not restricted, and the output from the program is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the program (independent of having been made by running the program). Whether that is true depends on what the program does. 1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the program's source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the notices that refer to this license and to the absence of any warranty; and give any other recipients of the program a copy of this license along with the Program. APPENDIX For example, if you distribute copies of such a program, whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that you have. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source code. And you must show them these terms so they know their rights. licensed for everyone's free use or not licensed at all. You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee. 2. You may modify your copy or copies of the program or any portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Program, and copy and distribute such modifications or work under the terms of section 1 above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: a) Y ou must cause the modified files to carry prominent notices stating that you changed the files and the date of any change. 103 APPENDIX b) Y ou must cause any work that you distribute or publish, that in whole or in part contains or is derived from the Program or any part there of, to be licensed as a whole at no charge to all third parties under the terms of this license. c) If the modified program normally reads commands interactively when run, you must cause it, when started running for such interactive use in the most ordinary way, to print or display an announcement including an appropriate copyright notice and a notice that there is no warranty (or else, saying that you provide a warranty) and that users may redistribute the program under these conditions, and telling the user how to view a copy of this license. (Exception: if the Program itself is interactive but does not normally print such an announcement, your work based on the Program is not required to print an announcement.) These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the Program, and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in themselves, then this license, and its terms, do not apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the Program, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this license, whose permissions for other licensees extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or collective works based on the program. APPENDIX In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the program with the Program (or with a work based on the program) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under the scope of this license. 3. You may copy and distribute the program (or a work based on it, under section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of sections 1 and 2 above provided that you also do one of the following: a) Accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code, which must be distributed under the terms of sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or, b) Accompany it with a written offer, valid for at least three years, to give any third party, for a charge no more than your cost of physically performing source distribution, a complete machine-readable copy of the corresponding source code, to be distributed under the terms of sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange; or, 104 c) A ccompany it with the information you received as to the offer to distribute corresponding source code. (This alternative is allowed only for noncommercial distribution and only if you received the program in object code or executable form with such an offer, in accord with Subsection b above.) The source code for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it. For an executable work, complete source code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation and installation of the executable. However, as a special exception, the source code distributed need not include anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component itself accompanies the executable. If distribution of executable or object code is made by offering access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same place counts as distribution of the source code, even though third parties are not compelled to copy the source along with the object code. 4. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, or distribute the Program except as expressly provided under this license. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense or distribute the Program is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this license. However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this license will not have their licenses terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance. 5. You are not required to accept this license, since you have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or distribute the Program or its derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept this license. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the program (or any work based on the program), you indicate your acceptance of this license to do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the program or works based on it. 6. Each time you redistribute the program (or any work based on the Program), the recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy, distribute or modify the Program subject to these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein. You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties to this license. 7. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this license, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this license. If you cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this license and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not distribute the program at all. For example, if a patent license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the program by all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this license would be to refrain entirely from distribution of the program. If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circumstances. It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system, which is implemented by public license practices. Many people have made generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a licensee cannot impose that choice. 8. If the distribution and/or use of the program is restricted in certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who places the program under this license may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this license incorporates the limitation as if written in the body of this license. 9. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/ or new versions of the General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. 10. If you wish to incorporate parts of the program into other free programs whose distribution conditions are different, write to the author to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally. NO WARRANTY 11. BECAUSE THE PROGRAM IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE PROGRAM, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE PROGRAM "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE PROGRAM IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE PROGRAM PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. 12. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE PROGRAM AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE PROGRAM (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE PROGRAM TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER PROGRAMS), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. APPENDIX This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this license. the program specifies a version number of this license which applies to it and "any later version", you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the program does not specify a version number of this license, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software Foundation. Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If 105 APPENDIX END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS How to apply these terms to your new programs If you develop a new program, and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the public, the best way to achieve this is to make it free software which everyone can redistribute and change under these terms. To do so, attach the following notices to the program. It is safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least the "copyright" line and a pointer to where the full notice is found. one line to give the program's name and a brief idea of what it does. Copyright (C)This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/ or modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2 of the license, or (at your option) any later version. This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU General Public License for more details. You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License along with this program; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA. APPENDIX 106 Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail. If the program is interactive, make it output a short notice like this when it starts in an interactive mode: Gnomovision version 69, Copyright (C) year name of author Gnomovision comes with ABSOLUTELY NO WARRANTY; for details type ‘show w’. This is free software, and you are welcome to redistribute it under certain conditions; type ‘show c’ for details. The hypothetical commands ‘show w’ and ‘show c’ should show the appropriate parts of the General Public License. Of course, the commands you use may be called something other than ‘show w’ and ‘show c’; they could even be mouse-clicks or menu items-whatever suits your program. You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a “copyright disclaimer” for the program, if necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names: Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the program ‘Gnomovision’ (which makes passes at compilers) written by James Hacker. signature of Ty Coon, 1 April 1989 Ty Coon, President of Vice This General Public License does not permit incorporating your program into proprietary programs. If your program is a subroutine library, you may consider it more useful to permit linking proprietary applications with the library. If this is what you want to do, use the GNU Lesser General Public License instead of this license. GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE Version 2.1, February 1999 Copyright (C) 1991, 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA Everyone is permitted to copy and distribute verbatim copies of this license document, but changing it is not allowed. [This is the first released version of the Lesser GPL. It also counts as the successor of the GNU Library Public License, version 2, hence the version number 2.1.] Preamble The licenses for most software are designed to take away your freedom to share and change it. By contrast, the GNU General Public Licenses are intended to guarantee your freedom to share and change free software - to make sure the software is free for all its users. This license, the Lesser General Public License, applies to some specially designated software packages - typically libraries - of the Free Software Foundation and other authors who decide to use it. You can use it too, but we suggest you first think carefully about whether this license or the ordinary General Public License is the better strategy to use in any particular case, based on the explanations below. To protect your rights, we need to make restrictions that forbid distributors to deny you these rights or to ask you to surrender these rights. These restrictions translate to certain responsibilities for you if you distribute copies of the library or if you modify it. For example, if you distribute copies of the library, whether gratis or for a fee, you must give the recipients all the rights that we gave you. You must make sure that they, too, receive or can get the source code. If you link other code with the library, you must provide complete object files to the recipients, so that they can relink them with the library after making changes to the library and recompiling it. And you must show them these terms so they know their rights. We protect your rights with a two-step method: (1) we copyright the library, and (2) we offer you this license, which gives you legal permission to copy, distribute and/or modify the library. To protect each distributor, we want to make it very clear Finally, software patents pose a constant threat to the existence of any free program. We wish to make sure that a company cannot effectively restrict the users of a free program by obtaining a restrictive license from a patent holder. Therefore, we insist that any patent license obtained for a version of the library must be consistent with the full freedom of use specified in this license. Most GNU software, including some libraries, is covered by the ordinary GNU General Public License. This license, the GNU Lesser General Public License, applies to certain designated libraries, and is quite different from the ordinary General Public License. We use this license for certain libraries in order to permit linking those libraries into nonfree programs. When a program is linked with a library, whether statically or using a shared library, the combination of the two is legally speaking a combined work, a derivative of the original library. The ordinary General Public License therefore permits such linking only if the entire combination fits its criteria of freedom. The Lesser General Public License permits more lax criteria for linking other code with the library. We call this license the "Lesser" General Public License because it does Less to protect the user's freedom than the ordinary General Public License. It also provides other free software developers Less of an advantage over competing non-free programs. These disadvantages are the reason we use the ordinary General Public License for many libraries. However, the Lesser license provides advantages in certain special circumstances. APPENDIX When we speak of free software, we are referring to freedom of use, not price. Our General Public Licenses are designed to make sure that you have the freedom to distribute copies of free software (and charge for this service if you wish); that you receive source code or can get it if you want it; that you can change the software and use pieces of it in new free programs; and that you are informed that you can do these things. that there is no warranty for the free library. Also, if the library is modified by someone else and passed on, the recipients should know that what they have is not the original version, so that the original author's reputation will not be affected by problems that might be introduced by others. For example, on rare occasions, there may be a special need to encourage the widest possible use of a certain library, so that it becomes a de-facto standard. To achieve this, non-free programs must be allowed to use the library. A more frequent case is that a free library does the same job as widely used non-free libraries. In this case, there is little to gain by limiting the free library to free software only, so we use the Lesser General Public License. In other cases, permission to use a particular library in nonfree programs enables a greater number of people to use a large body of free software. For example, permission to use the GNU C Library in non-free programs enables many more people to use the whole GNU operating system, as well as its variant, the GNU/Linux operating system. 107 APPENDIX Although the Lesser General Public License is Less protective of the users' freedom, it does ensure that the user of a program that is linked with the Library has the freedom and the wherewithal to run that program using a modified version of the Library. The precise terms and conditions for copying, distribution and modification follow. Pay close attention to the difference between a "work based on the library" and a "work that uses the library". The former contains code derived from the library, whereas the latter must be combined with the library in order to run. GNU LESSER GENERAL PUBLIC LICENSE TERMS AND CONDITIONS FOR COPYING, DISTRIBUTION AND MODIFICATION 0. This license agreement applies to any software library or other program which contains a notice placed by the copyright holder or other authorized party saying it may be distributed under the terms of this Lesser General Public License (also called “this license”). Each license is addressed as "you". A “library” means a collection of software functions and/or data prepared so as to be conveniently linked with application programs (which use some of those functions and data) to form executables. APPENDIX The “Library”, below, refers to any such software library or work which has been distributed under these terms. A “work based on the Library” means either the Library or any derivative work under copyright law: that is to say, a work containing the library or a portion of it, either verbatim or with modifications and/or translated straightforwardly into another language. (Hereinafter, translation is included without limitation in the term “modification”.) “Source code” for a work means the preferred form of the work for making modifications to it. For a library, complete source code means all the source code for all modules it contains, plus any associated interface definition files, plus the scripts used to control compilation and installation of the library. Activities other than copying, distribution and modification are not covered by this license; they are outside its scope. The act of running a program using the Library is not restricted, and output from such a program is covered only if its contents constitute a work based on the library (independent of the use of the Library in a tool for writing it). Whether that is true depends on what the library does and what the program that uses the library does. 1. You may copy and distribute verbatim copies of the library's complete source code as you receive it, in any medium, provided that you conspicuously and appropriately publish on each copy an appropriate copyright notice and disclaimer of warranty; keep intact all the 108 notices that refer to this license and to the absence of any warranty; and distribute a copy of this license along with the Library. You may charge a fee for the physical act of transferring a copy, and you may at your option offer warranty protection in exchange for a fee. 2. You may modify your copy or copies of the Library or any portion of it, thus forming a work based on the Library, and copy and distribute such modifications or work under the terms of section 1 above, provided that you also meet all of these conditions: a) The modified work must itself be a software library. b) You must cause the files modified to carry prominent notices stating that you changed the files and the date of any change. c) You must cause the whole of the work to be licensed at no charge to all third parties under the terms of this license. d) If a facility in the modified Library refers to a function or a table of data to be supplied by an application program that uses the facility, other than as an argument passed when the facility is invoked, then you must make a good faith effort to ensure that, in the event an application does not supply such function or table, the facility still operates, and performs whatever part of its purpose remains meaningful. (For example, a function in a library to compute square roots has a purpose that is entirely well-defined independent of the application. Therefore, Subsection 2d requires that any application-supplied function or table used by this function must be optional: if the application does not supply it, the square root function must still compute square roots.) These requirements apply to the modified work as a whole. If identifiable sections of that work are not derived from the library, and can be reasonably considered independent and separate works in themselves, then this license, and its terms, do not apply to those sections when you distribute them as separate works. But when you distribute the same sections as part of a whole which is a work based on the library, the distribution of the whole must be on the terms of this license, whose permissions for other licenses extend to the entire whole, and thus to each and every part regardless of who wrote it. Thus, it is not the intent of this section to claim rights or contest your rights to work written entirely by you; rather, the intent is to exercise the right to control the distribution of derivative or collective works based on the library. In addition, mere aggregation of another work not based on the library with the library (or with a work based on the library) on a volume of a storage or distribution medium does not bring the other work under the scope of this license. 3. You may opt to apply the terms of the ordinary GNU General Public License instead of this License to a given copy of the Library. To do this, you must alter all the notices that refer to this License, so that they refer to the ordinary GNU General Public License, version 2, instead of to this License. (If a newer version than version 2 of the ordinary GNU General Public License has appeared, then you can specify that version instead if you wish.) Do not make any other change in these notices. Once this change is made in a given copy, it is irreversible for that copy, so the ordinary GNU General Public License applies to all subsequent copies and derivative works made from that copy. This option is useful when you wish to copy part of the code of the library into a program that is not a library. 4. You may copy and distribute the library (or a portion or derivative of it, under Section 2) in object code or executable form under the terms of Sections 1 and 2 above provided that you accompany it with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code, which must be distributed under the terms of sections 1 and 2 above on a medium customarily used for software interchange. If distribution of object code is made by offering access to copy from a designated place, then offering equivalent access to copy the source code from the same place satisfies the requirement to distribute the source code, even though third parties are not compelled to copy the source along with the object code. However, linking a “work that uses the library” with the Library creates an executable that is a derivative of the Library (because it contains portions of the library), rather than a “work that uses the library”. The executable is therefore covered by this license. Section 6 states terms for distribution of such executable. When a “work that uses the library” uses material from a header file that is part of the library, the object code for the work may be a derivative work of the library even though the source code is not. Whether this is true is especially significant if the work can be linked without the library, or if the work is itself a library. The threshold for this to be true is not precisely defined by law. If such an object file uses only numerical parameters, data structure layouts and accessories, and small macros and small inline functions (ten lines or less in length), then the use of the object file is unrestricted, regardless of whether it is legally a derivative work. (Executable containing this object code plus portions of Otherwise, if the work is a derivative of the library, you may distribute the object code for the work under the terms of Section 6. Any executable containing that work also fall under Section 6, whether or not they are linked directly with the library itself. 6. As an exception to the sections above, you may also combine or link a "work that uses the library" with the library to produce a work containing portions of the library, and distribute that work under terms of your choice, provided that the terms permit modification of the work for the customer's own use and reverse engineering for debugging such modifications. You must give prominent notice with each copy of the work that the library is used in it and that the Library and its use are covered by this license. You must supply a copy of this license. If the work during execution displays copyright notices, you must include the copyright notice for the library among them, as well as a reference directing the user to the copy of this license. Also, you must do one of these things: a) A ccompany the work with the complete corresponding machine-readable source code for the library including whatever changes were used in the work (which must be distributed under Sections 1 and 2 above); and, if the work is an executable linked with the Library, with the complete machine-readable “work that uses the Library”, as object code and/or source code, so that the user can modify the library and then relink to produce a modified executable containing the modified library. (It is understood that the user who changes the contents of definitions files in the library will not necessarily be able to recompile the application to use the modified definitions.) b) Use a suitable shared library mechanism for linking with the library. A suitable mechanism is one that (1) uses at run time a copy of the library already present on the user’s computer system, rather than copying library functions into the executable, and (2) will operate properly with a modified version of the library, if the user installs one, as long as the modified version is interface-compatible with the version that the work was made with. c) Accompany the work with a written offer, valid for at least three years, to give the same user the materials specified in Subsection 6, above, for a charge no more than the cost of performing this distribution. d) If distribution of the work is made by offering access to copy from a designated place, offer equivalent access to copy the above specified materials from the same place. e) Verify that the user has already received a copy of these materials or that you have already sent this user a copy. APPENDIX 5. A program that contains no derivative of any portion of the Library, but is designed to work with the Library by being compiled or linked with it, is called a “work that uses the Library”. Such a work, in isolation, is not a derivative work of the Library, and therefore falls outside the scope of this license. the library will still fall under Section 6.) 109 APPENDIX For an executable, the required form of the "work that uses the library" must include any data and utility programs needed for reproducing the executable from it. However, as a special exception, the materials to be distributed need not include anything that is normally distributed (in either source or binary form) with the major components (compiler, kernel, and so on) of the operating system on which the executable runs, unless that component itself accompanies the executable. It may happen that this requirement contradicts the license restrictions of other proprietary libraries that do not normally accompany the operating system. Such a contradiction means you cannot use both them and the library together in an executable that you distribute. 7. You may place library facilities that are a work based on the library side-by-side in a single library together with other library facilities not covered by this license, and distribute such a combined library, provided that the separate distribution of the work based on the Library and of the other library facilities is otherwise permitted, and provided that you do these two things: a) A ccompany the combined library with a copy of the same work based on the Library, uncombined with any other library facilities. This must be distributed under the terms of the sections above. b) Give prominent notice with the combined library of the fact that part of it is a work based on the library, and explaining where to find the accompanying uncombined form of the same work. APPENDIX 8. You may not copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the library except as expressly provided under this license. Any attempt otherwise to copy, modify, sublicense, link with, or distribute the library is void, and will automatically terminate your rights under this license. However, parties who have received copies, or rights, from you under this license will not have their licenses terminated so long as such parties remain in full compliance. 9. You are not required to accept this license, since you have not signed it. However, nothing else grants you permission to modify or distribute the library or its derivative works. These actions are prohibited by law if you do not accept this license. Therefore, by modifying or distributing the library (or any work based on the library), you indicate your acceptance of this license to do so, and all its terms and conditions for copying, distributing or modifying the library or works based on it. 10. Each time you redistribute the library (or any work based on the Library), the recipient automatically receives a license from the original licensor to copy, distribute, link with or modify the library subject to these terms and conditions. You may not impose any further restrictions on the recipients' exercise of the rights granted herein. 110 You are not responsible for enforcing compliance by third parties with this license. 11. If, as a consequence of a court judgment or allegation of patent infringement or for any other reason (not limited to patent issues), conditions are imposed on you (whether by court order, agreement or otherwise) that contradict the conditions of this license, they do not excuse you from the conditions of this license. If you cannot distribute so as to satisfy simultaneously your obligations under this license and any other pertinent obligations, then as a consequence you may not distribute the library at all. For example, if a patent license would not permit royalty-free redistribution of the library by all those who receive copies directly or indirectly through you, then the only way you could satisfy both it and this license would be to refrain entirely from distribution of the library. If any portion of this section is held invalid or unenforceable under any particular circumstance, the balance of the section is intended to apply, and the section as a whole is intended to apply in other circumstances. It is not the purpose of this section to induce you to infringe any patents or other property right claims or to contest validity of any such claims; this section has the sole purpose of protecting the integrity of the free software distribution system which is implemented by public license practices. Many people have made generous contributions to the wide range of software distributed through that system in reliance on consistent application of that system; it is up to the author/donor to decide if he or she is willing to distribute software through any other system and a license cannot impose that choice. This section is intended to make thoroughly clear what is believed to be a consequence of the rest of this license. 12. If the distribution and/or use of the library is restricted in certain countries either by patents or by copyrighted interfaces, the original copyright holder who places the library under this license may add an explicit geographical distribution limitation excluding those countries, so that distribution is permitted only in or among countries not thus excluded. In such case, this license incorporates the limitation as if written in the body of this license. 13. The Free Software Foundation may publish revised and/ or new versions of the Lesser General Public License from time to time. Such new versions will be similar in spirit to the present version, but may differ in detail to address new problems or concerns. Each version is given a distinguishing version number. If the library specifies a version number of this license which applies to it and “any later version”, you have the option of following the terms and conditions either of that version or of any later version published by the Free Software Foundation. If the library does not specify a license version number, you may choose any version ever published by the Free Software Foundation. 14. If you wish to incorporate parts of the library into other free programs whose distribution conditions are incompatible with these, write to the author to ask for permission. For software which is copyrighted by the Free Software Foundation, write to the Free Software Foundation; we sometimes make exceptions for this. Our decision will be guided by the two goals of preserving the free status of all derivatives of our free software and of promoting the sharing and reuse of software generally. NO WARRANTY 15. BECAUSE THE LIBRARY IS LICENSED FREE OF CHARGE, THERE IS NO WARRANTY FOR THE LIBRARY, TO THE EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW. EXCEPT WHEN OTHERWISE STATED IN WRITING THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND/OR OTHER PARTIES PROVIDE THE LIBRARY "AS IS" WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE LIBRARY IS WITH YOU. SHOULD THE LIBRARY PROVE DEFECTIVE, YOU ASSUME THE COST OF ALL NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. To apply these terms, attach the following notices to the library. It is safest to attach them to the start of each source file to most effectively convey the exclusion of warranty; and each file should have at least the “copyright” line and a pointer to where the full notice is found. one line to give the library's name and a brief idea of what it does. Copyright (C) This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either version 2.1 of the license, or (at your option) any later version. This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU Lesser General Public License for more details. You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public License along with this library; if not, write to the Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA 02110-1301 USA Also add information on how to contact you by electronic and paper mail. You should also get your employer (if you work as a programmer) or your school, if any, to sign a “copyright disclaimer” for the library, if necessary. Here is a sample; alter the names: APPENDIX 16. IN NO EVENT UNLESS REQUIRED BY APPLICABLE LAW OR AGREED TO IN WRITING WILL ANY COPYRIGHT HOLDER, OR ANY OTHER PARTY WHO MAY MODIFY AND/OR REDISTRIBUTE THE LIBRARY AS PERMITTED ABOVE, BE LIABLE TO YOU FOR DAMAGES, INCLUDING ANY GENERAL, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES ARISING OUT OF THE USE OR INABILITY TO USE THE LIBRARY (INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO LOSS OF DATA OR DATA BEING RENDERED INACCURATE OR LOSSES SUSTAINED BY YOU OR THIRD PARTIES OR A FAILURE OF THE LIBRARY TO OPERATE WITH ANY OTHER SOFTWARE), EVEN IF SUCH HOLDER OR OTHER PARTY HAS BEEN ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. it free software that everyone can redistribute and change. You can do so by permitting redistribution under these terms (or, alternatively, under the terms of the ordinary General Public License). Yoyodyne, Inc., hereby disclaims all copyright interest in the library ‘Frob’ (a library for tweaking knobs) written by James Random Hacker. signature of Ty Coon, 1 April 1990 Ty Coon, President of Vice END OF TERMS AND CONDITIONS How to apply these terms to your new libraries If you develop a new library, and you want it to be of the greatest possible use to the public, we recommend making 111 APPENDIX MOZILLA PUBLIC LICENSE Version 1.1 --------------which, at the time of its release under this license is not already covered code governed by this license. 1.Definitions. 1.0.1. “Commercial use” means distribution or otherwise making the covered code available to a third party. 1.1. “Contributor” means each entity that creates or contributes to the creation of modifications. 1.2. “Contributor version” means the combination of the original code, prior modifications used by a contributor, and the modifications made by that particular contributor. 1.3. “Covered code” means the original code or modifications or the combination of the original code and modifications, in each case including portions thereof. 1.4. “Electronic distribution mechanism” means a mechanism generally accepted in the software development community for the electronic transfer of data. 1.11. “Source code” means the preferred form of the covered code for making modifications to it, including all modules it contains, plus any associated interface definition files, scripts used to control compilation and installation of an executable, or source code differential comparisons against either the original code or another well known, available covered code of the contributor's choice. The source code can be in a compressed or archival form, provided the appropriate decompression or de-archiving software is widely available for no charge. APPENDIX 1.5. “Executable” means covered code in any form other than source code. 1.6. “Initial developer” means the individual or entity identified as the initial Developer in the Source Code notice required by exhibit A. 1.7. “Larger work” means a work which combines covered code or portions thereof with code not governed by the terms of this License. 1.12. “You” (or “Your”) means an individual or a legal entity exercising rights under, and complying with all of the terms of, this license or a future version of this license issued under section 6.1. For legal entities, “You” includes any entity which controls, is controlled by, or is under common control with You. For purposes of this definition, “control” means (a) the power, direct or indirect, to cause the direction or management of such entity, whether by contract or otherwise, or (b) ownership of more than fifty percent (50%) of the outstanding shares or beneficial ownership of such entity. 1.8. “License” means this document. 2. Source Code License. 1.8.1. “Licensable” means having the right to grant, to the maximum extent possible, whether at the time of the initial grant or subsequently acquired, any and all of the rights conveyed herein. 1.9. “Modifications” means any addition to or deletion from the substance or structure of either the original code or any previous modifications. When covered code is released as a series of files, a modification is: A. Any addition to or deletion from the contents of a file containing original code or previous modifications. B. Any new file that contains any part of the original code or previous modifications. 1.10. “Original code” means source code of computer software code which is described in the source code notice required by exhibit as original code, and 112 1.10.1. “Patent claims” means any patent claim(s), now owned or hereafter acquired, including without limitation, method, process, and apparatus claims, in any patent licensable by grantor. 2.1. The initial developer grant. The initial developer hereby grants You a world-wide, royalty-free, non-exclusive license, subject to third party intellectual property claims: a) u nder intellectual property rights (other than patent or trademark) licensable by initial developer to use, reproduce, modify, display, perform, sublicense and distribute the original code (or portions thereof) with or without modifications, and/or as part of a larger work; and (b) under patents claims infringed by the making, using or selling of original code, to make, have made, use, practice, sell, and offer for sale, and/ or otherwise dispose of the original code (or portions there of). (c) the licenses granted in this section 2.1(a) and (b) are effective on the date Initial developer first distributes original code under the terms of this license. (d) Notwithstanding section 2.1(b) above, no patent license is granted: 1) for code that You delete from the original Code; 2) separate from the original code; or 3) for infringements caused by: i) the modification of the original code or ii) the combination of the original code with other software or devices. 2.2. Contributor Grant. Subject to third party intellectual property claims, each contributor hereby grants You a world-wide, royalty-free, non-exclusive license 3. Distribution Obligations. 3.1. Application of license. The modifications which You create or to which you contribute are governed by the terms of this license, including without limitation section 2.2. The source code version of covered code may be distributed only under the terms of this license or a future version of this license released under section 6.1, and you must include a copy of this license with every copy of the source code you distribute. You may not 3.2. Availability of source code. Any modification which you create or to which you contribute must be made available in source code form under the terms of this license either on the same media as an executable version or via an accepted electronic distribution mechanism to anyone to whom you made an executable version available; and if made available via electronic distribution mechanism, must remain available for at least twelve (12) months after the date it initially became available, or at least six (6) months after a subsequent version of that particular modification has been made available to such recipients. You are responsible for ensuring that the source code version remains available even if the electronic distribution mechanism is maintained by a third party. 3.3. Description of modifications. You must cause all covered code to which you contribute to contain a file documenting the changes You made to create that covered code and the date of any change. You must include a prominent statement that the modification is derived, directly or indirectly, from original code provided by the initial developer and including the name of the initial developer in (a) the source code, and (b) in any notice in an executable version or related documentation in which you describe the origin or ownership of the covered code. 3.4. Intellectual property matters (a) Third party claims. If contributor has knowledge that a license under a third party's intellectual property rights is required to exercise the rights granted by such contributor under sections 2.1 or 2.2, contributor must include a text file with the source code distribution titled "LEGAL" which describes the claim and the party making the claim in sufficient detail that a recipient will know whom to contact. If contributor obtains such knowledge after the modification is made available as described in section 3.2, contributor shall promptly modify the LEGAL file in all copies contributor makes available thereafter and shall take other steps (such as notifying appropriate mailing lists or newsgroups) reasonably calculated to inform those who received the covered code that new knowledge has been obtained. (b) Contributor APIs. If contributor's modifications include an application programming interface and contributor has knowledge of patent licenses which are reasonably necessary to implement that API, contributor must also include this information in the LEGAL file. APPENDIX (a) u nder intellectual property rights (other than patent or trademark) licensable by contributor, to use, reproduce, modify, display, perform, sublicense and distribute the modifications created by such contributor (or portions thereof) either on an unmodified basis, with other modifications, as covered code and/or as part of a larger work; and (b) under patent claims infringed by the making, using, or selling of modifications made by that contributor either alone and/or in combination with its contributor version (or portions of such combination), to make, use, sell, offer for sale, have made, and/or otherwise dispose of: 1) modifications made by that contributor (or portions thereof); and 2) the combination of modifications made by that contributor with its contributor version (or portions of such combination). (c) the licenses granted in sections 2.2(a) and 2.2(b) are effective on the date contributor first makes commercial use of the covered code. (d) Notwithstanding section 2.2(b) above, no patent license is granted: 1) for any code that contributor has deleted from the contributor version; 2) separate from the contributor version; 3) for infringements caused by: i) third party modifications of contributor version or ii) the combination of modifications made by that contributor with other software (except as part of the contributor version) or other devices; or 4) under patent claims infringed by covered code in the absence of modifications made by that contributor. offer or impose any terms on any source code version that alters or restricts the applicable version of this license or the recipients' rights hereunder. However, you may include an additional document offering the additional rights described in section 3.5. 113 APPENDIX (c) Representations. contributor represents that, except as disclosed pursuant to section 3.4(a) above, contributor believes that contributor's modifications are contributor's original creation(s) and/or contributor has sufficient rights to grant the rights conveyed by this license. 3.5. Required notices. You must duplicate the notice in exhibit A in each file of the source code. If it is not possible to put such notice in a particular source code file due to its structure, then You must include such notice in a location (such as a relevant directory) where a user would be likely to look for such a notice. If You created one or more modification(s), you may add your name as a contributor to the notice described in exhibit A. you must also duplicate this license in any documentation for the source code where You describe recipients' rights or ownership rights relating to covered code. You may choose to offer, and to charge a fee for, warranty, support, indemnity or liability obligations to one or more recipients of covered code. However, you may do so only on your own behalf, and not on behalf of the Initial developer or any contributor. You must make it absolutely clear than any such warranty, support, indemnity or liability obligation is offered by you alone, and You hereby agree to indemnify the Initial developer and every contributor for any liability incurred by the Initial developer or such contributor as a result of warranty, support, indemnity or liability terms you offer. APPENDIX 3.6. Distribution of executable versions. You may distribute covered code in executable form only if the requirements of section 3.1-3.5 have been met for that covered code, and if you include a notice stating that the source code version of the covered code is available under the terms of this license, including a description of how and where you have fulfilled the obligations of section 3.2. The notice must be conspicuously included in any notice in an executable version, related documentation or collateral in which you describe recipients' rights relating to the covered code. You may distribute the executable version of covered code or ownership rights under a license of your choice, which may contain terms different from this license, provided that you are in compliance with the terms of this license and that the license for the executable version does not attempt to limit or alter the recipient's rights in the source code version from the rights set forth in this license. If you distribute the executable version under a different license you must make it absolutely clear that any terms which differ from this license are offered by you alone, not by the Initial developer or any contributor. You hereby agree to indemnify the initial developer and every contributor for any liability incurred by the initial developer or such contributor as a result of any such terms You offer. 3.7. 114 Larger works. You may create a larger work by combining covered code with other code not governed by the terms of this license and distribute the larger work as a single product. In such a case, you must make sure the requirements of this license are fulfilled for the covered code. 4. Inability to comply due to statute or regulation. If it is impossible for you to comply with any of the terms of this license with respect to some or all of the covered code due to statute, judicial order, or regulation then you must: (a) comply with the terms of this license to the maximum extent possible; and (b) describe the limitations and the code they affect. Such description must be included in the LEGAL file described in section 3.4 and must be included with all distributions of the source code. Except to the extent prohibited by statute or regulation, such description must be sufficiently detailed for a recipient of ordinary skill to be able to understand it. 5. Application of this license. This license applies to code to which the initial developer has attached the notice in exhibit A and to related covered code. 6. Versions of the license. 6.1. New versions. Netscape communications corporation (“Netscape”) may publish revised and/or new versions of the license from time to time. Each version will be given a distinguishing version number. 6.2. Effect of new versions. Once covered code has been published under a particular version of the license, you may always continue to use it under the terms of that version. You may also choose to use such covered code under the terms of any subsequent version of the license published by netscape. No one other than netscape has the right to modify the terms applicable to covered code created under this license. 6.3. Derivative works. If You create or use a modified version of this license (which you may only do in order to apply it to code which is not already covered code governed by this license), You must (a) rename Your license so that the phrases "Mozilla", "MOZILLAPL", "MOZPL", "Netscape", "MPL", "NPL" or any confusingly similar phrase do not appear in your license (except to note that your license differs from this license) and (b) otherwise make it clear that Your version of the license contains terms which differ from the Mozilla Public license and netscape Public License. (Filling in the name of the initial developer, original code or contributor in the notice described in exhibit A shall not of themselves be deemed to be modifications of this license.) 7. DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY. COVERED CODE IS PROVIDED UNDER THIS LICENSE ON AN “AS IS” BASIS, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EITHER EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, WARRANTIES THAT THE COVERED CODE IS FREE OF DEFECTS, MERCHANTABLE, FIT FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE OR NON-INFRINGING. THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO THE QUALITY AND PERFORMANCE OF THE COVERED CODE IS WITH YOU. SHOULD ANY COVERED CODE PROVE DEFECTIVE IN ANY RESPECT, YOU (NOT THE INITIAL DEVELOPER OR ANY OTHER CONTRIBUTOR) ASSUME THE COST OF ANY NECESSARY SERVICING, REPAIR OR CORRECTION. THIS DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTY CONSTITUTES AN ESSENTIAL PART OF THIS LICENSE. NO USE OF ANY COVERED CODE IS AUTHORIZED HEREUNDER EXCEPT UNDER THIS DISCLAIMER. 8. TERMINATION. 8.1. This license and the rights granted hereunder will terminate automatically if you fail to comply with terms herein and fail to cure such breach within 30 days of becoming aware of the breach. All sublicenses to the covered code which are properly granted shall survive any termination of this license. Provisions which, by their nature, must remain in effect beyond the termination of this license shall survive. (a) s uch participant's contributor version directly or indirectly infringes any patent, then any and all rights granted by such participant to you under sections 2.1 and/or 2.2 of this license shall, upon 60 days notice from Participant terminate prospectively, unless if within 60 days after receipt of notice you either: (i) agree in writing to pay participant a mutually agreeable reasonable royalty for your past and future use of modifications made by such participant, or (ii) withdraw your litigation claim with respect to the contributor version against such participant. If within 60 days of notice, a reasonable royalty and payment arrangement are not mutually agreed upon in writing by the parties or the litigation claim is not withdrawn, the rights granted by participant to you under sections 2.1 and/or 2.2 automatically terminate at the expiration of the 60 day notice period specified above. (b) any software, hardware, or device, other than such participant's contributor Version, directly or indirectly infringes any patent, then any rights grant- 8.3. If you assert a patent infringement claim against participant alleging that such participant's contributor version directly or indirectly infringes any patent where such claim is resolved (such as by license or settlement) prior to the initiation of patent infringement litigation, then the reasonable value of the licenses granted by such participant under sections 2.1 or 2.2 shall be taken into account in determining the amount or value of any payment or license. 8.4. In the event of termination under sections 8.1 or 8.2 above, all end user license agreements (excluding distributors and resellers) which have been validly granted by you or any distributor hereunder prior to termination shall survive termination. 9. LIMITATION OF LIABILITY. UNDER NO CIRCUMSTANCES AND UNDER NO LEGAL THEORY, WHETHER TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE), CONTRACT, OR OTHERWISE, SHALL YOU, THE INITIAL DEVELOPER, ANY OTHER CONTRIBUTOR, OR ANY DISTRIBUTOR OF COVERED CODE,OR ANY SUPPLIER OF ANY OF SUCH PARTIES, BE LIABLE TO ANY PERSON FOR ANY INDIRECT, SPECIAL, INCIDENTAL, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OF ANY CHARACTER INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR LOSS OF GOODWILL, WORK STOPPAGE, COMPUTER FAILURE OR MALFUNCTION, OR ANY AND ALL OTHER COMMERCIAL DAMAGES OR LOSSES, EVEN IF SUCH PARTY SHALL HAVE BEEN INFORMED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. THIS LIMITATION OF LIABILITY SHALL NOT APPLY TO LIABILITY FOR DEATH OR PERSONAL INJURY RESULTING FROM SUCH PARTY'S NEGLIGENCE TO THE EXTENT APPLICABLE LAW PROHIBITS SUCH LIMITATION. SOME JURISDICTIONS DO NOT ALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES, SO THIS EXCLUSION AND LIMITATION MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU. APPENDIX 8.2. If you initiate litigation by asserting a patent infringement claim (excluding declatory judgment actions) against initial developer or a contributor (the initial developer or contributor against whom you file such action is referred to as “Participant”) alleging that: ed to You by such participant under sections 2.1(b) and 2.2(b) are revoked effective as of the date you first made, used, sold, distributed, or had made, modifications made by that participant. 10. U.S. GOVERNMENT END USERS. The covered code is a "commercial item," as that term is defined in 48 C.F.R. 2.101 (Oct. 1995), consisting of "commercial computer software" and "commercial computer software documentation," as such terms are used in 48 C.F.R. 12.212 (Sept. 1995). Consistent with 48 C.F.R. 12.212 and 48 C.F.R. 227.7202-1 through 227.7202-4 (June 1995), all U.S. Government end users acquire covered code with only those rights set forth herein. 115 APPENDIX 11. MISCELLANEOUS. This license represents the complete agreement concerning subject matter hereof. If any provision of this license is held to be unenforceable, such provision shall be reformed only to the extent necessary to make it enforceable. This License shall be governed by California law provisions (except to the extent applicable law, if any, provides otherwise), excluding its conflict-of-law provisions. With respect to disputes in which at least one party is a citizen of, or an entity chartered or registered to do business in the united states of america, any litigation relating to this License shall be subject to the jurisdiction of the federal courts of the northern district of california, with venue lying in santa clara county, california, with the losing party responsible for costs, including without limitation, court costs and reasonable attorneys' fees and expenses. The application of the united nations convention on contracts for the International sale of goods is expressly excluded. Any law or regulation which provides that the language of a contract shall be construed against the drafter shall not apply to this license. 12. RESPONSIBILITY FOR CLAIMS. As between initial developer and the contributors, each party is responsible for claims and damages arising, directly or indirectly, out of its utilization of rights under this license and you agree to work with initial developer and contributors to distribute such responsibility on an equitable basis. Nothing herein is intended or shall be deemed to constitute any admission of liability. APPENDIX 116 13. MULTIPLE-LICENSED CODE. Initial developer may designate portions of the covered code as "Multiple-Licensed". "MultipleLicensed" means that the initial developer permits you to utilize portions of the covered code under your choice of the NPL or the alternative licenses, if any, specified by the initial developer in the file described in exhibit A. EXHIBIT A -Mozilla Public License. The contents of this file are subject to the Mozilla Public License Version 1.1 (the “license”); you may not use this file except in compliance with the License. You may obtain a copy of the license at http://www.mozilla.org/MPL/ Software distributed under the license is distributed on an "AS IS" basis, WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, either express or implied. See the license for the specific language governing rights and limitations under the License. The Original Code is ______________________________________ . The Initial Developer of the Original Code is___________________. Portions created by ______________________ are Copyright (C) _______________________. All Rights Reserved. Contributor(s): ______________________________________. Alternatively, the contents of this file may be used under the terms of the _____ license (the "[___] License"), in which case the provisions of [______] license are applicable instead of those above. If you wish to allow use of your version of this file only under the terms of the [____] license and not to allow others to use your version of this file under the MPL, indicate your decision by deleting the provisions above and replace them with the notice and other provisions required by the [___] license. If you do not delete the provisions above, a recipient may use your version of this file under either the MPL or the [___] license." NOTE: The text of this exhibit A may differ slightly from the text of the notices in the source code files of the original code. You should use the text of this exhibit A rather than the text found in the original code/source code for Your modifications. OWNER’S MANUAL LCD TV Please read this manual carefully before operating your set and retain it for future reference. 26LD320H 32LD320H 37LD320H 42LD320H 32LD325H 37LD325H 26LD340H 32LD340H 37LD340H 42LD340H 26LD345H 32LD345H 37LD345H 42LD345H 32LD310H 37LD310H 32LD330H 37LD330H The model and serial number of the TV is located on the back and one side of the TV. Record it below should you ever need service. MODEL SERIAL P/NO : SAC34026009 (1104-REV03) www.lg.com 26LD320H 32LD320H 37LD320H 42LD320H 32LD325H 37LD325H Lodging Guest Interactive Pro:Centric™ TVs Commercial Mode Setup Guide Note: Selected features shown in this guide may not be available on all models. EXPERIENCED INSTALLER Commercial Mode Setup pages 12 – 13 Cloning Information pages 27 – 32 b-LAN™ Setup & Overview page 39 © Copyright 2011, LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. P/N: 206-4163 (Rev B) For Customer Support/Service, please call: 1-888-865-3026 The latest product information and documentation is available online at: www.LGsolutions.com/products MODEL and SERIAL NUMBER The model and serial numbers of this TV are located on the back of the cabinet. For future reference, LG suggests that you record those numbers here: Model No._________________Serial No. _______________ WARNING RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT OPEN WARNING: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK). NO USERSERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE. REFER TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL. The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral triangle, is intended to alert the user to the presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to persons. The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert the user to the presence of important operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the appliance. WARNING: TO PREVENT FIRE OR SHOCK HAZARDS, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS PRODUCT TO RAIN OR MOISTURE. POWER CORD POLARIZATION: This product is equipped with a 3-wire grounding-type alternating current power plug. This plug will fit into the power outlet only one way. This is a safety feature. If you are unable to insert the plug fully into the outlet, contact your electrician to replace your obsolete outlet. Do not defeat the safety purpose of the 3-wire grounding-type plug. NOTE TO CABLE/TV INSTALLER: This reminder is provided to call the cable TV system installer’s attention to Article 820-40 of the National Electric Code (U.S.A.). The code provides guidelines for proper grounding and, in particular, specifies that the cable ground shall be connected to the grounding system of the building, as close to the point of the cable entry as practical. REGULATORY INFORMATION: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: • Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna. • Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver. • Connect the equipment to an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. • Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help. CAUTION: Do not attempt to modify this product in any way without written authorization from LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. Unauthorized modification could void the user’s authority to operate this product. COMPLIANCE: The responsible party for this product’s compliance is: LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 1000 Sylvan Avenue, Englewood Cliffs, NJ 07632, USA • Phone: 1-201-816-2000 Marketed and Distributed in the United States by LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 1000 Sylvan Avenue, Englewood Cliffs, NJ 07632 2 © Copyright 2011, LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 206-4163 IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS 1. Read these instructions. 2. Keep these instructions. 3. Heed all warnings. 4. Follow all instructions. 5. Do not use this apparatus near water. 6. Clean only with dry cloth. 7. Do not block any ventilation openings. Install in accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions. 8. Do not install near any heat sources, such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus (including amplifiers) that produce heat. 9. Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or grounding-type plug. A polarized plug has two blades with one wider than the other. A grounding-type plug has two blades and a third grounding prong. The wide blade or the third prong are provided for your safety. If the provided plug does not fit into your outlet, consult an electrician for replacement of the obsolete outlet. 10. Protect the power cord from being walked on or pinched, particularly at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the point where it exits from the apparatus. 11. Only use attachments/accessories specified by the manufacturer. 12. Use only with the cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table specified by the manufacturer or sold with the apparatus. When a cart is used, use caution when moving the cart/apparatus combination in order to avoid injury from tip-over. 17. Power Cord Caution: It is recommended that appliances be placed upon a dedicated circuit; that is, a single outlet circuit which powers only that appliance and has no additional outlets or branch circuits. Check the specification page of the Owner’s Manual to be certain. Periodically examine the cord of your appliance, and if its appearance indicates damage or deterioration, unplug it, discontinue use of the appliance, and have the cord replaced with an exact replacement part by an authorized servicer. Protect the power cord from physical or mechanical abuse, such as twisting, kinking, or pinching or being closed in a door or walked upon. Pay particular attention to plugs, wall outlets, and the point where the cord exits the appliance. Do not use a damaged or loose power cord. Be sure to grasp the plug when unplugging the power cord. Do not pull on the power cord to unplug the TV. 18. Overloading Do not connect too many appliances to the same AC power outlet as this could result in fire or electric shock. Do not overload wall outlets. Overloaded wall outlets, loose or damaged wall outlets, extension cords, frayed power cords, or damaged or cracked wire insulation are dangerous. Any of these conditions could result in re or electric shock. 19. Outdoor Use/Wet Location Warning: To reduce the risk of fire or electrical shock, do not expose this product to rain, moisture or other liquids. Do not touch the TV with wet hands. Do not install this product near ammable objects such as gasoline or candles or expose the TV to direct air conditioning. Do not expose to dripping or splashing and do not place objects lled with liquids, such as vases, cups, etc., on or over the apparatus (e.g., on shelves above the unit). PORTABLE CART WARNING 13. Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel. Servicing is required when the apparatus has been damaged in any way, such as power-supply cord or plug is damaged, liquid has been spilled or objects have fallen into the apparatus, the apparatus has been exposed to rain or moisture, does not operate normally, or has been dropped. 14. Never touch this apparatus or antenna during a thunder or lighting storm. 15. When mounting a TV on the wall, make sure not to install the TV by the hanging power and signal cables on the back of the TV. 16. Do not allow an impact shock or any objects to fall into the product, and do not drop objects onto the screen. 206-4163 20. Grounding Ensure that you connect the earth ground wire to prevent possible electric shock (i.e., a TV with a three-prong grounded AC plug must be connected to a three-prong grounded AC outlet). If grounding methods are not possible, have a qualified electrician install a separate circuit breaker. Do not try to ground the unit by connecting it to telephone wires, lightening rods, or gas pipes. 21. Disconnect Device The mains plug is the disconnecting device. The plug must remain readily operable. As long as this unit is connected to the AC wall outlet, it is not disconnected from the AC power source even if you turn off this unit by SWITCH. (Continued on next page) 3 IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS (Continued from previous page) 22. Outdoor Antenna Grounding If an outside antenna or cable system is connected to the product, follow the precautions below. An outdoor antenna system should not be located in the vicinity of overhead power lines or other electric light or power circuits or where it can come into contact with such power lines or circuits as death or serious injury can occur. Be sure the antenna system is grounded so as to provide some protection against voltage surges and built-up static charges. Article 810 of the National Electrical Code (NEC) in the U.S.A. provides information with respect to proper grounding of the mast and supporting structure, grounding of the leadin wire to an antenna-discharge unit, size of grounding conductors, location of antenna-discharge unit, connection to grounding electrodes, and requirements for the grounding electrode. Antenna Grounding According to NEC, ANSI/NFPA 70 Ground Clamp Antenna Lead in Wire Antenna Discharge Unit (NEC Section 810-20) Electric Service Equipment Grounding Conductor (NEC Section 810-21) Ground Clamps Power Service Grounding Electrode System (NEC Art 250, Part H) 27. If you smell smoke or other odors coming from the TV or hear strange sounds, unplug the power cord, and contact an authorized service center. 28. Do not press strongly on the panel with a hand or sharp object (e.g., a nail, pencil, or pen) or make a scratch on it. 29. Keep the product away from direct sunlight. 30. Dot Defect The Plasma or LCD panel is a high technology product with resolution of two million to six million pixels. In a very few cases, you could see fine dots on the screen while you’re viewing the TV. Those dots are deactivated pixels and do not affect the performance and reliability of the TV. 31. Generated Sound “Cracking”: A cracking noise that occurs while the TV is On or when it is turned Off is generated by plastic thermal contraction due to temperature and humidity. This noise is common for products where thermal deformation is required. Electrical circuit humming/panel buzzing: A low level noise is generated from a high-speed switching circuit, which supplies a large amount of current to operate a product. It varies depending on the product. This generated sound does not affect the performance and reliability of the product. 32. For LCD TV If the TV feels cold to the touch, there may be a small “flicker” when it is turned On. This is normal; there is nothing wrong with TV. Some minute dot defects may be visible on the screen, appearing as tiny red, green, or blue spots. However, they have no adverse effect on the monitor’s performance. Avoid touching the LCD screen or holding your finger(s) against it for long periods of time. Doing so may produce some temporary distortion effects on the screen. 23. Cleaning When cleaning, unplug the power cord and rub gently with a soft cloth to prevent scratching. Do not spray water or other liquids directly on the TV as electric shock may occur. Do not clean with chemicals such as alcohol, thinners or benzene. 24. Transporting Product Make sure the product is turned Off and unplugged and that all cables have been removed. It may take two or more people to carry larger TVs. Do not press against or put stress on the front panel of the TV. 25. Ventilation Install the TV where there is proper ventilation. Do not install in a confined space such as a bookcase. Do not cover the product with cloth or other materials (e.g., plastic) while it is plugged in. Do not install in excessively dusty places. 26. Do not touch the ventilation openings, as they may become hot while the TV is operating. 4 206-4163 Table of Contents Safety Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Important Safety Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 – 4 Table of Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Setup Checklist / Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Pro:Centric TV Interactive Menu Features. . . . . . . . . . . 7 Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a TLL-1100A Clone Programmer . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 – 30 Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using an LT2002 Clone Programmer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 – 32 Remote Jack Pack / TV Connections & Setup . . . . . . 33 LD320H/LD325H Rear Jack Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 References Side Connections Panel / RF Antenna & MPI Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Upgrading TV/PTC Software using a USB Memory Device. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Installer Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Downloading a Splash Screen using a USB Memory Device. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Installer Remote Control Typical Key Functions . . . . . 11 Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV. . . . . . . . . 12 – 13 Installer Menu. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 – 20 Power Consumption Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 TV Camport Auto Sense Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 TV Setup Menus Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 TV Aux Input Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Adding Channel Icons / Custom Channel Labels (2-5-4 + MENU Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 RJP Model List and Input Auto-sensing Hierarchy. . . . 40 FTG Mode of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 – 26 FTG Setup Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Determining the TV Operating Mode / FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility Overview . . . . . . 24 b-LAN Setup & Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 – 44 General Troubleshooting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Troubleshooting Flow Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility / FTG Channel Map Editor Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Commercial Mode Check / FTG Operating Troubleshooting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility Overview. . 26 Clone Programmer Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Cloning Overview / Clonable Menu Features . . . . . . . 27 Glossary of Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Cloning Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 – 32 Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a USB Memory Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 Document Revision History / Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Back Cover. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Notes • Installer Menu content is intended for use primarily by quali ed TV electronics technicians. • Refer to the Owner’s Manual for additional information on TV features, speci cations, maintenance, and safety instructions. • For additional information, contact your LG representative. For Customer Support/Service, please call: 1-888-865-3026 www.LGsolutions.com Note: Design and specifications subject to change without prior notice. 206-4163 5 Setup Checklist / Overview Setup Checklist Installation and Setup Checklist __ Unpack TV and all accessories. __ Install batteries in remote control. __ Install TV on VESA mount or stand. Note: It may be advisable to make all cable connections before installing on VESA mount or stand, as appropriate. Hardware Connections __ Install any additional hardware as appropriate to your institution, LAN, etc. Commercial Mode Setup __ Complete Commercial Mode Setup (configure all relevant Installer Menu items as required of your institution and configure display features for the end user). Software Installation __ Install or configure any software, as applicable, for example, PPV, etc. Cable Connections __ Make all connections to rear jack panel and RF antenna on MPI/PPV card. __ Make all connections to signal, interactive resources, and Aux sources, as appropriate. Commercial Mode Setup Overview This document describes how to set up LD320H and LD325H Pro:Centric™ TVs for Commercial Mode either while in the Embedded b-LAN™ (EBL) module’s Pass-through Mode or its Free-To-Guest (FTG) Mode. Note: The b-LAN module is internal to the TV and allows the hotel/institution head end equipment to communicate with the TV for configuration and control. See Reference section, “b-LAN Setup & Overview,” for further information. Pass-through Mode This mode allows you to configure a Master TV Setup for cloning purposes as well as external VOD/PPV control. Use the Installer Remote to con gure Installer Menu items as required for TV operation and set up TV features (Channel, Picture, Audio, etc.). See pages 12 to 13 for detailed information. FTG Mode This mode enables Pro:Idiom® decryption and also allows logical channel mapping of physical channels to remove the need for dash tuning. FTG Con guration Application software is used to con gure and/or edit Channel Map and Installer Menu settings. See pages 23 to 26 for further information on FTG Mode and local con guration using a PC with the FTG Con guration Application. Since these TV models are equipped with the EBL Module, they can also be broadcast con gured in FTG Mode by a Free-To-Guest Management Appliance (FMA) head end device. Refer to the Free-To-Guest (FTG) Configuration Application manual and/or the Installation & Setup manual for the FMA device. 6 206-4163 Pro:Centric TV Interactive Menu Features Channel Guide Information Remote Help Watch TV Important: Pro:Centric operation requires that Installer Menu items 098 PRO:CENTRIC and 119 DATA CHANNEL be set appropriately and that the TV be in PPV or FTG Mode. The interactive Pro:Centric TV enables guests—from the comfort of their hotel rooms—to view and select from a complete listing of hotel services and amenities. The Pro:Centric TV is connected to the hotel's billing computer, and service/amenities charges are billed at the time of order. Interactive amenities may include: • Hotel information, news, and events • Directory services (tourist attractions, restaurants, etc.) • Reservation services (business meetings, fitness, spa, etc.) • Weather and traffic information ALARM TIMER • Shopping services (delivery to guest room) INPUT TV 1 4 7 2 5 8 0 INFO VOL 3 6 9 • Ticketing services • Check-out service (in the guest room) • Gaming services • E-mail resources/account access FLASHBK i PORTAL CH MUTE MENU • Room service (menu ordering, memo service, morning wake up call, laundry, etc.) GUIDE CC P A G E Use the Installer Remote to operate both interactive menus and regular TV features. Press PORTAL on the Installer Remote to access the interactive menus. Note: Interactive menu options may vary, depending on Pro:Centric features enabled for the site. The following are default interactive menus. Channel Guide ENTER RETURN SAP Shows available TV networks and channels. When available, Electronic Program Guide (EPG) data indicates the channel and the program start and finish times. EXIT EJECT RATIO Information Typically displays hotel information, for example, photos of guest rooms, dining rooms, business centers, fitness and pool facilities, etc. Information may also include resources, such as local school programs, run in cooperation with the hotel. Remote Help Provides help for navigating the interactive menus. Watch TV Removes the interactive menu from the screen and returns to the previously tuned TV channel. 206-4163 7 LD320H/LD325H Rear Jack Panel AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) Audio connection for RGB or DVI device. RJP Connection for Remote Jack Pack (RJP) Control cable. REMOTE CONTROL OUT IR output for controlling an auxiliary device. UPDATE Restricted to software updates. RESET Press RESET to re-initialize the TV. AUDIO/VIDEO IN 1 Connection for composite audio/ video output from external device. RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET HDMI HDMI /DVI IN 2 1 UPDATE ..... .... RJP REMOTE CONTROL OUT .......... .......... ..... ..... ..... AV IN 1 VIDEO L/MONO-AUDIO-R GAME CONTROL AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) ANTENNA IN Y PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO TV-LINK CFG RGB IN (PC) Connection for RGB output from PC. COMPONENT IN Connection for component output from external device. RS-232C IN Use for downloading software updates, etc. TV-LINK CFG Use for local FTG configuration. R COMPONENT IN HDMI/DVI IN Connection for HDMI/DVI output from external device. ANTENNA IN 26LD320H only. Connect to Antenna/ CATV. GAME CONTROL * EBL in LodgeNet PPV Mode only. SPEAKER OUT (8Ω) ** Connect to 8 ohm self-powered speaker input. Intended for special applications, such as a powered bathroom speaker with volume control. * For 26LD320H TVs, this is a GAME CONTROL/MPI port. GAME CONTROL function as described above. When the EBL is in Pass-through Mode, the MPI function enables an external MPI control device (i.e., clone programmer, VOD/PPV STB, etc.) to control the TV. ** This stereo jack provides a mono speaker fixed-level, 1 watt output (audio +, audio -, w/ground shield). Do NOT plug in a mono connector, as this may damage the TV. 8 206-4163 Side Connections Panel / RF Antenna & MPI Connections A/V 2 Input L/MONO-AUDIO-R IN Connect to audio output jacks on external device. For only mono audio output, connect to Left audio input. VIDEO L/MONO -AUDIO- R USB IN Insert USB memory device for software updates, cloning purposes, or picture/music entertainment, as applicable. USB IN Side Connections Panel VIDEO IN Connect to video output port on external device (see Reference section, “TV Camport Auto Sense Operation,” for further information). AV IN 2 RF Antenna & MPI Connections (32/37/42LD320H and 32/37LD325H TVs) Note: 26LD320H Antenna and MPI connections are on the rear jack panel (see previous page). Antenna or CATV ANTENNA IN MP I 206-4163 ANTENNA IN Connect to Antenna/CATV. MPI Enables an external MPI control device (i.e., clone programmer, VOD/ PPV STB, etc.) to control the TV when the EBL is in Pass-through Mode. 9 Installer Overview This is the Commercial Mode Setup Guide only. Installer Menu / Commercial Mode Setup XXLD320H PTC INSTALLER MENU To set up a Master TV, you will need to know how to enter the TV Installer Menu and make changes to the default values as required. Similarly, to configure a single TV’s Installer Menu settings in FTG Mode, you will need to know how to access and use the FTG Configuration Application utilities. If necessary, familiarize yourself with the Installer Menu and how to make and save changes. Refer to page 14 for information on accessing the Installer Menu in Pass-through Mode. Refer to page 23 for information on accessing the FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility in the FTG Configuration Application. Pages 15 to 20 describe Installer Menu items in detail. 000 INSTALLER SEQ 000 UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.000 FPGA E0F1 CPU V3.06.00 Typical Installer Menu Installer Remote The LG Installer Remote is supplied with and dedicated to operate the TV. See next page for typical key functions in TV operating mode. Some DVD and VCR controls may be available for selected LG DVD/VCR products. Cloning Cloning refers to the process of capturing a Master TV Setup and transferring it to a Target TV. The Master TV’s clonable features need to be configured as part of the Commercial Mode Setup. This is a critical step. If the Master TV’s clonable features—channel icons or labels, digital font options, etc.—are not set up correctly, the cloned TVs will all have problems. Pages 27 to 32 provide detailed information on cloning requirements and procedures. ALARM TIMER INPUT TV 1 4 7 2 5 8 0 INFO 3 6 9 FLASHBK i VOL PORTAL MENU GUIDE CH P A G E MUTE CC ENTER + A AA A AA + Installing Batteries in Installer Remote • Open the battery compartment cover on the back side of the remote. • Install two high-quality alkaline 1.5V AAA batteries. Never mix old or used batteries with new ones. Install batteries matching correct polarity as shown (+ with + and - with -). • Replace the battery compartment cover. 10 RETURN SAP EXIT EJECT RATIO 206-4163 Installer Remote Control Typical Key Functions The LG Installer Remote illustrated below and throughout this document shows typical remote control functions and is provided for reference only. This Installer Remote may vary from the Installer Remote supplied with the TV. POWER Turns TV On or Off. ALARM Sets the time when the TV will automatically turn itself ON. TIMER Sets the amount of time before the TV automatically turns itself OFF. INPUT Selects RGB, HDMI/DVI1, HDMI2, Component Input, AV1, and AV2 sources. TV Returns to the last TV channel. ALARM TIMER PORTAL Displays and removes the interactive menu. MUTE Switches sound ON or OFF. NUMBER Buttons (0 - 9) DASH Use to enter a program number or channel. Dash is used for sub-channel numbers such as 2-1, 2-2, 9-1, 9-2, 100-3, 100-4, etc. TV 1 4 7 VOLUME UP/DOWN Increases/decreases sound level. INFO Displays channel information. INPUT 2 5 8 0 INFO VOL 3 6 9 FLASHBK (FLASHBACK) Returns to the previously tuned channel. Arrows (Up/Down/Left/Right) & ENTER Use to navigate on-screen menus and adjust TV settings to your requirements. MENU Provides access to the TV setup menus on the screen. Also, enters or exits the onscreen menu system. FLASHBK i PORTAL CH GUIDE Displays and removes the electronic program guide. P A G E MUTE MENU CHANNEL UP/DOWN Selects available channels found with Auto Tuning. Moves to next available page in electronic program guide. GUIDE CC Press to activate subtitles. CC RETURN Returns one level to the previous menu/ display. ENTER RETURN SAP SAP Analog Mode: Selects MTS sound (Mono, Stereo, or SAP). DTV Mode: Changes audio language, if additional languages are available. * EXIT EXIT Clears all on-screen displays and returns to TV viewing. Color buttons access special functions in some menus. VCR/DVD BUTTONS Controls some video cassette recorders or DVD players. EJECT Ejects a USB memory device, CD, DVD, VHS tape, as applicable. RATIO Adjusts the picture aspect ratio. EJECT RATIO * SAP notes: • • • 206-4163 If SAP is selected and no SAP is provided, sound may not be heard on channel. Each analog channel may have its own SAP setting. Digital channels will reset to default audio language with a power off/on. 11 Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV This section describes how to set up a Master TV when the EBL is in Pass-through Mode. Note: Disconnect all Aux inputs. Under certain conditions, Auto Tuning (Channel Search) is disabled if there is an Aux input active. Note: Refer to “FTG Mode of Operation” on pages 23 to 26 for information on con guring/editing Channel Map and Installer Menu settings for an individual TV in FTG Mode. 1. Set Installer Menu items. a) Use the Installer Remote to enter the TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen menu locks up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. Refer to pages 14 to 20 for detailed information on Installer Menu items. b) Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001 and press ENTER on the Installer Remote. This clears all Installer Menu custom settings, channel labels/ icons, etc. and reloads the factory default settings. The value will change back to 0 after the internal TV controller (Protocol Translator Card [PTC]) has been restored to factory default condition. This step ensures that the TV Channel Memory will be the active Channel List. c) Set Installer Menu item 003 BAND/AFC, as appropriate. • Broadcast: Set to 000. • CATV: Set to 001 (default). • HRC: Set to 002. • IRC: Set to 003. XXLD320H PTC INSTALLER MENU 000 UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.000 2. Set up TV features. On-screen setup menus control the features of the TV (see page 21). Press MENU on the Installer Remote to access the setup menus, and then set Channel, Picture, Audio, Lock, Time, etc. options to the desired configurations. See also the Clonable Menu Features list on page 27. Note: If desired, you can run Auto Tuning (see step 3) prior to completing this step. 12 000 FPGA E0F1 CPU V3.06.00 Typical TV Installer Menu Note: The Installer Menu header will vary depending on the TV you are setting up. 117 FACT DEFAULT 001 003 BAND/AFC 00X Adjust the settings for these Installer Menu items. d) Set any other Installer Menu items that affect your TV programming network to the required con guration. For example, enable/disable Aux sources, set a Start Channel, etc. e) After you have adjusted all required Installer Menu item settings, press ENTER on the Installer Remote to exit the menu and save your changes. INSTALLER SEQ CHANNEL PICTURE AUDIO TIME LOCK OPTION INPUT MY MEDIA Set the TV features to the desired configuration for the end user. (Continued on next page) 206-4163 Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV (Cont.) (Continued from previous page) 3. Run Auto Tuning (Channel Search). a) Search for all available analog and digital channels: Go to the Channel Menu, select the Auto Tuning option, and follow the on-screen instructions. b) Use the Channel Edit option in the Channel Menu to edit the channel lineup, as necessary, to include free to guest channels only. • Add/delete channels per your system requirements. Note that physical channel numbers are used to identify virtual channels. Also, channel numbers cannot be higher than 255. • Use the Channel Label option in the Channel Menu to add familiar channel trademarks/logos such as ABC, CBS, NBC, etc. to the Channel-Time on-screen display. Identi able labels (logos) should enable the end user to readily know what common networks are available. (You can add the channel labels in this step, or you can add channel logos or labels for channels without icons in step 5.) 4. Transfer the TV Setup to the internal TV Controller (PTC): 2-5-5 + MENU Mode After the TV channel lineup has been edited and channel label icons added, enter the Installer Menu. Once in the Installer Menu, press 2-5-5 + MENU on the Installer Remote to initiate the transfer of the Master TV Setup to the PTC. Once the transfer is complete, the TV will exit the Installer Menu. Note: The maximum number of active channels that can be transferred is 141. Total channels numbering more than 141 will result in erratic TV operation. 5. Add Custom Channel and Aux Source Labels for Analog Channels: 2-5-4 + MENU Mode Enter the Installer Menu, and press 2-5-4 + MENU on the Installer Remote. Add/edit custom text labels to channel on-screen displays. Note that digital channels often have a broadcaster generated label (see 2-5-4 + MENU procedural information on page 22). When you are finished, press MENU to exit 2-5-4 + MENU Mode. 6. Verify the TV setup. At this point, verify that the channel lineup, channel icons, and custom labels are correct. Make sure the TV features are set per your requirements. CHANNEL Move Enter $XWR7XQLQJ 0DQXDO7XQLQJ &KDQQHO(GLW &KDQQHO/DEHO Run Auto Tuning, edit channels, and select familiar channel trademarks/logos using Channel Menu options. DIGITAL 19-3 MONO STEREO SAP WXYZ Custom Text Label “WXYZ” created in 2-5-4 + MENU (Add Channel Label) Mode. 028 CH. OVERIDE 000 After verifying the TV Setup, set Installer Menu item 028 CH. OVERIDE to 000.* * This step prevents end users from accessing channel settings (i.e., the Channel Menu will be inaccessible/ grayed out). 7. Lock the channel lineup. Enter the Installer Menu, and set item 028 CH. OVERIDE to 000 to lock the channel lineup and restrict access to the TV setup menus.* Press ENTER to exit the Installer Menu and save your changes. The Master TV Setup is now ready to be copied to a clone programmer (see cloning information in this document). 206-4163 13 Installer Menu Use the Installer Menu to set up or change operational settings. Refer to the table starting on the next page for brief descriptions of Installer Menu items. More detailed descriptions follow the table listing. Accessing the Installer Menu Make sure the TV is ON. Using an Installer Remote, press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER to access the Installer Menu. The Installer Menu opens with item 000 INSTALLER SEQ 000. Use the Up/ Down arrow keys to sequence through the available menu items, or access an item directly by keying in the line number and then pressing MENU. For example, to access the SLEEP TIMER option, which is item 015, press 0-1-5 + MENU. To change a setting, use the Left/Right arrow keys, or enter a value directly. Using the Installer Menu XXLD320H PTC INSTALLER MENU 000 INSTALLER SEQ UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.000 000 FPGA E0F1 CPU V3.06.00 Typical TV Installer Menu Items 000 ~ 119 are immediately accessible only upon entering the Installer Menu. Refer to the table on pages 15 and 16 for an overview of Installer Menu items, including item numbers, functions, ranges, and default values. Installer Menu items not relevant to these TV series are not present on the Installer Menu; therefore, some numbers are missing. For example, item 006 will not appear. Exiting the Installer Menu and Activating Updates To exit the Installer Menu, press ENTER again. Any changes you make will be stored in non-volatile memory. 14 206-4163 Installer Menu (Cont.) Installer Menu Items 000 through 071 Menu Item Function Value Range Default Value Brief Description of Function and Comments 000 INSTALLER SEQ 0~3 0 Leave default set to 0. 001 POWER MANAGE 0~7 0 Sets number of hours of no activity before automatic shutoff. 002 AC ON 0/1 0 Set to 1 to enable Auto Turn ON when AC power is applied. 003 BAND/AFC 0~3 1 Selects Tuning Band: 0=Broadcast, 1=CATV, 2=HRC, 3=IRC 0 ~ 127, 255 255 Channel tuned when TV is turned ON. (Set to 255 to tune to channel tuned before TV turned OFF.) 0/1 0 If set to 1, cannot tune from current channel. 0 ~ 63, 255 255 Volume level when TV is turned ON. (Set to 255 to use volume level before TV turned OFF.) 004 STRT CHANNEL 005 CHAN LOCK 007 STRT VOLUME 008 MIN VOLUME 0 ~ 63 0 Sets minimum allowable volume setting. 0 ~ 63 63 Sets maximum allowable volume setting. 0/1 0 Set to 1 to disable Mute Function. 009 MAX VOLUME 010 MUTE DISABLE 011 KEY DEFEAT 0/1 0 Set to 1 to disable menu navigation keys on display panel. 015 SLEEP TIMER 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable Sleep Timer. 016 EN TIMER 0/1 0 Set to 1 to enable On/Off Timers. 017 ALARM 020 FEATURE LEVEL 021 V-CHIP 022 MAX BLK HRS 023 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable Alarm. 0 ~ 1, 16 ~ 24 1 Determines the IR code scheme to which the TV will respond. 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable V-Chip (Parental Control) functions. 0 ~ 99 12 Sets number of V-Chip blocking hours. CAPTION LOCK 0/1 0 Set to 1 to retain caption setting set before TV turned OFF. 028 CH. OVERIDE 0/1 1 If set to 0, limits direct access to favorite channels. 029 OLD OCV 0/1 0 Set to 1 to change MPI operation to OCV. 030 ACK MASK 0/1 0 If set to 1, changes MPI for some OCV boxes. 031 POLL RATE 20 ~ 169 94 Selects poll rate for MPI. 032 TIMING PULSE 186 ~ 227 207 Sets baud rate for MPI. 034 CAMPORT EN 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable Video 2 input. 035 COMPPORT EN. 0/1 1 Set to 0 to disable HDMI 1. Set to 1 enable HDMI 1. 038 YPrPb EN. 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable display panel Component Video 1 input jacks. 039 REAR AUX EN 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable display panel Video 1 input jack. 040 AUTO CAMPORT 0/1 1 Set to 1 to automatically switch to Camport. If set to 1, STRT AUX SRCE cannot be set to 2. 046 STRT AUX SRCE 1 ~ 6, 255 6 Sets the starting Aux source (if item 004 STRT CHANNEL is set to 0). 047 AUX STATUS 0/1 0 Set to 1 for MPI Aux source to be reported as a channel number instead of Channel 0. 053 DIS. CH-TIME 0/1 0 Set to 1 to disable Channel-Time display. 069 EN. CH-T COL. 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable custom color for the Channel-Time display. 070 FOR. CH-TIME 0~7 2 Chooses custom foreground color for the Channel-Time display. 071 BCK. CH-TIME 0~7 2 Chooses custom background color for the Channel-Time display. 206-4163 15 Installer Menu (Cont.) Installer Menu Items 073 through 119 Menu Item 16 Function Value Range Default Value Brief Description of Function and Comments 073 CH NOT AVBLE 0/1 0 If set to 1 and Channel Override is 0, “NOT AVAILABLE” message is displayed when directly accessing a channel not in the favorite Channel List. 075 REVERT CH 0/1 0 If set to 1 and loss of MPI communication occurs, TV tunes to Start Channel. 078 UPN MSB 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, most significant byte. 079 UPN MSB-1 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, most significant byte - 1. 080 UPN MSB-2 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, most significant byte - 2. 081 UPN LSB 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, least significant byte. 082 CHKSM ERROR 0/1 1 Enforces rigid MPI checksum. 083 HANDSHK TIME 0~5 5 Relaxes MPI timing to be compatible with PC-based Windowscontrolled systems. 084 PERMANENT BLK 0/1 0 Removes block hours setting for Parental Control and makes block permanent. 087 REAR RGB EN. 0 / 1 / 17 1 Dependent on item 093 RJP AVAILABLE setting. Set to 0 to disable RGB1. Set to 1 to enable for RGB PC. Set to 17 for Auto Configure. 088 EN NOISE MUTE 0/1 1 If set to 1, audio is muted if no signal is present. 090 KEY LOCK 0/1 0 If set to 1, keyboard is locked out, IR is still functional. 091 YPrPb2 EN 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable HDMI 2 input. 093 RJP AVAILABLE 0, 1, 2, 5, 6 0 Set to 0 to disable. Set to 1, 2, 5, or 6 for HDMI or DVI Mode. (See detailed descriptions.) 094 SAP MENU EN 0/1 1 Set to 0 to disable feature on Function Menu. Set to 1 to enable feature on Function Menu. 096 DEF. ASP. RATIO 0~4 2 Sets default aspect ratio at power up. See detailed descriptions and item 106. 098 PRO:CENTRIC 0~2 0 Set to 0 to disable Pro:Centric operation. Set to 1 for Flash Mode. Set to 2 for GEM (Java Application) Mode. 099 BACK LIGHTING 1 ~ 100, 101 ~ 200, 255 100 Sets the level of the TV picture back lighting. (See detailed descriptions.) 102 ATSC BAND 0~4 4 Selects ATSC band. 103 ATSC TUNE MODE 0/1 1 Set to 1 (default) for Physical Channel scan. Set to 0 for Virtual Channel scan. 104 START MINOR CH 0 ~ 255 0 Selects Minor Start Channel. Set to 0 for NTSC. 106 ASP RATIO LOCK 0/1 0 To retain set aspect ratio on power cycle, set to 1. Set to 0 for default ratio on power cycle. 116 VIDEO MUTE EN 0/1 0 Set to 0 for Normal. Set to 1 for Blank. 117 FACT DEFAULT 0/1 0 Set to 0 for Normal. Set to 1 to load presets for all Installer Menu settings. 118 POWER SAVINGS 1/3/7 3 If set to 1, the b-LAN module is always powered. If set to 3, the b-LAN module is only powered when TV is turned ON. If set to 7, the b-LAN module is never powered. 119 DATA CHANNEL 0 ~ 135 0 Set to 0 to disable. Set to the RF channel number of the Data Channel for Pro:Centric or E-Z Installation data. (See detailed descriptions.) 206-4163 Installer Menu (Cont.) Detailed Descriptions of Installer Menu Items 000 - INSTALLER SEQUENCE Speci es entry sequence to the Installer Menu. 0 = 9876 2 = 1478 To translate a TV volume level to the Installer Menu value, use the following formula: 1 = 4321 3 = 3698 001 - POWER MANAGE (Power Management) Determines hours of no activity before automatic shutoff. The Power Management function is for saving energy. If set to 0, Power Manage is Off. Settings range from 0 ~ 7, with 1 ~ 7 representing the hours that the unit will remain ON, unless there has been activity from either the control panel or remote control. 002 - AC ON (AC Power Switchable) If set to 1, this allows the TV to turn ON when AC power is applied. Pressing the ON button is not necessary. This is desirable if the TV is plugged into a cable box or a power outlet controlled by a wall switch. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to choose 0 or 1, where 0 is the default (OFF), and 1 is ON. Note: If set to 1 (ON), the TV does not respond to On/Off commands from either the remote or the display control panel, and the SLEEP TIMER is also nonfunctional. 003 - BAND/AFC (Band/Automatic Frequency Control) There are four possible settings for this option: 0 = Broadcast 2 = HRC NOTE: For items 007, 008, and 009 For legacy reasons, the scale used is 0 – 63. The PTC software will translate this to the 0 – 100 scale used by the TV. 1 = CATV (default) 3 = IRC If some channels were not found by Auto Tuning (Channel Search), select the appropriate Band setting here, and add the channels using the Channel Edit option in the Channel Menu. 004 - STRT CHANNEL (Start Channel) If active, this function allows you to determine the initial Major Start Channel number when the TV is turned ON. This feature is useful for an in-house information channel, since the TV would always select that channel when it is turned ON. Setting this item to 255 causes the last channel viewed when the TV was turned OFF, to be the tuned to channel when the TV is turned ON again. Installer Value = TV Value x 63 100 Enter only the whole number (disregard fractions). 007 - STRT VOLUME (Start Volume) This function allows the Installer to determine the initial volume level setting when the TV is turned ON. This feature is useful for an in-house information channel, since the TV would always select that volume level when it is turned ON. The range of values are 0 - 63, 255. If 255 is selected, the current volume level will be retained in memory when the TV is turned OFF; at turn ON, the volume level will be automatically set at the previous or last level. 008 - MIN VOLUME (Minimum Volume) This function determines the minimum volume level allowable with the Volume (VOL) Up/Down control. In this way, for example, someone cannot set the volume too low to hear. The value range is from 0 to 63. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to change values. The factory default is 0, which provides the full range of volume control, if item 009 MAX VOLUME is also set to 63. It may be best to set the same value on every TV. Note: The minimum volume level cannot have a value setting higher than the maximum volume level (described below). 009 - MAX VOLUME (Maximum Volume) This function determines the maximum volume level allowable with the Volume (VOL) Up/Down control. In this way, for example, someone cannot set the volume level high enough to disturb others. The value range is 0 to 63, with 63 as the default, which gives the user the full range of volume control, if item 008 MIN VOLUME is also set at 0. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to change values. It may be best to set the same value on every TV. Note: For a digital Start Channel, always remember to set item 104 to the Minor Start Channel number. Note: The maximum volume level cannot have a value setting lower than the minimum volume level (described above). 255 = Last channel 126 = Map to Channel 3 010 - MUTE DISABLE Enables or disables sound mute function. If set to 1, sound cannot be muted. If set to 0, sound can be muted. 1 ~ 125 = Major Ch. # 127 = Map to Channel 4 0 = Aux 005 - CHAN LOCK (Channel Lock) Channel Lock is ideal if the system must always be on the same channel. Changing channels with the Channel Up/Down or keypad numbers is impossible. Channel Lock is inactive if set to 0 (default). Generally, this feature is used in connection with STRT CHANNEL (Installer Menu item 004) where the Start Channel may, for example, be set to 3 or 4. If the Start Channel is 3, then the TV will remain locked on channel 3. 206-4163 011 - KEY DEFEAT (Keyboard Defeat) If set to 1, KEY DEFEAT prevents the end user from accessing the on-screen menus from the display panel—MENU, ENTER, and menu navigation keys do not function. If set to 0, those keys do function. Note: Users can always access the menus by pressing MENU on the remote. 17 Installer Menu (Cont.) 015 - SLEEP TIMER If set to 1, the Sleep Timer feature may be used. If set to 0, the Sleep Timer is not available. 016 - EN TIMER (Enable On/Off Timers) * If set to 1, the Timer function is available to the end user and enabled continuously. Set to 0 to disable On/Off timers. Note: Clock must be set in order to use timers. 017 - ALARM * Gives the installer the option of making the Alarm function available to the end user. If set to 1, the Alarm function is available to the end user. Set to 0 to disable the Alarm function. Note: Clock must be set before the Alarm function will work. 020 - FEATURE LEVEL Determines the IR code scheme to which the TV will respond, allowing for the use of unique IR codes based on “bed number” in a multi-TV single room installation. First determine the IR mode; then select the bed number. 030 - ACK MASK MPI Communication Parameter. Leave at default setting unless changed by PPV provider. When set to 1, changes MPI for some OCV boxes. 031 - POLL RATE MPI Communication Parameter. Selects Poll Rate for MPI. Leave at default setting unless changed by Pay-Per-View provider. Step size of 16 ms. 032 - TIMING PULSE MPI Communication Parameter. Leave at default setting unless changed by Pay-Per-View provider. Sets baud rate. Step size of 4.3 uS. 034 - CAMPORT EN. (Camera Port Enable) Set to 1 to enable Video 2 input on display panel. If set to 0, Video 2 input on display panel is not functional. 035 - COMPPORT EN. (Computer Port Enable) Enable/disable TV display panel HDMI 1 input jack. Set to 0 to disable HDMI1. Set to 1 to enable HDMI1. IR Mode 0 = Legacy IR Mode 1 = Multi-code remote Note: This setting is ignored if item 093 RJP AVAILABLE is set to 1. Note: For further information, see documentation for the accessory package that includes the multi-code remote. 038 - YPrPb EN. (Rear Component Video Enable) Set to 1 to enable display panel rear Component Video input jacks. Set to 0 to disable display panel rear Component Video input jacks. 021 - V-CHIP (Parental Control) * Set to 1 to activate V-Chip (Parental Control) and have it available to the end user to lter and control or otherwise restrict programming content that can appear. Set to 0 to turn the V-Chip feature Off (not available to user); no programming restrictions can be set. 039 - REAR AUX EN. (Rear Aux Enable) Set to 1 to enable display panel rear Aux (Video 1) input. Set to 0 to disable display panel rear Aux (Video 1) input. 022 - MAX BLK HRS (Maximum Block Hours) * Sets hours from 0 to 99 for the maximum V-Chip (Parental Control) block hours. Default setting is for 12 blocking hours. 040 - AUTO CAMPORT Set to 1 to automatically switch to Camport when equipment is connected to front Video input. Set to 0 to disable front Video automatic source selection. 023 - CAPTION LOCK If set to 0, captions are OFF when the TV is turned ON. Set to 1 to use the caption setting con gured before the TV was turned OFF when the TV is turned ON. 046 - STRT AUX SRCE (Start Aux Source) Sets the starting Aux source. When turned ON, the TV will tune to starting Aux source if item 004 STRT CHANNEL is set to 0. 028 - CH. OVERIDE (Channel Override) If set to 1, the user can select channels with either Channel Up/ Down or by direct keypad entry. If set to 0, only those channels that are active in the TV’s memory can be selected. If item 093 RJP AVAILABLE is set to 0 and item 040 AUTO CAMPORT is set to 0: 1 = Video 1 4 = RGB 255 = Last Aux 2 = Video 2 5 = HDMI 2 3 = HDMI 1 6 = Component 029 - OLD OCV (On Command Video™) Set to 1 for operation with systems from On Command Corporation. If item 093 RJP AVAILABLE is set to 1: 2 = Video 2 5 = HDMI 2 6 = Component * Only affects Function Menu if enabled by some PPV providers. 18 Note: If set to 1, item 093 RJP AVAILABLE is automatically set to 0. If item 040 AUTO CAMPORT is set to 1: 1 = Video 1 4 = RGB 6 = Component 3 = HDMI 1 5 = HDMI 2 206-4163 Installer Menu (Cont.) 047 - AUX STATUS Set to 1 for MPI Aux source to be reported as a channel number instead of channel 0. Set to 0 to disable Aux identi cation change. Controls MPI status channel response for Aux inputs. 082 - CHKSM ERROR (Checksum Error) Enforces rigid MPI checksum validation. Set to 1 for validation. Set to 0 to disable (does not check checksum on MPI async port). SPI is always checked. 053 - DIS. CH-TIME (Disable Channel-Time) Set to 1 to disable the Channel-Time display; Channel-Time display will not appear. Set to 0 to enable the Channel-Time display. 083 - HANDSHK TIME (Handshake Time) Adds an additional delay to the handshake time which is 64 msec, thus relaxing MPI timing requirements to be compatible with PCbased Windows controlled systems. Range is 0 - 5. (Timeout = 25.5MS + [25.5 MS* Handshake time].) 069 - EN. CH-T COL. (Enable Channel-Time Custom Color) Set to 1 to enable custom color for the Channel-Time display. Set to 0 to disable custom color for the Channel-Time display. 070 - FOR. CH-TIME (Channel-Time Display Foreground Color) Set according to Color Chart: 0 = Black 3 = Cyan 6 = Yellow 1 = Blue 4 = Red 7 = White 2 = Green 5 = Violet Note: Applies only to “Channel Not Available” message if item 073 is set to 1 (enabled). If foreground color and background color are the same, the menu background will be transparent. 071 - BCK. CH-TIME (Channel-Time Display Background Color) Set according to Color Chart: 0 = Black 3 = Cyan 6 = Yellow 1 = Blue 4 = Red 7 = White 2 = Green 5 = Violet 084 - PERMANENT BLK (Permanent Block) Allows Lock (Parental Control) blocking schemes to be permanent by disabling the blocking hours function. Set to 1 to install Parental Control restrictions permanently. Set to 0 for user-speci ed hours control of blocking schemes. 087 - REAR RGB EN. (Rear RGB Enable) Controls access to rear RGB input on TV. Set to 0 to disable RGB input. Set to 1 to enable for PC RGB input. Set to 17 to initiate a one-time automatic con guration after an AC power cycle; otherwise, automatic adjustment will be performed each time the RGB input is accessed. 088 - EN NOISE MUTE (Enable Noise Mute) If set to 1, audio mutes if no signal is present. Note: Applies only to “Channel Not Available” message if item 073 is set to 1 (enabled). If foreground color and background color are the same, the menu background will be transparent. 090 - KEY LOCK If set to 1, front keyboard Channel, Volume, and Captions buttons are disabled, Power button remains enabled. If set to 0, the Channel, Volume, Captions, and Power buttons are all enabled. 073 - CH NOT AVBLE (Channel Not Available) If set to 1 and item 028 CH. OVERIDE is set to 0, a “NOT AVAILABLE” message is displayed when directly accessing a channel not in the channel scan list available in memory. 091 - YPrPb2 EN. (HDMI2 Enable) Set to 0 to disable display panel HDMI2 input. Set to 1 to enable DTV mode. Set to 2 to enable PC mode. 075 - REVERT CH (Revert to Start Channel) If set to 1 and loss of MPI communication occurs, TV automatically tunes to the speci ed Start Channel. 078 - UPN MSB (UPN Most Significant Byte) User programmable number, most signi cant byte readable by MPI command. Not linked to serial number. 079 - UPN MSB-1 (UPN Most Significant Byte-1) User programmable number, most signi cant byte-1 readable by MPI command. Not linked to serial number. 080 - UPN MSB-2 (UPN Most Significant Byte-2) User programmable number, most signi cant byte-2 readable by MPI command. Note: Not linked to serial number. 081 - UPN LSB (UPN Least Significant Byte) User programmable number, least signi cant byte readable by MPI command. Note: Not linked to serial number. 206-4163 093 - RJP AVAILABLE (Remote Jack Pack Available) • 0 = Remote jack pack is not available or disabled. • 1 = Legacy Model RJPs: HDMI Mode Enables RJP feature for use with full cable bundle models. In this mode, when an HDMI source is connected to the RJP, both digital video and audio are expected via the HDMI cable. If no digital audio is present, no audio will be heard. • 2 = Legacy Model RJPs: DVI Mode Enables RJP feature for use with full cable bundle models. In this mode, when an HDMI/DVI source is connected to the RJP, only digital video is expected via the HDMI cable. Analog audio is provided via a separate cable, from the source, connected to an RJP AUDIO IN. If no analog audio cable is connected, tuner audio will be heard. • 5 = Scaler Model RJPs: HDMI Mode Enables RJP feature for use with reduced cable bundle models. In this mode, when an HDMI source is connected to the RJP, both digital video and audio are expected via the HDMI cable. If no digital audio is present, no audio will be heard. 19 Installer Menu (Cont.) • 6 = Scaler Model RJPs: DVI Mode Enables RJP feature for use with reduced cable bundle models. In this mode, when an HDMI/DVI source is connected to the RJP, only digital video is expected via the HDMI cable. Analog audio is provided via separate cable, from the source, connected to an RJP AUDIO IN. If no analog audio cable is connected, tuner audio will be heard. Notes: See Reference section, “RJP Model List and Input Auto-sensing Hierarchy.” If RJP AVAILABLE is set to 1, 2, 5, or 6, item 040 AUTO CAMPORT is automatically set to 0. Settings 1, 2, 5, and 6 allow the lodge staff to customize each TV’s RJP setup based on customer requirements. 094 - SAP MENU EN (2nd Audio Program) Set to 1 to enable SAP feature on Function Menu, if Function Menu is available. Set to 0 to disable SAP feature on Function Menu, if Function Menu is available. 096 - DEF. ASP. RATIO (Default Aspect Ratio) Selects default aspect ratio at power up. • • • • • Set to 0 for Set By System. Set to 1 for 4:3. Set to 2 for 16:9 (Factory Default). Set to 3 for Just Scan. Set to 4 for Zoom. Note: Only applies if item 106 ASP RATIO LOCK is disabled, set to 0. 098 - PRO:CENTRIC Selects the Pro:Centric Mode. Set to 0 (default) to disable Pro:Centric operation. Set to 1 for Flash Mode. Set to 2 for GEM (Java Application) Mode. 099 - BACK LIGHTING Sets the TV screen brightness at power up. Default setting is 100. • 1 - 100 Static Back Lighting (1 = Dimmest picture, 100 = Brightest picture) • 101 - 200 Dynamic Back Lighting (101 = Dimmest picture, 200 = Brightest picture) If set between 101 and 200, the TV automatically controls back lighting depending upon the picture level of the current program. If set to 255, back lighting is controlled via the Picture settings in the TV’s setup menus. 102 - ATSC BAND Sets up TV to receive different types of incoming signals: 0 = Broadcast, 1 = CATV, 2 = HRC, 3 = IRC, 4 = Same as NTSC. 103 - ATSC TUNE MODE Sets ATSC tuning mode: Default set to 1 for Physical Channel scan. Set to 0 for Virtual Channel scan. 20 104 - START MINOR CHANNEL Sets Minor Start Channel number at power up. 0 = NTSC. If not 0, number selected is the digital channel’s Minor Start Channel number. 106 - ASP RATIO LOCK (Aspect Ratio Lock) Set to 1 to retain previous aspect ratio with power off. Set to 0 to retain default aspect ratio with power off. See item 096 DEF. ASP. RATIO above. 116 - VIDEO MUTE EN (Video Mute Enable) Set to 0 for Normal. Set to 1 for Blank. 117 - FACT DEFAULT (Factory Default) Set to 0 for normal. Set to 1 to load presets of all Installer Menu item settings. Warning: If set to 1, this will reload the factory defaults and clear the Channel List, including any assigned channel icons and custom channel labels. 118 - POWER SAVINGS Default is set to 3. When the TV is in Standby mode, the MPI card slot is powered by the Standby power supply and embedded b-LAN is not powered. When the TV is in Power On mode, the MPI card slot is powered by the main 12V power supply and embedded b-LAN is powered. Note that the TV must be turned ON in order to communicate with the Embedded b-LAN module for con guration and control when POWER SAVINGS is set to 3. Note: MPI cards with b-LAN technology—LMT7Z5, LMT7Z7, LMT7Z9—are NOT supported on TVs in which the b-LAN module is embedded. • 1 = MPI card slot Standby Mode power provided from Standby power supply, and Embedded b-LAN is always powered. • 3 = MPI card slot Standby Mode power provided from Standby power supply, and Embedded b-LAN is only powered when the TV is turned ON. • 7 = MPI card slot Standby Mode power provided from Standby power supply, and Embedded b-LAN (including the Pro:Centric data tuner) is never powered. Note: See Reference section, “b-LAN Setup & Overview,” for further information. 119 - DATA CHANNEL Set to 0 (default) to disable. Set to the RF channel number of the Data Channel for Pro:Centric or E-Z Installation (splash screen, configuration, or firmware) data. Note: Pro:Centric updates are downloaded from the Pro:Centric server to the TV when the TV is turned OFF. Also, while Pro:Centric updates are in progress, it is not possible to turn the TV ON. The TV may take several minutes to load EPG data after the initial download of the Pro:Centric application. Subsequent updates generally will take less than one minute. 206-4163 TV Setup Menus Overview On-screen setup menus control the features of the TV. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to access the TV setup menus, and set the TV features to the desired configuration for the end user. CHANNEL PICTURE AUDIO TIME LOCK OPTION INPUT MY MEDIA Refer to the Owner’s Manual for further information on the TV setup menus. 206-4163 21 Adding Channel Label Icons / Custom Channel Labels (2-5-4 + MENU Mode) Editing/Adding Channel Icons and/or Labels If there is no pre-assigned icon, you can make a custom channel label of up to seven (7) characters to help identify a channel or network. If desired, channel labels can also be added in addition to a pre-assigned icon. You may also add labels for the Aux input sources to clearly identify the devices that are connected to the Aux inputs. (Icon) XYZ XYZ XYZ NETWORK 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 Editing and adding the labels can only be done if there are channels entered into the TV’s Channel Map either during Commercial Mode Setup (see pages 12 to 13), by cloning, or by using some PPV provider’s master remote controls. Note: A blank letter space is available between “Z” and “!”. To perform channel editing/labeling: 1. Enter the TV Installer Menu. 2. Press 2-5-4 + MENU on the Installer Remote to enter the Channel Label Editing Mode. 3. Add channel icons and channel labels as described in the procedures below. (You can do this more than once.) 4. To exit the menu when you are done, press MENU. (Label) Changing a Channel’s Icon on the Master TV Changing/Adding Channel Labels on the Master TV Changing Source Labels on the Master TV 1. Use Channel Up/Down to select the channel for which to change the icon. 1. Use Channel Up/Down to select the desired channel. 1. Press INPUT to select the desired Aux input source: A/V 1, A/V 2, HDMI Component, RGB, etc. 2. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to select the thin letter “I” on the Channel ID display. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the icon with which you want to identify the channel. (If you know the icon number, enter the number, and press ENTER.) 4. Proceed to change/add channel labels, or go to the next channel. 2. Press the Left/Right arrow repeatedly until the numbers 1 to 7 appear on the display. The number shows the position of the character that can be changed. Number 1 is the rst character, number 2 the second character, etc. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the desired character. 4. Proceed to the next number position, or use Channel Up/Down to go to the next channel. 2. Press the Left/Right arrow repeatedly until the numbers 0 to 9 appear on the display. The number shows the position of the character that can be changed. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the desired character. 4. Press INPUT for the next Aux source, or proceed to change an icon or change/add labels. Use Channel Up/Down to return to channels. Installer Remote Control Key Functions for Master TV Channel Editing/Labeling Menu • Channel Up/Down: Tunes in the next channel in scan. • Left/Right Arrows: Select the item to change. If “I” is shown, the icon can be changed. If a number is shown, it indicates the position of the character that can be changed. • Up/Down Arrows: Select the icon or the character to be displayed. Tip: Arrows can be held down for fast scrolling. 22 • 0 – 9: Use to enter the index number of the icon, if known. • ENTER: Changes the icon after the number has been entered. • INPUT: Changes the Aux input label. • MENU: Exits the editing process. 206-4163 FTG Mode of Operation FTG Configuration Overview The following steps outline local FTG configuration of individual TVs. Since these models are equipped with the EBL module, they can also be broadcast configured in FTG Mode by a Free-To-Guest Management Appliance (FMA) head end device. Refer to the Free-To-Guest (FTG) Configuration Application manual and/or the Installation & Setup manual for the FMA device for further information. Note: FTG Configuration Application software is available online at: www.LGcommercial.com/ FTGsoftware. 1. Install (if necessary) and launch the FTG Configuration Application (v5.0.0 or higher) on the PC that will be used to configure the EBL. 2. Build a Channel Map using the FTG Channel Map Editor in the FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility (or, if applicable, open an existing FTG Configuration (.rml) file). 3. Connect the PC to the TV-LINK CFG jack on the rear connections panel using a USB-to-TTL serial cable (TTL-232R-5V-AJ). If necessary, install the device driver on the PC. 4. Turn ON the TV. Note: The TV will briefly display a green text banner that shows the EBL firmware version and release date. 5. “Write” the FTG Channel Map to the EBL (converts EBL from Pass-through Mode to FTG Mode). 6. “Read” the current FTG Installer Menu settings from the EBL using the FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility. If necessary to make changes to Installer Menu items, “Write” them back to the EBL in FTG Mode. 7. Save the FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings to an FTG Configuration (.rml) file for future use. 8. Tune the TV to a Logical Channel in the FTG Channel Map. (26LD320H only) RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE HDMI 2 .......... HDMI /DVI IN 1 .......... ..... .... RJP REMOTE CONTROL OUT ..... ..... ..... (26LD320H only: GAME CONTROL/MPI) AV IN 1 VIDEO L/MONO-AUDIO-R GAME CONTROL AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) ANTENNA IN Y PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO TV-LINK CFG USB-to-TTL Serial Cable Required for local FTG configuration. R COMPONENT IN TV-LINK CFG Use for local FTG configuration. 206-4163 Laptop PC 23 FTG Mode of Operation (Cont.) Determining the TV Operating Mode / FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility Overview To determine the operating mode of the TV, press MENU on the Installer Remote. If the end user Function Menu (showing aspect ratio options—see below) appears, the TV/EBL is in FTG Mode. If the TV setup menus appear, the EBL is in Passthrough Mode. The following pages provide overviews of the FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utilities that comprise the FTG Configuration Application. Refer to the Free-To-Guest (FTG) Configuration Application manual for further information. ASPECT RATIO Move Enter Function Menu Shows that the EBL is in FTG Mode. While this menu is present on-screen, Installer Menu settings can ONLY be accessed/changed using the FTG Configuration Application. Set By Program ABC 4:3 16:9 Zoom Just Scan CHANNEL PICTURE AUDIO TIME LOCK OPTION INPUT MY MEDIA TV Setup Menus Shows that the EBL is in Pass-through Mode. Writing an FTG Channel Map into the EBL will switch the EBL from Pass-through Mode to FTG Mode. PRINT MAP Click to display a printable FTG Channel Map Report. The report can also be exported as an HTML or Text file. EDIT/ADD MAP Click to open the FTG Channel Map Editor to create or edit an FTG Channel Map (see next page). WRITE Click to transfer the FTG Channel Map to the EBL. READ Click to transfer the FTG Channel Map from the EBL to the FTG Configuration Application. FTG CHANNEL MAP CONFIGURATION UTILITY 24 LEARN Click to transfer the TV Channel Map from the PTC to the EBL and the FTG Configuration Application. (Requires that 2-5-5 + MENU was performed to transfer TV Channel Map to PTC.) * * Logical Channel numbers will automatically be assigned in ascending order, starting with 0 (zero), to the Physical Channels from the TV Channel Map. 206-4163 FTG Mode of Operation (Cont.) FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility / FTG Channel Map Editor Overview The FTG Channel Map Editor shows a single Logical Channel’s Data and the FTG Channel Map. LOGICAL CHANNEL MAPPING Select a Logical Channel number, then assign it the RF, Major, and Minor channel numbers to complete the mapping. CUSTOM CHANNEL LABELS/ICONS Enter custom labels and select icons by name on menu or by number. DELETE Click to remove highlighted channel from FTG Channel Map. SET CHANNEL ATTRIBUTES Check/select Encrypted, OSD, or Blank Video. EXIT Click to exit editor and return to FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility. ADD After defining a new Logical Channel, click to add channel to the FTG Channel Map. UPDATE After editing an existing Logical Channel’s data, click to commit the changes in the FTG Channel Map. 206-4163 25 FTG Mode of Operation (Cont.) FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility Overview CONFIGURATION SETTINGS Select tabs for categories of Installer Menu items to set up TV. INSTALLER DEFAULTS Click to reset FTG Installer Menu items shown in the FTG Configuration Application to defaults. IR REMOTE ACCESS Toggle IR Remote Access to ON to obtain access to TV setup menus and Installer Menu. WRITE Click to transfer the FTG Installer Menu settings to the EBL. HOSPITAL-GRADE TV ONLY Set Hospital items on Installer Menu for hospital-grade TVs. LEARN Click to transfer Installer Menu settings from the PTC to the EBL and FTG Configuration Application. * READ Click to transfer the Installer Menu settings in the EBL to the FTG Configuration Application. * Logical Channel numbers will automatically be assigned in ascending order, starting with 0 (zero), to the Physical Channels from the TV Channel Map. 26 206-4163 Cloning Overview / Clonable Menu Features IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION There are three options for cloning a Master TV Setup: • Using a USB memory device • Using a TLL-1100A clone programmer • Using a LT2002 clone programmer Each option is described in further detail on the pages that follow. As you perform cloning procedures, be sure to complete each task as indicated. If a procedure or step is omitted or not performed completely, cloning may not work. At each step, pay attention to ensure the TV screen shows the proper message when cloning. If the message indicated does not appear, there is a problem with that step, and cloning may not be successful. Warning: Copying a blank or incorrect memory into a TV will cause the TV to operate erratically or become inoperable. Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs. Also, if the TV is in LodgeNet PPV Mode (check with the site administrator if you are not certain), do not connect a clone programmer to the GAME CONTROL/MPI port. Either of these actions will damage the clone programmer and, if applicable, the PPV card. Before you begin cloning: • Complete the Commercial Mode Setup procedure on pages 12 to 13. • All equipment should be connected to power and turned ON. • Learning and Teaching is only possible between identical model TVs. • For both Master and Target TVs—The TV EBL must be in Pass-through Mode. • If using a USB memory device, ensure the USB device has been formatted with FAT format. • For both Master and Target TVs—If using a clone programmer, ensure the TV signal source is either an Aux or TV (RF) source. If a TV (RF) source, the TV must be tuned to an analog (not a digital) channel. • LT2002 only—Make sure the batteries in the clone programmer are fresh. If batteries are removed, the clone programmer clock time (if set) will be lost (see page 32 for information on the clone programmer clock). • Do not unplug the TV power cord or remove/disconnect the USB memory device/clone programmer while Learning or Teaching, as doing so may cause the TV to malfunction or harm the USB device/clone programmer, respectively. Clonable Menu Features Installer Menu Installer Menu item settings Channel Auto Tuning (Channel Lineup) Manual Tuning Channel Edit Channel Label Picture Aspect Ratio Picture Mode Advanced Control Audio Auto Volume Clear Voice Sound Mode Balance TV Speaker Option Menu Language Audio Language Caption Caption Mode Digital Caption Options Lock Movie Rating TV Rating – Children TV Rating – General Input Block Time Auto Clock Manual Clock Off Time On Time Auto Off (Sleep Timer) Note: Some menu options vary between analog and digital channels and Aux sources. 206-4163 27 Cloning Procedures Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a USB Memory Device USB Cloning Notes • Read the IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 27 before beginning any cloning procedures. • You may edit a lename as part of the Learning procedure; however, a le with edited contents will not be recognized. • It is not possible to clone a Master TV’s clock using a USB memory device. Either set a Target TV’s clock manually, or use the Auto Clock setting in the TV setup menus. Learn Setup from Master TV 1. Ensure the Master TV is set up completely and the EBL is in Pass-through Mode. USB Download Menu 2. Plug the USB memory device into the USB IN port on the Master TV. Upgrade TV Software 3. Press MENU to display the TV setup menus. Teach To TV 5. To gain access to the Learn From TV option in the USB Download Menu, key in the password used to enter the Installer Menu (Example: Press 9-8-7-6). Learn From TV Previous Learn From TV Select the le name and press OK to start 6. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Learn From TV and press ENTER. 8. Remove the USB memory device. xxLD320H-UA00001.TLL ► 7. To identify the pro le from others, you can use the Up/Down arrow keys to change the last ve digits of the lename. Press ENTER when you are ready to initiate Learning. Learning status will be shown on the progress bar. When the Learning process is complete, the USB Download menu will reappear on screen. Enter ► 4. Use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight the Option menu icon; then, press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. Upgrade PTC Software Previous ! Enter Learn From TV UPDATING... 25% Do not remove the USB from the port! Do not unplug! Teach Master TV Setup to Target TV 1. Ensure the Target TV EBL is in Pass-through Mode, and then plug the USB memory device with the Master TV Setup le into the Target TV USB IN port. USB Download Menu 2. Press MENU to display the TV setup menus. Upgrade PTC Software 3. Use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight the Option menu icon; then, press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. 4. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Teach To TV and press ENTER. 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select/highlight the Master TV Setup you want to install and press ENTER. Note: Filenames identify the TV and the TLL version (see example at right). Teaching status will be shown on the progress bar. When the Teaching process is complete, the USB Download menu will reappear on screen. 6. When Teaching is done, remove the USB memory device, turn OFF the TV, and unplug the TV power cord for 15 seconds. 7. Reconnect the TV power cord, and turn ON the TV. The Master TV Setup should be resident on the Target TV. 28 Upgrade TV Software Teach To TV Learn From TV Previous Enter Teach To TV xxLD320H-UA00001.TLL Previous ! Enter Teach To TV UPDATING... 50% Do not remove the USB from the port! Do not unplug! 206-4163 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a TLL-1100A Clone Programmer Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs. Also, if the TV is in LodgeNet PPV Mode (check with the site administrator if you are not certain), do not connect a clone programmer to the GAME CONTROL/MPI port. Either of these actions will damage the clone programmer and, if applicable, the PPV card. TLL-1100A Cloning Notes • Read the IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 27 before beginning any cloning procedures. • Ensure the TLL-1100A is either fully charged or connected to AC power. • Learning and Teaching is only possible between identical model TVs; however, the TLL-1100A clone programmer can store up to eight different Master TV Setups. TLL-1100A Clone Programmer TV Link Loader CHARGE Cloning is accomplished using the TV/ clone programmer MPI ports for communication (see figure). TLL1100A Ready Antenna or CATV MODE CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP MPI Cable MENU ENTER RECEIVE SEND TLL-1100A Learn Setup from Master TV 1. Ensure the Master TV is set up completely and the EBL is in Passthrough Mode. 2. If an analog channel is not available, direct tune the TV to an Aux source, or select an Aux source, such as AV-1, from the Input Menu. Then, plug one end of the MPI cable into the TV MPI port. 3. Turn ON the TLL-1100A. 4. Use the MODE button on the TLL-1100A to select Clone Mode. 5. Use the Left/Right arrows on the TLL-1100A to select the Memory CBank (1 to 8) in which to store the Master TV Setup. 6. Plug the other end of the MPI cable into the MPI port on the bottom of the TLL-1100A. The Clone Selection Menu will display on the TV screen. 7. Press 1 on the Installer Remote to select LEARN FROM TV from the Clone Selection Menu. Then, press ENTER to transfer the Master TV Setup into CBankX on the TLL-1100A. Learning usually takes about 90 seconds. “LEARNING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen while the TLL-1100A copies the Master Setup. When the Learning process is complete, a “LEARNING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. 206-4163 CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX THE CLONE IS VERSION VX.X.X - To change menu items, press channel keys or digits. - To execute item, press Enter. 29 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a TLL-1100A Clone Programmer (Cont.) (Optional) Set the Clock Set the time on a Master TV’s clock. (If the time has already been copied from a TV into the TLL-1100A clone programmer, you can set the Master TV’s clock by copying the time from the clone programmer.) The TLL1100A can copy the current time to both a Master TV and to the clone’s internal clock—accurate to within one minute. Since the TLL-1100A’s time cannot be set directly, the current time needs to be copied from an LG TV equipped with an enabled MPI port. After the time is copied to the TLL-1100A clone programmer, the current time will be maintained and can then be transferred to another TV. (This can be a Master TV or another TV which has already had the features set up.) CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX THE CLONE IS VERSION VX.X.X - To change menu items, press channel keys or digits. - To execute item, press Enter. Teach Master TV Setup to Target TV 1. When Learning is complete, disconnect the MPI cable from the Master TV. 2. Ensure the Target TV EBL is in Pass-through Mode and the TV is tuned/ set to an analog channel or Aux source, and then connect the MPI cable to the MPI port on the Target TV. The Clone Selection Menu will display on the TV screen. 3. Ensure the correct Memory CBank(X) is selected on the TLL-1100A. 4. Press 2 on the Installer Remote to select TEACH TO TV from the Clone Selection Menu. Then, press ENTER to transfer the Master TV Setup to the Target TV. Teaching usually takes 3 to 4 minutes. “TEACHING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen during Teaching. When the Teaching process is complete, a “TEACHING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. 5. When Teaching is done, disconnect the MPI cable from the Target TV, turn OFF the TV, and unplug the TV power cord for 15 seconds. 6. Reconnect the TV power cord, and turn ON the TV. The Master TV Setup should be resident on the Target TV. 30 CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX THE CLONE IS VERSION VX.X.X - To change menu items, press channel keys or digits. - To execute item, press Enter. 206-4163 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using an LT2002 Clone Programmer Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs. Also, if the TV is in LodgeNet PPV Mode (check with the site administrator if you are not certain), do not connect a clone programmer to the GAME CONTROL/MPI port. Either of these actions will damage the clone programmer and, if applicable, the PPV card. Cloning is accomplished using the TV/ clone programmer MPI ports for communication (see figure). LT2002 Cloning Notes • Read the IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 27 before beginning any cloning procedures. • A slow ashing green light indicates that there are communication problems between the TV and the LT2002 clone programmer. If this is the case, check for a damaged cable, poor contacts, or other connection troubles. • If the status indicator is red, the LT2002 batteries are low and should be replaced. Install four (4) high-quality alkaline AA batteries. MPI Cable Antenna or CATV Ferrite Core (TDK, ZCAT 2035-0930) $POOFDUDBCMFUP 57.1*+BDLBOE GPMMPXPOTDSFFO instructions Status *OEJDBUPS MPI $PMPS tHSFFO CBUUFSZPL tSFE CBUUFSZMPX Reset #MJOLQBUUFSO tTMPX QPXFSPO no communications tIFBSUCFBUQPXFSPO communications ok THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF THE TV THE CLONE IS VERSION XX THE TV IS VERSION XX THE SW IS REViSION XX CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX ® QuickSet II Programmer LT2002 - PRESS ANY KEY TO CONTINUE LT2002 Clone Programmer ZENITH ELECTRONICS CORPORATION, LINCOLNSHIRE, ILLINOIS, USA • Learning and Teaching is only possible between identical model TVs; however, the LT2002 clone programmer can store up to three different Master TV Setups. Learn Setup from Master TV 1. Ensure the Master TV is set up completely and the EBL is in Passthrough Mode. 2. If an analog channel is not available, direct tune the TV to an Aux source, or select an Aux source, such as AV-1, from the Input Menu. Then, plug one end of the MPI cable into the TV MPI port. 3. If there is a good connection after the LT2002 is connected to the TV MPI port, “THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF THE TV” message will appear on the TV screen. Press any key on the Installer Remote to access the LT2002 Clone Selection Menu. 4. Press 1 on the Installer Remote to select LEARN FROM TV from the Clone Selection Menu; then press ENTER to proceed to the Memory Bank Selection Menu (see sample screen on next page). 5. Select the clone Memory Bank in which to store the Master Setup by pressing either Channel key repeatedly to choose Memory Bank 1, 2, or 3. Note: If you choose a Memory Bank that already has a Master device’s setup programmed into it, that setup will be overwritten by the new Master TV Setup. (Continued on next page) 206-4163 THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF THE TV THE CLONE IS VERSION XX THE TV IS VERSION XX THE SW IS REVISION XX CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX - PRESS ANY KEY TO CONTINUE. - DISCONNECT CLONE WHEN DONE. CLONE SELECTION MENU (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) LEARN FROM TV TEACH TO TV SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE DISPLAY TV SETUP DISPLAY CLONE SETUP - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. 31 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using an LT2002 Clone Programmer (Cont.) (Continued from previous page) 6. Once you select the clone Memory Bank, press ENTER on the Installer Remote. The Memory Bank you selected will be shown. 7. Press POWER to transfer the Master TV Setup into the selected Memory Bank on the LT2002. Learning usually takes about 90 seconds. “LEARNING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen while the LT2002 copies the Master Setup. When the Learning process is complete, a “LEARNING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. SAVE TV SETUP IN SELECTED CLONE MEMORY (1) (2) (3) (4) MEMORY 1 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 2 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 3 VER XX REV XX RETURN TO CLONE MENU - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. (Optional) Set the Clock Set the time on a Master TV’s clock. (If the time has already been copied from a TV into the LT2002 clone programmer, you can set the Master TV’s clock by copying the time from the clone programmer.) The LT2002 can copy the current time to both a Master TV and to the clone’s internal clock—accurate to within one minute. (Another reason that the LT2002 should be equipped with fresh, high-quality alkaline batteries, is for it to keep the time as accurately as possible.) Since the LT2002’s time cannot be set directly, the current time needs to be copied from an LG TV equipped with an enabled MPI port. CLONE SELECTION MENU (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) LEARN FROM TV TEACH TO TV SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE DISPLAY TV SETUP DISPLAY CLONE SETUP - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. After the time is copied to the LT2002 clone programmer, the current time will be maintained and can then be transferred to another TV. (This can be a Master TV or another TV which has already had the features set up.) Teach Master TV Setup to Target TV 1. When Learning is complete, disconnect the MPI cable from the Master TV. 2. Ensure the Target TV EBL is in Pass-through Mode and the TV is tuned/ set to an analog channel or Aux source, and then connect the MPI cable to the MPI port on the Target TV. 3. With “THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF TV” message on display, press 2 on the Installer Remote to select TEACH TO TV from the LT2002 Clone Selection Menu. Then, press ENTER. 4. Select the LT2002 Memory Bank in which the new setup is located. Then, press POWER to transfer the Master TV Setup to the Target TV. Teaching usually takes 3 to 4 minutes. “TEACHING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen during Teaching. When the Teaching process is complete, a “TEACHING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. 5. When Teaching is done, press any key on the Installer Remote to return to the Clone Selection Menu. Then, press ENTER. 6. Disconnect the MPI cable from the Target TV, turn OFF the TV, and unplug the TV power cord for 15 seconds. 7. Reconnect the TV power cord, and turn ON the TV. The Master TV Setup should be resident on the Target TV. 32 CLONE SELECTION MENU (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) LEARN FROM TV TEACH TO TV SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE DISPLAY TV SETUP DISPLAY CLONE SETUP - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. COPY SELECTED CLONE MEMORY TO TV (1) (2) (3) (4) MEMORY 1 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 2 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 3 VER XX REV XX RETURN TO CLONE MENU - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. 206-4163 Remote Jack Pack / TV Connections & Setup Remote Jack Pack Setup RJP Available? If you will use a Remote Jack Pack (RJP) in your system, set Installer Menu item 093 RJP AVAILABLE appropriately (for example, on a legacy model RJP: HDMI Mode, set RJP AVAILABLE to 001). See Installer Menu detailed descriptions for further information. 093 RJP AVAILABLE 001 TV Connections Make these connections ONLY after Commercial Mode Setup and Cloning Master TV procedures are complete. Refer to the figure below, and connect the RJ-45 Control cable from the RJP cable bundle to the RJP INTERFACE port on the TV’s jack panel. Then, connect HDMI, RGB, and Composite Video/Audio connectors, as applicable, for the cable bundle. AUDIO/VIDEO IN 1 Connect Composite Video/ Audio connectors from RJP cable bundle. (Composite Video on legacy RJP only.) RJP Connect RJ-45 Control cable from RJP cable bundle. (26LD320H only) RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) HDMI HDMI /DVI IN RESET UPDATE 2 .......... 1 .......... ANTENNA IN ..... .... RJP REMOTE CONTROL OUT ..... ..... ..... AV IN 1 GAME CONTROL AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT (8 ) Y PB VIDEO (26LD320H only: GAME CONTROL/MPI) VIDEO L/MONO-AUDIO-R PR L AUDIO TV-LINK CFG R COMPONENT IN RGB IN (PC) Connect RGB connector from RJP cable bundle (legacy RJP only). HDMI/DVI IN 1 Connect HDMI connector from RJP cable bundle. 206-4163 33 Reference: Upgrading TV/PTC Software using a USB Memory Device Checking the Software Versions XXLD320H PTC INSTALLER MENU Note: This function is not accessible while the TV is in FTG or PPV Mode. You can check the software versions of the TV by accessing the Installer Menu with the Installer Remote: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. When you are finished, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. 000 INSTALLER SEQ UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.000 PTC Version 000 Typical Installer Menu FPGA E0F1 CPU V3.06.00 CPU Version Upgrading TV/PTC Software Before you begin, note that the software upgrade les must be stored in a folder named “LG_DTV” in the root directory of the USB memory device. Also, ensure the USB device has been formatted with FAT format. Note for TV Software Upgrade only: If the TV detects a later version of software on the USB device, it will automatically display a dialog from which you can start the software upgrade immediately. Otherwise, you can close the dialog, and access the USB Download Menu as described below. 1. Turn the TV ON. USB Download Menu Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV Previous Enter TV Software Update (Expert) 2. Plug the USB memory device into the USB IN port on the TV. 3. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to display the TV setup menus. 4. Use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight either the Option (if EBL is in Pass-through Mode) or Lock (if TV is in FTG or LodgeNet PPV Mode) menu icon; then, press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. TV Software Update 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Upgrade TV Software or Upgrade PTC Software, as applicable, and press ENTER. 6. Select the appropriate option(s), depending on the type of upgrade you are performing: • TV Software Upgrade: (See screen samples at right.) Select TV Software Update from the rst TV Software Update window. In the second TV Software Update window, select/highlight the update le to install and press ENTER. Note: Do not select Forced Update options unless you have been speci cally instructed to do so or have previous experience with Expert Software Updates. • PTC Software Upgrade: In the PTC Software Update window, select/highlight the update le to install and press ENTER. Note: The PTC Software Update window is similar to the second TV Software Update window, though there are no Forced Update options. Current software version information is shown at the top and update les on the USB device are listed at the bottom of the window. LOGO Image Download TV Software Update (Expert) [ Current TV Software Version Information ] EPK : 03.03.00 The following software files are found in the memory card. Select the file you want to download to this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. EPK : 03.05.00 [ Forced Update Option ] Ext. MICOM SPI Boot LOGO Image xxLD320H_v3_05_RevNo4204_USB The TV will show update completion progress in a new window. Do NOT remove the USB device until the software upgrade is complete. When a TV software upgrade is complete, the TV will reset itself with an automatic restart. When a PTC upgrade is complete, the TV will turn OFF. 34 206-4163 Reference: Downloading a Splash Screen using a USB Memory Device Splash Screen Image File Guidelines USB Download Menu • The splash screen image must be a baseline (not progressive) JPEG. Upgrade TV Software • The image should be no larger than 1 MB. • The ideal size for the image is 1366 x 768 pixels or under. • The image le must be stored in a folder named “LG_DTV” in the root directory of USB memory device. • Ensure the USB device has been formatted with FAT format. Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV Previous Enter TV Software Update (Expert) Downloading a Splash Screen Image 1. Turn the TV ON. 2. Plug the USB memory device into the USB IN port on the TV. 3. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to display the TV setup menus. 4. Use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight either the Option (if EBL is in Pass-through Mode) or Lock (if TV is in FTG or LodgeNet PPV Mode) menu icon; then, press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Upgrade TV Software and then press ENTER. 6. Select LOGO Image Download from the rst TV Software Update window. TV Software Update LOGO Image Download TV Software Update (Expert) The following software files are found in the memory card. Select the file you want to download to this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. 7. In the second TV Software Update window, select/highlight the image le to download and press ENTER. The TV will show download completion progress in a new window. Do NOT remove the USB device until the image download is complete. When the image download is complete, the TV will reset itself with an automatic restart. Upon the restart, you should see the new splash screen. 206-4163 Splash Image 1366 X 768 ProCentric 35 Reference: Power Consumption Settings The following tables assume that Installer Menu item 118 POWER SAVINGS is set to 003 (default) and Installer Menu item 099 BACK LIGHTING is set as shown below (default value is 100). 26LD320H Item 099 Back Lighting (Static) 32LD320H / 32LD325H Power Consumption (Watts) Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) 100 56.82 0.00% 72.97 0.00% 90 80 70 60 50 40 30 20 10 1 51.98 47.09 42.06 39.71 37.36 36.31 35.12 32.59 30.23 27.95 8.52% 17.13% 25.97% 30.12% 34.25% 36.10% 38.19% 42.64% 46.80% 50.82% 63.82 58.53 53.58 44.24 41.27 38.71 36.20 33.51 31.01 28.55 12.54% 19.78% 26.57% 39.38% 43.45% 46.95% 50.39% 54.07% 57.51% 60.87% 26LD320H Item 099 Back Lighting (Dynamic) Percent Savings 32LD320H / 32LD325H 37LD320H / 37LD325H Power Consumption (Watts) 42LD320H Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) 88.92 0.00% 107.53 0.00% 84.19 77.84 72.19 66.28 60.90 56.58 52.35 47.75 43.68 39.62 5.32% 12.46% 18.81% 25.46% 31.51% 36.37% 41.13% 46.30% 50.88% 55.44% 86.68 78.79 72.81 66.78 60.61 56.35 52.90 47.71 43.04 38.86 19.39% 26.73% 32.29% 37.89% 43.63% 47.60% 50.81% 55.63% 59.98% 63.86% 37LD320H / 37LD325H Power Consumption (Watts) Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) 200 72.19 0.00% 75.45 0.00% 190 180 170 160 150 140 130 120 110 101 68.21 63.72 59.21 55.04 50.81 46.03 41.49 36.32 31.52 26.95 5.51% 11.74% 17.99% 23.76% 29.62% 36.24% 42.53% 49.69% 56.34% 62.67% 69.23 65.26 60.72 56.29 51.82 46.62 41.67 36.14 31.11 26.41 8.25% 13.51% 19.53% 25.40% 31.33% 38.21% 44.78% 52.10% 58.76% 65.00% Percent Savings 42LD320H Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) 110.86 0.00% 125.41 0.00% 99.05 92.33 85.39 78.61 71.70 63.53 55.65 47.34 39.90 33.00 10.65% 16.72% 22.98% 29.10% 35.32% 42.69% 49.80% 57.30% 64.01% 70.24% 111.41 103.30 95.29 87.64 79.71 70.73 61.80 51.86 42.90 34.52 11.16% 17.63% 24.02% 30.11% 36.44% 43.60% 50.72% 58.65% 65.79% 72.47% Percent Savings Note: Values are results of controlled experiments under laboratory conditions. 36 206-4163 Reference: TV Camport Auto Sense Operation The Camport Auto Sense function is enabled when: 1. Installer Menu item 034 CAMPORT EN is set to 1 AND 2. Installer Menu item 040 AUTO CAMPORT is enabled (1). Selectable: Can be accessed with INPUT key, direct access, etc. Auto Sense: TV switches to this input when connector is inserted. The Camport (Side [AV IN 2] Video) has the highest priority and will override any commands including tuning to the Start Channel. Camport Operation (Stand-alone) When Camport Auto Sense is enabled as above, the TV’s source will switch to the Side (AV IN 2) Video Aux source whenever a plug is inserted into the AV IN 2 Video input. When the plug is removed, the TV will switch back to the previous channel or input source that was being displayed before the plug was inserted. However, if any direct access to an RF channel or Aux channel is requested while the Camport is active, then, when the video plug is removed, the TV will switch to the last requested channel. Source changes using any Source keys (INPUT) are ignored. Channel Up/Down and Flashback commands are not direct access tuning commands, and they are also ignored. Camport Operation (FTG or PPV) The operation will be similar to that of the Stand-alone Mode. However, when the Channel Map is maintained external to the PTC (i.e., FTG and PPV), Channel Up/ Down or Flashback keys are sent as Direct Access tuning commands to the PTC/TV. 206-4163 CAMPORT (Side Video) Functionality Control Item 034 CAMPORT EN Item 040 AUTO CAMPORT Side (AV IN 2) Video Operation 0 0 Disabled 0 1 Disabled 1 0 Selectable 1 1 Auto Sense Previous State Before Inserting CAMPORT Operation While CAMPORT is Active State Upon Removal of CAMPORT Aux or RF Channel None Previous Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Direct Access Last Requested Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Ch Up/Down, Flashback, and Input Keys Previous Aux or RF Channel Previous State Before Inserting CAMPORT Operation While CAMPORT is Active State Upon Removal of CAMPORT Aux or RF Channel None Previous Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Direct Access Last Requested Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Ch Up/Down, Flashback, and Input Keys Last Requested Aux or RF Channel 37 Reference: TV Aux Input Configuration ENABLE DIRECT ACCESS Tuning TV Installer Menu MPI DATA MPI DATA STATUS TYPE 0x41 SOURCES ENABLED (R/W) DATA STATUS TYPE 0xD2 CURRENT AV SOURCE (R) DATA STATUS TYPE 0x0D AUX SOURCE (R) START AUX SOURCE ASSIGNMENT OLD_ OCV = 0 OLD_ OCV = 1 Source Input Source Mode Number Labeling Value Labeling Value Labeling 130 90 Video2 (Side) CV 34 CAMPORT_EN 0x01 Video Front (Camport) 0 Video Front (Camport) 0 (VIDEO) 2 131 91 Video1 (Rear) CV 39 REAR_AUX_EN 0x02 Rear Video (Aux) 1 Rear Video (Aux) 0 (VIDEO) 1 132 92 HDMI2 DTV/PC 91 YPrPb2 EN = 1 0x04 S-Video Rear 2 S-Video Rear 0 (VIDEO) 5 133 93 HDMI1/DVI DTV/PC 35 COMPPORT_EN =1 0x08 Front Computer 3 Front Computer 0 (VIDEO) 3 134 94 RGB PC 87 REAR RGB EN =2 0x10 SVGA Rear Computer 4 SVGA Rear Computer 2 (COMPUTER) 4 136 96 Component 38 YPrPb EN 0x40 Y/UV Component 6 Rear Y/PrPb Component Video 0 (VIDEO) 6 38 206-4163 Reference: b-LAN Setup & Overview The b-LAN module is internal to the TV. It allows the hotel/institution head end equipment to communicate, via the institution’s RF distribution system, with the TV for configuration and control. Note: MPI cards with b-LAN technology—LMT7Z5, LMT7Z7, LMT7Z9—are NOT supported on TVs in which the b-LAN module is embedded. Power to the b-LAN module is controlled by Installer Menu item 118 POWER SAVINGS. The default value is 003—the b-LAN module is only powered when the TV is turned ON. See chart below. TV Standby State TV Power On State b-LAN Power b-LAN Power 001 On On 003 (default) Off On 007 Off Off POWER SAVINGS The control device at the head end, for example, an LG FMA-LG101, can control multiple TVs. When the TV is first installed, it must be turned ON in order for the head end to be able to communicate with the b-LAN. At this point, if it is desired for the b-LAN to always be powered, including while the TV is in Standby, set Installer Menu item 118 POWER SAVINGS to 001. If the embedded b-LAN will not be used, enable maximum power savings in both Standby and TV Power On Mode by setting Installer Menu item 118 POWER SAVINGS to 007. 206-4163 39 Reference: RJP Model List and Input Auto-sensing Hierarchy RJP Model List Legacy Models Scaler Models RJP-101M N/A RJP-101ML N/A RJP-110F RJP-210F RJP-110FW RJP-210FW RJP-110W RJP-210W RJP-110WBR RJP-210WBR RJP-110S RJP-210S RJP-120G RJP-220G RJP-120T RJP-220T RJP-201B RJP-301B RJP-202B RJP-302B RJP Input Auto-sensing Hierarchy 40 Priority Video Audio 1st (Highest) Digital Video In Audio In (3.5mm) 2nd PC Video In Audio In (L/R) 3rd Video In Digital Video In 206-4163 Troubleshooting General Troubleshooting Some Quick and Easy Tips for Resolving Problems Symptom Possible Cause(s) Possible Solution(s) Channel not included in channel lineup in TV controller. After 2-5-5 + MENU, only channels included in TV controller will appear. If channel is available, it can be added to channel lineup. If it is not available, the “No Signal” message appears on the TV screen. Software Problems Cannot direct enter channel number or “No Signal” appears. Power No power. See troubleshooting flow chart on following page. Display Panel Picture No picture. Display panel is turned off. • Turn TV ON. • Power failure? Antenna/cable not connected. Connect antenna/cable signal to TV. Connections incorrect. Check connections on TV. MPI not connected. If applicable, connect MPI cable to MPI device. Encrypted program. Try another channel. Wrong tuning band. Adjust Installer Menu settings. Wrong Installer Menu settings. Adjust Installer Menu settings as required. Remote not in TV Mode. Use MODE key to select “TV”; puts remote into TV Mode. Not aimed at IR remote sensor. Point remote at TV’s IR receiver on TV. Remote too far from IR sensor. Move remote closer to TV’s IR receiver or darken room. Erratic Operation Installer Menu setup. Installer Remote Remote doesn’t work. MPI not connected. If applicable, connect MPI cable to MPI device. IR path to TV’s receiver obstructed. Remove obstructions. Weak batteries. Replace batteries. Wrong battery polarity. Check that “+” and “-” match in battery compartment. Too much light in room. Dim room light. Wrong Installer Remote. Requires compatible Installer Remote. Contact your LG dealer. Audio muted. Press MUTE or use Volume Up key to increase sound level. Broadcast problem. Try a different channel. Picture Reception Normal picture, poor or no sound. Note: For other problems not caused by the TV, refer to the other devices’ operating guide(s). 206-4163 41 Troubleshooting (Cont.) Troubleshooting Flow Chart Controller Quick Check STATUS LED on PTC Board blinking? No TV connected to AC Power? No Plug into AC Power outlet. Yes Yes Bad TV Cycle the power by removing and reconnecting the AC Power cord. Then, observe POWER LED on front of TV. POWER LED lit? No Bad Analog or Digital Board Yes No Bad TV No Bad PPV Card Yes Press POWER on Installer Remote. TV turned ON? TV responded? Press VOLUME UP/ DOWN or MUTE key on User-supplied Remote. No Bad TV TV responded? Yes Yes Press VOLUME UP/ DOWN or MUTE key on Installer Remote. 42 End 206-4163 Troubleshooting (Cont.) Commercial Mode Check / FTG Operation Troubleshooting Commercial Mode Check Press POWER on Installer Remote. TV responded? No Bad TV Yes Leave the TV set ON. Go to Installer Menu by pressing MENU until the on-screen setup menus lock up (i.e., stop responding). TV stopped responding or continued to respond? Stopped responding TV is in Commercial Mode. Continued to respond TV is not in Commercial Mode. Call Technical Support for assistance. FTG Operation Troubleshooting The following table provides troubleshooting information for when the EBL is configured in the FTG Mode of operation. Symptom Possible Cause(s) Solution(s) Communication Error (“Communications Timeout”) Cable(s) not connected. Check and connect communication cables. TV not powered. Check/connect the TV power cord. TV not turned ON. TV needs to be turned ON (default FTG Mode). Wrong COM (communication) port. In the FTG Configuration Application, select the correct COM port for the cable being used. 206-4163 43 Troubleshooting (Cont.) Clone Programmer Troubleshooting Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs. Also, if the TV is in LodgeNet PPV Mode (check with the site administrator if you are not certain), do not connect a clone programmer to the GAME CONTROL/ MPI port. Either of these actions will damage the clone programmer and, if applicable, the PPV card. Reset Clone Programmer After Static Shock After replacing exhausted batteries (LT2002 only), or if the clone programmer behaves strangely after a static shock: • TLL-1100A: Turn the TLL-1100A OFF and then ON. • LT2002: Use a paper clip or similar instrument inserted through the small hole marked RESET to activate the internal reset switch and restore normal operation. Symptom After a reset, check the real-time clock setting. It may be necessary to set the clone programmer clock from a TV containing the correct time. Notes • The TLL-1100A and LT2002 clone programmers are designed to be used with TVs containing the 221-01006 and later processors. Use with earlier TVs may give unpredictable results. Processors used before the 221-01006-04 have a limited screen display capability; they cannot display entire screens as shown in the setup instructions accompanying the clone programmer. Use the printed menu illustrations in the documentation as an aid to making your programming choices. • For both Master and Target TVs—The TV EBL must be in Pass-through Mode for cloning purposes. See also IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 27. Possible Cause(s) Possible Solution(s) Clone copies setup in less than 30 seconds. Not enough time to copy entire TV setup. TLL-1100A: Turn the TLL-1100A Off and then ON. LT2002: Press RESET on clone programmer. Then redo Learn/Teach. (Learning usually takes about 90 seconds; Teaching usually takes 3 to 4 minutes.) Remote does not operate clone programmer. Wrong Installer Remote. Only use an LG Installer Remote to operate clone programmer with TV. Clone menu does not display on TV screen, TLL1100A shows error message, or LT2002 LED does not blink. MPI cord not connected. Connect MPI cord properly, and ensure good connection. TV not turned ON. TV must be powered ON for clone programmer to work. (LT2002 only) Weak batteries. Install four (4) fresh AA high-quality alkaline batteries. (TLL-1100A only) No charge. Ensure the TLL-1100A is fully charged or connected to AC power. Clone menu hard to read. Weak signal. Connect TV to a reliable analog channel signal source. No time set. Time not available. Set time on a TV, and copy time to clone programmer. Clone not working. Clone programmer problem. • Try a different clone programmer. • Reset the clone programmer. Clone scans channels more than once. Clone should only scan channels Ensure TV is set up correctly, and try cloning again. once. Clone Programmer Master and Target TVs Cloning did not work. Procedure interrupted. Wait until procedure complete message is displayed. Different TV models. Cloning is only possible with identical model TVs. Step(s) omitted or not performed. Refer to the applicable cloning procedure(s), and make sure all tasks were performed. (LT2002 only) Clone time disappeared. Batteries were removed. Batteries must remain installed to retain time settings. New setup not present. Target TV not reset. Disconnect Target TV from AC power for fifteen (15) seconds. • After cloning operations are complete, unplug the TLL-1100A/LT2002 from the TV. • If the TV does not display a picture (blank screen) after a few seconds, just change channels. 44 206-4163 Glossary of Terms A list of de nitions for some of the words found in this guide. 75 OHM RF CABLE The wire that comes from an off-air antenna or cable service provider. The end looks like a hex-shaped nut with a wire through the middle. It screws onto the Antenna/Cable threaded jack on the back of the TV. 300 TO 75 OHM ADAPTER A small device that connects a 2-wire 300 ohm antenna to a 75 ohm RF jack. It is usually about an inch long with two screws on one end and a round opening with a wire extending out the other end. A/V CABLES Audio/Video cables. Three cables bunched together—right audio (red), left audio (white), and video (yellow). A/V cables are used for stereo playback of videocassettes and for higher quality picture and sound from other A/V devices. COMPOSITE VIDEO Typical video jack, uses one wire for transporting three-color video signals. DELETE Lets you remove channels from the list that the end user can scroll through using Channel Up/Down. DIGITAL TELEVISION High-resolution, cinema-quality television signals transmitted digitally. DVI Digital Video Interface. Accommodates analog and digital interfaces with a single connector. HDMI High-de nition multi-media interface. A/V DEVICE Any device that produces video or sound (VCR, DVD, cable box, or television). HDSTB High-de nition set top box. Refers to a tuner device that receives high-de nition television signals which have higher resolution than ordinary analog TV signals. AMPLIFIER An electronic device that ampli es sound from a television, CD player, VCR, DVD player, or other Audio/Video device. HDTV High-de nition television. Refers to television signals that have higher resolution than ordinary analog TV signals. ANTENNA The physical receiver of television signals sent over the air. A large metal piece of equipment does not always have to be visible to be using an antenna. INPUT Refers to the input jack that receives a signal from a TV, VCR, DVD Player or other Audio/Video device. b-LAN Licensed proprietary RF communication system used to con gure/control TV via RF distribution system. CABLE Cable service box. Refers to the descrambler box cable subscribers use to receive cable programming signals. CATV Programming provided by a cable service. JACK An input or output connector on the back of a TV, VCR, DVD Player or other Audio/Video device. MONO SOUND Mono (monaural) sound is one channel of sound. On more than one speaker, all the speakers play the same audio. OUTPUT Refers to the output jack that sends a signal out of a VCR, DVD, or other A/V device. PHYSICAL CHANNEL NUMBER The actual channel number. Analog channels use the Physical Channel number and digital channels can use a Virtual Channel number. RGB (RED, GREEN, BLUE) Connection input or output port available for producing a video image using three separate colors: Red, Green, and Blue. RS-232 Serial communication port through which rmware is downloaded. 2ND AUDIO PROGRAMMING/SAP Second Audio Programming (SAP) is another, separate audio channel available with some programming. Choosing SAP often refers to listening to audio in another language, such as Spanish or French. SIGNAL Picture and sound traveling through a cable, or over the air, to the TV. STEREO SOUND Stereo (Stereophonic) sound refers to audio that’s divided into right and left sides. TUNER Device that picks up the broadcast signal and turns it into picture and sound. VIRTUAL CHANNEL NUMBER A re-mapped channel number. Analog channels use the Physical Channel number; however digital channels use a Virtual (or false) Channel number. XDS Extended Data Service. Additional program information included on the signal provided at the discretion of the broadcaster. Note: Refer to www.atsc.org for further information. COMPONENT VIDEO Uses three wires for transporting threecolor video signals. The end result is usually better video quality. 206-4163 45 Document Revision History / Notes Document Revision History Date Description December 2010 Revision A: New Document January 2011 Revision B: Includes LD325H TVs Product documentation is available online at: www.LGsolutions.com/products. From the Products page, select TVs, Systems & Solutions, then LCD TVs, then the applicable TV. Click the Literature & Downloads tab at the bottom of the TV page, and select the required document(s) from the Downloads list. Notes 46 206-4163 For Customer Support/Service, please call: 1-888-865-3026 www.LGsolutions.com Pro:Idiom is a registered trademark of Zenith Electronics LLC. Pro:Centric is a trademark of LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. b-LAN is a trademark of LodgeNet Interactive Corporation. All other trademarks or registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. © Copyright 2011, LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 206-4163 Revision B 32LD310H 37LD310H Lodging Guest Interactive Pro:Centric™ TVs Commercial Mode Setup Guide Note: Selected features shown in this guide may not be available on all models. EXPERIENCED INSTALLER Commercial Mode Setup pages 12 – 13 Cloning Information pages 23 – 28 FTG Mode of Operation pages 29 – 36 © Copyright 2011, LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. P/N: 206-4177 (Rev A) For Customer Support/Service, please call: 1-888-865-3026 The latest product information and documentation is available online at: www.LGsolutions.com/products MODEL and SERIAL NUMBER The model and serial numbers of this TV are located on the back of the cabinet. For future reference, LG suggests that you record those numbers here: Model No._________________Serial No. _______________ WARNING RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT OPEN WARNING: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK). NO USERSERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE. REFER TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL. The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral triangle, is intended to alert the user to the presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to persons. The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert the user to the presence of important operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the appliance. WARNING: TO PREVENT FIRE OR SHOCK HAZARDS, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS PRODUCT TO RAIN OR MOISTURE. POWER CORD POLARIZATION: This product is equipped with a 3-wire grounding-type alternating current power plug. This plug will fit into the power outlet only one way. This is a safety feature. If you are unable to insert the plug fully into the outlet, contact your electrician to replace your obsolete outlet. Do not defeat the safety purpose of the 3-wire grounding-type plug. NOTE TO CABLE/TV INSTALLER: This reminder is provided to call the cable TV system installer’s attention to Article 820-40 of the National Electric Code (U.S.A.). The code provides guidelines for proper grounding and, in particular, specifies that the cable ground shall be connected to the grounding system of the building, as close to the point of the cable entry as practical. REGULATORY INFORMATION: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: • Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna. • Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver. • Connect the equipment to an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. • Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help. CAUTION: Do not attempt to modify this product in any way without written authorization from LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. Unauthorized modification could void the user’s authority to operate this product. COMPLIANCE: The responsible party for this product’s compliance is: LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 1000 Sylvan Avenue, Englewood Cliffs, NJ 07632, USA • Phone: 1-201-816-2000 Marketed and Distributed in the United States by LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 1000 Sylvan Avenue, Englewood Cliffs, NJ 07632 2 © Copyright 2011, LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 206-4177 IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS 1. Read these instructions. 2. Keep these instructions. 3. Heed all warnings. 4. Follow all instructions. 5. Do not use this apparatus near water. 6. Clean only with dry cloth. 7. Do not block any ventilation openings. Install in accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions. 8. Do not install near any heat sources, such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus (including amplifiers) that produce heat. 9. Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or grounding-type plug. A polarized plug has two blades with one wider than the other. A grounding-type plug has two blades and a third grounding prong. The wide blade or the third prong are provided for your safety. If the provided plug does not fit into your outlet, consult an electrician for replacement of the obsolete outlet. 10. Protect the power cord from being walked on or pinched, particularly at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the point where it exits from the apparatus. 11. Only use attachments/accessories specified by the manufacturer. 12. Use only with the cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table specified by the manufacturer or sold with the apparatus. When a cart is used, use caution when moving the cart/ apparatus combination in order to avoid injury from tipover. 17. Power Cord Caution: It is recommended that appliances be placed upon a dedicated circuit; that is, a single outlet circuit which powers only that appliance and has no additional outlets or branch circuits. Check the specification page of the Owner’s Manual to be certain. Periodically examine the cord of your appliance, and if its appearance indicates damage or deterioration, unplug it, discontinue use of the appliance, and have the cord replaced with an exact replacement part by an authorized servicer. Protect the power cord from physical or mechanical abuse, such as twisting, kinking, or pinching or being closed in a door or walked upon. Pay particular attention to plugs, wall outlets, and the point where the cord exits the appliance. Do not use a damaged or loose power cord. Be sure to grasp the plug when unplugging the power cord. Do not pull on the power cord to unplug the TV. 18. Overloading Do not connect too many appliances to the same AC power outlet as this could result in fire or electric shock. Do not overload wall outlets. Overloaded wall outlets, loose or damaged wall outlets, extension cords, frayed power cords, or damaged or cracked wire insulation are dangerous. Any of these conditions could result in re or electric shock. 19. Outdoor Use/Wet Location Warning: To reduce the risk of fire or electrical shock, do not expose this product to rain, moisture or other liquids. Do not touch the TV with wet hands. Do not install this product near ammable objects such as gasoline or candles or expose the TV to direct air conditioning. Do not expose to dripping or splashing and do not place objects lled with liquids, such as vases, cups, etc., on or over the apparatus (e.g., on shelves above the unit). PORTABLE CART WARNING 13. Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel. Servicing is required when the apparatus has been damaged in any way, such as power-supply cord or plug is damaged, liquid has been spilled or objects have fallen into the apparatus, the apparatus has been exposed to rain or moisture, does not operate normally, or has been dropped. 14. Never touch this apparatus or antenna during a thunder or lighting storm. 15. When mounting a TV on the wall, make sure not to install the TV by the hanging power and signal cables on the back of the TV. 16. Do not allow an impact shock or any objects to fall into the product, and do not drop objects onto the screen. 206-4177 20. Grounding Ensure that you connect the earth ground wire to prevent possible electric shock (i.e., a TV with a three-prong grounded AC plug must be connected to a three-prong grounded AC outlet). If grounding methods are not possible, have a qualified electrician install a separate circuit breaker. Do not try to ground the unit by connecting it to telephone wires, lightening rods, or gas pipes. 21. Disconnect Device The mains plug is the disconnecting device. The plug must remain readily operable. As long as this unit is connected to the AC wall outlet, it is not disconnected from the AC power source even if you turn off this unit by SWITCH. (Continued on next page) 3 IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS (Continued from previous page) 22. Outdoor Antenna Grounding If an outside antenna or cable system is connected to the product, follow the precautions below. An outdoor antenna system should not be located in the vicinity of overhead power lines or other electric light or power circuits or where it can come into contact with such power lines or circuits as death or serious injury can occur. Be sure the antenna system is grounded so as to provide some protection against voltage surges and built-up static charges. Article 810 of the National Electrical Code (NEC) in the U.S.A. provides information with respect to proper grounding of the mast and supporting structure, grounding of the leadin wire to an antenna-discharge unit, size of grounding conductors, location of antenna-discharge unit, connection to grounding electrodes, and requirements for the grounding electrode. Antenna Grounding According to NEC, ANSI/NFPA 70 Ground Clamp Antenna Lead in Wire Antenna Discharge Unit (NEC Section 810-20) Electric Service Equipment Grounding Conductor (NEC Section 810-21) Ground Clamps Power Service Grounding Electrode System (NEC Art 250, Part H) 27. If you smell smoke or other odors coming from the TV or hear strange sounds, unplug the power cord, and contact an authorized service center. 28. Do not press strongly on the panel with a hand or sharp object (e.g., a nail, pencil, or pen) or make a scratch on it. 29. Keep the product away from direct sunlight. 30. Dot Defect The Plasma or LCD panel is a high technology product with resolution of two million to six million pixels. In a very few cases, you could see fine dots on the screen while you’re viewing the TV. Those dots are deactivated pixels and do not affect the performance and reliability of the TV. 31. Generated Sound “Cracking”: A cracking noise that occurs while the TV is On or when it is turned Off is generated by plastic thermal contraction due to temperature and humidity. This noise is common for products where thermal deformation is required. Electrical circuit humming/panel buzzing: A low level noise is generated from a high-speed switching circuit, which supplies a large amount of current to operate a product. It varies depending on the product. This generated sound does not affect the performance and reliability of the product. 32. For LCD TV If the TV feels cold to the touch, there may be a small “flicker” when it is turned On. This is normal; there is nothing wrong with TV. Some minute dot defects may be visible on the screen, appearing as tiny red, green, or blue spots. However, they have no adverse effect on the monitor’s performance. Avoid touching the LCD screen or holding your finger(s) against it for long periods of time. Doing so may produce some temporary distortion effects on the screen. 23. Cleaning When cleaning, unplug the power cord and rub gently with a soft cloth to prevent scratching. Do not spray water or other liquids directly on the TV as electric shock may occur. Do not clean with chemicals such as alcohol, thinners or benzene. 24. Transporting Product Make sure the product is turned Off and unplugged and that all cables have been removed. It may take two or more people to carry larger TVs. Do not press against or put stress on the front panel of the TV. 25. Ventilation Install the TV where there is proper ventilation. Do not install in a confined space such as a bookcase. Do not cover the product with cloth or other materials (e.g., plastic) while it is plugged in. Do not install in excessively dusty places. 26. Do not touch the ventilation openings, as they may become hot while the TV is operating. 4 206-4177 Table of Contents Safety Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 Teaching FMA Configuration to a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Important Safety Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 – 4 Learning an FMA Configuration File from a TV . . . . 31 Table of Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Optional Manual Configuration / Setup for a TV. . . . 32 Setup Checklist / Commercial Mode Setup Overview . . 6 FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility Overview. . . 33 Pro:Centric TV Interactive Menu Features. . . . . . . . . . . 7 FTG Channel Map Editor Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 LD310H Rear Jack Panel. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility Overview. . 35 Side Connections Panel / RF Antenna & MPI Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 FMA Configuration Utility Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Installer Overview. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Installer Remote Control Typical Key Functions . . . . . 11 Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV . . . . . . . 12 – 13 Installer Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 – 20 TV Setup Menus Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Adding Channel Icons / Custom Channel Labels (2-5-4 + MENU Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Cloning Overview / Clonable Menu Features . . . . . 23 References Upgrading TV/PTC Software using a USB Memory Device. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Downloading a Splash Screen using a USB Memory Device. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Power Consumption Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 TV Camport Auto Sense Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 TV Aux Input Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Cloning Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 – 28 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 – 45 Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a USB Memory Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 General Troubleshooting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a TLL-1100A Clone Programmer . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 – 26 Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using an LT2002 Clone Programmer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 – 28 FTG Mode of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 – 36 FTG Mode Overview / Determining the TV Operating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Creating an FMA Configuration File using the FTG Configuration Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Troubleshooting Flow Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Commercial Mode Check / FTG Operation Troubleshooting. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Clone Programmer Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Glossary of Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Document Revision History / Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 Back Cover. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Notes • Installer Menu content is intended for use primarily by quali ed TV electronics technicians. • Refer to the Owner’s Manual for additional information on TV features, speci cations, maintenance, and safety instructions. • For additional information, contact your LG representative. For Customer Support/Service, please call: 1-888-865-3026 www.LGsolutions.com Note: Design and specifications subject to change without prior notice. 206-4177 5 Setup Checklist / Commercial Mode Setup Overview Setup Checklist Installation and Setup Checklist __ Unpack TV and all accessories. __ Install batteries in remote control. __ Install TV on VESA mount or stand. Note: It may be advisable to make all cable connections before installing on VESA mount or stand, as appropriate. Hardware Connections __ Install any additional hardware as appropriate to your institution, LAN, etc. Commercial Mode Setup __ Complete Commercial Mode Setup (configure all relevant Installer Menu items as required of your institution and configure display features for the end user). Software Installation __ Install or configure any software, as applicable, for example, PPV, etc. Cable Connections __ Make all connections to rear jack panel and RF antenna on MPI/PPV card. __ Make all connections to signal, interactive resources, and Aux sources, as appropriate. Commercial Mode Setup Overview This document describes how to set up LD310H Pro:Centric™ TVs for Commercial Mode either while in Pass-through Mode or Free-To-Guest (FTG) Mode. Pass-through Mode This mode allows you to configure a Master TV Setup for cloning purposes as well as external VOD/PPV control. Use the Installer Remote to con gure Installer Menu items as required for TV operation and set up TV features (Channel, Picture, Audio, etc.). See pages 12 to 13 for detailed information. FTG Mode This mode enables Pro:Idiom ® decryption and also allows logical channel mapping of physical channels to remove the need for dash tuning. FTG Con guration Application software is used to con gure and/or edit FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings. See pages 29 to 36 for basic information on FTG Mode and using a PC with the FTG Con guration Application to create an FMA Con guration le. Refer to the Free-To-Guest (FTG) Configuration Application manual for further details. 6 206-4177 Pro:Centric TV Interactive Menu Features Channel Guide Information Remote Help Watch TV Important: Pro:Centric operation requires that Installer Menu items 098 PRO:CENTRIC and 119 DATA CHANNEL be set appropriately and that the TV be in PPV or FTG Mode. The interactive Pro:Centric TV enables guests—from the comfort of their hotel rooms—to view and select from a complete listing of hotel services and amenities. The Pro:Centric TV is connected to the hotel's billing computer, and service/amenities charges are billed at the time of order. Interactive amenities may include: • Hotel information, news, and events • Directory services (tourist attractions, restaurants, etc.) • Reservation services (business meetings, fitness, spa, etc.) • Weather and traffic information ALARM TIMER • Shopping services (delivery to guest room) INPUT TV 1 4 7 2 5 8 0 INFO VOL 3 6 9 • Ticketing services • Check-out service (in the guest room) • Gaming services • E-mail resources/account access FLASHBK i PORTAL CH MUTE MENU • Room service (menu ordering, memo service, morning wake up call, laundry, etc.) GUIDE CC P A G E Use the Installer Remote to operate both interactive menus and regular TV features. Press PORTAL on the Installer Remote to access the interactive menus. Note: Interactive menu options may vary, depending on Pro:Centric features enabled for the site. The following are default interactive menus. Channel Guide ENTER RETURN SAP Shows available TV networks and channels. When available, Electronic Program Guide (EPG) data indicates the channel and the program start and finish times. EXIT EJECT RATIO Information Typically displays hotel information, for example, photos of guest rooms, dining rooms, business centers, fitness and pool facilities, etc. Information may also include resources, such as local school programs, run in cooperation with the hotel. Remote Help Provides help for navigating the interactive menus. Watch TV Removes the interactive menu from the screen and returns to the previously tuned TV channel. 206-4177 7 LD310H Rear Jack Panel AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) Audio connection for RGB or DVI device. UPDATE Restricted to software updates. REMOTE CONTROL OUT IR output for controlling an auxiliary device. RESET Press RESET to re-initialize the TV. RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE HDMI 2 .......... HDMI /DVI IN 1 .......... ..... .... REMOTE CONTROL OUT ..... ..... ..... AV IN 1 VIDEO L/MONO-AUDIO-R AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT ( 8 ) Y PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO R RS-232C IN Use for downloading software updates, etc. AUDIO/VIDEO IN 1 Connection for composite audio/video output from external device. COMPONENT IN HDMI/DVI IN Connection for HDMI/DVI output from external device. RGB IN (PC) Connection for RGB output from PC. COMPONENT IN Connection for component output from external device. SPEAKER OUT (8Ω) * Connect to 8 ohm self-powered speaker input. Intended for special applications, such as a powered bathroom speaker with volume control. * This stereo jack provides a mono speaker fixed-level, 1 watt output (audio +, audio -, w/ground shield). Do NOT plug in a mono connector, as this may damage the TV. 8 206-4177 Side Connections Panel / RF Antenna & MPI Connections A/V 2 Input L/MONO-AUDIO-R IN Connect to audio output jacks on external device. For only mono audio output, connect to Left audio input. VIDEO L/MONO -AUDIO- R USB IN Insert USB memory device for software updates, cloning purposes, or picture/music entertainment, as applicable. USB IN Side Connections Panel VIDEO IN Connect to video output port on external device (see Reference section, “TV Camport Auto Sense Operation,” for further information). AV IN 2 RF Antenna & MPI Connections Antenna or CATV ANTENNA IN MP I 206-4177 ANTENNA IN Connect to Antenna/CATV. MPI Enables an external MPI control device (i.e., clone programmer, VOD/ PPV STB, etc.) to control the TV. 9 Installer Overview This is the Commercial Mode Setup Guide only. Installer Menu / Commercial Mode Setup xxLD310H PTC INSTALLER MENU To set up a Master TV for cloning purposes, you will need to know how to enter the TV Installer Menu and make changes to the default values as required. Similarly, to configure a TV’s Installer Menu settings in FTG Mode, you will need to know how to access and use the FTG Configuration Application utilities. If necessary, familiarize yourself with the Installer Menu and how to make and save changes. Refer to page 14 for information on accessing the Installer Menu in Pass-through Mode. Pages 15 to 20 describe Installer Menu items in detail. Refer to pages 29 to 36 for information on entering FTG Mode and using the FTG Configuration Application utilities. 000 INSTALLER SEQ 000 UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.25.00 Typical Installer Menu Installer Remote The LG Installer Remote is supplied with and dedicated to operate the TV. See next page for typical key functions in TV operating mode. Some DVD and VCR controls may be available for selected LG DVD/VCR products. Cloning Cloning refers to the process of capturing a Master TV Setup and transferring it to a Target TV. The Master TV’s clonable features need to be configured as part of the Commercial Mode Setup. This is a critical step. If the Master TV’s clonable features—channel icons or labels, digital font options, etc.—are not set up correctly, the cloned TVs will all have problems. Pages 23 to 28 provide detailed information on cloning requirements and procedures. ALARM TIMER INPUT TV 1 4 7 2 5 8 0 INFO 3 6 9 FLASHBK i VOL PORTAL MENU GUIDE CH P A G E MUTE CC ENTER + A AA A AA + Installing Batteries in Installer Remote • Open the battery compartment cover on the back side of the remote. • Install two high-quality alkaline 1.5V AAA batteries. Never mix old or used batteries with new ones. Install batteries matching correct polarity as shown (+ with + and - with -). • Replace the battery compartment cover. 10 RETURN SAP EXIT EJECT RATIO 206-4177 Installer Remote Control Typical Key Functions The LG Installer Remote illustrated below and throughout this document shows typical remote control functions and is provided for reference only. This Installer Remote may vary from the Installer Remote supplied with the TV. POWER Turns TV ON or OFF. ALARM Sets the time when the TV will automatically turn itself ON. TIMER Sets the amount of time before the TV automatically turns itself OFF. INPUT Selects RGB, HDMI/DVI1, HDMI2, Component Input, AV1, and AV2 sources. TV Returns to the last TV channel (from an Aux input). ALARM TIMER PORTAL Displays and removes the interactive menu. MUTE Switches sound ON or OFF. NUMBER Buttons (0 - 9) DASH Use to enter a program number or channel. Dash is used for sub-channel numbers such as 2-1, 2-2, 9-1, 9-2, 100-3, 100-4, etc. TV 1 4 7 VOLUME UP/DOWN Increases/decreases sound level. INFO Displays channel information. INPUT 2 5 8 0 INFO VOL 3 6 9 FLASHBK (FLASHBACK) Returns to the previously tuned channel. Arrows (Up/Down/Left/Right) & ENTER Use to navigate on-screen menus and adjust TV settings to your requirements. MENU Displays the TV setup menus on the screen. Also exits the on-screen menu system and returns to TV viewing. FLASHBK GUIDE Displays and removes the electronic program guide. i PORTAL CH P A G E MUTE MENU CHANNEL/PAGE UP/DOWN Changes the channel. Moves from one full set of screen information to the next. GUIDE CC Press to activate subtitles. CC RETURN Returns one level to the previous menu/ display. ENTER RETURN SAP SAP Analog Mode: Selects MTS sound (Mono, Stereo, or SAP). DTV Mode: Changes audio language, if additional languages are available. * EXIT EXIT Clears all on-screen displays and returns to TV viewing. Color buttons access special functions in some menus. VCR/DVD BUTTONS Controls some video cassette recorders or DVD players. EJECT Ejects a USB memory device, CD, DVD, VHS tape, as applicable. RATIO Adjusts the picture aspect ratio. EJECT RATIO * SAP notes: • • • 206-4177 If SAP is selected and no SAP is provided, sound may not be heard on channel. Each analog channel may have its own SAP setting. Digital channels will reset to default audio language with a power off/on. 11 Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV This section describes how to set up a Master TV for cloning purposes when the TV is in Pass-through Mode. Note: Disconnect all Aux inputs. Under certain conditions, Auto Tuning (Channel Search) is disabled if there is an Aux input active. Note: Refer to “FTG Mode of Operation” on pages 29 to 36 for information on entering FTG Mode and configuring/editing FTG Channel Map and Installer Menu settings using the FTG Configuration Application. 1. Set Installer Menu items. This step provides speci c instruction only on the Installer Menu items that should be set on a Master TV. Refer to pages 14 to 20 for detailed information on all Installer Menu items. a) Make sure the TV is ON. Then, use the Installer Remote to enter the TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. b) Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001 and press ENTER on the Installer Remote. This clears all Installer Menu custom settings, the channel lineup, etc. and reloads the factory default settings. The value will change back to 0 after the internal TV controller (Protocol Translator Card [PTC]) has been restored to factory default condition. This step ensures that the TV Channel Memory will be the active channel lineup. c) Set Installer Menu item 003 BAND/AFC, as appropriate. • Broadcast: Set to 000. • HRC: Set to 002. • CATV: Set to 001 (default). • IRC: Set to 003. xxLD310H PTC INSTALLER MENU 000 INSTALLER SEQ UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 2. Set up TV features. On-screen setup menus control the features of the TV (see page 21). Press MENU on the Installer Remote to access the setup menus, and then set Channel, Picture, Audio, Lock, Time, etc. options to the desired configurations. See also the Clonable Menu Features list on page 23. Note: If desired, you can run Auto Tuning (see step 3) prior to completing this step. ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.25.00 Typical TV Installer Menu Note: The Installer Menu header will vary depending on the TV you are setting up. 117 FACT DEFAULT 001 003 BAND/AFC 00X Adjust the settings for these Installer Menu items. d) Set any other Installer Menu items that affect your TV programming network to the required con guration. For example, enable/ disable Aux sources, set a Start Channel, etc. e) After you have adjusted all required Installer Menu item settings, press ENTER once on the Installer Remote to save your changes; then, press ENTER again to exit the menu. 000 CHANNEL PICTURE AUDIO TIME LOCK OPTION INPUT MY MEDIA Set the TV features to the desired configuration for the end user. (Continued on next page) 12 206-4177 Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV (Cont.) (Continued from previous page) 3. Run Auto Tuning (Channel Search). a) Search for all available analog and digital channels: Go to the Channel Menu, select the Auto Tuning option, and follow the on-screen instructions. b) Use the Channel Edit option in the Channel Menu to edit the channel lineup, as necessary, to include free to guest channels only. • Add/delete channels per your system requirements. Note that physical channel numbers are used to identify virtual channels. Also, channel numbers cannot be higher than 255. • Use the Channel Label option in the Channel Menu to add familiar channel trademarks/logos such as ABC, CBS, NBC, etc. to the Channel-Time on-screen display. Identi able labels (logos) should enable the end user to readily know what common networks are available. (You can add the channel labels in this step, or you can add channel labels or logos for channels without icons in step 5.) 4. Transfer the TV Setup to the internal TV Controller (PTC): 2-5-5 + MENU Mode After the TV channel lineup has been edited and channel label icons added, enter the Installer Menu. Once in the Installer Menu, press 2-5-5 + MENU on the Installer Remote to initiate the transfer of the Master TV Setup to the PTC. The TV exits the Installer Menu and then tunes through the channels in the channel lineup during the transfer. When the transfer is complete, the TV tunes back to the channel that was tuned before the transfer began. CHANNEL Move Enter Auto Tuning Manual Tuning Channel Edit Channel Label Run Auto Tuning, edit channels, and select familiar channel trademarks/logos using Channel Menu options. 19-3 DIGITAL MONO STEREO SAP WXYZ Custom Text Label “WXYZ” created in 2-5-4 + MENU (Add Channel Label) Mode. Note: The maximum number of active channels that can be transferred is 141. Total channels numbering more than 141 will result in erratic TV operation. 5. Add Custom Channel and Aux Source Labels for Analog Channels: 2-5-4 + MENU Mode Enter the Installer Menu, and press 2-5-4 + MENU on the Installer Remote. Add/edit custom text labels to channel on-screen displays. Note that digital channels often have a broadcaster generated label (see 2-5-4 + MENU procedural information on page 22). When you are finished, press MENU to exit 2-5-4 + MENU Mode. 028 CH. OVERIDE 000 After verifying the TV Setup, set Installer Menu item 028 CH. OVERIDE to 000.* * This step prevents end users from accessing channel settings (i.e., the Channel Menu will be inaccessible/ grayed out). 6. Verify the TV setup. At this point, verify that the channel lineup, channel icons, and custom labels are correct. Make sure the TV features are set per your requirements. 7. Lock the channel lineup. Enter the Installer Menu. Set item 028 CH. OVERIDE to 000 and press ENTER to lock the channel lineup and restrict access to the TV setup menus. Press ENTER again to save your changes and exit the Installer Menu.* The Master TV Setup is now ready to be copied to a USB memory device or a clone programmer (see cloning information in this document). 206-4177 13 Installer Menu Use the Installer Menu to set up or change operational settings. Refer to the table starting on the next page for brief descriptions of Installer Menu items. More detailed descriptions follow the table listing. Accessing the Installer Menu 1. Make sure the TV is ON. 2. Using an Installer Remote, press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER to access the Installer Menu. The Installer Menu opens with item 000 INSTALLER SEQ 000. Using the Installer Menu Items 000 ~ 119 are accessible only upon entering the Installer Menu. Refer to the table on pages 15 and 16 for an overview of Installer Menu items, including item numbers, functions, ranges, and default values. Installer Menu items not relevant to this TV series are not present on the Installer Menu; therefore, some numbers are missing. For example, item 006 will not appear. xxLD310H PTC INSTALLER MENU 000 INSTALLER SEQ UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 000 ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.25.00 Typical TV Installer Menu Navigation within the Installer Menu Use the Up/Down arrow keys on the Installer Remote to sequence through the available menu items, or access an item directly by keying in the line number and then pressing MENU. For example, to access the SLEEP TIMER option, which is item 015, press 0-1-5 + MENU. Changing Installer Menu Settings To change an Installer Menu item setting, use the Left/Right arrow keys on the Installer Remote, or enter a value directly. Press ENTER to save the new setting, or use the Up/Down arrow keys to navigate to a new Installer Menu item if you have additional items to edit. Exiting the Installer Menu and Activating Updates After you have adjusted all required Installer Menu item settings, press ENTER once on the Installer Remote to save your changes; then, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. Any changes you make will be stored in non-volatile memory. 14 206-4177 Installer Menu (Cont.) Installer Menu Items 000 through 071 Menu Item Function Value Range Default Value Brief Description of Function and Comments 000 INSTALLER SEQ 0~3 0 Leave default set to 0. 001 POWER MANAGE 0~7 0 Sets number of hours of no activity before automatic shutoff. 002 AC ON 0/1 0 Set to 1 to enable Auto Turn ON when AC power is applied. 003 BAND/AFC 0~3 1 Selects Tuning Band: 0=Broadcast, 1=CATV, 2=HRC, 3=IRC 0 ~ 127, 255 255 Channel tuned when TV is turned ON. (Set to 255 to tune to channel tuned before TV turned OFF.) 0/1 0 If set to 1, cannot tune from current channel. 0 ~ 63, 255 255 Volume level when TV is turned ON. (Set to 255 to use volume level before TV turned OFF.) 004 STRT CHANNEL 005 CHAN LOCK 007 STRT VOLUME 008 MIN VOLUME 0 ~ 63 0 Sets minimum allowable volume setting. 0 ~ 63 63 Sets maximum allowable volume setting. 0/1 0 Set to 1 to disable Mute Function. 009 MAX VOLUME 010 MUTE DISABLE 011 KEY DEFEAT 0/1 0 Set to 1 to disable menu navigation keys on display panel. 015 SLEEP TIMER 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable Sleep Timer. 016 EN TIMER 0/1 0 Set to 1 to enable On/Off Timers. 017 ALARM 020 FEATURE LEVEL 021 V-CHIP 022 MAX BLK HRS 023 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable Alarm. 0 ~ 1, 16 ~ 24 1 Determines the IR code scheme to which the TV will respond. 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable V-Chip (Parental Control) functions. 0 ~ 99 12 Sets number of V-Chip blocking hours. CAPTION LOCK 0/1 0 Set to 1 to retain caption setting set before TV turned OFF. 028 CH. OVERIDE 0/1 1 If set to 0, limits direct access to favorite channels. 029 OLD OCV 0/1 0 Set to 1 to change MPI operation to OCV. 030 ACK MASK 0/1 0 If set to 1, changes MPI for some OCV boxes. 031 POLL RATE 20 ~ 169 94 Selects poll rate for MPI. 032 TIMING PULSE 186 ~ 227 207 Sets baud rate for MPI. 034 CAMPORT EN 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable Video 2 input. 035 COMPPORT EN. 0/1 1 Set to 0 to disable HDMI 1. Set to 1 enable HDMI 1. 038 YPrPb EN. 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable display panel Component Video 1 input jacks. 039 REAR AUX EN 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable display panel Video 1 input jack. 040 AUTO CAMPORT 0/1 1 Set to 1 to automatically switch to Camport. If set to 1, STRT AUX SRCE cannot be set to 2. 046 STRT AUX SRCE 1 ~ 6, 255 6 Sets the starting Aux source (if item 004 STRT CHANNEL is set to 0). 047 AUX STATUS 0/1 0 Set to 1 for MPI Aux source to be reported as a channel number instead of Channel 0. 053 DIS. CH-TIME 0/1 0 Set to 1 to disable Channel-Time display. 069 EN. CH-T COL. 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable custom color for the Channel-Time display. 070 FOR. CH-TIME 0~7 2 Chooses custom foreground color for the Channel-Time display. 071 BCK. CH-TIME 0~7 2 Chooses custom background color for the Channel-Time display. 206-4177 15 Installer Menu (Cont.) Installer Menu Items 073 through 119 Menu Item 16 Function Value Range Default Value Brief Description of Function and Comments 073 CH NOT AVBLE 0/1 0 If set to 1 and Channel Override is 0, “NOT AVAILABLE” message is displayed when directly accessing a channel not in the favorite Channel List. 075 REVERT CH 0/1 0 If set to 1 and loss of MPI communication occurs, TV tunes to Start Channel. 078 UPN MSB 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, most significant byte. 079 UPN MSB-1 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, most significant byte - 1. 080 UPN MSB-2 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, most significant byte - 2. 081 UPN LSB 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, least significant byte. 082 CHKSM ERROR 0/1 1 Enforces rigid MPI checksum. 083 HANDSHK TIME 0~5 5 Relaxes MPI timing to be compatible with PC-based Windowscontrolled systems. 084 PERMANENT BLK 0/1 0 Removes block hours setting for Parental Control and makes block permanent. 087 REAR RGB EN. 0 / 1 / 17 1 Set to 0 to disable RGB1. Set to 1 to enable for RGB PC. Set to 17 for Auto Configure. 088 EN NOISE MUTE 0/1 1 If set to 1, audio is muted if no signal is present. 090 KEY LOCK 0/1 0 If set to 1, keyboard is locked out, IR is still functional. 091 YPrPb2 EN 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable HDMI 2 input. 094 SAP MENU EN 0/1 1 Set to 0 to disable feature on Function Menu. Set to 1 to enable feature on Function Menu. 096 DEF. ASP. RATIO 0~4 2 Sets default aspect ratio at power up. See detailed descriptions and item 106. 098 PRO:CENTRIC 0~2 0 Set to 0 to disable Pro:Centric operation. Set to 1 for Flash Mode. Set to 2 for GEM (Java Application) Mode. 099 BACK LIGHTING 1 ~ 100, 101 ~ 200, 255 100 Sets the level of the TV picture back lighting. (See detailed descriptions.) 102 ATSC BAND 0~4 4 Selects ATSC band. 103 ATSC TUNE MODE 0/1 1 Set to 1 (default) for Physical Channel scan. Set to 0 for Virtual Channel scan. 104 START MINOR CH 0 ~ 255 0 Selects Minor Start Channel. Set to 0 for NTSC. 106 ASP RATIO LOCK 0/1 0 To retain set aspect ratio on power cycle, set to 1. Set to 0 for default ratio on power cycle. 116 VIDEO MUTE EN 0/1 0 Set to 0 for Normal. Set to 1 for Blank. 117 FACT DEFAULT 0/1 0 Set to 0 for Normal. Set to 1 to load presets for all Installer Menu settings. 119 DATA CHANNEL 0 ~ 135 0 Set to 0 to disable. Set to the RF channel number of the Data Channel for Pro:Centric or E-Z Installation data. (See detailed descriptions.) 206-4177 Installer Menu (Cont.) Detailed Descriptions of Installer Menu Items 000 - INSTALLER SEQUENCE Speci es entry sequence to the Installer Menu. 0 = 9876 2 = 1478 To translate a TV volume level to the Installer Menu value, use the following formula: 1 = 4321 3 = 3698 001 - POWER MANAGE (Power Management) Determines hours of no activity before automatic shutoff. The Power Management function is for saving energy. If set to 0, Power Manage is Off. Settings range from 0 ~ 7, with 1 ~ 7 representing the hours that the unit will remain ON, unless there has been activity from either the control panel or remote control. 002 - AC ON (AC Power Switchable) If set to 1, this allows the TV to turn ON when AC power is applied. Pressing the ON button is not necessary. This is desirable if the TV is plugged into a cable box or a power outlet controlled by a wall switch. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to choose 0 or 1, where 0 is the default (OFF), and 1 is ON. Note: If set to 1 (ON), the TV does not respond to On/Off commands from either the remote or the display control panel, and the SLEEP TIMER is also nonfunctional. 003 - BAND/AFC (Band/Automatic Frequency Control) There are four possible settings for this option: 0 = Broadcast 2 = HRC NOTE: For items 007, 008, and 009 For legacy reasons, the scale used is 0 – 63. The PTC software will translate this to the 0 – 100 scale used by the TV. 1 = CATV (default) 3 = IRC If some channels were not found by Auto Tuning (Channel Search), select the appropriate Band setting here, and add the channels using the Channel Edit option in the Channel Menu. 004 - STRT CHANNEL (Start Channel) If active, this function allows you to determine the initial Major Start Channel number when the TV is turned ON. This feature is useful for an in-house information channel, since the TV would always select that channel when it is turned ON. Setting this item to 255 causes the last channel viewed when the TV was turned OFF, to be the tuned to channel when the TV is turned ON again. Installer Value = TV Value x 63 100 Enter only the whole number (disregard fractions). 007 - STRT VOLUME (Start Volume) This function allows the Installer to determine the initial volume level setting when the TV is turned ON. This feature is useful for an in-house information channel, since the TV would always select that volume level when it is turned ON. The range of values are 0 - 63, 255. If 255 is selected, the current volume level will be retained in memory when the TV is turned OFF; at turn ON, the volume level will be automatically set at the previous or last level. 008 - MIN VOLUME (Minimum Volume) This function determines the minimum volume level allowable with the Volume (VOL) Up/Down control. In this way, for example, someone cannot set the volume too low to hear. The value range is from 0 to 63. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to change values. The factory default is 0, which provides the full range of volume control, if item 009 MAX VOLUME is also set to 63. It may be best to set the same value on every TV. Note: The minimum volume level cannot have a value setting higher than the maximum volume level (described below). 009 - MAX VOLUME (Maximum Volume) This function determines the maximum volume level allowable with the Volume (VOL) Up/Down control. In this way, for example, someone cannot set the volume level high enough to disturb others. The value range is 0 to 63, with 63 as the default, which gives the user the full range of volume control, if item 008 MIN VOLUME is also set at 0. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to change values. It may be best to set the same value on every TV. Note: For a digital Start Channel, always remember to set item 104 to the Minor Start Channel number. Note: The maximum volume level cannot have a value setting lower than the minimum volume level (described above). 255 = Last channel 126 = Map to Channel 3 010 - MUTE DISABLE Enables or disables sound mute function. If set to 1, sound cannot be muted. If set to 0, sound can be muted. 1 ~ 125 = Major Ch. # 127 = Map to Channel 4 0 = Aux 005 - CHAN LOCK (Channel Lock) Channel Lock is ideal if the system must always be on the same channel. Changing channels with the Channel Up/Down or keypad numbers is impossible. Channel Lock is inactive if set to 0 (default). Generally, this feature is used in connection with STRT CHANNEL (Installer Menu item 004) where the Start Channel may, for example, be set to 3 or 4. If the Start Channel is 3, then the TV will remain locked on channel 3. 206-4177 011 - KEY DEFEAT (Keyboard Defeat) If set to 1, KEY DEFEAT prevents the end user from accessing the on-screen menus from the display panel—MENU, ENTER, and menu navigation keys do not function. If set to 0, those keys do function. Note: Users can always access the menus by pressing MENU on the remote. 17 Installer Menu (Cont.) 015 - SLEEP TIMER If set to 1, the Sleep Timer feature may be used. If set to 0, the Sleep Timer is not available. 016 - EN TIMER (Enable On/Off Timers) * If set to 1, the Timer function is available to the end user and enabled continuously. Set to 0 to disable On/Off timers. Note: Clock must be set in order to use timers. 017 - ALARM * Gives the installer the option of making the Alarm function available to the end user. If set to 1, the Alarm function is available to the end user. Set to 0 to disable the Alarm function. Note: Clock must be set before the Alarm function will work. 020 - FEATURE LEVEL Determines the IR code scheme to which the TV will respond, allowing for the use of unique IR codes based on “bed number” in a multi-TV single room installation. First determine the IR mode; then select the bed number. Note: Multi-code remotes are not available for the current release. For additional information, contact your LG representative. 021 - V-CHIP (Parental Control) * Set to 1 to activate V-Chip (Parental Control) and have it available to the end user to lter and control or otherwise restrict programming content that can appear. Set to 0 to turn the V-Chip feature Off (not available to user); no programming restrictions can be set. 022 - MAX BLK HRS (Maximum Block Hours) * Sets hours from 0 to 99 for the maximum V-Chip (Parental Control) block hours. Default setting is for 12 blocking hours. 023 - CAPTION LOCK If set to 0, captions are OFF when the TV is turned ON. Set to 1 to use the caption setting con gured before the TV was turned OFF when the TV is turned ON. 028 - CH. OVERIDE (Channel Override) If set to 1, the user can select channels with either Channel Up/ Down or by direct keypad entry. If set to 0, only those channels that are active in the TV’s memory can be selected. 029 - OLD OCV (On Command Video™) Set to 1 for operation with systems from On Command Corporation. 030 - ACK MASK MPI Communication Parameter. Leave at default setting unless changed by PPV provider. When set to 1, changes MPI for some OCV boxes. 031 - POLL RATE MPI Communication Parameter. Selects Poll Rate for MPI. Leave at default setting unless changed by Pay-Per-View provider. Step size of 16 ms. 032 - TIMING PULSE MPI Communication Parameter. Leave at default setting unless changed by Pay-Per-View provider. Sets baud rate. Step size of 4.3 uS. 034 - CAMPORT EN. (Camera Port Enable) Set to 1 to enable Video 2 input on display panel. If set to 0, Video 2 input on display panel is not functional. 035 - COMPPORT EN. (Computer Port Enable) Enable/disable TV display panel HDMI 1 input jack. Set to 0 to disable HDMI1. Set to 1 to enable HDMI1. 038 - YPrPb EN. (Rear Component Video Enable) Set to 1 to enable display panel rear Component Video input jacks. Set to 0 to disable display panel rear Component Video input jacks. 039 - REAR AUX EN. (Rear Aux Enable) Set to 1 to enable display panel rear Aux (Video 1) input. Set to 0 to disable display panel rear Aux (Video 1) input. 040 - AUTO CAMPORT Set to 1 to automatically switch to Camport when equipment is connected to side Video input. Set to 0 to disable side Video automatic source selection. If set to 1, STRT AUX SRCE cannot be set to 2. 046 - STRT AUX SRCE (Start Aux Source) Sets the starting Aux source. When turned ON, the TV will tune to starting Aux source if item 004 STRT CHANNEL is set to 0. If item 040 AUTO CAMPORT is set to 0: 1 = Video 1 4 = RGB 255 = Last Aux 2 = Video 2 5 = HDMI 2 3 = HDMI 1 6 = Component If item 040 AUTO CAMPORT is set to 1: 1 = Video 1 4 = RGB 6 = Component 3 = HDMI 1 5 = HDMI 2 047 - AUX STATUS Set to 1 for MPI Aux source to be reported as a channel number instead of channel 0. Set to 0 to disable Aux identi cation change. Controls MPI status channel response for Aux inputs. 053 - DIS. CH-TIME (Disable Channel-Time) Set to 1 to disable the Channel-Time display; Channel-Time display will not appear. Set to 0 to enable the Channel-Time display. * Only affects Function Menu if enabled by some PPV providers. 18 206-4177 Installer Menu (Cont.) 069 - EN. CH-T COL. (Enable Channel-Time Custom Color) Set to 1 to enable custom color for the Channel-Time display. Set to 0 to disable custom color for the Channel-Time display. 070 - FOR. CH-TIME (Channel-Time Display Foreground Color) Set according to Color Chart: 0 = Black 3 = Cyan 6 = Yellow 1 = Blue 4 = Red 7 = White 2 = Green 5 = Violet Note: Applies only to “Channel Not Available” message if item 073 is set to 1 (enabled). If foreground color and background color are the same, the menu background will be transparent. 071 - BCK. CH-TIME (Channel-Time Display Background Color) Set according to Color Chart: 0 = Black 3 = Cyan 6 = Yellow 1 = Blue 4 = Red 7 = White 2 = Green 5 = Violet Note: Applies only to “Channel Not Available” message if item 073 is set to 1 (enabled). If foreground color and background color are the same, the menu background will be transparent. 073 - CH NOT AVBLE (Channel Not Available) If set to 1 and item 028 CH. OVERIDE is set to 0, a “NOT AVAILABLE” message is displayed when directly accessing a channel not in the channel scan list available in memory. 075 - REVERT CH (Revert to Start Channel) If set to 1 and loss of MPI communication occurs, TV automatically tunes to the speci ed Start Channel. 083 - HANDSHK TIME (Handshake Time) Adds an additional delay to the handshake time which is 64 msec, thus relaxing MPI timing requirements to be compatible with PCbased Windows controlled systems. Range is 0 - 5. (Timeout = 25.5MS + [25.5 MS* Handshake time].) 084 - PERMANENT BLK (Permanent Block) Allows Lock (Parental Control) blocking schemes to be permanent by disabling the blocking hours function. Set to 1 to install Parental Control restrictions permanently. Set to 0 for user-speci ed hours control of blocking schemes. 087 - REAR RGB EN. (Rear RGB Enable) Controls access to rear RGB input on TV. Set to 0 to disable RGB input. Set to 1 to enable for PC RGB input. Set to 17 to initiate a one-time automatic con guration after an AC power cycle; otherwise, automatic adjustment will be performed each time the RGB input is accessed. 088 - EN NOISE MUTE (Enable Noise Mute) If set to 1, audio mutes if no signal is present. 090 - KEY LOCK If set to 1, front keyboard Channel, Volume, and Captions buttons are disabled, Power button remains enabled. If set to 0, the Channel, Volume, Captions, and Power buttons are all enabled. 091 - YPrPb2 EN. (HDMI2 Enable) Set to 0 to disable display panel HDMI2 input. Set to 1 to enable DTV mode. Set to 2 to enable PC mode. 078 - UPN MSB (UPN Most Significant Byte) User programmable number, most signi cant byte readable by MPI command. Not linked to serial number. 094 - SAP MENU EN (2nd Audio Program) Set to 1 to enable SAP feature on Function Menu, if Function Menu is available. Set to 0 to disable SAP feature on Function Menu, if Function Menu is available. 079 - UPN MSB-1 (UPN Most Significant Byte-1) User programmable number, most signi cant byte-1 readable by MPI command. Not linked to serial number. 096 - DEF. ASP. RATIO (Default Aspect Ratio) Selects default aspect ratio at power up. 080 - UPN MSB-2 (UPN Most Significant Byte-2) User programmable number, most signi cant byte-2 readable by MPI command. Note: Not linked to serial number. 081 - UPN LSB (UPN Least Significant Byte) User programmable number, least signi cant byte readable by MPI command. Note: Not linked to serial number. 082 - CHKSM ERROR (Checksum Error) Enforces rigid MPI checksum validation. Set to 1 for validation. Set to 0 to disable (does not check checksum on MPI async port). SPI is always checked. 206-4177 • • • • • Set to 0 for Set By System. Set to 1 for 4:3. Set to 2 for 16:9 (Factory Default). Set to 3 for Just Scan. Set to 4 for Zoom. Note: Only applies if item 106 ASP RATIO LOCK is disabled, set to 0. 098 - PRO:CENTRIC Selects the Pro:Centric Mode. Set to 0 (default) to disable Pro:Centric operation. Set to 1 for Flash Mode. Set to 2 for GEM (Java Application) Mode. 19 Installer Menu (Cont.) 099 - BACK LIGHTING Sets the TV screen brightness at power up. Default setting is 100. • 1 - 100 Static Back Lighting (1 = Dimmest picture, 100 = Brightest picture) • 101 - 200 Dynamic Back Lighting (101 = Dimmest picture, 200 = Brightest picture) If set between 101 and 200, the TV automatically controls back lighting depending upon the picture level of the current program. If set to 255, back lighting is controlled via the Picture settings in the TV’s setup menus. 102 - ATSC BAND Sets up TV to receive different types of incoming signals: 0 = Broadcast, 1 = CATV, 2 = HRC, 3 = IRC, 4 = Same as NTSC. 103 - ATSC TUNE MODE Sets ATSC tuning mode: Default set to 1 for Physical Channel scan. Set to 0 for Virtual Channel scan. 104 - START MINOR CHANNEL Sets Minor Start Channel number at power up. 0 = NTSC. If not 0, number selected is the digital channel’s Minor Start Channel number. 116 - VIDEO MUTE EN (Video Mute Enable) Set to 0 for Normal. Set to 1 for Blank. 117 - FACT DEFAULT (Factory Default) Set to 0 for normal. Set to 1 to load presets of all Installer Menu item settings. Warning: If set to 1, this will reload the factory defaults and clear the channel lineup, including any assigned channel icons and custom channel labels. 119 - DATA CHANNEL Set to 0 (default) to disable. Set to the RF channel number of the Data Channel for Pro:Centric or E-Z Installation (splash screen, configuration, or firmware) data. Note: Pro:Centric updates are downloaded from the Pro:Centric server to the TV when the TV is turned OFF. Also, while Pro:Centric updates are in progress, it is not possible to turn the TV ON. The TV may take several minutes to load EPG data after the initial download of the Pro:Centric application. Subsequent updates generally will take less than one minute. 106 - ASP RATIO LOCK (Aspect Ratio Lock) Set to 1 to retain previous aspect ratio with power off. Set to 0 to retain default aspect ratio with power off. See item 096 DEF. ASP. RATIO above. 20 206-4177 TV Setup Menus Overview On-screen setup menus control the features of the TV. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to access the TV setup menus, and set the TV features to the desired configuration for the end user. CHANNEL PICTURE AUDIO TIME LOCK OPTION INPUT MY MEDIA Refer to the Owner’s Manual for further information on the TV setup menus. 206-4177 21 Adding Channel Label Icons / Custom Channel Labels (2-5-4 + MENU Mode) Editing/Adding Channel Icons and/or Labels If there is no pre-assigned icon, you can make a custom channel label of up to seven (7) characters to help identify a channel or network. If desired, channel labels can also be added in addition to a pre-assigned icon. You may also add labels for the Aux input sources to clearly identify the devices that are connected to the Aux inputs. (Icon) XYZ XYZ XYZ NETWORK 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 (Label) Editing and adding the labels can only be done if there are channels entered into the TV’s Channel Map either during Commercial Mode Setup (see pages 12 to 13), by cloning, or by using some PPV providers’ master remote controls. Note: A blank letter space is available between “Z” and “!”. To perform channel editing/labeling: 1. Enter the TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 2. Press 2-5-4 + MENU on the Installer Remote to enter the Channel Label Editing Mode. 3. Add channel icons and channel labels as described in the procedures below. (You can do this more than once.) 4. To exit the menu when you are done, press MENU. Changing a Channel’s Icon on the Master TV Changing/Adding Channel Labels on the Master TV Changing Source Labels on the Master TV 1. Use Channel Up/Down to select the desired channel. 1. Use Channel Up/Down to select the desired channel. 2. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to select the thin letter “I” on the Channel ID display. 2. Press the Left or Right arrow repeatedly until the numbers 1 to 7 appear on the display. The number shows the position of the character that can be changed. Number 1 is the rst character, number 2 the second character, etc. 1. Press INPUT to select the desired Aux input source: A/V 1, A/V 2, HDMI Component, RGB, etc. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the icon with which you want to identify the channel. (If you know the icon number, enter the number, and press ENTER.) 4. Proceed to change/add channel labels, or go to the next channel. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the desired character. 4. Proceed to the next number position, or use Channel Up/Down to go to the next channel. 2. Press the Left or Right arrow repeatedly until the numbers 0 to 9 appear on the display. The number shows the position of the character that can be changed. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the desired character. 4. Press INPUT for the next Aux source, or use Channel Up/Down to return to channels. Installer Remote Control Key Functions for Master TV Channel Editing/Labeling Menu • Channel Up/Down: Tunes to the next channel in scan. • Left/Right Arrows: Select the item to change. If “I” is shown, the icon can be changed. If a number is shown, it indicates the position of the character that can be changed. • Up/Down Arrows: Select the icon or the character to be displayed. Tip: Arrows can be held down for fast scrolling. 22 • 0 – 9: Use to enter the index number of the icon, if known. • ENTER: Changes the icon after the number has been entered. • INPUT: Changes the Aux input label. • MENU: Exits the editing process. 206-4177 Cloning Overview / Clonable Menu Features IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION There are three options for cloning a Master TV Setup: • Using a USB memory device • Using a TLL-1100A clone programmer • Using a LT2002 clone programmer Each option is described in further detail on the pages that follow. As you perform cloning procedures, be sure to complete each task as indicated. If a procedure or step is omitted or not performed completely, cloning may not work. At each step, pay attention to ensure the TV screen shows the proper message when cloning. If the message indicated does not appear, there is a problem with that step, and cloning may not be successful. Warning: Copying a blank or incorrect memory into a TV will cause the TV to operate erratically or become inoperable. Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs, as this will damage the clone programmer and the PPV card. Before you begin cloning: • Complete the Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV procedure on pages 12 to 13. • Ensure Installer Menu items on Target TVs are set/restored to factory default settings (i.e., set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001 on Target TVs) before Teaching is initiated. • All equipment should be connected to power and turned ON. • Learning and Teaching is only possible between identical model TVs. • The Master and Target TVs must be in Pass-through Mode. • If using a USB memory device, ensure the USB device has been formatted with FAT format. • For both Master and Target TVs—If using a clone programmer, ensure the TV signal source is either an Aux or TV (RF) source. If a TV (RF) source, the TV must be tuned to an analog (not a digital) channel. • LT2002 only—Make sure the batteries in the clone programmer are fresh. If batteries are removed, the clone programmer clock time (if set) will be lost (see page 28 for information on the clone programmer clock). • Do not unplug the TV power cord or remove/disconnect the USB memory device/clone programmer while Learning or Teaching, as doing so may cause the TV to malfunction or harm the USB device/ clone programmer, respectively. Clonable Menu Features Installer Menu Installer Menu item settings Channel Auto Tuning (Channel Lineup) Manual Tuning Channel Edit Channel Label Picture Aspect Ratio Picture Mode Advanced Control Audio Auto Volume Clear Voice Sound Mode Balance TV Speaker Option Menu Language Audio Language Caption Caption Mode Digital Caption Options Lock Movie Rating TV Rating – Children TV Rating – General Input Block Time Auto Clock Manual Clock Off Time On Time Auto Off (Sleep Timer) Note: Some menu options vary between analog and digital channels and Aux sources. 206-4177 23 Cloning Procedures Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a USB Memory Device USB Cloning Notes • Read the IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 23 before beginning any cloning procedures. • You may edit a lename as part of the Learning procedure; however, a le with edited contents will not be recognized. • It is not possible to clone a Master TV’s clock using a USB memory device. Either set a Target TV’s clock manually, or use the Auto Clock setting in the TV setup menus. Learn Setup from Master TV 1. Ensure the Master TV is set up completely and in Pass-through Mode. 2. Plug the USB memory device into the USB IN port on the Master TV. 3. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to display the TV setup menus, use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight the Option menu icon, and then press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. USB Download Menu Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Learn From TV (TLL) Learn From TV (FMA) 4. To gain access to the Learn From TV option in the USB Download Menu, key in the password used to enter the Installer Menu (Example: Press 9-8-7-6). 7. Remove the USB memory device. Teach Master TV Setup to Target TV 1. Ensure the Target TV is in Pass-through Mode, and then use the Installer Remote to enter the Target TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 2. Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001, and press ENTER. When the value changes back to 0, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. 3. Plug the USB memory device with the Master TV Setup le into the Target TV USB IN port. 4. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to display the TV setup menus, use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight the Option menu icon, and then press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. Learn From TV (TLL) Select the le name and press OK to start xxLD310H-UA00001.TLL ► 6. To identify the pro le from others, you can use the Up/Down arrow keys to change the last ve digits of the lename. Press ENTER when you are ready to initiate Learning. Learning status will be shown on the progress bar. When the Learning process is complete, the USB Download menu will reappear on screen. Return ! 7. When Teaching is done, remove the USB memory device, turn OFF the TV, and unplug the TV power cord for 15 seconds. 8. Reconnect the TV power cord, and turn ON the TV. The Master TV Setup should be resident on the Target TV. 24 Enter Learn From TV UPDATING... 25% Do not remove the USB from the port! Do not unplug! USB Download Menu Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Return Enter Teach To TV (TLL) 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Teach To TV (TLL), and then press ENTER. 6. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the Master TV Setup you want to install, and then press ENTER. Note: Filenames identify the TV and the TLL version (see example at right). Teaching status will be shown on the progress bar. When the Teaching process is complete, the USB Download menu will reappear on screen. Enter ► 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Learn From TV (TLL), and then press ENTER. Return xxLD310H-UA00001.TLL Return ! Enter Teach To TV UPDATING... 50% Do not remove the USB from the port! Do not unplug! 206-4177 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a TLL-1100A Clone Programmer Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs, as this will damage the clone programmer and the PPV card. TLL-1100A Cloning Notes • Read the IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 23 before beginning any cloning procedures. • Ensure the TLL-1100A is either fully charged or connected to AC power. • Learning and Teaching is only possible between identical model TVs; however, the TLL-1100A clone programmer can store up to eight different Master TV Setups. TLL-1100A Clone Programmer TV Link Loader CHARGE Cloning is accomplished using the TV/ clone programmer MPI ports for communication (see figure). TLL1100A Ready Antenna or CATV MODE CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP MPI Cable MENU ENTER SEND RECEIVE TLL-1100A Learn Setup from Master TV 1. Ensure the Master TV is set up completely and in Pass-through Mode. 2. If an analog channel is not available, direct tune the TV to an Aux source, or select an Aux source, such as AV-1, from the Input Menu. Then, plug one end of the MPI cable into the TV MPI port. 3. Turn ON the TLL-1100A. 4. Use the MODE button on the TLL-1100A to select Clone Mode. 5. Use the Left/Right arrows on the TLL-1100A to select the Memory CBank (1 to 8) in which to store the Master TV Setup. 6. Plug the other end of the MPI cable into the MPI port on the bottom of the TLL-1100A. The Clone Selection Menu will display on the TV screen. 7. Press 1 on the Installer Remote to select LEARN FROM TV from the Clone Selection Menu. Then, press ENTER to transfer the Master TV Setup into CBankX on the TLL-1100A. Learning usually takes about 90 seconds. “LEARNING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen while the TLL-1100A copies the Master Setup. When the Learning process is complete, a “LEARNING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. 206-4177 CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX THE CLONE IS VERSION VX.X.X - To change menu items, press channel keys or digits. - To execute item, press Enter. 25 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a TLL-1100A Clone Programmer (Cont.) (Optional) Set the Clock Set the time on a Master TV’s clock. (If the time has already been copied from a TV into the TLL-1100A clone programmer, you can set the Master TV’s clock by copying the time from the clone programmer.) The TLL-1100A can copy the current time to both a Master TV and to the clone’s internal clock— accurate to within one minute. Since the TLL-1100A’s time cannot be set directly, the current time needs to be copied from an LG TV equipped with an enabled MPI port. After the time is copied to the TLL-1100A clone programmer, the current time will be maintained and can then be transferred to another TV. (This can be a Master TV or another TV which has already had the features set up.) Teach Master TV Setup to Target TV CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX THE CLONE IS VERSION VX.X.X - To change menu items, press channel keys or digits. - To execute item, press Enter. 1. When Learning is complete, disconnect the MPI cable from the Master TV. 2. Ensure the Target TV is in Pass-through Mode, and then use the Installer Remote to enter the Target TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 3. Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001, and press ENTER. When the value changes back to 0, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. 4. Tune/set the TV to an analog channel or Aux source, and then connect the MPI cable to the MPI port on the Target TV. The Clone Selection Menu will display on the TV screen. 5. Ensure the correct Memory CBank(X) is selected on the TLL-1100A. 6. Press 2 on the Installer Remote to select TEACH TO TV from the Clone Selection Menu. Then, press ENTER to transfer the Master TV Setup to the Target TV. Teaching usually takes 3 to 4 minutes. “TEACHING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen during Teaching. When the Teaching process is complete, a “TEACHING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. 7. When Teaching is done, disconnect the MPI cable from the Target TV, turn OFF the TV, and unplug the TV power cord for 15 seconds. 8. Reconnect the TV power cord, and turn ON the TV. The Master TV Setup should be resident on the Target TV. 26 CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX THE CLONE IS VERSION VX.X.X - To change menu items, press channel keys or digits. - To execute item, press Enter. 206-4177 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using an LT2002 Clone Programmer Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs, as this will damage the clone programmer and the PPV card. Cloning is accomplished using the TV/clone programmer MPI ports for communication (see figure). LT2002 Cloning Notes • Read the IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 23 before beginning any cloning procedures. • A slow ashing green light indicates that there are communication problems between the TV and the LT2002 clone programmer. If this is the case, check for a damaged cable, poor contacts, or other connection troubles. • If the status indicator is red, the LT2002 batteries are low and should be replaced. Install four (4) high-quality alkaline AA batteries. • Learning and Teaching is only possible between identical model TVs; however, the LT2002 clone programmer can store up to three different Master TV Setups. MPI Cable Antenna or CATV Ferrite Core (TDK, ZCAT 2035-0930) $POOFDUDBCMFUP 57.1*+BDLBOE GPMMPXPOTDSFFO instructions $PMPS tHSFFO CBUUFSZPL tSFE CBUUFSZMPX Reset #MJOLQBUUFSO tTMPX QPXFSPO no communications tIFBSUCFBUQPXFSPO communications ok THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF THE TV THE CLONE IS VERSION XX THE TV IS VERSION XX THE SW IS REViSION XX CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX ® QuickSet II Programmer LT2002 - PRESS ANY KEY TO CONTINUE LT2002 Clone Programmer Learn Setup from Master TV ZENITH ELECTRONICS CORPORATION, LINCOLNSHIRE, ILLINOIS, USA THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF THE TV 1. Ensure the Master TV is set up completely and in Pass-through Mode. 2. If an analog channel is not available, direct tune the TV to an Aux source, or select an Aux source, such as AV-1, from the Input Menu. Then, plug one end of the MPI cable into the TV MPI port. 3. If there is a good connection after the LT2002 is connected to the TV MPI port, “THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF THE TV” message will appear on the TV screen. Press any key on the Installer Remote to access the LT2002 Clone Selection Menu. 4. Press 1 on the Installer Remote to select LEARN FROM TV from the Clone Selection Menu; then press ENTER to proceed to the Memory Bank Selection Menu (see sample screen on next page). 5. Select the clone Memory Bank in which to store the Master Setup by pressing either Channel key repeatedly to choose Memory Bank 1, 2, or 3. Note: If you choose a Memory Bank that already has a Master device’s setup programmed into it, that setup will be overwritten by the new Master TV Setup. (Continued on next page) 206-4177 Status *OEJDBUPS MPI THE CLONE IS VERSION XX THE TV IS VERSION XX THE SW IS REVISION XX CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX - PRESS ANY KEY TO CONTINUE. - DISCONNECT CLONE WHEN DONE. CLONE SELECTION MENU (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) LEARN FROM TV TEACH TO TV SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE DISPLAY TV SETUP DISPLAY CLONE SETUP - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. 27 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using an LT2002 Clone Programmer (Cont.) (Continued from previous page) 6. Once you select the clone Memory Bank, press ENTER on the Installer Remote. The Memory Bank you selected will be shown. 7. Press POWER to transfer the Master TV Setup into the selected Memory Bank on the LT2002. Learning usually takes about 90 seconds. “LEARNING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen while the LT2002 copies the Master Setup. When the Learning process is complete, a “LEARNING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. SAVE TV SETUP IN SELECTED CLONE MEMORY (1) (2) (3) (4) MEMORY 1 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 2 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 3 VER XX REV XX RETURN TO CLONE MENU - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. (Optional) Set the Clock Set the time on a Master TV’s clock. (If the time has already been copied from a TV into the LT2002 clone programmer, you can set the Master TV’s clock by copying the time from the clone programmer.) The LT2002 can copy the current time to both a Master TV and to the clone’s internal clock—accurate to within one minute. (Another reason that the LT2002 should be equipped with fresh, high-quality alkaline batteries, is for it to keep the time as accurately as possible.) CLONE SELECTION MENU (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) LEARN FROM TV TEACH TO TV SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE DISPLAY TV SETUP DISPLAY CLONE SETUP Since the LT2002’s time cannot be set directly, the current time needs to be copied from an LG TV equipped with an enabled MPI port. - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. After the time is copied to the LT2002 clone programmer, the current time will be maintained and can then be transferred to another TV. (This can be a Master TV or another TV which has already had the features set up.) - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. Teach Master TV Setup to Target TV 1. When Learning is complete, disconnect the MPI cable from the Master TV. 2. Ensure the Target TV is in Pass-through Mode, and then use the Installer Remote to enter the Target TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 3. Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001, and press ENTER. When the value changes back to 0, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. 4. Tune/set the TV to an analog channel or Aux source, and then connect the MPI cable to the MPI port on the Target TV. 3. With “THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF TV” message on display, press 2 on the Installer Remote to select TEACH TO TV from the LT2002 Clone Selection Menu. Then, press ENTER. 4. Select the LT2002 Memory Bank in which the new setup is located. Then, press POWER to transfer the Master TV Setup to the Target TV. Teaching usually takes 3 to 4 minutes. “TEACHING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen during Teaching. When the Teaching process is complete, a “TEACHING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. 5. When Teaching is done, press any key on the Installer Remote to return to the Clone Selection Menu. Then, press ENTER. 6. Disconnect the MPI cable from the Target TV, turn OFF the TV, and unplug the TV power cord for 15 seconds. 7. Reconnect the TV power cord, and turn ON the TV. The Master TV Setup should be resident on the Target TV. 28 CLONE SELECTION MENU (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) LEARN FROM TV TEACH TO TV SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE DISPLAY TV SETUP DISPLAY CLONE SETUP - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. COPY SELECTED CLONE MEMORY TO TV (1) (2) (3) (4) MEMORY 1 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 2 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 3 VER XX REV XX RETURN TO CLONE MENU - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. 206-4177 FTG Mode of Operation FTG Mode Overview / Determining the TV Operating Mode FTG Mode Overview FTG Mode enables Pro:Idiom decryption and also allows logical channel mapping of physical channels. “Teaching” an FMA Configuration file to a LD310H TV puts the TV into FTG Mode. Once the LD310H TV is in FTG Mode: • Users can still access the Installer Menu; however, all Installer Menu items, with the exception of item 117 FACT DEFAULT will be read-only. To return the TV to Pass-through Mode, you must set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001 to reload factory default settings on the TV. (See “Installer Menu” section of this document for further information.) • Any con guration updates must be made in the FTG Con guration Application. FTG Channel Map Con guration and FTG Installer Menu Con guration Utilities enable you to update the FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu, as necessary, and the FMA Con guration Utility enables you to save the updates to a FMA Con guration le. The FMA Con guration le can then be transferred to the TV via a USB memory device. This section outlines how to create an FMA Configuration file using the FTG Channel Map, FTG Installer Menu, and FMA Configuration Utilities that comprise the FTG Configuration Application. It also describes how to transfer (Teach) an FMA Configuration file to a TV using a USB device. Refer to the Free-To-Guest (FTG) Configuration Application manual for further information. Note: The LD310H cannot be put into FTG Mode in this manner if an MPI slot card or external MPI device has been implemented as a means of controlling the TV. Determining the TV Operating Mode To determine the operating mode of the TV, press MENU on the Installer Remote. If the end user Function Menu (showing aspect ratio options) appears, the TV is in FTG Mode. If the TV setup menus appear, the TV is in Pass-through Mode. ASPECT RATIO Move Enter Function Menu Shows that the TV is in FTG Mode. While this menu is present on-screen, Installer Menu settings can ONLY be changed using the FTG Configuration Application to update the FMA Configuration file. Set By Program 4:3 ABC 16:9 Zoom Just Scan 206-4177 CHANNEL PICTURE AUDIO TIME LOCK OPTION INPUT MY MEDIA TV Setup Menus Shows that the TV is in Pass-through Mode. 29 FTG Mode of Operation (Cont.) Creating an FMA Configuration File using the FTG Configuration Application In order to enable Pro:Idiom decryption, it is recommended that you create an FMA Con guration le using the FTG Con guration Application. However, if you do not know the RF channels at the site, you can Learn an FMA Con guration le from a TV (see next page). The procedure below provides an overview of the steps required to create an FMA Configuration (.fma) file. Refer to the Free-To-Guest (FTG) Configuration Application manual for further information. See also FTG Configuration Application sample screens on pages 33 to 36. Note: FTG Configuration Application software is available online at: www.LGcommercial.com/FTGsoftware. 1. Install (if necessary) and launch the FTG Configuration Application (v5.0.0 or higher) on the PC that will be used to create the FMA Configuration file. 2. Either: • Open an existing FTG Con guration (.rml) le, if applicable, to use its FTG Channel Map. Otherwise, create a new FTG Channel Map using the FTG Channel Map Editor in the FTG Channel Map Con guration Utility. Then, continue with step 3. Note: Up to 141 logical channels can be defined in the FTG Channel Map. • To view and/or base a new FMA Con guration le on an existing LD310H FMA Con guration le, click Configure in the FTG Configuration Application menu bar, and select FMA to access the FMA Configuration Utility. Then, click the Open button above the FMA Configuration List, and double-click the desired (.fma) file. A list of the file’s contents will be displayed in the FMA Configuration List window, and you can edit the FMA Configuration List as necessary to create a new file. Proceed to step 4 when you are ready to continue. 3. Click Configure in the FTG Configuration Application menu bar, and select FMA to access the FMA Configuration Utility. 4. To add an FTG Channel Map, click >> under FTG Channel Map to copy the current FTG Channel Map to the FMA Configuration List. Note: If you make any change(s) in the FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility to the current data to be included in the FMA Configuration List, you will need to recopy the FTG Channel Map to the FMA Configuration List. 5. Load default Installer Menu settings for the LD310H TV: • Click the down arrow at the right of the Chassis eld under Installer Menu Templates, and select 32/37LD310H from the drop-down list of available models. • Click the Load button. • Use the FTG Installer Menu Con guration Utility to modify settings, if necessary. Then, return to the FMA Con guration Utility. • Click >> under FTG Installer Menu Settings to copy the LD310H settings to the FMA Con guration List. 6. Click the Save button above the FMA Configuration List to save its contents to an FMA Configuration (.fma) file for later use. 7. Save the FMA Configuration file to a USB memory device, and proceed to “Teaching FMA Configuration to a TV” on the following page to transfer the FMA Configuration file to an LD310H TV. 30 206-4177 FTG Mode of Operation (Cont.) Teaching FMA Configuration to a TV / Learning an FMA Configuration File from a TV Teaching FMA Configuration to a TV 1. Plug the USB memory device that contains the FMA Con guration le into the Target LD310H TV USB IN port. 2. Press MENU to display the TV setup menus, use the arrow navigation keys to select/ highlight either the Option (if TV is in Pass-through Mode) or Lock (if TV is already in FTG Mode) menu icon, and then press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Teach To TV (FMA), and then press ENTER. 4. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the FMA Con guration le you want to install, and then press ENTER. The TV will show Teaching completion progress in a new window. Do NOT remove the USB device until Teaching is complete. When Teaching is complete, the TV will tune to the rst logical channel in the FTG Channel Map. 5. When Teaching is done, remove the USB memory device. The FMA Configuration should be resident on the Target TV. Also, the Target TV is now in FTG Mode (if it was previously in Pass-through Mode). USB Download Menu Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Return Enter Teach To TV (FMA) xx0BAL-PLAT200001.FMA Return ! Enter Teach To TV UPDATING... 50% Do not unplug! Learning an FMA Configuration File from a TV To ensure that Pro:Idiom decryption is enabled, it is recommended that you create an FMA Configuration file using the FTG Configuration Application as described on the previous page. However, if necessary, this option enables you to save (Learn) an FMA Configuration file from an LD310H TV to a USB memory device. Note: If the LD310H TV is NOT already in FTG Mode, you may need to perform some manual configuration on the TV before you start this procedure (see following page). USB Download Menu 1. Plug a USB memory device into the USB IN port on the TV. Upgrade TV Software 2. Press MENU to display the TV setup menus, use the arrow navigation keys to select/ highlight either the Option (if TV is in Pass-through Mode) or Lock (if TV is already in FTG Mode) menu icon, and then press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. Teach To TV (TLL) Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (FMA) Learn From TV (TLL) Learn From TV (FMA) Return Enter Learn From TV (FMA) 4. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Learn From TV (FMA), and then press ENTER. Select the le name and press OK to start 6. When you are nished, remove the USB memory device. Note: It is highly recommended that you open this FMA Configuration file in the FTG Configuration Application—BEFORE transferring (Teaching) the file to any TVs—to verify FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings and enable Pro:Idiom decryption by marking Encrypted channels. This will also enable you to confirm and add channel attributes, labels, etc. 206-4177 xx0BAL-PLAT200001.FMA ► 5. To identify the le from others, you can use the Up/Down arrow keys to change the last ve digits of the lename. Press ENTER when you are ready to initiate Learning. The TV will show Learning completion progress in a new window. Do NOT remove the USB device until Learning is complete. When Learning is complete, the USB Download Menu will reappear on screen. ► 3. To gain access to the Learn From TV options in the USB Download Menu, key in the password used to enter the Installer Menu (Example: Press 9-8-7-6). Return ! Enter Learn From TV UPDATING... 25% Do not unplug! 31 FTG Mode of Operation (Cont.) Optional Manual Configuration / Setup for a TV The manual configuration procedures below should only be performed if you do not know the RF channels at the site and need to Learn the FMA Configuration file from an LD310H TV. Set Installer Menu Items These steps provide speci c instruction only on the Installer Menu items that should be set on an LD310H TV. Refer to pages 14 to 20 for detailed information on all Installer Menu items. 1. Make sure the TV is ON. Then, use the Installer Remote to enter the TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 2. Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001 and press ENTER on the Installer Remote. This clears all Installer Menu custom settings, the channel lineup, etc. and reloads the factory default settings. The value will change back to 0 after the internal TV controller (PTC) has been restored to factory default condition. This step ensures that the TV Channel Memory will be the active channel lineup. 3. Set Installer Menu item 003 BAND/AFC, as appropriate. • Broadcast: Set to 000. • HRC: Set to 002. • CATV: Set to 001 (default). • IRC: Set to 003. 4. Set any other Installer Menu items that affect your TV programming network to the required con guration. For example, enable/disable Aux sources, set a Start Channel, etc. 5. After you have adjusted all required Installer Menu item settings, press ENTER once on the Installer Remote to save your changes; then, press ENTER again to exit the menu. Run Auto Tuning (Channel Search) Note: In the FMA Con guration le, Logical Channel numbers will automatically be assigned in ascending order, starting with 0 (zero), to the Physical Channels from the TV Channel Map. xxLD310H PTC INSTALLER MENU 000 INSTALLER SEQ UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 000 ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.25.00 Typical TV Installer Menu Note: The Installer Menu header will vary depending on the TV you are setting up. 117 FACT DEFAULT 001 003 BAND/AFC 00X Adjust the settings for these Installer Menu items. CHANNEL Move Enter Auto Tuning Manual Tuning Channel Edit Channel Label Note: Pro:Idiom decryption for encrypted channels will not be enabled unless you use the FTG Con guration Application to set the channel attributes. 1. Search for all available analog and digital channels: Use the Installer Remote to go to the Channel Menu, select the Auto Tuning option, and follow the on-screen instructions. Run Auto Tuning and edit the channel lineup, as necessary. 2. Use the Channel Edit option in the Channel Menu to edit the channel lineup, as necessary, to include free to guest channels only. Add/delete channels per your system requirements. Note that physical channel numbers are used to identify virtual channels. Also, channel numbers cannot be higher than 255. 32 206-4177 FTG Mode of Operation (Cont.) FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility Overview The FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility enables you to build a Channel Map with logical channel numbers. Note: Write, Read, and Learn functions in the FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility are used for local FTG configuration of TVs that support a direct connection to a PC. These functions are not applicable to the process of creating an FMA Configuration file to be used with LD310H TVs. EDIT/ADD MAP Click to open the FTG Channel Map Editor to create or edit an FTG Channel Map (see below). PRINT MAP Click to display a printable FTG Channel Map Report. The report can also be exported as an HTML or Text file. 206-4177 33 FTG Mode of Operation (Cont.) FTG Channel Map Editor Overview The FTG Channel Map Editor shows a single Logical Channel’s Data and the FTG Channel Map. LOGICAL CHANNEL MAPPING Select a Logical Channel number, then assign it the RF, Major, and Minor channel numbers to complete the mapping. CUSTOM CHANNEL LABELS/ICONS Enter custom labels and select icons by name on menu or by number. DELETE Click to remove highlighted channel from FTG Channel Map. SET CHANNEL ATTRIBUTES Check/select Encrypted, OSD, or Blank Video. EXIT Click to exit editor and return to FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility. ADD After defining a new Logical Channel, click to add channel to the FTG Channel Map. UPDATE After editing an existing Logical Channel’s data, click to commit the changes in the FTG Channel Map. 34 206-4177 FTG Mode of Operation (Cont.) FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility Overview Note: Write, Read, Learn, and IR Remote Access functions in the FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility are used for local FTG configuration of TVs that support a direct connection to a PC. These functions are not applicable to the process of creating an FMA Configuration file to be used with LD310H TVs. CONFIGURATION SETTINGS Select tabs for categories of Installer Menu items to set up TV. HOSPITAL-GRADE TV ONLY Set Hospital items on Installer Menu for hospital-grade TVs. INSTALLER DEFAULTS Click to reset FTG Installer Menu items shown in the FTG Configuration Application to defaults. 206-4177 35 FTG Mode of Operation (Cont.) FMA Configuration Utility Overview Note: FMA Write, Read, Clock, Broadcast, Firmware, and IP Communication functions in the FMA Configuration Utility are used to configure control equipment (Example: FMA-LG101) at the hotel/institution head end. These functions are not applicable to the process of creating an FMA Configuration file to be used with LD310H TVs. Filename of opened FTG Configuration file (if applicable) FMA CONFIGURATION LIST (data to be saved or already saved in FMA Configuration file) NEW/OPEN/SAVE FMA File options Copy FTG Channel Map to and from FMA Configuration List. Copy FTG Installer Menu settings to and from FMA Configuration List. Load default FTG Installer Menu for LD310H. Note: The data referenced in the FMA Configuration List is only a snapshot of the current FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings when copied to the list. If you make any change(s) to the current data to be included in the FMA Configuration List, you will need to recopy Channel Map and Installer Menu settings to the FMA Configuration List. 36 206-4177 Reference: Upgrading TV/PTC Software using a USB Memory Device Checking the Software Versions Note: This function is not accessible while the TV is in FTG or PPV Mode. You can check the software versions of the TV by accessing the Installer Menu with the Installer Remote: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. When you are finished, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. xxLD310H PTC INSTALLER MENU 000 INSTALLER SEQ UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 PTC Version Upgrading TV/PTC Software Before you begin, note that the software upgrade les must be stored in a folder named “LG_DTV” in the root directory of the USB memory device. Also, ensure the USB device has been formatted with FAT format. Note for TV Software Upgrade only: If the TV detects a later version of software on the USB device, it will automatically display a dialog from which you can start the software upgrade immediately. Otherwise, you can close the dialog, and access the USB Download Menu as described below. 1. Turn the TV ON. Typical Installer Menu 000 ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.25.00 CPU Version USB Download Menu Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Return Enter TV Software Update (Expert) 2. Plug the USB memory device into the USB IN port on the TV. 3. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to display the TV setup menus. 4. Use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight either the Option (if TV is in Pass-through Mode) or Lock (if TV is in FTG or LodgeNet PPV Mode) menu icon; then, press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. The following update files are found in the USB device. Select the file you want to apply to update this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. TV Software Update LOGO Image Download 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Upgrade TV Software or Upgrade PTC Software, as applicable, and then press ENTER. 6. Select the appropriate option(s), depending on the type of upgrade you are performing: • TV Software Upgrade: (See screen samples at right.) Select TV Software Update from the rst TV Software Update window. In the second TV Software Update window, select the update le to install and press ENTER. Note: Do not select Forced Update options unless you have been speci cally instructed to do so or have previous experience with Expert Software Updates. • PTC Software Upgrade: In the PTC Software Update window, select the update le to install and press ENTER. Note: The PTC Software Update window is similar to the second TV Software Update window, though there are no Forced Update options. Current software version information is shown at the top and update les on the USB device are listed at the bottom of the window. TV Software Update (Expert) [ Current TV Software Version Information ] EPK : 03.23.00 The following software files are found in the memory card. Select the file you want to download to this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. EPK : 03.25.00 [ Forced Update Option ] Ext. MICOM SPI Boot LOGO Image xxLD310H_v3_25_RevNo4697_USB The TV will show update completion progress in a new window. Do NOT remove the USB device until the software upgrade is complete. When a TV software upgrade is complete, the TV will reset itself with an automatic restart. When a PTC upgrade is complete, the TV will turn OFF. 206-4177 37 Reference: Downloading a Splash Screen using a USB Memory Device Splash Screen Image File Guidelines USB Download Menu • The splash screen image must be a baseline (not progressive) JPEG. Upgrade TV Software • The image should be no larger than 1 MB. Upgrade PTC Software • The ideal size for the image is 1366 x 768 pixels or under. • The image le must be stored in a folder named “LG_DTV” in the root directory of USB memory device. • Ensure the USB device has been formatted with FAT format. Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Return Enter TV Software Update (Expert) Downloading a Splash Screen Image 1. Turn the TV ON. 2. Plug the USB memory device into the USB IN port on the TV. The following update files are found in the USB device. Select the file you want to apply to update this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. 3. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to display the TV setup menus. 4. Use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight either the Option (if TV is in Pass-through Mode) or Lock (if TV is in FTG or LodgeNet PPV Mode) menu icon; then, press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Upgrade TV Software, and then press ENTER. 6. Select LOGO Image Download from the rst TV Software Update window. 7. In the second TV Software Update window, select the image le to download and press ENTER. The TV will show download completion progress in a new window. Do NOT remove the USB device until the image download is complete. When the image download is complete, the TV will reset itself with an automatic restart. Upon the restart, you should see the new splash screen. 38 TV Software Update LOGO Image Download TV Software Update (Expert) The following software files are found in the memory card. Select the file you want to download to this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. Splash Image 1366 X 768 ProCentric 206-4177 Reference: Power Consumption Settings The following tables assume Installer Menu item 099 BACK LIGHTING is set as shown below (default value is 100). 32LD310H Item 099 Back Lighting (Static) Power Consumption (Watts) 37LD310H Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) Percent Savings 100 72.97 0.00% 88.92 0.00% 90 80 70 60 50 40 30 20 10 1 63.82 58.53 53.58 44.24 41.27 38.71 36.20 33.51 31.01 28.55 12.54% 19.78% 26.57% 39.38% 43.45% 46.95% 50.39% 54.07% 57.51% 60.87% 84.19 77.84 72.19 66.28 60.90 56.58 52.35 47.75 43.68 39.62 5.32% 12.46% 18.81% 25.46% 31.51% 36.37% 41.13% 46.30% 50.88% 55.44% 32LD310H Item 099 Back Lighting (Dynamic) 37LD310H Power Consumption (Watts) Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) 200 75.45 0.00% 110.86 0.00% 190 180 170 160 150 140 130 120 110 101 69.23 65.26 60.72 56.29 51.82 46.62 41.67 36.14 31.11 26.41 8.25% 13.51% 19.53% 25.40% 31.33% 38.21% 44.78% 52.10% 58.76% 65.00% 99.05 92.33 85.39 78.61 71.70 63.53 55.65 47.34 39.90 33.00 10.65% 16.72% 22.98% 29.10% 35.32% 42.69% 49.80% 57.30% 64.01% 70.24% Percent Savings Note: Values are results of controlled experiments under laboratory conditions. 206-4177 39 Reference: TV Camport Auto Sense Operation The Camport Auto Sense function is enabled when: 1. Installer Menu item 034 CAMPORT EN is set to 1 AND 2. Installer Menu item 040 AUTO CAMPORT is enabled (1). Selectable: Can be accessed with INPUT key, direct access, etc. Auto Sense: TV switches to this input when connector is inserted. The Camport (Side [AV IN 2] Video) has the highest priority and will override any commands including tuning to the Start Channel. Camport Operation (Stand-alone) When Camport Auto Sense is enabled as above, the TV’s source will switch to the Side (AV IN 2) Video Aux source whenever a plug is inserted into the AV IN 2 Video input. When the plug is removed, the TV will switch back to the previous channel or input source that was being displayed before the plug was inserted. However, if any direct access to an RF channel or Aux channel is requested while the Camport is active, then, when the video plug is removed, the TV will switch to the last requested channel. Source changes using any Source keys (INPUT) are ignored. Channel Up/Down and Flashback commands are not direct access tuning commands, and they are also ignored. Camport Operation (FTG or PPV) The operation will be similar to that of the Stand-alone Mode. However, when the Channel Map is maintained external to the PTC (i.e., FTG and PPV), Channel Up/ Down or Flashback keys are sent as Direct Access tuning commands to the PTC/TV. 40 CAMPORT (Side Video) Functionality Control Item 034 CAMPORT EN Item 040 AUTO CAMPORT Side (AV IN 2) Video Operation 0 0 Disabled 0 1 Disabled 1 0 Selectable 1 1 Auto Sense Previous State Before Inserting CAMPORT Operation While CAMPORT is Active State Upon Removal of CAMPORT Aux or RF Channel None Previous Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Direct Access Last Requested Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Ch Up/Down, Flashback, and Input Keys Previous Aux or RF Channel Previous State Before Inserting CAMPORT Operation While CAMPORT is Active State Upon Removal of CAMPORT Aux or RF Channel None Previous Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Direct Access Last Requested Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Ch Up/Down, Flashback, and Input Keys Last Requested Aux or RF Channel 206-4177 Reference: TV Aux Input Configuration ENABLE DIRECT ACCESS Tuning TV Installer Menu MPI DATA MPI DATA STATUS TYPE 0x41 SOURCES ENABLED (R/W) DATA STATUS TYPE 0xD2 CURRENT AV SOURCE (R) DATA STATUS TYPE 0x0D AUX SOURCE (R) START AUX SOURCE ASSIGNMENT OLD_ OCV = 0 OLD_ OCV = 1 Source Input Source Mode Number Labeling Value Labeling Value Labeling 130 90 Video2 (Side) CV 34 CAMPORT_EN 0x01 Video Front (Camport) 0 Video Front (Camport) 0 (VIDEO) 2 131 91 Video1 (Rear) CV 39 REAR_AUX_EN 0x02 Rear Video (Aux) 1 Rear Video (Aux) 0 (VIDEO) 1 132 92 HDMI2 DTV/PC 91 YPrPb2 EN = 1 0x04 S-Video Rear 2 S-Video Rear 0 (VIDEO) 5 133 93 HDMI1/DVI DTV/PC 35 COMPPORT_EN =1 0x08 Front Computer 3 Front Computer 0 (VIDEO) 3 134 94 RGB PC 87 REAR RGB EN =2 0x10 SVGA Rear Computer 4 SVGA Rear Computer 2 (COMPUTER) 4 136 96 Component 38 YPrPb EN 0x40 Y/UV Component 6 Rear Y/PrPb Component Video 0 (VIDEO) 6 206-4177 41 Troubleshooting General Troubleshooting Some Quick and Easy Tips for Resolving Problems Symptom Possible Cause(s) Possible Solution(s) Channel not included in channel lineup in TV controller. After 2-5-5 + MENU, only channels included in TV controller will appear. If channel is available, it can be added to channel lineup. If it is not available, the “No Signal” message appears on the TV screen. Software Problems Cannot direct enter channel number or “No Signal” appears. Power No power. See troubleshooting flow chart on following page. Display Panel Picture No picture. Display panel is turned off. • Turn TV ON. • Power failure? Antenna/cable not connected. Connect antenna/cable signal to TV. Connections incorrect. Check connections on TV. MPI not connected. If applicable, connect MPI cable to MPI device. Encrypted program. Try another channel. Wrong tuning band. Adjust Installer Menu settings. Wrong Installer Menu settings. Adjust Installer Menu settings as required. Remote not in TV Mode. Use MODE key to select “TV”; puts remote into TV Mode. Not aimed at IR remote sensor. Point remote at TV’s IR receiver on TV. Remote too far from IR sensor. Move remote closer to TV’s IR receiver or darken room. Erratic Operation Installer Menu setup. Installer Remote Remote doesn’t work. MPI not connected. If applicable, connect MPI cable to MPI device. IR path to TV’s receiver obstructed. Remove obstructions. Weak batteries. Replace batteries. Wrong battery polarity. Check that “+” and “-” match in battery compartment. Too much light in room. Dim room light. Wrong Installer Remote. Requires compatible Installer Remote. Contact your LG dealer. Audio muted. Press MUTE or use Volume Up key to increase sound level. Broadcast problem. Try a different channel. Picture Reception Normal picture, poor or no sound. Note: For other problems not caused by the TV, refer to the other devices’ operating guide(s). 42 206-4177 Troubleshooting (Cont.) Troubleshooting Flow Chart Controller Quick Check STATUS LED on PTC Board blinking? No TV connected to AC Power? No Plug into AC Power outlet. Yes Yes Bad TV Cycle the power by removing and reconnecting the AC Power cord. Then, observe POWER LED on front of TV. POWER LED lit? No Bad Analog or Digital Board Yes No Bad TV No Bad PPV Card Yes Press POWER on Installer Remote. TV turned ON? TV responded? Press VOLUME UP/ DOWN or MUTE key on User-supplied Remote. No Bad TV TV responded? Yes Yes Press VOLUME UP/ DOWN or MUTE key on Installer Remote. 206-4177 End 43 Troubleshooting (Cont.) Commercial Mode Check / FTG Operation Troubleshooting Commercial Mode Check Press POWER on Installer Remote. TV responded? No Bad TV Yes Leave the TV set ON. Go to Installer Menu by pressing MENU until the on-screen setup menus lock up (i.e., stop responding). TV stopped responding or continued to respond? Stopped responding TV is in Commercial Mode. Continued to respond TV is not in Commercial Mode. Call Technical Support for assistance. FTG Operation Troubleshooting The following table provides troubleshooting information for when the TV is configured in the FTG Mode of operation. Symptom Possible Cause(s) Solution(s) Communication Error (“Communications Timeout”) TV not powered. Check/connect the TV power cord. TV not turned ON. TV needs to be turned ON (default FTG Mode). 44 206-4177 Troubleshooting (Cont.) Clone Programmer Troubleshooting Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs, as this will damage the clone programmer and the PPV card. Reset Clone Programmer After Static Shock After replacing exhausted batteries (LT2002 only), or if the clone programmer behaves strangely after a static shock: • TLL-1100A: Turn the TLL-1100A OFF and then ON. • LT2002: Use a paper clip or similar instrument inserted through the small hole marked RESET to activate the internal reset switch and restore normal operation. After a reset, check the real-time clock setting. It may be necessary to set the clone programmer clock from a TV containing the correct time. Symptom Notes • The TLL-1100A and LT2002 clone programmers are designed to be used with TVs containing the 22101006 and later processors. Use with earlier TVs may give unpredictable results. Processors used before the 221-01006-04 have a limited screen display capability; they cannot display entire screens as shown in the setup instructions accompanying the clone programmer. Use the printed menu illustrations in the documentation as an aid to making your programming choices. • The Master and Target TVs must be in Pass-through Mode for cloning purposes. See also IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 23. Possible Cause(s) Possible Solution(s) Clone copies setup in less than 30 seconds. Not enough time to copy entire TV setup. TLL-1100A: Turn the TLL-1100A Off and then ON. LT2002: Press RESET on clone programmer. Then redo Learn/Teach. (Learning usually takes about 90 seconds; Teaching usually takes 3 to 4 minutes.) Remote does not operate clone programmer. Wrong Installer Remote. Only use an LG Installer Remote to operate clone programmer with TV. Clone menu does not display on TV screen, TLL1100A shows error message, or LT2002 LED does not blink. MPI cord not connected. Connect MPI cord properly, and ensure good connection. TV not turned ON. TV must be powered ON for clone programmer to work. (LT2002 only) Weak batteries. Install four (4) fresh AA high-quality alkaline batteries. (TLL-1100A only) No charge. Ensure the TLL-1100A is fully charged or connected to AC power. Clone menu hard to read. Weak signal. Connect TV to a reliable analog channel signal source. No time set. Time not available. Set time on a TV, and copy time to clone programmer. Clone not working. Clone programmer problem. • Try a different clone programmer. • Reset the clone programmer. Clone scans channels more than once. Clone should only scan channels Ensure TV is set up correctly, and try cloning again. once. Clone Programmer Master and Target TVs Cloning did not work. Procedure interrupted. Wait until procedure complete message is displayed. Different TV models. Cloning is only possible with identical model TVs. Step(s) omitted or not performed. Refer to the applicable cloning procedure(s), and make sure all tasks were performed. (LT2002 only) Clone time disappeared. Batteries were removed. Batteries must remain installed to retain time settings. New setup not present. Target TV not reset. Disconnect Target TV from AC power for fifteen (15) seconds. • After cloning operations are complete, unplug the TLL-1100A/LT2002 from the TV. • If the TV does not display a picture (blank screen) after a few seconds, just change channels. 206-4177 45 Glossary of Terms A list of de nitions for some of the words found in this guide. 75 OHM RF CABLE The wire that comes from an off-air antenna or cable service provider. The end looks like a hex-shaped nut with a wire through the middle. It screws onto the Antenna/Cable threaded jack on the back of the TV. 300 TO 75 OHM ADAPTER A small device that connects a 2-wire 300 ohm antenna to a 75 ohm RF jack. It is usually about an inch long with two screws on one end and a round opening with a wire extending out the other end. A/V CABLES Audio/Video cables. Three cables bunched together—right audio (red), left audio (white), and video (yellow). A/V cables are used for stereo playback of videocassettes and for higher quality picture and sound from other A/V devices. COMPOSITE VIDEO Typical video jack, uses one wire for transporting three-color video signals. DELETE Lets you remove channels from the list that the end user can scroll through using Channel Up/Down. DIGITAL TELEVISION High-resolution, cinema-quality television signals transmitted digitally. DVI Digital Video Interface. Accommodates analog and digital interfaces with a single connector. HDMI High-de nition multi-media interface. A/V DEVICE Any device that produces video or sound (VCR, DVD, cable box, or television). HDSTB High-de nition set top box. Refers to a tuner device that receives high-de nition television signals which have higher resolution than ordinary analog TV signals. AMPLIFIER An electronic device that ampli es sound from a television, CD player, VCR, DVD player, or other Audio/Video device. HDTV High-de nition television. Refers to television signals that have higher resolution than ordinary analog TV signals. ANTENNA The physical receiver of television signals sent over the air. A large metal piece of equipment does not always have to be visible to be using an antenna. INPUT Refers to the input jack that receives a signal from a TV, VCR, DVD Player or other Audio/Video device. CABLE Cable service box. Refers to the descrambler box cable subscribers use to receive cable programming signals. JACK An input or output connector on the back of a TV, VCR, DVD Player or other Audio/Video device. CATV Programming provided by a cable service. MONO SOUND Mono (monaural) sound is one channel of sound. On more than one speaker, all the speakers play the same audio. COMPONENT VIDEO Uses three wires for transporting threecolor video signals. The end result is usually better video quality. OUTPUT Refers to the output jack that sends a signal out of a VCR, DVD, or other A/V device. 46 PHYSICAL CHANNEL NUMBER The actual channel number. Analog channels use the Physical Channel number and digital channels can use a Virtual Channel number. RGB (RED, GREEN, BLUE) Connection input or output port available for producing a video image using three separate colors: Red, Green, and Blue. RS-232 Serial communication port through which rmware is downloaded. 2ND AUDIO PROGRAMMING/SAP Second Audio Programming (SAP) is another, separate audio channel available with some programming. Choosing SAP often refers to listening to audio in another language, such as Spanish or French. SIGNAL Picture and sound traveling through a cable, or over the air, to the TV. STEREO SOUND Stereo (Stereophonic) sound refers to audio that’s divided into right and left sides. TUNER Device that picks up the broadcast signal and turns it into picture and sound. VIRTUAL CHANNEL NUMBER A re-mapped channel number. Analog channels use the Physical Channel number; however digital channels use a Virtual (or false) Channel number. XDS Extended Data Service. Additional program information included on the signal provided at the discretion of the broadcaster. Note: Refer to www.atsc.org for further information. 206-4177 Document Revision History / Notes Document Revision History Date Description January 2011 Revision A: New Document Product documentation is available online at: www.LGsolutions.com/products. From the Products page, select TVs, Systems & Solutions, then LCD TVs, then the applicable TV. Click the Literature & Downloads tab at the bottom of the TV page, and select the required document(s) from the Downloads list. Notes 206-4177 47 For Customer Support/Service, please call: 1-888-865-3026 www.LGsolutions.com Pro:Idiom is a registered trademark of Zenith Electronics LLC. Pro:Centric is a trademark of LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. All other trademarks or registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. © Copyright 2011, LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 206-4177 Revision A 26LD340H 32LD340H 37LD340H 42LD340H 26LD343H 32LD343H 37LD343H 42LD343H 26LD345H 32LD345H 37LD345H 42LD345H Lodging Guest Interactive Pro:Centric™ TVs Commercial Mode Setup Guide Note: Selected features shown in this guide may not be available on all models. EXPERIENCED INSTALLER Commercial Mode Setup pages 12 – 13 Cloning Information pages 23 – 28 FTG Mode of Operation pages 29 – 39 © Copyright 2011, LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. P/N: 206-4186 (Rev A) For Customer Support/Service, please call: 1-888-865-3026 The latest product information and documentation is available online at: www.LGsolutions.com/products MODEL and SERIAL NUMBER The model and serial numbers of this TV are located on the back of the cabinet. For future reference, LG suggests that you record those numbers here: Model No._________________ Serial No._______________ WARNING RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT OPEN WARNING: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK). NO USERSERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE. REFER TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL. The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral triangle, is intended to alert the user to the presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to persons. The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert the user to the presence of important operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the appliance. WARNING: TO PREVENT FIRE OR SHOCK HAZARDS, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS PRODUCT TO RAIN OR MOISTURE. POWER CORD POLARIZATION: This product is equipped with a 3-wire grounding-type alternating current power plug. This plug will fit into the power outlet only one way. This is a safety feature. If you are unable to insert the plug fully into the outlet, contact your electrician to replace your obsolete outlet. Do not defeat the safety purpose of the 3-wire grounding-type plug. NOTE TO CABLE/TV INSTALLER: This reminder is provided to call the cable TV system installer’s attention to Article 820-40 of the National Electric Code (U.S.A.). The code provides guidelines for proper grounding and, in particular, specifies that the cable ground shall be connected to the grounding system of the building, as close to the point of the cable entry as practical. REGULATORY INFORMATION: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: • Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna. • Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver. • Connect the equipment to an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. • Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help. CAUTION: Do not attempt to modify this product in any way without written authorization from LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. Unauthorized modification could void the user’s authority to operate this product. COMPLIANCE: The responsible party for this product’s compliance is: LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 1000 Sylvan Avenue, Englewood Cliffs, NJ 07632, USA • Phone: 1-201-816-2000 Marketed and Distributed in the United States by LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 1000 Sylvan Avenue, Englewood Cliffs, NJ 07632 2 © Copyright 2011, LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 206-4186 IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS 1. Read these instructions. 2. Keep these instructions. 3. Heed all warnings. 4. Follow all instructions. 5. Do not use this apparatus near water. 6. Clean only with dry cloth. 7. Do not block any ventilation openings. Install in accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions. 8. Do not install near any heat sources, such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus (including amplifiers) that produce heat. 9. Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or grounding-type plug. A polarized plug has two blades with one wider than the other. A grounding-type plug has two blades and a third grounding prong. The wide blade or the third prong are provided for your safety. If the provided plug does not fit into your outlet, consult an electrician for replacement of the obsolete outlet. 10. Protect the power cord from being walked on or pinched, particularly at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the point where it exits from the apparatus. 11. Only use attachments/accessories specified by the manufacturer. 12. Use only with the cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table specified by the manufacturer or sold with the apparatus. When a cart is used, use caution when moving the cart/apparatus combination in order to avoid injury from tip-over. 17. Power Cord Caution: It is recommended that appliances be placed upon a dedicated circuit; that is, a single outlet circuit which powers only that appliance and has no additional outlets or branch circuits. Check the specification page of the Owner’s Manual to be certain. Periodically examine the cord of your appliance, and if its appearance indicates damage or deterioration, unplug it, discontinue use of the appliance, and have the cord replaced with an exact replacement part by an authorized servicer. Protect the power cord from physical or mechanical abuse, such as twisting, kinking, or pinching or being closed in a door or walked upon. Pay particular attention to plugs, wall outlets, and the point where the cord exits the appliance. Do not use a damaged or loose power cord. Be sure to grasp the plug when unplugging the power cord. Do not pull on the power cord to unplug the TV. 18. Overloading Do not connect too many appliances to the same AC power outlet as this could result in fire or electric shock. Do not overload wall outlets. Overloaded wall outlets, loose or damaged wall outlets, extension cords, frayed power cords, or damaged or cracked wire insulation are dangerous. Any of these conditions could result in fire or electric shock. 19. Outdoor Use/Wet Location Warning: To reduce the risk of fire or electrical shock, do not expose this product to rain, moisture or other liquids. Do not touch the TV with wet hands. Do not install this product near flammable objects such as gasoline or candles or expose the TV to direct air conditioning. Do not expose to dripping or splashing and do not place objects filled with liquids, such as vases, cups, etc., on or over the apparatus (e.g., on shelves above the unit). PORTABLE CART WARNING 13. Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel. Servicing is required when the apparatus has been damaged in any way, such as power-supply cord or plug is damaged, liquid has been spilled or objects have fallen into the apparatus, the apparatus has been exposed to rain or moisture, does not operate normally, or has been dropped. 14. Never touch this apparatus or antenna during a thunder or lighting storm. 15. When mounting a TV on the wall, make sure not to install the TV by the hanging power and signal cables on the back of the TV. 16. Do not allow an impact shock or any objects to fall into the product, and do not drop objects onto the screen. 206-4186 20. Grounding Ensure that you connect the earth ground wire to prevent possible electric shock (i.e., a TV with a three-prong grounded AC plug must be connected to a three-prong grounded AC outlet). If grounding methods are not possible, have a qualified electrician install a separate circuit breaker. Do not try to ground the unit by connecting it to telephone wires, lightening rods, or gas pipes. 21. Disconnect Device The mains plug is the disconnecting device. The plug must remain readily operable. As long as this unit is connected to the AC wall outlet, it is not disconnected from the AC power source even if you turn off this unit by SWITCH. (Continued on next page) 3 IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS (Continued from previous page) 22. Outdoor Antenna Grounding If an outside antenna or cable system is connected to the product, follow the precautions below. An outdoor antenna system should not be located in the vicinity of overhead power lines or other electric light or power circuits or where it can come into contact with such power lines or circuits as death or serious injury can occur. Be sure the antenna system is grounded so as to provide some protection against voltage surges and built-up static charges. Article 810 of the National Electrical Code (NEC) in the U.S.A. provides information with respect to proper grounding of the mast and supporting structure, grounding of the lead-in wire to an antenna-discharge unit, size of grounding conductors, location of antenna-discharge unit, connection to grounding electrodes, and requirements for the grounding electrode. Antenna Grounding According to NEC, ANSI/NFPA 70 Ground Clamp Antenna Lead in Wire Antenna Discharge Unit (NEC Section 810-20) Electric Service Equipment Grounding Conductor (NEC Section 810-21) Ground Clamps Power Service Grounding Electrode System (NEC Art 250, Part H) 27. If you smell smoke or other odors coming from the TV or hear strange sounds, unplug the power cord, and contact an authorized service center. 28. Do not press strongly on the panel with a hand or sharp object (e.g., a nail, pencil, or pen) or make a scratch on it. 29. Keep the product away from direct sunlight. 30. Dot Defect The Plasma or LCD panel is a high technology product with resolution of two million to six million pixels. In a very few cases, you could see fine dots on the screen while you’re viewing the TV. Those dots are deactivated pixels and do not affect the performance and reliability of the TV. 31. Generated Sound “Cracking”: A cracking noise that occurs while the TV is On or when it is turned Off is generated by plastic thermal contraction due to temperature and humidity. This noise is common for products where thermal deformation is required. Electrical circuit humming/panel buzzing: A low level noise is generated from a high-speed switching circuit, which supplies a large amount of current to operate a product. It varies depending on the product. This generated sound does not affect the performance and reliability of the product. 32. For LCD TV If the TV feels cold to the touch, there may be a small “flicker” when it is turned On. This is normal; there is nothing wrong with TV. Some minute dot defects may be visible on the screen, appearing as tiny red, green, or blue spots. However, they have no adverse effect on the monitor’s performance. Avoid touching the LCD screen or holding your finger(s) against it for long periods of time. Doing so may produce some temporary distortion effects on the screen. 23. Cleaning When cleaning, unplug the power cord and rub gently with a soft cloth to prevent scratching. Do not spray water or other liquids directly on the TV as electric shock may occur. Do not clean with chemicals such as alcohol, thinners or benzene. 24. Transporting Product Make sure the product is turned Off and unplugged and that all cables have been removed. It may take two or more people to carry larger TVs. Do not press against or put stress on the front panel of the TV. 25. Ventilation Install the TV where there is proper ventilation. Do not install in a confined space such as a bookcase. Do not cover the product with cloth or other materials (e.g., plastic) while it is plugged in. Do not install in excessively dusty places. 26. Do not touch the ventilation openings, as they may become hot while the TV is operating. 4 206-4186 Table of Contents Safety Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 FTG Mode via EBL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Important Safety Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 – 4 FTG Configuration Application Utilities Overview . . 36 – 39 Table of Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility . . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Setup Checklist / Commercial Mode Setup Overview . . . . 6 FTG Channel Map Editor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 Pro:Centric TV Interactive Menu Features . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility . . . . . . . . . . . 38 LD340H/LD343H/LD345H Rear Jack Panel . . . . . . . . . . . 8 FMA Configuration Utility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Side Connections Panel / RF Antenna Connection . . . . . 9 Remote Jack Pack / TV Connections & Setup . . . . . . . . 40 Installer Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Installer Remote Control Typical Key Functions . . . . . . 11 Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV . . . . . . . 12 – 13 Installer Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 – 20 TV Setup Menus Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Adding Channel Icons / Custom Channel Labels (2-5-4 + MENU Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Cloning Overview / Clonable Menu Features . . . . . . . 23 Cloning Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 – 28 Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a USB Memory Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a TLL-1100A Clone Programmer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using an LT2002 Clone Programmer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 FTG Mode of Operation Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 – 30 FTG Mode via CPU or EBL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Determining the TV Operating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 FTG Mode via CPU . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 – 34 Creating an FMA Configuration File using the FTG Configuration Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Teaching FMA Configuration to a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 Learning an FMA Configuration File from a TV . . . . . . 33 References Upgrading TV/PTC Software using a USB Memory Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Downloading a Splash Screen using a USB Memory Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Power Consumption Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 TV Camport Auto Sense Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 TV Aux Input Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 b-LAN Setup & Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 RJP Model List and Input Auto-sensing Hierarchy . . . . . 47 Resetting a TV to Pass-through Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 – 52 General Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Troubleshooting Flow Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Commercial Mode Check / FTG Operating Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51 Clone Programmer Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 Glossary of Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53 Document Revision History / Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Back Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55 Optional Manual Configuration / Setup for a TV . . . . . 34 Notes • Installer Menu content is intended for use primarily by qualified TV electronics technicians. • Refer to the Owner’s Manual for additional information on TV features, specifications, maintenance, and safety instructions. • For additional information, contact your LG representative. Note: Design and specifications subject to change without prior notice. 206-4186 5 Setup Checklist / Overview Setup Checklist Installation and Setup Checklist __ Unpack TV and all accessories. __ Install batteries in remote control. __ Install TV on VESA mount or stand. Note: It may be advisable to make all cable connections before installing on VESA mount or stand, as appropriate. Hardware Connections __ Install any additional hardware as appropriate to your institution, LAN, etc. Commercial Mode Setup __ Complete Commercial Mode Setup (configure all relevant Installer Menu items as required of your institution and configure display features for the end user). Software Installation __ Install or configure any software, as applicable, for example, PPV, etc. Cable Connections __ Make all connections to rear jack panel and RF antenna on MPI/PPV card. __ Make all connections to signal, interactive resources, and Aux sources, as appropriate. Commercial Mode Setup Overview This document describes how to set up LD340H, LD343H and LD345H Pro:Centric™ TVs for Commercial Mode while the TV/Embedded b-LAN™ (EBL) module is in either Pass-through Mode or Free-To-Guest (FTG) Mode. Note: The b-LAN module is internal to the TV and allows hotel/institution head end equipment with b-LAN technology to communicate with the TV for configuration and control. See Reference section, “b-LAN Setup & Overview,” for further information. Pass-through Mode This mode allows you to configure a Master TV Setup for cloning purposes as well as external VOD/PPV control. Use the Installer Remote to configure Installer Menu items as required for TV operation and set up TV features (Channel, Picture, Audio, etc.). See pages 12 to 13 for detailed information. FTG Mode This mode enables Pro:Idiom ® decryption and also allows logical channel mapping of physical channels to remove the need for dash tuning. FTG Configuration Application software is used to configure and/or edit FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings. With the LD340H/LD343H/LD345H models, there are two separate and distinct methods for configuring the TVs for the FTG Mode of operation. See pages 29 to 39 for information on FTG Mode options and using the FTG Configuration Application. 6 206-4186 Pro:Centric TV Interactive Menu Features Important: Pro:Centric operation requires that Installer Menu items 098 PRO:CENTRIC and 119 DATA CHANNEL be set appropriately and that the TV be in PPV or FTG Mode. The interactive Pro:Centric TV enables guests—from the comfort of their hotel rooms—to view and select from a complete listing of hotel services and amenities. The Pro:Centric TV is connected to the hotel's billing computer, and service/amenities charges are billed at the time of order. Interactive amenities may include: • Hotel information, news, and events • Directory services (tourist attractions, restaurants, etc.) • Reservation services (business meetings, fitness, spa, etc.) • Weather and traffic information ALARM TIMER • Shopping services (delivery to guest room) INPUT • Room service (menu ordering, memo service, morning wake up call, laundry, etc.) TV 1 4 7 2 5 8 0 INFO • Ticketing services 3 6 9 • Check-out service (in the guest room) • Gaming services • E-mail resources/account access FLASHBK Use the Installer Remote to operate both interactive menus and regular TV features. Press PORTAL on the Installer Remote to access the interactive menus. i VOL PORTAL MENU GUIDE CH MUTE CC P A G E Note: Interactive menu options may vary, depending on Pro:Centric features enabled for the site. The following are default interactive menus. Channel Guide Shows available TV networks and channels. When available, electronic program guide (EPG) data indicates the channel and the program start and finish times. ENTER Information RETURN SAP EXIT EJECT RATIO Typically displays hotel information, for example, photos of guest rooms, dining rooms, business centers, facilities, etc., as well as information on local weather and attractions. Information may also include resources, such as local school programs, run in cooperation with the hotel. Help Provides help for navigating the interactive menus. Watch TV Removes the interactive menu from the screen and returns to the previously tuned TV channel. 206-4186 7 LD340H/LD343H/LD345H Rear Jack Panel AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) Audio connection for RGB or DVI device. RJP Connection for Remote Jack Pack (RJP) Control cable. REMOTE CONTROL OUT IR output for controlling an auxiliary device. UPDATE Restricted to software updates. RESET Press RESET to re-initialize the TV. AUDIO/VIDEO IN 1 Connection for composite audio/ video output from external device. RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET HDMI HDMI /DVI IN 2 1 UPDATE .......... .......... ..... .... RJP REMOTE CONTROL OUT ..... ..... ..... AV IN 1 VIDEO L/MONO-AUDIO-R AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT ( 8 ) Y PB VIDEO ANTENNA IN PR L AUDIO GAME CONTROL/ MPI TV-LINK CFG TV-LINK CFG Use for local FTG configuration. R COMPONENT IN HDMI/DVI IN Connection for HDMI/DVI output from external device. RGB IN (PC) Connection for RGB output from PC. COMPONENT IN Connection for component output from external device. SPEAKER OUT (8Ω) * Connect to 8 ohm self-powered speaker input. Intended for special applications, such as a powered bathroom speaker with volume control. ANTENNA IN 26LD340H, 26LD343H and 26LD345H only. Connect to Antenna/ CATV. RS-232C IN Use for downloading software updates, etc. GAME CONTROL/MPI When the TV/EBL is in Pass-through Mode, the MPI function enables an external MPI control device (i.e., clone programmer, VOD/ PPV STB, etc.) to control the TV. Game Control—EBL in LodgeNet PPV mode only. * This stereo jack provides a mono speaker fixed-level, 1 watt output (audio +, audio -, w/ground shield). Do NOT plug in a mono connector, as this may damage the TV. 8 206-4186 Side Connections Panel / RF Antenna Connection USB IN Side Connections Panel USB IN Insert USB memory device for software updates, cloning purposes, or picture/music entertainment, as applicable. A/V 2 Input VIDEO L/MONO -AUDIO- R L/MONO-AUDIO-R IN Connect to audio output jacks on external device. For only mono audio output, connect to Left audio input. VIDEO IN Connect to video output port on external device (see Reference section, “TV Camport Auto Sense Operation,” for further information). AV IN 2 RF Antenna Connection (32/37/42LD340H, 32/37/42LD343H and 32/37/42LD345H TVs) Note: 26LD340H, 26LD343H and 26LD345H Antenna connections are on the rear jack panel (see previous page). Antenna or CATV ANTENNA IN 206-4186 ANTENNA IN Connect to Antenna/ CATV. 9 Installer Overview This is the Commercial Mode Setup Guide only. Installer Menu / Commercial Mode Setup xxLD340H PTC INSTALLER MENU To set up a Master TV for cloning purposes, you will need to know how to enter the TV Installer Menu and make changes to the default values as required. Similarly, to configure a TV’s Installer Menu settings in FTG Mode, you will need to know how to access and use the FTG Configuration Application utilities. If necessary, familiarize yourself with the Installer Menu and how to make and save changes. Refer to page 14 for information on accessing the Installer Menu in Pass-through Mode. Pages 15 to 20 describe Installer Menu items in detail. Refer to pages 29 to 39 for information on entering FTG Mode and using the FTG Configuration Application utilities. 000 INSTALLER SEQ 000 UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.25.00 Typical Installer Menu Installer Remote The LG Installer Remote is supplied with and dedicated to operate the TV. See next page for typical key functions in TV operating mode. Some DVD and VCR controls may be available for selected LG DVD/VCR products. Cloning Cloning refers to the process of capturing a Master TV Setup and transferring it to a Target TV. The Master TV’s clonable features need to be configured as part of the Commercial Mode Setup. This is a critical step. If the Master TV’s clonable features—channel icons or labels, digital font options, etc.—are not set up correctly, the cloned TVs will all have problems. Pages 23 to 28 provide detailed information on cloning requirements and procedures. ALARM TIMER INPUT TV 1 4 7 2 5 8 0 INFO VOL 3 6 9 FLASHBK i PORTAL CH P A G E MUTE MENU GUIDE CC ENTER + A AA A AA + Installing Batteries in Installer Remote • Open the battery compartment cover on the back side of the remote. • Install two high-quality alkaline 1.5V AAA batteries. Never mix old or used batteries with new ones. Install batteries matching correct polarity as shown (+ with + and - with -). • Replace the battery compartment cover. 10 RETURN SAP EXIT EJECT RATIO 206-4186 Installer Remote Control Typical Key Functions The LG Installer Remote illustrated below and throughout this document shows typical remote control functions and is provided for reference only. This Installer Remote may vary from the Installer Remote supplied with the TV. POWER Turns TV ON or OFF. ALARM Sets the time when the TV will automatically turn itself ON. TIMER Sets the amount of time before the TV automatically turns itself OFF. INPUT Selects RGB, HDMI/DVI1, HDMI2, Component Input, AV1, and AV2 sources. TV Returns to the last TV channel (from an Aux input). ALARM TIMER PORTAL Displays and removes the interactive menu. MUTE Switches sound ON or OFF. NUMBER Buttons (0 - 9) & DASH Use to enter a program number or channel. Dash is used for sub-channel numbers such as 2-1, 2-2, 9-1, 9-2, 100-3, 100-4, etc. TV 1 4 7 VOLUME UP/DOWN Increases/decreases sound level. INFO Displays channel information. INPUT 2 5 8 0 INFO VOL 3 6 9 FLASHBK (FLASHBACK) Returns to the previously tuned channel. Arrows (Up/Down/Left/Right) & ENTER Use to navigate on-screen menus and adjust TV settings to your requirements. MENU Displays the TV setup menus on the screen. Also exits the on-screen menu system and returns to TV viewing. FLASHBK i PORTAL CH GUIDE Displays and removes the electronic program guide. P A G E MUTE MENU CHANNEL/PAGE UP/DOWN Changes the channel. Moves from one full set of screen information to the next. GUIDE CC Press to activate subtitles. CC BACK Returns one level to the previous menu/ display. ENTER RETURN SAP SAP Analog Mode: Selects MTS sound (Mono, Stereo, or SAP). DTV Mode: Changes audio language, if additional languages are available. * EXIT EXIT Clears all on-screen displays and returns to TV viewing. Color buttons access special functions in some menus. DVD/VCR BUTTONS Controls some DVD players or video cassette recorders. EJECT Ejects a USB memory device, CD, DVD, VHS tape, as applicable. RATIO Adjusts the picture aspect ratio. EJECT RATIO * SAP notes: • • • 206-4186 If SAP is selected and no SAP is provided, sound may not be heard on channel. Each analog channel may have its own SAP setting. Digital channels will reset to default audio language with a power off/on. 11 Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV This section describes how to set up a Master TV for cloning purposes when the TV is in Pass-through Mode. Note: Disconnect all Aux inputs. Under certain conditions, Auto Tuning (Channel Search) is disabled if there is an Aux input active. Note: Refer to FTG Mode information on pages 29 to 39 for details on entering FTG Mode and configuring/editing FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings using the FTG Configuration Application. 1. Set Installer Menu items. This step provides specific instruction only on the Installer Menu items that should be set on a Master TV. Refer to pages 14 to 20 for detailed information on all Installer Menu items. a) Make sure the TV is ON. Then, use the Installer Remote to enter the TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. b) Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001 and press ENTER on the Installer Remote. This clears all Installer Menu custom settings, channel lineup, etc. and reloads the factory default settings. The value will change back to 0 after the internal TV controller (Protocol Translator Card [PTC]) has been restored to factory default condition. This step ensures that the TV Channel Memory will be the active channel lineup. c) Set Installer Menu item 003 BAND/AFC, as appropriate. • Broadcast: Set to 000. • HRC: Set to 002. • CATV: Set to 001 (default). • IRC: Set to 003. xxLD340H PTC INSTALLER MENU 000 INSTALLER SEQ UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 2. Set up TV features. On-screen setup menus control the features of the TV (see page 21). Press MENU on the Installer Remote to access the setup menus, and then set Channel, Picture, Audio, Lock, Time, etc. options to the desired configurations. See also the Clonable Menu Features list on page 23. Note: If desired, you can run Auto Tuning (see step 3) prior to completing this step. ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.25.00 Typical TV Installer Menu Note: The Installer Menu header will vary depending on the TV you are setting up. 117 FACT DEFAULT 001 003 BAND/AFC 00X Adjust the settings for these Installer Menu items. d) Set any other Installer Menu items that affect your TV programming network to the required configuration. For example, enable/ disable Aux sources, set a Start Channel, etc. e) After you have adjusted all required Installer Menu item settings, press ENTER once on the Installer Remote to save your changes; then, press ENTER again to exit the menu. 000 CHANNEL PICTURE AUDIO TIME LOCK OPTION INPUT MY MEDIA Set the TV features to the desired configuration for the end user. 3. Run Auto Tuning (Channel Search). a) Search for all available analog and digital channels: Go to the Channel Menu, select the Auto Tuning option, and follow the on-screen instructions. (Continued on next page) 12 206-4186 Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV (Cont.) (Continued from previous page) 3. Run Auto Tuning (Channel Search). (continued) b) Use the Channel Edit option in the Channel Menu to edit the channel lineup, as necessary, to include free to guest channels only. • Add/delete channels per your system requirements. Note that if Installer Menu item 103 ATSC TUNE MODE is set for Physical Channel tuning (default and recommended setting), channels with minor channel numbers higher than 255 will not transfer correctly in step 4. If it is set for Virtual Channel tuning and either the major or minor channel numbers are higher than 255, the channel(s) will not transfer correctly in step 4. • Use the Channel Label option in the Channel Menu to add familiar channel trademarks/logos such as ABC, CBS, NBC, etc. to the Channel-Time on-screen display. Identifiable labels (logos) should enable the end user to readily know what common networks are available. (You can add the channel labels in this step, or you can add channel labels or logos for channels without icons in step 5.) 4. Transfer the TV Setup to the internal TV Controller (PTC): 2-5-5 + MENU Mode After the TV channel lineup has been edited and channel label icons added, enter the Installer Menu. Once in the Installer Menu, press 2-5-5 + MENU on the Installer Remote to initiate the transfer of the Master TV Setup to the PTC. The TV exits the Installer Menu and then tunes through the channels in the channel lineup during the transfer. When the transfer is complete, the TV tunes back to the channel that was tuned before the transfer began. Note: The maximum number of active channels that can be transferred is 141. An attempt to transfer more than 141 channels will result in erratic TV tuning operation. 5. Add Custom Channel and Aux Source Labels for Analog Channels: 2-5-4 + MENU Mode Enter the Installer Menu, and press 2-5-4 + MENU on the Installer Remote. Add/edit custom text labels to channel on-screen displays. Note that digital channels often have a broadcaster generated label (see 2-5-4 + MENU procedural information on page 22). When you are finished, press MENU to exit 2-5-4 + MENU Mode. CHANNEL Move Enter Auto Tuning Manual Tuning Channel Edit Channel Label Run Auto Tuning, edit channels, and select familiar channel trademarks/logos using Channel Menu options. DIGITAL 19-3 MONO STEREO SAP WXYZ Custom Text Label “WXYZ” created in 2-5-4 + MENU (Add Channel Label) Mode. 028 CH. OVERIDE 000 After verifying the TV Setup, set Installer Menu item 028 CH. OVERIDE to 000.* * This step prevents end users from accessing channel settings (i.e., the Channel Menu will be inaccessible/ grayed out). 6. Verify the TV setup. At this point, verify that the channel lineup, channel icons, and custom labels are correct. Make sure the TV features are set per your requirements. 7. Lock the channel lineup. Enter the Installer Menu. Set item 028 CH. OVERIDE to 000 and press ENTER to lock the channel lineup and restrict access to the TV setup menus. Press ENTER again to save your changes and exit the Installer Menu.* The Master TV Setup is now ready to be copied to a USB memory device or a clone programmer (see cloning information in this document). 206-4186 13 Installer Menu Use the Installer Menu to set up or change operational settings. Refer to the table starting on the next page for brief descriptions of Installer Menu items. More detailed descriptions follow the table listing. Accessing the Installer Menu 1. Make sure the TV is ON. 2. Using an Installer Remote, press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER to access the Installer Menu. The Installer Menu opens with item 000 INSTALLER SEQ 000. Using the Installer Menu Items 000 ~ 119 are accessible only upon entering the Installer Menu. Refer to the table on pages 15 and 16 for an overview of Installer Menu items, including item numbers, functions, ranges, and default values. Installer Menu items not relevant to this TV series are not present on the Installer Menu; therefore, some numbers are missing. For example, item 006 will not appear. xxLD340H PTC INSTALLER MENU 000 INSTALLER SEQ UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 000 ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.25.00 Typical TV Installer Menu Navigation within the Installer Menu Use the Up/Down arrow keys on the Installer Remote to sequence through the available menu items, or access an item directly by keying in the line number and then pressing MENU. For example, to access the SLEEP TIMER option, which is item 015, press 0-1-5 + MENU. Changing Installer Menu Settings To change an Installer Menu item setting, use the Left/Right arrow keys on the Installer Remote, or enter a value directly. Press ENTER to save the new setting, or use the Up/Down arrow keys to navigate to a new Installer Menu item if you have additional items to edit. Exiting the Installer Menu and Activating Updates After you have adjusted all required Installer Menu item settings, press ENTER once on the Installer Remote to save your changes; then, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. Any changes you make will be stored in non-volatile memory. 14 206-4186 Installer Menu (Cont.) Installer Menu Items 000 through 071 Menu Item Function Value Range Default Value Brief Description of Function and Comments 000 INSTALLER SEQ 0~3 0 Leave default set to 0. 001 POWER MANAGE 0~7 0 Sets number of hours of no activity before automatic shutoff. 002 AC ON 0/1 0 Set to 1 to enable Auto Turn ON when AC power is applied. 003 BAND/AFC 0~3 1 Selects Tuning Band: 0=Broadcast, 1=CATV, 2=HRC, 3=IRC 0 ~ 127, 255 255 Channel tuned when TV is turned ON. (Set to 255 to tune to channel tuned before TV turned OFF.) 0/1 0 If set to 1, cannot tune from current channel. 0 ~ 63, 255 255 Volume level when TV is turned ON. (Set to 255 to use volume level before TV turned OFF.) 004 STRT CHANNEL 005 CHAN LOCK 007 STRT VOLUME 008 MIN VOLUME 0 ~ 63 0 Sets minimum allowable volume setting. 009 MAX VOLUME 0 ~ 63 63 Sets maximum allowable volume setting. 010 MUTE DISABLE 0/1 0 Set to 1 to disable Mute Function. 011 KEY DEFEAT 0/1 0 Set to 1 to disable menu navigation keys on display panel. 015 SLEEP TIMER 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable Sleep Timer. 016 EN TIMER 0/1 0 Set to 1 to enable On/Off Timers. 017 ALARM 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable Alarm. 020 FEATURE LEVEL 0 ~ 1, 16 ~ 24 1 Determines the IR code scheme to which the TV will respond. 021 V-CHIP 022 MAX BLK HRS 023 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable V-Chip (Parental Control) functions. 0 ~ 99 12 Sets number of V-Chip blocking hours. CAPTION LOCK 0/1 0 Set to 1 to retain caption setting set before TV turned OFF. 028 CH. OVERIDE 0/1 1 If set to 0, limits direct access to favorite channels. 029 OLD OCV 0/1 0 Set to 1 to change MPI operation to OCV. 030 ACK MASK 0/1 0 If set to 1, changes MPI for some OCV boxes. 031 POLL RATE 20 ~ 169 94 Selects poll rate for MPI. 032 TIMING PULSE 186 ~ 227 207 Sets baud rate for MPI. 034 CAMPORT EN 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable Video 2 input. 035 COMPPORT EN. 0/1 1 Set to 0 to disable HDMI 1. Set to 1 enable HDMI 1. 038 YPrPb EN. 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable display panel Component Video 1 input jacks. 039 REAR AUX EN 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable display panel Video 1 input jack. 040 AUTO CAMPORT 0/1 1 Set to 1 to automatically switch to Camport. If set to 1, STRT AUX SRCE cannot be set to 2. 046 STRT AUX SRCE 1 ~ 6, 255 6 Sets the starting Aux source (if item 004 STRT CHANNEL is set to 0). 047 AUX STATUS 0/1 0 Set to 1 for MPI Aux source to be reported as a channel number instead of Channel 0. 053 DIS. CH-TIME 0/1 0 Set to 1 to disable Channel-Time display. 069 EN. CH-T COL. 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable custom color for the Channel-Time display. 070 FOR. CH-TIME 0~7 2 Chooses custom foreground color for the Channel-Time display. 071 BCK. CH-TIME 0~7 2 Chooses custom background color for the Channel-Time display. 206-4186 15 Installer Menu (Cont.) Installer Menu Items 073 through 119 Menu Item 16 Function Value Range Default Value Brief Description of Function and Comments 073 CH NOT AVBLE 0/1 0 If set to 1 and Channel Override is 0, “NOT AVAILABLE” message is displayed when directly accessing a channel not in the favorite Channel List. 075 REVERT CH 0/1 0 If set to 1 and loss of MPI communication occurs, TV tunes to Start Channel. 078 UPN MSB 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, most significant byte. 079 UPN MSB-1 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, most significant byte - 1. 080 UPN MSB-2 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, most significant byte - 2. 081 UPN LSB 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, least significant byte. 082 CHKSM ERROR 0/1 1 Enforces rigid MPI checksum. 083 HANDSHK TIME 0~5 5 Relaxes MPI timing to be compatible with PC-based Windowscontrolled systems. 084 PERMANENT BLK 0/1 0 Removes block hours setting for Parental Control and makes block permanent. 087 REAR RGB EN. 0 / 1 / 17 1 Dependent on item 093 RJP AVAILABLE setting. Set to 0 to disable RGB input. Set to 1 to enable RGB input. Set to 17 for Auto Configure. 088 EN NOISE MUTE 0/1 1 If set to 1, audio is muted if no signal is present. 090 KEY LOCK 0/1 0 If set to 1, keyboard is locked out, IR is still functional. 091 YPrPb2 EN 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable HDMI 2 input. 093 RJP AVAILABLE 0, 1, 2, 5, 6 0 Set to 0 to disable. Set to 1, 2, 5, or 6 for HDMI or DVI Mode. (See detailed descriptions.) 094 SAP MENU EN 0/1 1 Set to 0 to disable feature on Function Menu. Set to 1 to enable feature on Function Menu. 096 DEF. ASP. RATIO 0~4 2 Sets default aspect ratio at power up. See detailed descriptions and item 106. 098 PRO:CENTRIC 0~2 0 Set to 0 to disable Pro:Centric operation. Set to 1 for Flash Mode. Set to 2 for GEM (Java Application) Mode. 099 BACK LIGHTING 1 ~ 100, 101 ~ 200, 255 100 Sets the level of the TV picture back lighting. (See detailed descriptions.) 102 ATSC BAND 0~4 4 Selects ATSC band. 103 ATSC TUNE MODE 0/1 1 Set to 1 (default) for Physical Channel scan. Set to 0 for Virtual Channel scan. 104 START MINOR CH 0 ~ 255 0 Selects Minor Start Channel. Set to 0 for NTSC. 106 ASP RATIO LOCK 0/1 0 To retain set aspect ratio on power cycle, set to 1. Set to 0 for default ratio on power cycle. 116 VIDEO MUTE EN 0/1 0 Set to 0 for Normal. Set to 1 for Blank. 117 FACT DEFAULT 0/1 0 Set to 0 for Normal. Set to 1 to load presets for all Installer Menu settings. 118 POWER SAVINGS 1/3 3 Set to 3 (default—b-LAN module only powered when TV is turned ON), or set to 1 (b-LAN module is always powered). 119 DATA CHANNEL 0 ~ 135 0 Set to 0 to disable. Set to the RF channel number of the Data Channel for Pro:Centric or E-Z Installation data. (See detailed descriptions.) 206-4186 Installer Menu (Cont.) Detailed Descriptions of Installer Menu Items 000 - INSTALLER SEQUENCE Specifies entry sequence to the Installer Menu. 0 = 9876 2 = 1478 To translate a TV volume level to the Installer Menu value, use the following formula: 1 = 4321 3 = 3698 001 - POWER MANAGE (Power Management) Determines hours of no activity before automatic shutoff. The Power Management function is for saving energy. If set to 0, Power Manage is Off. Settings range from 0 ~ 7, with 1 ~ 7 representing the hours that the unit will remain ON, unless there has been activity from either the control panel or remote control. 002 - AC ON (AC Power Switchable) If set to 1, this allows the TV to turn ON when AC power is applied. Pressing the ON button is not necessary. This is desirable if the TV is plugged into a cable box or a power outlet controlled by a wall switch. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to choose 0 or 1, where 0 is the default (OFF), and 1 is ON. Note: If set to 1 (ON), the TV does not respond to On/Off commands from either the remote or the display control panel, and the SLEEP TIMER is also nonfunctional. 003 - BAND/AFC (Band/Automatic Frequency Control) There are four possible settings for this option: 0 = Broadcast 2 = HRC NOTE: For items 007, 008, and 009 For legacy reasons, the scale used is 0 – 63. The PTC software will translate this to the 0 – 100 scale used by the TV. 1 = CATV (default) 3 = IRC If some channels were not found by Auto Tuning (Channel Search), select the appropriate Band setting here, and add the channels using the Channel Edit option in the Channel Menu. 004 - STRT CHANNEL (Start Channel) If active, this function allows you to determine the initial Major Start Channel number when the TV is turned ON. This feature is useful for an in-house information channel, since the TV would always select that channel when it is turned ON. Setting this item to 255 causes the last channel viewed when the TV was turned OFF, to be the tuned to channel when the TV is turned ON again. Installer Value = TV Value x 63 100 Enter only the whole number (disregard fractions). 007 - STRT VOLUME (Start Volume) This function allows the Installer to determine the initial volume level setting when the TV is turned ON. This feature is useful for an in-house information channel, since the TV would always select that volume level when it is turned ON. The range of values are 0 - 63, 255. If 255 is selected, the current volume level will be retained in memory when the TV is turned OFF; at turn ON, the volume level will be automatically set at the previous or last level. 008 - MIN VOLUME (Minimum Volume) This function determines the minimum volume level allowable with the Volume (VOL) Up/Down control. In this way, for example, someone cannot set the volume too low to hear. The value range is from 0 to 63. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to change values. The factory default is 0, which provides the full range of volume control, if item 009 MAX VOLUME is also set to 63. It may be best to set the same value on every TV. Note: The minimum volume level cannot have a value setting higher than the maximum volume level (described below). 009 - MAX VOLUME (Maximum Volume) This function determines the maximum volume level allowable with the Volume (VOL) Up/Down control. In this way, for example, someone cannot set the volume level high enough to disturb others. The value range is 0 to 63, with 63 as the default, which gives the user the full range of volume control, if item 008 MIN VOLUME is also set at 0. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to change values. It may be best to set the same value on every TV. Note: For a digital Start Channel, always remember to set item 104 to the Minor Start Channel number. Note: The maximum volume level cannot have a value setting lower than the minimum volume level (described above). 255 = Last channel 126 = Map to Channel 3 010 - MUTE DISABLE Enables or disables sound mute function. If set to 1, sound cannot be muted. If set to 0, sound can be muted. 1 ~ 125 = Major Ch. # 127 = Map to Channel 4 0 = Aux 005 - CHAN LOCK (Channel Lock) Channel Lock is ideal if the system must always be on the same channel. Changing channels with the Channel Up/Down or keypad numbers is impossible. Channel Lock is inactive if set to 0 (default). Generally, this feature is used in connection with STRT CHANNEL (Installer Menu item 004) where the Start Channel may, for example, be set to 3 or 4. If the Start Channel is 3, then the TV will remain locked on channel 3. 206-4186 011 - KEY DEFEAT (Keyboard Defeat) If set to 1, KEY DEFEAT prevents the end user from accessing the on-screen menus from the display panel—MENU, ENTER, and menu navigation keys do not function. If set to 0, those keys do function. Note: Users can always access the menus by pressing MENU on the remote. 17 Installer Menu (Cont.) 015 - SLEEP TIMER If set to 1, the Sleep Timer feature may be used. If set to 0, the Sleep Timer is not available. 016 - EN TIMER (Enable On/Off Timers) * If set to 1, the Timer function is available to the end user and enabled continuously. Set to 0 to disable On/Off timers. Note: Clock must be set in order to use timers. 017 - ALARM * Gives the installer the option of making the Alarm function available to the end user. If set to 1, the Alarm function is available to the end user. Set to 0 to disable the Alarm function. Note: Clock must be set before the Alarm function will work. 020 - FEATURE LEVEL Determines an additional IR code scheme to which the TV will respond, allowing for the use of unique IR codes based on “bed number” in a multi-TV single room installation. First determine the IR mode; then select the bed number. IR Mode Bed # Values Legacy (Hospital) 1–2 0–1 Multi-code Remote 1–9 16 – 24 Note: For further information, see documentation for the accessory package that includes the multi-code remote. 021 - V-CHIP (Parental Control) * Set to 1 to activate V-Chip (Parental Control) and have it available to the end user to filter and control or otherwise restrict programming content that can appear. Set to 0 to turn the V-Chip feature Off (not available to user); no programming restrictions can be set. 022 - MAX BLK HRS (Maximum Block Hours) * Sets hours from 0 to 99 for the maximum V-Chip (Parental Control) block hours. Default setting is for 12 blocking hours. 023 - CAPTION LOCK If set to 0, captions are OFF when the TV is turned ON. Set to 1 to use the caption setting configured before the TV was turned OFF when the TV is turned ON. 028 - CH. OVERIDE (Channel Override) If set to 1, the user can select channels with either Channel Up/ Down or by direct keypad entry. If set to 0, only those channels that are active in the TV’s memory can be selected. 029 - OLD OCV (On Command Video™) Set to 1 for operation with systems from On Command Corporation. 030 - ACK MASK MPI Communication Parameter. Leave at default setting unless changed by PPV provider. When set to 1, changes MPI for some OCV boxes. 031 - POLL RATE MPI Communication Parameter. Selects Poll Rate for MPI. Leave at default setting unless changed by Pay-Per-View provider. Step size of 16 ms. 032 - TIMING PULSE MPI Communication Parameter. Leave at default setting unless changed by Pay-Per-View provider. Sets baud rate. Step size of 4.3 uS. 034 - CAMPORT EN. (Camera Port Enable) Set to 1 to enable Video 2 input on display panel. If set to 0, Video 2 input on display panel is not functional. 035 - COMPPORT EN. (Computer Port Enable) Enable/disable TV display panel HDMI 1 input jack. Set to 0 to disable HDMI1. Set to 1 to enable HDMI1. Note: This setting is ignored if item 093 RJP AVAILABLE is set to 1. 038 - YPrPb EN. (Rear Component Video Enable) Set to 1 to enable display panel rear Component Video input jacks. Set to 0 to disable display panel rear Component Video input jacks. 039 - REAR AUX EN. (Rear Aux Enable) Set to 1 to enable display panel rear Aux (Video 1) input. Set to 0 to disable display panel rear Aux (Video 1) input. 040 - AUTO CAMPORT Set to 1 to automatically switch to Camport when equipment is connected to side Video input. Set to 0 to disable side Video automatic source selection. If set to 1, STRT AUX SRCE cannot be set to 2. Note: If set to 1, item 093 RJP AVAILABLE is automatically set to 0. 046 - STRT AUX SRCE (Start Aux Source) Sets the starting Aux source. When turned ON, the TV will tune to starting Aux source if item 004 STRT CHANNEL is set to 0. If item 093 RJP AVAILABLE is set to 0 and item 040 AUTO CAMPORT is set to 0: 1 = Video 1 4 = RGB 255 = Last Aux 2 = Video 2 5 = HDMI 2 3 = HDMI 1 6 = Component If item 093 RJP AVAILABLE is set to 1: 2 = Video 2 5 = HDMI 2 6 = Component If item 040 AUTO CAMPORT is set to 1: 1 = Video 1 4 = RGB 6 = Component 3 = HDMI 1 5 = HDMI 2 * Only affects Function Menu if enabled by some PPV providers. 18 206-4186 Installer Menu (Cont.) 047 - AUX STATUS Set to 1 for MPI Aux source to be reported as a channel number instead of channel 0. Set to 0 to disable Aux identification change. Controls MPI status channel response for Aux inputs. 082 - CHKSM ERROR (Checksum Error) Enforces rigid MPI checksum validation. Set to 1 for validation. Set to 0 to disable (does not check checksum on MPI async port). SPI is always checked. 053 - DIS. CH-TIME (Disable Channel-Time) Set to 1 to disable the Channel-Time display; Channel-Time display will not appear. Set to 0 to enable the Channel-Time display. 083 - HANDSHK TIME (Handshake Time) Adds an additional delay to the handshake time which is 64 msec, thus relaxing MPI timing requirements to be compatible with PCbased Windows controlled systems. Range is 0 - 5. (Timeout = 25.5MS + [25.5 MS* Handshake time].) 069 - EN. CH-T COL. (Enable Channel-Time Custom Color) Set to 1 to enable custom color for the Channel-Time display. Set to 0 to disable custom color for the Channel-Time display. 070 - FOR. CH-TIME (Channel-Time Display Foreground Color) Set according to Color Chart: 0 = Black 3 = Cyan 6 = Yellow 1 = Blue 4 = Red 7 = White 2 = Green 5 = Violet Note: Applies only to “Channel Not Available” message if item 073 is set to 1 (enabled). If foreground color and background color are the same, the menu background will be transparent. 071 - BCK. CH-TIME (Channel-Time Display Background Color) Set according to Color Chart: 0 = Black 3 = Cyan 6 = Yellow 1 = Blue 4 = Red 7 = White 2 = Green 5 = Violet 084 - PERMANENT BLK (Permanent Block) Allows Lock (Parental Control) blocking schemes to be permanent by disabling the blocking hours function. Set to 1 to install Parental Control restrictions permanently. Set to 0 for user-specified hours control of blocking schemes. 087 - REAR RGB EN. (Rear RGB Enable) Controls access to rear RGB input on TV. Set to 0 to disable RGB input. Set to 1 to enable RGB input. Set to 17 to initiate a onetime automatic configuration after an AC power cycle; otherwise, automatic adjustment will be performed each time the RGB input is accessed. 088 - EN NOISE MUTE (Enable Noise Mute) If set to 1, audio mutes if no signal is present. Note: Applies only to “Channel Not Available” message if item 073 is set to 1 (enabled). If foreground color and background color are the same, the menu background will be transparent. 090 - KEY LOCK If set to 1, display panel Channel, Volume, and Captions buttons are disabled, Power button remains enabled. If set to 0, the Channel, Volume, Captions, and Power buttons are all enabled. 073 - CH NOT AVBLE (Channel Not Available) If set to 1 and item 028 CH. OVERIDE is set to 0, a “NOT AVAILABLE” message is displayed when directly accessing a channel not in the channel scan list available in memory. 091 - YPrPb2 EN. (HDMI2 Enable) Set to 0 to disable display panel HDMI2 input. Set to 1 to enable DTV mode. Set to 2 to enable PC mode. 075 - REVERT CH (Revert to Start Channel) If set to 1 and loss of MPI communication occurs, TV automatically tunes to the specified Start Channel. 078 - UPN MSB (UPN Most Significant Byte) User programmable number, most significant byte readable by MPI command. Note: Not linked to serial number. 079 - UPN MSB-1 (UPN Most Significant Byte-1) User programmable number, most significant byte-1 readable by MPI command. Note: Not linked to serial number. 080 - UPN MSB-2 (UPN Most Significant Byte-2) User programmable number, most significant byte-2 readable by MPI command. Note: Not linked to serial number. 081 - UPN LSB (UPN Least Significant Byte) User programmable number, least significant byte readable by MPI command. Note: Not linked to serial number. 206-4186 093 - RJP AVAILABLE (Remote Jack Pack Available) • 0 = Remote jack pack is not available or disabled. • 1 = Legacy Model RJPs: HDMI Mode Enables RJP feature for use with full cable bundle models. In this mode, when an HDMI source is connected to the RJP, both digital video and audio are expected via the HDMI cable. If no digital audio is present, no audio will be heard. • 2 = Legacy Model RJPs: DVI Mode Enables RJP feature for use with full cable bundle models. In this mode, when an HDMI/DVI source is connected to the RJP, only digital video is expected via the HDMI cable. Analog audio is provided via a separate cable, from the source, connected to an RJP AUDIO IN. If no analog audio cable is connected, tuner audio will be heard. • 5 = Scaler Model RJPs: HDMI Mode Enables RJP feature for use with reduced cable bundle models. In this mode, when an HDMI source is connected to the RJP, both digital video and audio are expected via the HDMI cable. If no digital audio is present, no audio will be heard. 19 Installer Menu (Cont.) • 6 = Scaler Model RJPs: DVI Mode Enables RJP feature for use with reduced cable bundle models. In this mode, when an HDMI/DVI source is connected to the RJP, only digital video is expected via the HDMI cable. Analog audio is provided via separate cable, from the source, connected to an RJP AUDIO IN. If no analog audio cable is connected, tuner audio will be heard. Notes: See Reference section, “RJP Model List and Input Auto-sensing Hierarchy.” If RJP AVAILABLE is set to 1, 2, 5, or 6, item 040 AUTO CAMPORT is automatically set to 0. Settings 1, 2, 5, and 6 allow the lodge staff to customize each TV’s RJP setup based on customer requirements. 094 - SAP MENU EN (2nd Audio Program) Set to 1 to enable SAP feature on Function Menu, if Function Menu is available. Set to 0 to disable SAP feature on Function Menu, if Function Menu is available. 096 - DEF. ASP. RATIO (Default Aspect Ratio) Selects default aspect ratio at power up. • • • • • Set to 0 for Set By System. Set to 1 for 4:3. Set to 2 for 16:9 (Factory Default). Set to 3 for Just Scan. Set to 4 for Zoom. Note: Only applies if item 106 ASP RATIO LOCK is disabled, set to 0. 098 - PRO:CENTRIC Selects the Pro:Centric Mode. Set to 0 (default) to disable Pro:Centric operation. Set to 1 for Flash Mode. Set to 2 for GEM (Java Application) Mode. 099 - BACK LIGHTING Sets the TV screen brightness at power up. Default setting is 100. • 1 - 100 Static Back Lighting (1 = Dimmest picture, 100 = Brightest picture) • 101 - 200 Dynamic Back Lighting (101 = Dimmest picture, 200 = Brightest picture) If set between 101 and 200, the TV automatically controls back lighting depending upon the picture level of the current program. If set to 255, back lighting is controlled via the Picture settings in the TV’s setup menus. 20 102 - ATSC BAND Sets up TV to receive different types of incoming signals: 0 = Broadcast, 1 = CATV, 2 = HRC, 3 = IRC, 4 = Same as NTSC. 103 - ATSC TUNE MODE Sets ATSC tuning mode: Default set to 1 for Physical Channel scan. Set to 0 for Virtual Channel scan. 104 - START MINOR CHANNEL Sets Minor Start Channel number at power up. 0 = NTSC. If not 0, number selected is the digital channel’s Minor Start Channel number. 106 - ASP RATIO LOCK (Aspect Ratio Lock) Set to 1 to retain previous aspect ratio with power off. Set to 0 to retain default aspect ratio with power off. See item 096 DEF. ASP. RATIO above. 116 - VIDEO MUTE EN (Video Mute Enable) Set to 0 for Normal. Set to 1 for Blank. 117 - FACT DEFAULT (Factory Default) Set to 0 for normal. Set to 1 to load presets of all Installer Menu item settings. Warning: If set to 1, this will reload the factory defaults and clear the Channel List, including any assigned channel icons and custom channel labels. 118 - POWER SAVINGS Default set to 3—the embedded b-LAN module is only powered when the TV is turned ON. If set to 1, the b-LAN module is always powered. Note: MPI cards with b-LAN technology—LMT7Z5, LMT7Z7, LMT7Z9—are NOT supported in TVs in which b-LAN technology is already integrated. Note: See Reference section, “b-LAN Setup & Overview,” for further information. 119 - DATA CHANNEL Set to 0 (default) to disable. Set to the RF channel number of the Data Channel for Pro:Centric or E-Z Installation (splash screen, configuration, or firmware) data. Note: Pro:Centric updates are downloaded from the Pro:Centric server to the TV when the TV is turned OFF. Also, while Pro:Centric updates are in progress, it is not possible to turn the TV ON. The TV may take several minutes to load EPG data after the initial download of the Pro:Centric application. Subsequent updates generally will take less than one minute. 206-4186 TV Setup Menus Overview On-screen setup menus control the features of the TV. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to access the TV setup menus, and set the TV features to the desired configuration for the end user. CHANNEL PICTURE AUDIO TIME LOCK OPTION INPUT MY MEDIA Refer to the Owner’s Manual for further information on the TV setup menus. 206-4186 21 Adding Channel Icons / Custom Channel Labels (2-5-4 + MENU Mode) Editing/Adding Channel Icons and/or Labels If there is no pre-assigned icon, you can make a custom channel label of up to seven (7) characters to help identify a channel or network. If desired, channel labels can also be added in addition to a pre-assigned icon. You may also add labels for the Aux input sources to clearly identify the devices that are connected to the Aux inputs. (Icon) XYZ XYZ XYZ NETWORK 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 (Label) Editing and adding the labels can only be done if there are channels entered into the TV’s Channel Map either during Commercial Mode Setup (see pages 12 to 13), by cloning, or by using some PPV providers’ master remote controls. Note: A blank letter space is available between “Z” and “!”. To perform channel editing/labeling: 1. Enter the TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 2. Press 2-5-4 + MENU on the Installer Remote to enter the Channel Label Editing Mode. 3. Add channel icons and channel labels as described in the procedures below. (You can do this more than once.) 4. To exit the menu when you are done, press MENU. Changing a Channel’s Icon on the Master TV Changing/Adding Channel Labels on the Master TV Changing Source Labels on the Master TV 1. Use Channel Up/Down to select the desired channel. 1. Use Channel Up/Down to select the desired channel. 2. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to select the thin letter “I” on the Channel ID display. 2. Press the Left or Right arrow repeatedly until the numbers 1 to 7 appear on the display. The number shows the position of the character that can be changed. Number 1 is the first character, number 2 the second character, etc. 1. Press INPUT to select the desired Aux input source: A/V 1, A/V 2, HDMI Component, RGB, etc. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the icon with which you want to identify the channel. (If you know the icon number, enter the number, and press ENTER.) 4. Proceed to change/add channel labels, or go to the next channel. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the desired character. 4. Proceed to the next number position, or use Channel Up/Down to go to the next channel. 2. Press the Left or Right arrow repeatedly until the numbers 0 to 9 appear on the display. The number shows the position of the character that can be changed. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the desired character. 4. Press INPUT for the next Aux source, or use Channel Up/Down to return to channels. Installer Remote Control Key Functions for Master TV Channel Editing/Labeling Menu • Channel Up/Down: Tunes to the next channel in scan. • Left/Right Arrows: Select the item to change. If “I” is shown, the icon can be changed. If a number is shown, it indicates the position of the character that can be changed. • Up/Down Arrows: Select the icon or the character to be displayed. Tip: Arrows can be held down for fast scrolling. 22 • 0 – 9: Use to enter the index number of the icon, if known. • ENTER: Changes the icon after the number has been entered. • INPUT: Changes the Aux input label. • MENU: Exits the editing process. 206-4186 Cloning Overview / Clonable Menu Features IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION There are three options for cloning a Master TV Setup: • Using a USB memory device • Using a TLL-1100A clone programmer • Using a LT2002 clone programmer Each option is described in further detail on the pages that follow. As you perform cloning procedures, be sure to complete each task as indicated. If a procedure or step is omitted or not performed completely, cloning may not work. At each step, pay attention to ensure the TV screen shows the proper message when cloning. If the message indicated does not appear, there is a problem with that step, and cloning may not be successful. Warning: Copying a blank or incorrect memory into a TV will cause the TV to operate erratically or become inoperable. Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs. Also, if the TV is in LodgeNet PPV Mode (check with the site administrator if you are not certain), do not connect a clone programmer to the GAME CONTROL/MPI port. Either of these actions will damage the clone programmer and, if applicable, the PPV card. Before you begin cloning: • Complete the Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV procedure on pages 12 to 13. • All equipment should be connected to power and turned ON. • Both the Master and Target TVs must be in Pass-through Mode. • Ensure Installer Menu items on Target TVs are set/restored to factory default settings (i.e., set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001 on Target TVs) before Teaching is initiated. • Learning and Teaching is only possible between identical model TVs. • If using a USB memory device, ensure the USB device has been formatted with FAT format. • For both Master and Target TVs—If using a clone programmer, ensure the TV signal source is either an Aux or TV (RF) source. If a TV (RF) source, the TV must be tuned to an analog (not a digital) channel. • LT2002 only—Make sure the batteries in the clone programmer are fresh. If batteries are removed, the clone programmer clock time (if set) will be lost (see page 28 for information on the clone programmer clock). • Do not unplug the TV power cord or remove/disconnect the USB memory device/clone programmer while Learning or Teaching, as doing so may cause the TV to malfunction or harm the USB device/clone programmer, respectively. Clonable Menu Features Installer Menu Installer Menu item settings Channel Auto Tuning (Channel Lineup) Manual Tuning Channel Edit Channel Label Picture Aspect Ratio Picture Mode Advanced Control Audio Auto Volume Clear Voice Sound Mode Balance TV Speaker Option Menu Language Audio Language Caption Caption Mode Digital Caption Options Lock Movie Rating TV Rating – Children TV Rating – General Input Block Time Auto Clock Manual Clock Off Time On Time Auto Off (Sleep Timer) Note: Some menu options vary between analog and digital channels and Aux sources. 206-4186 23 Cloning Procedures Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a USB Memory Device USB Cloning Notes • Read the IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 23 before beginning any cloning procedures. • You may edit a filename as part of the Learning procedure; however, a file with edited contents will not be recognized. • It is not possible to clone a Master TV’s clock using a USB memory device. Either set a Target TV’s clock manually, or use the Auto Clock setting in the TV setup menus. Learn Setup from Master TV 1. Ensure the Master TV is set up completely and in Pass-through Mode. 2. Plug the USB memory device into the USB IN port on the Master TV. 3. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to display the TV setup menus, use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight the Option menu icon, and then press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. USB Download Menu Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Learn From TV (TLL) Learn From TV (FMA) 4. To gain access to the “Learn From TV” option in the USB Download Menu, key in the password used to enter the Installer Menu (Example: Press 9-8-7-6). 7. Remove the USB memory device from the Master TV. Teach Master TV Setup to Target TV 1. Ensure the Target TV is in Pass-through Mode, and then use the Installer Remote to enter the Target TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 2. Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001, and press ENTER. When the value changes back to 0, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. 3. Plug the USB memory device with the Master TV Setup file into the Target TV USB IN port. 4. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to display the TV setup menus, use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight the Option menu icon, and then press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. Learn From TV (TLL) Select the file name and press OK to start xxLD340H-UA00001.TLL ► 6. To identify the profile from others, you can use the Up/Down arrow keys to change the last five digits of the filename. Press ENTER when you are ready to initiate Learning. Learning status will be shown on the progress bar. When the Learning process is complete, the USB Download menu will reappear on screen. Return ! 7. When Teaching is done, remove the USB memory device from the Target TV, turn OFF the TV, and unplug the TV power cord for 15 seconds. 8. Reconnect the TV power cord, and turn ON the TV. The Master TV Setup should be resident on the Target TV. 24 Enter Learn From TV UPDATING... 25% Do not remove the USB from the port! Do not unplug! USB Download Menu Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Return Enter Teach To TV (TLL) 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Teach To TV (TLL), and then press ENTER. 6. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the Master TV Setup you want to install, and then press ENTER. Note: Filenames identify the TV and the TLL version (see example at right). Teaching status will be shown on the progress bar. When the Teaching process is complete, the USB Download menu will reappear on screen. Enter ► 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Learn From TV (TLL), and then press ENTER. Return xxLD340H-UA00001.TLL Return ! Enter Teach To TV UPDATING... 50% Do not remove the USB from the port! Do not unplug! 206-4186 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a TLL-1100A Clone Programmer Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs. Also, if the TV is in LodgeNet PPV Mode (check with the site administrator if you are not certain), do not connect a clone programmer to the GAME CONTROL/MPI port. Either of these actions will damage the clone programmer and, if applicable, the PPV card. TLL-1100A Cloning Notes • Read the IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 23 before beginning any cloning procedures. • Ensure the TLL-1100A is either fully charged or connected to AC power. • Learning and Teaching is only possible between identical model TVs; however, the TLL-1100A clone programmer can store up to eight different Master TV Setups. TLL-1100A Clone Programmer TV Link Loader CHARGE Cloning is accomplished using the TV/ clone programmer MPI ports for communication (see figure). TLL1100A Ready Antenna or CATV MODE CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP MPI Cable MENU ENTER SEND RECEIVE TLL-1100A Learn Setup from Master TV 1. Ensure the Master TV is set up completely and in Pass-through Mode. 2. If an analog channel is not available, direct tune the TV to an Aux source, or select an Aux source, such as AV-1, from the Input Menu. Then, plug one end of the MPI cable into the TV MPI port. 3. Turn ON the TLL-1100A. 4. Use the MODE button on the TLL-1100A to select Clone Mode. 5. Use the Left/Right arrows on the TLL-1100A to select the Memory CBank (1 to 8) in which to store the Master TV Setup. 6. Plug the other end of the MPI cable into the MPI port on the bottom of the TLL-1100A. The Clone Selection Menu will display on the TV screen. 7. Press 1 on the Installer Remote to select LEARN FROM TV from the Clone Selection Menu. Then, press ENTER to transfer the Master TV Setup into CBankX on the TLL-1100A. Learning usually takes about 90 seconds. “LEARNING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen while the TLL-1100A copies the Master Setup. When the Learning process is complete, a “LEARNING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. 8. When Learning is complete, disconnect the MPI cable from the Master TV. 206-4186 CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX THE CLONE IS VERSION VX.X.X - To change menu items, press channel keys or digits. - To execute item, press Enter. 25 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a TLL-1100A Clone Programmer (Cont.) (Optional) Set the Clock Set the time on a Master TV’s clock. (If the time has already been copied from a TV into the TLL-1100A clone programmer, you can set the Master TV’s clock by copying the time from the clone programmer.) The TLL1100A can copy the current time to both a Master TV and to the clone’s internal clock—accurate to within one minute. Since the TLL-1100A’s time cannot be set directly, the current time needs to be copied from an LG TV equipped with an enabled MPI port. After the time is copied to the TLL-1100A clone programmer, the current time will be maintained and can then be transferred to another TV. (This can be a Master TV or another TV which has already had the features set up.) CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX THE CLONE IS VERSION VX.X.X - To change menu items, press channel keys or digits. - To execute item, press Enter. Teach Master TV Setup to Target TV 1. Ensure the Target TV is in Pass-through Mode, and then use the Installer Remote to enter the Target TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 2. Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001, and press ENTER. When the value changes back to 0, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. 3. Tune/set the TV to an analog channel or Aux source, and then connect the MPI cable to the MPI port on the Target TV. The Clone Selection Menu will display on the TV screen. 4. Ensure the correct Memory CBank(X) is selected on the TLL-1100A. 5. Press 2 on the Installer Remote to select TEACH TO TV from the Clone Selection Menu. Then, press ENTER to transfer the Master TV Setup to the Target TV. Teaching usually takes 3 to 4 minutes. “TEACHING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen during Teaching. When the Teaching process is complete, a “TEACHING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. 6. When Teaching is done, disconnect the MPI cable from the Target TV, turn OFF the TV, and unplug the TV power cord for 15 seconds. 7. Reconnect the TV power cord, and turn ON the TV. The Master TV Setup should be resident on the Target TV. 26 CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX THE CLONE IS VERSION VX.X.X - To change menu items, press channel keys or digits. - To execute item, press Enter. 206-4186 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using an LT2002 Clone Programmer Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs. Also, if the TV is in LodgeNet PPV Mode (check with the site administrator if you are not certain), do not connect a clone programmer to the GAME CONTROL/MPI port. Either of these actions will damage the clone programmer and, if applicable, the PPV card. Cloning is accomplished using the TV/ clone programmer MPI ports for communication (see figure). LT2002 Cloning Notes • Read the IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 23 before beginning any cloning procedures. • A slow flashing green light indicates that there are communication problems between the TV and the LT2002 clone programmer. If this is the case, check for a damaged cable, poor contacts, or other connection troubles. • If the status indicator is red, the LT2002 batteries are low and should be replaced. Install four (4) high-quality alkaline AA batteries. MPI Cable Antenna or CATV Ferrite Core (TDK, ZCAT 2035-0930) Connect cable to TV MPI Jack and follow on screen instructions Status Indicator MPI Color battery ok battery low • green • red Reset Blink pattern • slow power on no communications • heartbeat power on communications ok THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF THE TV THE CLONE IS VERSION XX THE TV IS VERSION XX THE SW IS REViSION XX CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX ® QuickSet II Programmer LT2002 - PRESS ANY KEY TO CONTINUE LT2002 Clone Programmer ZENITH ELECTRONICS CORPORATION, LINCOLNSHIRE, ILLINOIS, USA • Learning and Teaching is only possible between identical model TVs; however, the LT2002 clone programmer can store up to three different Master TV Setups. Learn Setup from Master TV THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF THE TV 1. Ensure the Master TV is set up completely and in Pass-through Mode. THE CLONE IS VERSION XX THE TV IS VERSION XX THE SW IS REVISION XX 2. If an analog channel is not available, direct tune the TV to an Aux source, or select an Aux source, such as AV-1, from the Input Menu. Then, plug one end of the MPI cable into the TV MPI port. 3. If there is a good connection after the LT2002 is connected to the TV MPI port, “THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF THE TV” message will appear on the TV screen. Press any key on the Installer Remote to access the LT2002 Clone Selection Menu. 4. Press 1 on the Installer Remote to select LEARN FROM TV from the Clone Selection Menu; then press ENTER to proceed to the Memory Bank Selection Menu (see sample screen on next page). 5. Press 1, 2, or 3 on the Installer Remote to select the clone Memory Bank in which to store the Master Setup. Then, press ENTER. Note: If you choose a Memory Bank that already has a Master device’s setup programmed into it, that setup will be overwritten by the new Master TV Setup. (Continued on next page) 206-4186 CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX - PRESS ANY KEY TO CONTINUE. - DISCONNECT CLONE WHEN DONE. CLONE SELECTION MENU (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) LEARN FROM TV TEACH TO TV SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE DISPLAY TV SETUP DISPLAY CLONE SETUP - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. 27 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using an LT2002 Clone Programmer (Cont.) (Continued from previous page) 6. Verify the Learning setup information on the next screen, and then press POWER to transfer the Master TV Setup into the selected Memory Bank on the LT2002. Learning usually takes about 90 seconds. “LEARNING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen while the LT2002 copies the Master Setup. When the Learning process is complete, a “LEARNING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. 7. When Learning is complete, disconnect the MPI cable from the Master TV. (Optional) Set the Clock Set the time on a Master TV’s clock. (If the time has already been copied from a TV into the LT2002 clone programmer, you can set the Master TV’s clock by copying the time from the clone programmer.) The LT2002 can copy the current time to both a Master TV and to the clone’s internal clock—accurate to within one minute. (Another reason that the LT2002 should be equipped with fresh, highquality alkaline batteries, is for it to keep the time as accurately as possible.) Since the LT2002’s time cannot be set directly, the current time needs to be copied from an LG TV equipped with an enabled MPI port. After the time is copied to the LT2002 clone programmer, the current time will be maintained and can then be transferred to another TV. (This can be a Master TV or another TV which has already had the features set up.) SAVE TV SETUP IN SELECTED CLONE MEMORY (1) (2) (3) (4) MEMORY 1 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 2 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 3 VER XX REV XX RETURN TO CLONE MENU - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. COPY SELECTED CLONE MEMORY TO TV (1) MEMORY 1 VER XX REV XX (2) MEMORY 2 VERMENU XX REV XX CLONE SELECTION (3) MEMORY 3 VER XX REV XX (4) LEARN RETURN TO CLONE MENU (1) FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. Teach Master TV Setup to Target TV 1. Ensure the Target TV is in Pass-through Mode, and then use the Installer Remote to enter the Target TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 2. Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001, and press ENTER. When the value changes back to 0, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. 3. Tune/set the TV to an analog channel or Aux source, and then connect the MPI cable to the MPI port on the Target TV. 4. With “THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF TV” message on display, press 2 on the Installer Remote to select TEACH TO TV from the LT2002 Clone Selection Menu. Then, press ENTER. 5. Select the LT2002 Memory Bank in which the new Master TV Setup is located, and press ENTER. 6. Verify the Teaching setup information on the next screen, and then press POWER to transfer the Master TV Setup to the Target TV. Teaching usually takes 3 to 4 minutes. “TEACHING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on-screen during Teaching. When the Teaching process is complete, a “TEACHING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. 7. When Teaching is done, disconnect the MPI cable from the Target TV, turn OFF the TV, and unplug the TV power cord for 15 seconds. CLONE SELECTION MENU SAVE TV SETUP IN SELECTED CLONE MEMORY (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (1) MEMORY 1 VER XX FROM REV XX (3) SET CLONE CLOCK TV (2) 2 VERFROM XX REV XX (4) MEMORY SET TV CLOCK CLONE (3) 3 VER XX REV XX (5) MEMORY DISPLAY TV SETUP (4) CLONE MENU (6) RETURN DISPLAY TO CLONE SETUP - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS - TO CHANGE MENU CHANNEL KEYS ORITEMS, DIGITS.PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. POWER, OR ENTER. COPY SELECTED CLONE MEMORY TO TV (1) (2) (3) (4) MEMORY 1 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 2 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 3 VER XX REV XX RETURN TO CLONE MENU - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. 8. Reconnect the TV power cord, and turn ON the TV. The Master TV Setup should be resident on the Target TV. 28 206-4186 FTG Mode of Operation Overview FTG Mode via CPU or EBL FTG Mode enables Pro:Idiom decryption and also allows logical channel mapping of physical channels. There are two separate and distinct methods for configuring LD340H/LD343H/LD345H TVs for FTG Mode of operation: one (new) method is to configure the TV CPU for FTG Mode operation, while the other is to configure the TV EBL for FTG Mode operation. EACH OF THESE METHODS IS MUTUALLY EXCLUSIVE. IF THE CPU IS IN FTG MODE, THE EBL CANNOT BE SWITCHED TO FTG MODE. LIKEWISE, IF THE EBL IS IN FTG MODE, THE CPU CANNOT BE SWITCHED TO FTG MODE. Caution: Once the initial method for configuring the TVs for FTG Mode of operation has been selected, all subsequent changes to FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings must also be performed in accordance with the selected FTG Mode of operation (via CPU or EBL). • FTG Mode via CPU: With this method, the TV’s CPU is configured with an FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings using one of the following processes: −− Configure an individual LD340H/LD343H/LD345H TV via its USB port using an FMA Configuration (.fma) file on a USB memory device. The “Teach to TV (FMA)” process, along with associated procedures, is described on pages 31 to 34. −− Configure all LD340H/LD343H/LD345H TVs at the site using a Pro:Centric server head end device (Example: PCS150R). Load an FMA Configuration (.fma) file on the Pro:Centric server using the TV E-Z Installation “Configuration” option in the Pro:Centric Server Admin Client. Refer to the Pro:Centric™ Server Admin Client User Guide for further information. • FTG Mode via EBL: With this method, the TV’s EBL module is configured with an FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings using one of the following processes: −− Configure an individual LD340H/LD343H/LD345H TV’s EBL via its TV-LINK CFG jack using a direct PCto-TV connection and the FTG Configuration Application. The “Write” process for an FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings is described on page 35. −− Configure all LD340H/LD343H/LD345H TV EBLs at the site using a Free-To-Guest Management Appliance (FMA) head end device (Example: FMA-LG101). Refer to the Free-To-Guest (FTG) Configuration Application manual and/or the Installation & Setup manual for the FMA device for further information. While the TV is in FTG Mode: • Users can still access the Installer Menu using an LG Installer Remote; however, all Installer Menu items will be read-only. • Any FTG configuration changes must be made using the FTG Configuration Application. FTG Channel Map Configuration and FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utilities enable you to make changes, respectively, to the FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings as necessary. Based on the initial method used to configure the TV for FTG Mode operation (via CPU or EBL), all subsequent changes must be transferred to the TV/EBL via a process that is in accordance with that method. • If it becomes necessary to reset the TV to Pass-through Mode, there are several options that will enable you to do so. Refer to Reference section, “Resetting a TV to Pass-through Mode,” for further information. Pages 36 to 39 provide overviews of the FTG Channel Map, FTG Installer Menu, and FMA Configuration Utilities that comprise the FTG Configuration Application. Refer to the Free-To-Guest (FTG) Configuration Application manual for further information on the FTG Configuration Application. 206-4186 29 FTG Mode of Operation Overview (Cont.) Determining the TV Operating Mode To determine the operating mode of the TV, press MENU on the Installer Remote. The menu display alternates based on the operating mode. See examples below. If the end user Function Menu appears, the TV is in FTG Mode. If the TV setup menus appear, the TV is in Pass-through Mode. ASPECT RATIO Move Function Menu Indicates the TV (CPU or EBL) is in FTG Mode. While the TV is in FTG Mode, Installer Menu settings can be accessed as read-only using an Installer Remote. To make changes, use the FTG Configuration Application. Set By Program ABC 4:3 16:9 Zoom Just Scan 30 Enter CHANNEL PICTURE AUDIO TIME LOCK OPTION INPUT MY MEDIA TV Setup Menus Shows that the TV is in Pass-through Mode. 206-4186 FTG Mode via CPU Creating an FMA Configuration File using the FTG Configuration Application This section describes how to create an FMA Configuration file that can be saved to a USB memory device. In order to enable Pro:Idiom decryption, it is recommended that you create an FMA Configuration file using the FTG Configuration Application. However, if you do not know the RF channels at the site, there is an option to save (Learn) an FMA Configuration file from a TV (see “Learning an FMA Configuration File from a TV” on page 33). The procedure below provides an overview of the steps required to create an FMA Configuration (.fma) file. Refer to the Free-To-Guest (FTG) Configuration Application manual for further information. See also FTG Configuration Application sample screens on pages 36 to 39. Note: FTG Configuration Application software is available online at: www.LGcommercial.com/FTGsoftware. 1. Install (if necessary) and launch the FTG Configuration Application (v5.0.0 or higher) on the PC that will be used to create the FMA Configuration file. 2. Either: • Open an existing FTG Configuration (.rml) file, if applicable, to use its FTG Channel Map. Otherwise, create a new FTG Channel Map using the FTG Channel Map Editor in the FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility. Then, continue with step 3. Note: Up to 141 logical channels can be defined in the FTG Channel Map. • To view and/or base a new FMA Configuration file on an existing LD340H/LD343H/LD345H FMA Configuration file, click Configure in the FTG Configuration Application menu bar, and select FMA to access the FMA Configuration Utility. Then, click the Open button above the FMA Configuration List, and double-click the desired (.fma) file. A list of the file’s contents will be displayed in the FMA Configuration List window, and you can edit the FMA Configuration List as necessary to create a new file. Proceed to step 4 when you are ready to continue. 3. Click Configure in the FTG Configuration Application menu bar, and select FMA to access the FMA Configuration Utility. 4. To add an FTG Channel Map, click >> under FTG Channel Map to copy the current FTG Channel Map to the FMA Configuration List. Note: If you make any change(s) in the FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility to the current data to be included in the FMA Configuration List, you will need to recopy the FTG Channel Map to the FMA Configuration List. 5. Load default Installer Menu settings for the LD340H/LD343H/LD345H TV: • Click the down arrow at the right of the Chassis field under Installer Menu Templates, and select the appropriate LD340H/LD343H/LD345HH option (depending on the TV size) from the drop-down list of available models. • Click the Load button. • Use the FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility to modify settings, if necessary. Then, return to the FMA Configuration Utility. • Click >> under FTG Installer Menu Settings to copy the LD340H/LD343H/LD345H settings to the FMA Configuration List. 6. Click the Save button above the FMA Configuration List to save its contents to an FMA Configuration (.fma) file for later use. 7. Save the FMA Configuration file to a USB memory device, and proceed to “Teaching FMA Configuration to a TV” on the following page to transfer the FMA Configuration file to an LD340H/ LD343H/LD345H TV. 206-4186 31 FTG Mode via CPU (Cont.) Teaching FMA Configuration to a TV This procedure describes how to “Teach” an FMA Configuration file from a USB memory device to a TV. Ensure you have completed the procedure on the previous page to create the FMA Configuration file before proceeding with the steps below. Caution: If the TV EBL is already in FTG Mode, you cannot use this procedure to make changes to the FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings. You must use a direct PC-to-TV connection as described on page 35 or an FMA head end device to reconfigure the EBL. 1. Plug the USB memory device that contains the FMA Configuration file into the Target LD340H/LD343H/LD345H TV USB IN port. 2. Press MENU to display the TV setup menus, use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight either the Option (if TV is in Pass-through Mode) or Lock (if TV is already in FTG Mode) menu icon, and then press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Teach To TV (FMA), and then press ENTER. 4. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the FMA Configuration file you want to install, and then press ENTER. The TV will show Teaching completion progress in a new window. Do NOT remove the USB device until Teaching is complete. When Teaching is complete, the TV will tune to the first logical channel in the FTG Channel Map. 5. When Teaching is done, remove the USB memory device. The FMA Configuration should be resident on the Target TV. Also, the Target TV CPU is now in FTG Mode (if it was previously in Pass-through Mode). 32 USB Download Menu Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Return Enter Teach To TV (FMA) xx0BAL-PLAT200001.FMA Return ! Enter Teach To TV UPDATING... 50% Do not unplug! 206-4186 FTG Mode via CPU (Cont.) Learning an FMA Configuration File from a TV To ensure that Pro:Idiom decryption is enabled, it is recommended that you create an FMA Configuration file using the FTG Configuration Application as described on page 31. However, if necessary, this option enables you to save (Learn) an FMA Configuration file from an LD340H/LD343H/LD345H TV to a USB memory device. 1. Plug a USB memory device into the USB IN port on the TV. 2. Press MENU to display the TV setup menus, use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight either the Option (if TV is in Pass-through Mode) or Lock (if TV is already in FTG Mode) menu icon, and then press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. 3. To gain access to the Learn From TV options in the USB Download Menu, key in the password used to enter the Installer Menu (Example: Press 9-8-7-6). USB Download Menu Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Learn From TV (TLL) Learn From TV (FMA) Return Learn From TV (FMA) Select the file name and press OK to start xx0BAL-PLAT200001.FMA ► 4. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Learn From TV (FMA), and then press ENTER. 5. To identify the file from others, you can use the Up/Down arrow keys to change the last five digits of the filename. Press ENTER when you are ready to initiate Learning. The TV will show Learning completion progress in a new window. Do NOT remove the USB device until Learning is complete. When Learning is complete, the USB Download Menu will reappear on screen. Enter ► Note: If the LD340H/LD343H/LD345H TV is NOT already in FTG Mode, you may need to perform some manual configuration on the TV before you start this procedure (see “Optional Manual Configuration / Setup for a TV” on following page). Return ! Enter Learn From TV UPDATING... 25% Do not unplug! 6. When you are finished, remove the USB memory device. Note: It is highly recommended that you open this FMA Configuration file in the FTG Configuration Application—BEFORE transferring (Teaching) the file to any TVs—to verify FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings and enable Pro:Idiom decryption by marking Encrypted channels. This will also enable you to confirm and add channel attributes, labels, etc. 206-4186 33 FTG Mode via CPU (Cont.) Optional Manual Configuration / Setup for a TV The manual configuration procedures below should only be performed if you do not know the RF channels at the site and need to “Learn” an FMA Configuration file from an LD340H/LD343H/LD345H TV as described on the previous page. Ensure the TV is in Pass-through Mode before you begin. Set Installer Menu Items These steps provide specific instruction only on the Installer Menu items that should be set on an LD340H/LD343H/LD345H TV. Refer to pages 14 to 20 for detailed information on all Installer Menu items. 1. Make sure the TV is ON. Then, use the Installer Remote to enter the TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 2. Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001 and press ENTER on the Installer Remote. This clears all Installer Menu custom settings, the channel lineup, etc. and reloads the factory default settings. The value will change back to 0 after the internal TV controller (PTC) has been restored to factory default condition. This step ensures that the TV Channel Memory will be the active channel lineup. 3. Set Installer Menu item 003 BAND/AFC, as appropriate. • Broadcast: Set to 000. • HRC: Set to 002. • CATV: Set to 001 (default). • IRC: Set to 003. 4. Set any other Installer Menu items that affect your TV programming network to the required configuration. For example, enable/disable Aux sources, set a Start Channel, etc. 5. After you have adjusted all required Installer Menu item settings, press ENTER once on the Installer Remote to save your changes; then, press ENTER again to exit the menu. Run Auto Tuning (Channel Search) Note: In the FMA Configuration file, Logical Channel numbers will automatically be assigned in ascending order, starting with 0 (zero), to the Physical Channels from the TV Channel Map. Note: Pro:Idiom decryption for encrypted channels will not be enabled unless you use the FTG Configuration Application to set the channel attributes. 1. Search for all available analog and digital channels: Use the Installer Remote to go to the Channel Menu, select the Auto Tuning option, and follow the on-screen instructions. 2. Use the Channel Edit option in the Channel Menu to edit the channel lineup, as necessary, to include free to guest channels only. Add/delete channels per your system requirements. * Once you have completed these procedures, return to “Learning an FMA Configuration File from a TV” on the previous page to complete the Learn sequence. 34 xxLD340H PTC INSTALLER MENU 000 INSTALLER SEQ UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 000 ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.25.00 Typical TV Installer Menu Note: The Installer Menu header will vary depending on the TV you are setting up. 117 FACT DEFAULT 001 003 BAND/AFC 00X Adjust the settings for these Installer Menu items. CHANNEL Move Enter Auto Tuning Manual Tuning Channel Edit Channel Label Run Auto Tuning and edit the channel lineup, as necessary. * If Installer Menu item 103 ATSC TUNE MODE is set for Physical Channel tuning (default and recommended setting), minor channel numbers cannot be higher than 255. If set for Virtual Channel tuning, neither major nor minor channel numbers can be higher than 255. 206-4186 FTG Mode via EBL The following steps outline local FTG configuration of individual TV EBLs using a direct PC-to-TV connection. Refer to the Free-To-Guest (FTG) Configuration Application manual for further information. See also FTG Configuration Application sample screens on pages 36 to 38. Note: FTG Configuration Application software is available online at: www.LGcommercial.com/FTGsoftware. Caution: If the TV CPU is already in FTG Mode, you cannot use this procedure to make changes to the FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings. Instead, refer to and use the processes described on pages 31 and 32 to reconfigure the TV CPU. 1. Install (if necessary) and launch the FTG Configuration Application (v5.0.0 or higher) on the PC that will be used to configure the EBL. 2. Build a Channel Map using the FTG Channel Map Editor in the FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility (or, if applicable, open an existing FTG Configuration [.rml] file). Note: Up to 141 logical channels can be defined in the FTG Channel Map. 3. Connect the PC to the TV-LINK CFG jack on the TV’s rear connections panel using a USB-to-TTL serial cable (TTL-232R-5V-AJ). If necessary, install the device driver on the PC. 4. Turn ON the TV. Note: The TV will briefly display a green text banner that shows the EBL firmware version and release date. 5. “Write” the FTG Channel Map to the EBL (switches the EBL from Pass-through Mode to FTG Mode). 6. “Read” the current FTG Installer Menu settings from the EBL using the FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility. If necessary to make changes to Installer Menu items, “Write” them back to the EBL in FTG Mode. 7. Save the FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings to an FTG Configuration (.rml) file for future use. 8. Tune the TV to a Logical Channel in the FTG Channel Map. RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET HDMI HDMI /DVI IN 2 1 UPDATE .......... .......... ..... .... RJP REMOTE CONTROL OUT ..... ..... ..... AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) Y PB VIDEO (26LD340H, 26LD343H and 26LD345H only) Laptop PC AV IN 1 VIDEO L/MONO-AUDIO-R RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT ( 8 ) ANTENNA IN PR L AUDIO GAME CONTROL/ MPI TV-LINK CFG USB-to-TTL Serial Cable Required for direct PC-to-TV FTG configuration. R COMPONENT IN TV-LINK CFG Use for direct PC-to-TV FTG configuration. 206-4186 35 FTG Configuration Application Utilities Overview FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility The FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility enables you to build a Channel Map with logical channel numbers. Note: Write, Read, and Learn functions in the FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility are used for direct PC-to-TV FTG configuration of LD340H/LD343H/LD345H TVs (FTG Mode via EBL). These functions are not applicable to the process of creating an FMA Configuration file to be saved to a USB memory device (FTG Mode via CPU). PRINT MAP Click to display a printable FTG Channel Map Report. The report can also be exported as an HTML or Text file. EDIT/ADD MAP Click to open the FTG Channel Map Editor to create or edit an FTG Channel Map (see next page). * Logical Channel numbers will automatically be assigned in ascending order, starting with 0 (zero), to the Physical Channels from the TV Channel Map. 36 LEARN Click to transfer the TV Channel Map from the PTC to the EBL and the FTG Configuration Application. (Requires that 2-5-5 + MENU was performed to transfer TV Channel Map to PTC.) * READ Click to transfer the FTG Channel Map from the EBL to the FTG Configuration Application. WRITE Click to transfer the FTG Channel Map to the EBL. This will switch the EBL from Pass-through Mode to FTG Mode. 206-4186 FTG Configuration Application Utilities Overview (Cont.) FTG Channel Map Editor The FTG Channel Map Editor shows a single Logical Channel’s Data and the FTG Channel Map. LOGICAL CHANNEL MAPPING Select a Logical Channel number, then assign it the RF, Major, and Minor channel numbers to complete the mapping. CUSTOM CHANNEL LABELS/ICONS Enter custom labels and select icons by name on menu or by number. DELETE Click to remove highlighted channel from FTG Channel Map. SET CHANNEL ATTRIBUTES Check/select Encrypted, OSD, or Blank Video. EXIT Click to exit editor and return to FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility. ADD After defining a new Logical Channel, click to add channel to the FTG Channel Map. UPDATE After editing an existing Logical Channel’s data, click to commit the changes in the FTG Channel Map. 206-4186 37 FTG Configuration Application Utilities Overview (Cont.) FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility Note: Write, Read, Learn, and IR Remote Access functions in the FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility are used for direct PC-to-TV FTG configuration of LD340H/LD343H/LD345H TVs (FTG Mode via EBL). These functions are not applicable to the process of creating an FMA Configuration file to be saved to a USB memory device (FTG Mode via CPU). CONFIGURATION SETTINGS Select tabs for categories of Installer Menu items to set up TV. INSTALLER DEFAULTS Click to reset FTG Installer Menu items shown in the FTG Configuration Application to defaults. IR REMOTE ACCESS Toggle IR Remote Access to ON to obtain access to TV setup menus and Installer Menu. WRITE Click to transfer the FTG Installer Menu settings to the EBL. 38 HOSPITAL-GRADE TV ONLY Set Hospital items on Installer Menu for hospital-grade TVs. LEARN Click to transfer Installer Menu settings from the PTC to the EBL and FTG Configuration Application. * READ Click to transfer the Installer Menu settings in the EBL to the FTG Configuration Application. * Logical Channel numbers will automatically be assigned in ascending order, starting with 0 (zero), to the Physical Channels from the TV Channel Map. 206-4186 FTG Configuration Application Utilities Overview (Cont.) FMA Configuration Utility Note: FMA Write, Read, Clock, Broadcast, Firmware, and IP Communication functions in the FMA Configuration Utility are used to configure b-LAN enabled equipment (Example: FMA-LG101) at the hotel/ institution head end. These functions are not applicable to the process of creating an FMA Configuration file to be used with LD340H/LD343H/LD345H TVs (FTG Mode via CPU). Filename of opened FTG Configuration file (if applicable) FMA CONFIGURATION LIST (data to be saved or already saved in FMA Configuration file) Copy FTG Channel Map to and from FMA Configuration List. Copy FTG Installer Menu settings to and from FMA Configuration List. Load default FTG Installer Menu for LD340H/LD343H/ LD345H. Note: The data referenced in the FMA Configuration List is only a snapshot of the current FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings when copied to the list. If you make any change(s) to the current data to be included in the FMA Configuration List, you will need to recopy Channel Map and Installer Menu settings to the FMA Configuration List. 206-4186 39 Remote Jack Pack / TV Connections & Setup Remote Jack Pack Setup RJP Available? If you will use a Remote Jack Pack (RJP) in your system, set Installer Menu item 093 RJP AVAILABLE appropriately (for example, on a legacy model RJP: HDMI Mode, set RJP AVAILABLE to 001). See Installer Menu detailed descriptions for further information. 093 RJP AVAILABLE 001 TV Connections Make these connections ONLY after Commercial Mode Setup and TV Cloning procedures are complete. Refer to the figure below, and connect the RJ-45 Control cable from the RJP cable bundle to the RJP INTERFACE port on the TV’s jack panel. Then, connect HDMI, RGB, and Composite Video/Audio connectors, as applicable, for the cable bundle. AUDIO/VIDEO IN 1 Connect Composite Video/ Audio connectors from RJP cable bundle. (Composite Video on legacy RJP only.) RJP Connect RJ-45 Control cable from RJP cable bundle. RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET HDMI HDMI /DVI IN 2 1 UPDATE .......... .......... ..... ..... ..... AV IN 1 VIDEO L/MONO-AUDIO-R AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) GAME CONTROL/ MPI RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT ( 8 ) Y PB VIDEO (26LD340H, 26LD343H and 26LD345H only) ..... .... RJP REMOTE CONTROL OUT ANTENNA IN PR L AUDIO TV-LINK CFG R COMPONENT IN RGB IN (PC) Connect RGB connector from RJP cable bundle (legacy RJP only). HDMI/DVI IN 1 Connect HDMI connector from RJP cable bundle. 40 206-4186 Reference: Upgrading TV/PTC Software using a USB Memory Device Checking the Software Versions xxLD340H PTC INSTALLER MENU You can check the software versions of the TV by accessing the Installer Menu with the Installer Remote: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. When you are finished, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. 000 INSTALLER SEQ UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 PTC Version Typical Installer Menu 000 ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.25.00 CPU Version Upgrading TV/PTC Software Before you begin, note that the software upgrade files must be stored in a folder named “LG_DTV” in the root directory of the USB memory device. Also, ensure the USB device has been formatted with FAT format. Note for TV Software Upgrade only: If the TV detects a later version of software on the USB device, it will automatically display a dialog from which you can start the software upgrade immediately. Otherwise, you can close the dialog, and access the USB Download Menu as described below. 1. Turn the TV ON. TV Software Update (Expert) 2. Plug the USB memory device into the USB IN port on the TV. 3. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to display the TV setup menus. 4. Use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight either the Option (if TV is in Pass-through Mode) or Lock (if TV is in FTG or LodgeNet PPV Mode) menu icon; then, press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. TV Software Update 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Upgrade TV Software orLOGO Upgrade Image Download PTC Software, as applicable, and press ENTER. 6. Select the appropriate option(s), depending on the type of upgrade you are performing: TVTV Software Update (Expert) • TV Software Upgrade: (See screen samples at right.) Select Software Update from the first TV Software Update window. In the second TV Software Update window, select/highlight the update file to install and press ENTER. Note: Do not select Forced Update options unless you have been specifically instructed to do so or have previous experience with Expert Software Updates. • PTC Software Upgrade: In the PTC Software Update window, select/highlight the update file to install and press ENTER. TV Software Update Note: The PTC Software Update window is similar to the second TV SoftLOGO Image Download ware Update window, though there are no Forced Update options. Current software version information is shown at the top and update files on the USB device are listed at the bottom of the window. USB Download Menu Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Return Enter TV Software Update (Expert) TV Software Update (Expert) TV So The following software files are found in the memory card. Select the file you want to download to this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. The following Select the file or press EXIT TV Software Update Splash Image 1366 X 768 ProCentric LOGO Image Download Splash Im TV Software Update (Expert) TV Software Update (Expert) TV S [ Current TV Software Version Information ] [ Current T EPK : 03.03.00 EPK : 03.0 The following software files are found in the memory card. Select the file you want to download to this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. The follow Select the or press E EPK : 03.05.00 EPK : 03.0 [ Forced Update Option ] Ext. MICOM [ Forced U SPI Boot LOGO Image TV Software Update Ext. M LOGO xxLD340H_v1_00_RevNo1000_USB LOGO Image Download xxLD340 The TV will show update completion progress in a new window. Do NOT remove the USB device until the software upgrade is complete. When a TV software upgrade is complete, the TV will reset Upgrade PTC Software itself with an automatic restart. When a PTC upgrade is complete, the TV will turn OFF. Upgr [ Current PTC Software Version Information ] TXT : 03.03.00 206-4186 41 [ Current P TXT : 03.0 The following software files are found in the memory card. The follow Reference: Downloading a Splash Screen using a USB Memory Device TV S TV Software Update (Expert) The followin Select the fi or press EX Splash Screen Image File Guidelines USB Download Menu • The splash screen image must be a baseline (not progressive) JPEG. Upgrade TV Software • The image should be no larger than 1 MB. Upgrade PTC TVSoftware Software Update • The ideal size for the image is 1366 x 768 pixels or under. • The image file must be stored in a folder named “LG_DTV” in the root directory of USB memory device. • Ensure the USB device has been formatted with FAT format. Teach To TV (TLL) LOGO Image Download Teach To TV (FMA) Splash I Return Enter TV Software Update (Expert) Downloading a Splash Screen Image TV S [ Current EPK : 03. 1. Turn the TV ON. The follow Select the or press E 2. Plug the USB memory device into the USB IN port on the TV. 3. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to display the TV setup menus. 4. Use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight either the Option (if TV is in Pass-through Mode) or Lock (if TV is in FTG or LodgeNet PPV Mode) menu icon; then, press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Upgrade TV Software, and then press TV Software Update (Expert) ENTER. 6. Select LOGO Image Download from the first TV Software Update window. 7. In the second TV Software Update window, use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the image file to download, and then press ENTER. The TV will show download completion progress in a new window. Do NOT remove the USB device until the image download is complete. When the image TV Software Update download is complete, the TV will reset itself with an automatic restart. Upon the restart, you should see the new splash screen. LOGO Image Download EPK : 03. [ Forced U TV Software Update Ext. LOG LOGO Image Download xxLD34 TV Software Update (Expert) The following software files are found in the memory card. Select the file you want to download to this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. Upg [ Current TXT : 03 The follo Splash Image 1366 X 768 ProCentric xxLD34 TV Software Update (Expert) TV Software Update (Expert) [ Current TV Software Version Information ] EPK : 03.03.00 The following software files are found in the memory card. Select the file you want to download to this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. EPK : 03.05.00 [ Forced Update Option ] TV Software Update LOGO Image Download Ext. MICOM SPI Boot LOGO Image xxLD340H_v1_00_RevNo1000_USB Upgrade PTC Software [ Current PTC Software Version Information ] TXT : 03.03.00 42 206-4186 The following software files are found in the memory card. Reference: Power Consumption Settings The following tables assume that Installer Menu item 118 POWER SAVINGS is set to 003 (default) and Installer Menu item 099 BACK LIGHTING is set as shown below (default value is 100). Item 099 Back Lighting (Static) 26LD340H / 26LD343H / 26LD345H 32LD340H / 32LD343H / 32LD345H Power Consumption (Watts) Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) 100 56.82 0.00% 90 80 70 60 50 40 30 20 10 1 51.98 47.09 42.06 39.71 37.36 36.31 35.12 32.59 30.23 27.95 8.52% 17.13% 25.97% 30.12% 34.25% 36.10% 38.19% 42.64% 46.80% 50.82% Item 099 Back Lighting (Dynamic) 26LD340H / 26LD343H / 26LD345H 37LD340H / 37LD343H / 37LD345H 42LD340H / 42LD343H / 42LD345H Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) 72.97 0.00% 88.92 0.00% 107.53 0.00% 63.82 58.53 53.58 44.24 41.27 38.71 36.20 33.51 31.01 28.55 12.54% 19.78% 26.57% 39.38% 43.45% 46.95% 50.39% 54.07% 57.51% 60.87% 84.19 77.84 72.19 66.28 60.90 56.58 52.35 47.75 43.68 39.62 5.32% 12.46% 18.81% 25.46% 31.51% 36.37% 41.13% 46.30% 50.88% 55.44% 86.68 78.79 72.81 66.78 60.61 56.35 52.90 47.71 43.04 38.86 19.39% 26.73% 32.29% 37.89% 43.63% 47.60% 50.81% 55.63% 59.98% 63.86% 32LD340H / 32LD343H / 32LD345H 37LD340H / 37LD343H / 37LD345H Percent Savings 42LD340H / 42LD343H / 42LD345H Power Consumption (Watts) Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) Percent Savings 200 72.19 0.00% 75.45 0.00% 110.86 0.00% 125.41 0.00% 190 180 170 160 150 140 130 120 110 101 68.21 63.72 59.21 55.04 50.81 46.03 41.49 36.32 31.52 26.95 5.51% 11.74% 17.99% 23.76% 29.62% 36.24% 42.53% 49.69% 56.34% 62.67% 69.23 65.26 60.72 56.29 51.82 46.62 41.67 36.14 31.11 26.41 8.25% 13.51% 19.53% 25.40% 31.33% 38.21% 44.78% 52.10% 58.76% 65.00% 99.05 92.33 85.39 78.61 71.70 63.53 55.65 47.34 39.90 33.00 10.65% 16.72% 22.98% 29.10% 35.32% 42.69% 49.80% 57.30% 64.01% 70.24% 111.41 103.30 95.29 87.64 79.71 70.73 61.80 51.86 42.90 34.52 11.16% 17.63% 24.02% 30.11% 36.44% 43.60% 50.72% 58.65% 65.79% 72.47% Note: Values are results of controlled experiments under laboratory conditions. 206-4186 43 Reference: TV Camport Auto Sense Operation The Camport Auto Sense function is enabled when: 1. Installer Menu item 034 CAMPORT EN is set to 1 AND 2. Installer Menu item 040 AUTO CAMPORT is enabled (1). Selectable: Can be accessed with INPUT key, direct access, etc. Auto Sense: TV switches to this input when connector is inserted. The Camport (Side [AV IN 2] Video) has the highest priority and will override any commands including tuning to the Start Channel. Camport Operation (Stand-alone) When Camport Auto Sense is enabled as above, the TV’s source will switch to the Side (AV IN 2) Video Aux source whenever a plug is inserted into the AV IN 2 Video input. When the plug is removed, the TV will switch back to the previous channel or input source that was being displayed before the plug was inserted. However, if any direct access to an RF channel or Aux channel is requested while the Camport is active, then, when the video plug is removed, the TV will switch to the last requested channel. Source changes using any Source keys (INPUT) are ignored. Channel Up/Down and Flashback commands are not direct access tuning commands, and they are also ignored. Camport Operation (FTG or PPV) The operation will be similar to that of the Stand-alone Mode. However, when the Channel Map is maintained external to the PTC (i.e., FTG and PPV), Channel Up/ Down or Flashback keys are sent as Direct Access tuning commands to the PTC/TV. 44 CAMPORT (Side Video) Functionality Control Item 034 CAMPORT EN Item 040 AUTO CAMPORT Side (AV IN 2) Video Operation 0 0 Disabled 0 1 Disabled 1 0 Selectable 1 1 Auto Sense Previous State Before Inserting CAMPORT Operation While CAMPORT is Active State Upon Removal of CAMPORT Aux or RF Channel None Previous Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Direct Access Last Requested Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Ch Up/Down, Flashback, and Input Keys Previous Aux or RF Channel Previous State Before Inserting CAMPORT Operation While CAMPORT is Active State Upon Removal of CAMPORT Aux or RF Channel None Previous Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Direct Access Last Requested Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Ch Up/Down, Flashback, and Input Keys Last Requested Aux or RF Channel 206-4186 Reference: TV Aux Input Configuration ENABLE DIRECT ACCESS Tuning TV Installer Menu MPI DATA MPI DATA STATUS TYPE 0x41 SOURCES ENABLED (R/W) DATA STATUS TYPE 0xD2 CURRENT AV SOURCE (R) DATA STATUS TYPE 0x0D AUX SOURCE (R) START AUX SOURCE ASSIGNMENT OLD_ OCV = 0 OLD_ OCV = 1 Source Input Source Mode Number Labeling Value Labeling Value Labeling 130 90 Video2 (Side) CV 34 CAMPORT_EN 0x01 Video Front (Camport) 0 Video Front (Camport) 0 (VIDEO) 2 131 91 Video1 (Rear) CV 39 REAR_AUX_EN 0x02 Rear Video (Aux) 1 Rear Video (Aux) 0 (VIDEO) 1 132 92 HDMI2 DTV/PC 91 YPrPb2 EN = 1 0x04 S-Video Rear 2 S-Video Rear 0 (VIDEO) 5 133 93 HDMI1/DVI DTV/PC 35 COMPPORT_EN =1 0x08 Front Computer 3 Front Computer 0 (VIDEO) 3 134 94 RGB PC 87 REAR RGB EN =2 0x10 SVGA Rear Computer 4 SVGA Rear Computer 2 (COMPUTER) 4 136 96 Component 38 YPrPb EN 0x40 Y/UV Component 6 Rear Y/PrPb Component Video 0 (VIDEO) 6 206-4186 45 Reference: b-LAN Setup & Overview The b-LAN module is internal to the TV. It allows hotel/institution head end equipment with b-LAN technology to communicate, via the institution’s RF distribution system, with the TV for configuration and control. Note: MPI cards with b-LAN technology—LMT7Z5, LMT7Z7, LMT7Z9—are NOT supported in TVs in which b-LAN technology is already integrated. Power to the b-LAN module is controlled by Installer Menu item 118 POWER SAVINGS. The default value is 003—the b-LAN module is only powered when the TV is turned ON. See chart below. TV Standby State TV Power On State b-LAN Power b-LAN Power 001 On On 003 (default) Off On POWER SAVINGS A b-LAN enabled head end device, such as an LG FMA-LG101, broadcasts over the RF distribution system to communicate to multiple TVs. When the TV is first installed, it must be turned ON in order for its embedded b-LAN module to receive communication from the head end device. At this point, if it is desired for the b-LAN module to always be powered, including while the TV is in Standby, set Installer Menu item 118 POWER SAVINGS to 001. 46 206-4186 Reference: RJP Model List and Input Auto-sensing Hierarchy RJP Model List Legacy Models Scaler Models RJP-101M N/A RJP-101ML N/A RJP-110F RJP-210F RJP-110FW RJP-210FW RJP-110W RJP-210W RJP-110WBR RJP-210WBR RJP-110S RJP-210S RJP-120G RJP-220G RJP-120T RJP-220T RJP-201B RJP-301B RJP-202B RJP-302B RJP Input Auto-sensing Hierarchy 206-4186 Priority Video Audio 1st (Highest) Digital Video In Audio In (3.5mm) 2nd PC Video In Audio In (L/R) 3rd Video In Digital Video In 47 Resetting a TV to Pass-through Mode This section describes how you can reset a TV that is currently in FTG Mode to Pass-through Mode. Note that the reset to Pass-through Mode will also restore all factory default settings on the TV. FTG Mode via CPU There are three options for resetting Pass-through Mode on TVs that are in FTG Mode via the CPU. The first and second options enable you to reset a single TV to Pass-through Mode, while the third option enables you to reset multiple TVs to Pass-through Mode at one time. • A predefined value for Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT enables access to initiate a factory “INSTOP” process that will reset the TV to Pass-through Mode. Contact technical support for the required value for Installer Menu item 117 and for additional information on performing the IN-STOP from the Installer Menu. • Using a USB memory device, “Teach” an FMA Configuration file that only contains a “0 Mapped Channels” FTG Channel Map to the TV. Refer to “Creating an FMA Configuration File using the FTG Configuration Application” and “Teaching FMA Configuration to a TV” on pages 31 and 32, respectively, for further information. • If your system uses a Pro:Centric server for configuration, use the Pro:Centric Admin Client to load an FMA Configuration file that only contains a “0 Mapped Channels” FTG Channel Map on the Pro:Centric server. Refer to the Pro:Centric™ Server Admin Client User Guide for further information. FTG Mode via EBL There are three options for resetting Pass-through Mode on TVs that are in FTG Mode via the EBL. The first and second options enable you to reset a single TV to Pass-through Mode, while the third option enables you to reset multiple TVs to Pass-through Mode at one time. • A predefined value for Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT enables access to initiate a factory “INSTOP” process that will reset the TV to Pass-through Mode. Contact technical support for the required value for Installer Menu item 117 and for additional information on performing the IN-STOP from the Installer Menu. • Using a direct PC-to-TV connection, “Write” an unpopulated Channel Map—that is, a Channel Map with zero channels—to the TV. Refer to the “FTG Mode via EBL” procedure on page 35 and/or the Free-ToGuest (FTG) Configuration Application manual for further information. • If your system uses an FMA for broadcast configuration, configure the FMA device with an FMA Configuration file that only contains a “0 Mapped Channels” FTG Channel Map to broadcast to the TV EBL(s). Refer to the Free-To-Guest (FTG) Configuration Application manual and/or the Installation & Setup manual for the FMA device for further information. 48 206-4186 Troubleshooting General Troubleshooting Some Quick and Easy Tips for Resolving Problems Symptom Possible Cause(s) Possible Solution(s) Channel not included in channel lineup in internal TV controller (PTC). After 2-5-5 + MENU, only channels included in the TV PTC will appear. If a channel is available, it can be added to channel lineup. If it is not available, the “No Signal” message appears on the TV screen. Software Problems When direct enter channel number, “No Signal” appears. Power No power. Display Panel Picture No picture. See troubleshooting flow chart on following page. Display panel is turned off. • Turn TV ON. • Power failure? Antenna/cable not connected. Connect antenna/cable signal to TV Connections incorrect. Check connections on TV MPI not connected. If applicable, connect MPI cable to MPI device. Encrypted program. Try another channel. Wrong tuning band. Adjust Installer Menu settings. Wrong Installer Menu settings. Adjust Installer Menu settings as required. Remote not in TV Mode. Use MODE key to select “TV”; puts remote into TV Mode. Not aimed at IR remote sensor. Point remote at IR receiver on TV. Remote too far from IR sensor. Move remote closer to IR receiver on TV or darken room. Erratic Operation Installer Menu setup. Installer Remote Remote doesn’t work. MPI not connected. If applicable, connect MPI cable to MPI device. IR path to TV’s receiver obstructed. Remove obstructions. Weak batteries. Replace batteries. Wrong battery polarity. Check that “+” and “-” match in battery compartment. Too much light in room. Dim room light. Wrong Installer Remote. Requires compatible Installer Remote. Contact your LG dealer. Audio muted. Press MUTE or use Volume Up key to increase sound level. Broadcast problem. Try a different channel. Picture Reception Normal picture, poor or no sound. Note: For other problems not caused by the TV, refer to the other devices’ operating guide(s). 206-4186 49 Troubleshooting (Cont.) Troubleshooting Flow Chart Controller Quick Check STATUS LED on PTC Board blinking? No TV connected to AC Power? No Plug into AC Power outlet. Yes Yes Bad TV Cycle the power by removing and reconnecting the AC Power cord. Then, observe POWER LED on front of TV. POWER LED lit? No Bad Analog or Digital Board Yes No Bad TV No Bad PPV Card Yes Press POWER on Installer Remote. TV turned ON? TV responded? Press VOLUME UP/ DOWN or MUTE key on User-supplied Remote. No Bad TV TV responded? Yes Yes Press VOLUME UP/ DOWN or MUTE key on Installer Remote. 50 End 206-4186 Troubleshooting (Cont.) Commercial Mode Check / FTG Operation Troubleshooting Commercial Mode Check Press POWER on Installer Remote. TV responded? No Bad TV Yes Leave the TV set ON. Go to Installer Menu by pressing MENU until the on-screen setup menus lock up (i.e., stop responding). TV stopped responding or continued to respond? Stopped responding TV is in Commercial Mode. Continued to respond TV is not in Commercial Mode. Call Technical Support for assistance. FTG Operation Troubleshooting The following table provides troubleshooting information for when the EBL is configured in the FTG Mode of operation. Symptom Possible Cause(s) Solution(s) Communication Error (“Communications Timeout”) Cable(s) not connected. Check and connect communication cables. TV not powered. Check/connect the TV power cord. TV not turned ON. TV needs to be turned ON (default FTG Mode). Wrong COM (communication) port. In the FTG Configuration Application, select the correct COM port for the cable being used. 206-4186 51 Troubleshooting (Cont.) Clone Programmer Troubleshooting Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs. Also, if the TV is in LodgeNet PPV Mode (check with the site administrator if you are not certain), do not connect a clone programmer to the GAME CONTROL/MPI port. Either of these actions will damage the clone programmer and, if applicable, the PPV card. Symptom Reset Clone Programmer After Static Shock After replacing exhausted batteries (LT2002 only), or if the clone programmer behaves strangely after a static shock: • TLL-1100A: Turn the TLL-1100A OFF and then ON. • LT2002: Use a paper clip or similar instrument inserted through the small hole marked RESET to activate the internal reset switch and restore normal operation. After a reset, check the real-time clock setting. It may be necessary to set the clone programmer clock from a TV containing the correct time. Note: Both the Master and Target TVs must be in Pass-through Mode for cloning purposes. See also IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 23. Possible Cause(s) Possible Solution(s) Clone copies setup in less than 30 seconds. Not enough time to copy entire TV setup. TLL-1100A: Turn the TLL-1100A OFF and then ON. LT2002: Press RESET on clone programmer. Then redo Learn/Teach. (Learning usually takes about 90 seconds; Teaching usually takes 3 to 4 minutes.) Remote does not operate clone programmer. Wrong Installer Remote. Only use an LG Installer Remote to operate clone programmer with TV. Clone menu does not appear on display panel screen, TLL-1100A shows error message, or LT2002 LED does not blink. MPI cord not connected. Connect MPI cord properly, and ensure good connection. TV not turned ON. TV must be powered ON for clone programmer to work. (LT2002 only) Weak batteries. Install four (4) fresh AA high-quality alkaline batteries. (TLL-1100A only) No charge. Ensure the TLL-1100A is fully charged or connected to AC power. Clone menu hard to read. Weak signal. Connect TV to a reliable analog channel signal source. No time set. Time not available. Set time on a TV, and copy time to clone programmer. Clone not working. Clone programmer problem. • Try a different clone programmer. • Reset the clone programmer. Clone scans channels more than once. Clone should only scan channels Ensure TV is set up correctly, and try cloning again. once. Clone Programmer Master and Target TVs Cloning did not work. Procedure interrupted. Wait until procedure complete message is displayed. Different TV models. Cloning is only possible with identical model TVs. Step(s) omitted or not performed. Refer to the applicable cloning procedure(s), and make sure all tasks were performed. (LT2002 only) Clone time disappeared. Batteries were removed. Batteries must remain installed to retain time settings. New setup not present. Target TV not reset. Disconnect Target TV from AC power for 15 seconds. • After cloning operations are complete, unplug the TLL-1100A/LT2002 from the TV. • If the TV does not display a picture (blank screen) after a few seconds, just change channels. 52 206-4186 Glossary of Terms A list of definitions for some of the words found in this guide. 75 OHM RF CABLE The wire that comes from an off-air antenna or cable service provider. The end looks like a hex-shaped nut with a wire through the middle. It screws onto the Antenna/Cable threaded jack on the back of the TV. 300 TO 75 OHM ADAPTER A small device that connects a 2-wire 300 ohm antenna to a 75 ohm RF jack. It is usually about an inch long with two screws on one end and a round opening with a wire extending out the other end. A/V CABLES Audio/Video cables. Three cables bunched together—right audio (red), left audio (white), and video (yellow). A/V cables are used for stereo playback of videocassettes and for higher quality picture and sound from other A/V devices. A/V DEVICE Any device that produces video or sound (VCR, DVD, cable box, or television). AMPLIFIER An electronic device that amplifies sound from a television, CD player, VCR, DVD player, or other Audio/Video device. ANTENNA The physical receiver of television signals sent over the air. A large metal piece of equipment does not always have to be visible to be using an antenna. b-LAN LodgeNet Interactive Corporation proprietary RF communication system used to configure/control TV via RF distribution system. CABLE Cable service box. Refers to the descrambler box cable subscribers use to receive cable programming signals. CATV Programming provided by a cable service. COMPONENT VIDEO Uses three wires for transporting threecolor video signals. The end result is usually better video quality. OUTPUT Refers to the output jack that sends a signal out of a VCR, DVD, or other A/V device. COMPOSITE VIDEO Typical video jack, uses one wire for transporting three-color video signals. PHYSICAL CHANNEL NUMBER The actual channel number. Analog channels use the Physical Channel number and digital channels can use a Virtual Channel number. DELETE Lets you remove channels from the list that the end user can scroll through using Channel Up/Down. DIGITAL TELEVISION High-resolution, cinema-quality television signals transmitted digitally. DVI Digital Video Interface. Accommodates analog and digital interfaces with a single connector. HDMI High-definition multi-media interface. HDSTB High-definition set top box. Refers to a tuner device that receives high-definition television signals which have higher resolution than ordinary analog TV signals. RGB (RED, GREEN, BLUE) Connection input or output port available for producing a video image using three separate colors: Red, Green, and Blue. RS-232 Serial communication port through which firmware is downloaded. 2ND AUDIO PROGRAMMING/SAP Second Audio Programming (SAP) is another, separate audio channel available with some programming. Choosing SAP often refers to listening to audio in another language, such as Spanish or French. SIGNAL Picture and sound traveling through a cable, or over the air, to the TV. HDTV High-definition television. Refers to television signals that have higher resolution than ordinary analog TV signals. STEREO SOUND Stereo (Stereophonic) sound refers to audio that’s divided into right and left sides. INPUT Refers to the input jack that receives a signal from a TV, VCR, DVD Player, or other Audio/Video device. TUNER Device that picks up the broadcast signal and turns it into picture and sound. JACK An input or output connector on the back of a TV, VCR, DVD Player, or other Audio/Video device. MONO SOUND Mono (monaural) sound is one channel of sound. On more than one speaker, all the speakers play the same audio. VIRTUAL CHANNEL NUMBER A re-mapped channel number. Analog channels use the Physical Channel number; however digital channels use a Virtual (or false) Channel number. XDS Extended Data Service. Additional program information included on the signal provided at the discretion of the broadcaster. Note: Refer to www.atsc.org for further information. 206-4186 53 Document Revision History / Notes Document Revision History Date Description May 2011 Revision A: New document Product documentation is available online at: www.LGsolutions.com/products. From the Products page, select TVs, Systems & Solutions, then LCD TVs, then the applicable TV. Click the Literature & Downloads tab at the bottom of the TV page, and select the required document(s) from the Downloads list. Notes 54 206-4186 For Customer Support/Service, please call: 1-888-865-3026 www.LGsolutions.com Pro:Idiom is a registered trademark of Zenith Electronics LLC. Pro:Centric is a trademark of LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. b-LAN is a trademark of LodgeNet Interactive Corporation. All other trademarks or registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. © Copyright 2011, LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 206-4186 Revision A 32LD330H 37LD330H 32LD333H 37LD333H Lodging Guest Interactive Pro:Centric™ TVs Commercial Mode Setup Guide Note: Selected features shown in this guide may not be available on all models. EXPERIENCED INSTALLER Commercial Mode Setup pages 12 – 13 Cloning Information pages 23 – 28 FTG Mode of Operation pages 29 – 37 © Copyright 2011, LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. P/N: 206-4185 (Rev A) For Customer Support/Service, please call: 1-888-865-3026 The latest product information and documentation is available online at: www.LGsolutions.com/products MODEL and SERIAL NUMBER The model and serial numbers of this TV are located on the back of the cabinet. For future reference, LG suggests that you record those numbers here: Model No._________________ Serial No._______________ WARNING RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT OPEN WARNING: TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK DO NOT REMOVE COVER (OR BACK). NO USERSERVICEABLE PARTS INSIDE. REFER TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL. The lightning flash with arrowhead symbol, within an equilateral triangle, is intended to alert the user to the presence of uninsulated “dangerous voltage” within the product’s enclosure that may be of sufficient magnitude to constitute a risk of electric shock to persons. The exclamation point within an equilateral triangle is intended to alert the user to the presence of important operating and maintenance (servicing) instructions in the literature accompanying the appliance. WARNING: TO PREVENT FIRE OR SHOCK HAZARDS, DO NOT EXPOSE THIS PRODUCT TO RAIN OR MOISTURE. POWER CORD POLARIZATION: This product is equipped with a 3-wire grounding-type alternating current power plug. This plug will fit into the power outlet only one way. This is a safety feature. If you are unable to insert the plug fully into the outlet, contact your electrician to replace your obsolete outlet. Do not defeat the safety purpose of the 3-wire grounding-type plug. NOTE TO CABLE/TV INSTALLER: This reminder is provided to call the cable TV system installer’s attention to Article 820-40 of the National Electric Code (U.S.A.). The code provides guidelines for proper grounding and, in particular, specifies that the cable ground shall be connected to the grounding system of the building, as close to the point of the cable entry as practical. REGULATORY INFORMATION: This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference when the equipment is operated in a residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with the instruction manual, may cause harmful interference to radio communications. However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures: • Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna. • Increase the separation between the equipment and receiver. • Connect the equipment to an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is connected. • Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician for help. CAUTION: Do not attempt to modify this product in any way without written authorization from LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. Unauthorized modification could void the user’s authority to operate this product. COMPLIANCE: The responsible party for this product’s compliance is: LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 1000 Sylvan Avenue, Englewood Cliffs, NJ 07632, USA • Phone: 1-201-816-2000 Marketed and Distributed in the United States by LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 1000 Sylvan Avenue, Englewood Cliffs, NJ 07632 2 © Copyright 2011, LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 206-4185 IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS 1. Read these instructions. 2. Keep these instructions. 3. Heed all warnings. 4. Follow all instructions. 5. Do not use this apparatus near water. 6. Clean only with dry cloth. 7. Do not block any ventilation openings. Install in accordance with the manufacturer’s instructions. 8. Do not install near any heat sources, such as radiators, heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus (including amplifiers) that produce heat. 9. Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or grounding-type plug. A polarized plug has two blades with one wider than the other. A grounding-type plug has two blades and a third grounding prong. The wide blade or the third prong are provided for your safety. If the provided plug does not fit into your outlet, consult an electrician for replacement of the obsolete outlet. 10. Protect the power cord from being walked on or pinched, particularly at plugs, convenience receptacles, and the point where it exits from the apparatus. 11. Only use attachments/accessories specified by the manufacturer. 12. Use only with the cart, stand, tripod, bracket, or table specified by the manufacturer or sold with the apparatus. When a cart is used, use caution when moving the cart/ apparatus combination in order to avoid injury from tipover. 17. Power Cord Caution: It is recommended that appliances be placed upon a dedicated circuit; that is, a single outlet circuit which powers only that appliance and has no additional outlets or branch circuits. Check the specification page of the Owner’s Manual to be certain. Periodically examine the cord of your appliance, and if its appearance indicates damage or deterioration, unplug it, discontinue use of the appliance, and have the cord replaced with an exact replacement part by an authorized servicer. Protect the power cord from physical or mechanical abuse, such as twisting, kinking, or pinching or being closed in a door or walked upon. Pay particular attention to plugs, wall outlets, and the point where the cord exits the appliance. Do not use a damaged or loose power cord. Be sure to grasp the plug when unplugging the power cord. Do not pull on the power cord to unplug the TV. 18. Overloading Do not connect too many appliances to the same AC power outlet as this could result in fire or electric shock. Do not overload wall outlets. Overloaded wall outlets, loose or damaged wall outlets, extension cords, frayed power cords, or damaged or cracked wire insulation are dangerous. Any of these conditions could result in fire or electric shock. 19. Outdoor Use/Wet Location Warning: To reduce the risk of fire or electrical shock, do not expose this product to rain, moisture or other liquids. Do not touch the TV with wet hands. Do not install this product near flammable objects, such as gasoline or candles, or expose the TV to direct air conditioning. Do not expose to dripping or splashing and do not place objects filled with liquids, such as vases, cups, etc., on or over the apparatus (e.g., on shelves above the unit). PORTABLE CART WARNING 13. Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel. Servicing is required when the apparatus has been damaged in any way, such as power-supply cord or plug is damaged, liquid has been spilled or objects have fallen into the apparatus, the apparatus has been exposed to rain or moisture, does not operate normally, or has been dropped. 14. Never touch this apparatus or antenna during a thunder or lighting storm. 15. When mounting a TV on the wall, make sure not to install the TV by the hanging power and signal cables on the back of the TV. 16. Do not allow an impact shock or any objects to fall into the product, and do not drop objects onto the screen. 206-4185 20. Grounding Ensure that you connect the earth ground wire to prevent possible electric shock (i.e., a TV with a three-prong grounded AC plug must be connected to a three-prong grounded AC outlet). If grounding methods are not possible, have a qualified electrician install a separate circuit breaker. Do not try to ground the unit by connecting it to telephone wires, lightening rods, or gas pipes. 21. Disconnect Device The mains plug is the disconnecting device. The plug must remain readily operable. As long as this unit is connected to the AC wall outlet, it is not disconnected from the AC power source even if the unit is turned Off. (Continued on next page) 3 IMPORTANT SAFETY INSTRUCTIONS (Continued from previous page) 22. Outdoor Antenna Grounding If an outside antenna or cable system is connected to the product, follow the precautions below. An outdoor antenna system should not be located in the vicinity of overhead power lines or other electric light or power circuits or where it can come into contact with such power lines or circuits as death or serious injury can occur. Be sure the antenna system is grounded so as to provide some protection against voltage surges and built-up static charges. Article 810 of the National Electrical Code (NEC) in the U.S.A. provides information with respect to proper grounding of the mast and supporting structure, grounding of the leadin wire to an antenna-discharge unit, size of grounding conductors, location of antenna-discharge unit, connection to grounding electrodes, and requirements for the grounding electrode. Antenna Grounding According to NEC, ANSI/NFPA 70 Ground Clamp Antenna Lead in Wire Antenna Discharge Unit (NEC Section 810-20) Electric Service Equipment Grounding Conductor (NEC Section 810-21) Ground Clamps Power Service Grounding Electrode System (NEC Art 250, Part H) 27. If you smell smoke or other odors coming from the TV or hear strange sounds, unplug the power cord, and contact an authorized service center. 28. Do not press strongly on the panel with your hand or a sharp object (e.g., a nail, pencil, or pen) or make a scratch on it. 29. Keep the product away from direct sunlight. 30. Dot Defect The Plasma or LCD panel is a high technology product with resolution of two million to six million pixels. In a very few cases, you could see fine dots on the screen while you’re viewing the TV. Those dots are deactivated pixels and do not affect the performance and reliability of the TV. 31. Generated Sound “Cracking”: A cracking noise that occurs while the TV is On or when it is turned Off is generated by plastic thermal contraction due to temperature and humidity. This noise is common for products where thermal deformation is required. Electrical circuit humming/panel buzzing: A low level noise is generated from a high-speed switching circuit, which supplies a large amount of current to operate a product. It varies depending on the product. This generated sound does not affect the performance and reliability of the product. 32. For LCD TV If the TV feels cold to the touch, there may be a small “flicker” when it is turned On. This is normal; there is nothing wrong with TV. Some minute dot defects may be visible on the screen, appearing as tiny red, green, or blue spots. However, they have no adverse effect on the TV’s performance. Avoid touching the LCD screen or holding your finger(s) against it for long periods of time. Doing so may produce some temporary distortion effects on the screen. 23. Cleaning When cleaning, unplug the power cord and wipe gently with a soft cloth to prevent scratching. Do not spray water or other liquids directly on the TV as electric shock may occur. Do not clean with chemicals such as alcohol, thinners or benzene. 24. Transporting Product Make sure the product is turned Off and unplugged and that all cables have been removed. It may take two or more people to carry larger TVs. Do not press against or put stress on the front panel of the TV. 25. Ventilation Install the TV where there is proper ventilation. Do not install in a confined space such as a bookcase. Do not cover the product with cloth or other materials (e.g., plastic) while it is plugged in. Do not install in excessively dusty places. 26. Do not touch the ventilation openings, as they may become hot while the TV is operating. 4 206-4185 Table of Contents Safety Warnings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 FTG Configuration Application Utilities Overview . . 34 – 37 Important Safety Instructions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .3 – 4 FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility . . . . . . . . . . . . 34 Table of Contents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 FTG Channel Map Editor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 Setup Checklist / Commercial Mode Setup Overview . . . . 6 FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility . . . . . . . . . . . 36 Pro:Centric TV Interactive Menu Features . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 FMA Configuration Utility . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 37 LD330H/LD333H Rear Jack Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Side Connections Panel / RF Antenna Connection . . . . . 9 Installer Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Installer Remote Control Typical Key Functions . . . . . . 11 References Upgrading TV/PTC Software using a USB Memory Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV . . . . . . . 12 – 13 Downloading a Splash Screen using a USB Memory Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39 Installer Menu . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 – 20 Power Consumption Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 TV Setup Menus Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 TV Camport Auto Sense Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 41 Adding Channel Icons / Custom Channel Labels (2-5-4 + MENU Mode) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 TV Aux Input Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 42 Cloning Overview / Clonable Menu Features . . . . . . . 23 Resetting a TV to Pass-through Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43 Cloning Procedures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 – 28 Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 – 47 Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a USB Memory Device . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 General Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a TLL-1100A Clone Programmer . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 – 26 Commercial Mode Check / FTG Operation Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 46 Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using an LT2002 Clone Programmer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 – 28 Clone Programmer Troubleshooting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 FTG Mode of Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 – 33 FTG Mode Overview / Determining the TV Operating Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 Creating an FMA Configuration File using the FTG Configuration Application . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 Troubleshooting Flow Chart . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 Glossary of Terms . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Document Revision History / Notes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49 Back Cover . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Teaching FMA Configuration to a TV . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 Learning an FMA Configuration File from a TV . . . . . . 32 Optional Manual Configuration / Setup for a TV . . . . . 33 Notes • Installer Menu content is intended for use primarily by qualified TV electronics technicians. • Refer to the Owner’s Manual for additional information on TV features, specifications, maintenance, and safety instructions. • For additional information, contact your LG representative. Note: Design and specifications subject to change without prior notice. 206-4185 5 Setup Checklist / Commercial Mode Setup Overview Setup Checklist Installation and Setup Checklist __ Unpack TV and all accessories. __ Install batteries in remote control. __ Install TV on VESA mount or stand. Note: It may be advisable to make all cable connections before installing on VESA mount or stand, as appropriate. Hardware Connections __ Install any additional hardware as appropriate to your institution, LAN, etc. Commercial Mode Setup __ Complete Commercial Mode Setup (configure all relevant Installer Menu items as required of your institution and configure display features for the end user). Software Installation __ Install or configure any software, as applicable, for example, PPV, etc. Cable Connections __ Make all connections to rear jack panel and RF antenna on MPI/PPV card. __ Make all connections to signal, interactive resources, and Aux sources, as appropriate. Commercial Mode Setup Overview This document describes how to set up LD330H/LD333H Pro:Centric™ TVs for Commercial Mode either while in Pass-through Mode or Free-To-Guest (FTG) Mode. Pass-through Mode This mode allows you to configure a Master TV Setup for cloning purposes as well as external VOD/PPV control. Use the Installer Remote to configure Installer Menu items as required for TV operation and set up TV features (Channel, Picture, Audio, etc.). See pages 12 to 13 for detailed information. FTG Mode This mode enables Pro:Idiom ® decryption and also allows logical channel mapping of physical channels to remove the need for dash tuning. FTG Configuration Application software is used to configure and/or edit FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings. See pages 29 to 37 for information on FTG Mode options and using the FTG Configuration Application. 6 206-4185 Pro:Centric TV Interactive Menu Features Important: Pro:Centric operation requires that Installer Menu items 098 PRO:CENTRIC and 119 DATA CHANNEL be set appropriately and that the TV be in PPV or FTG Mode. The interactive Pro:Centric TV enables guests—from the comfort of their hotel rooms—to view and select from a complete listing of hotel services and amenities. The Pro:Centric TV is connected to the hotel's billing computer, and service/amenities charges are billed at the time of order. Interactive amenities may include: • Hotel information, news, and events • Directory services (tourist attractions, restaurants, etc.) • Reservation services (business meetings, fitness, spa, etc.) • Weather and traffic information ALARM TIMER • Shopping services (delivery to guest room) INPUT • Room service (menu ordering, memo service, morning wake up call, laundry, etc.) TV 1 4 7 2 5 8 0 INFO VOL • Check-out service (in the guest room) • Gaming services • E-mail resources/account access FLASHBK Use the Installer Remote to operate both interactive menus and regular TV features. Press PORTAL on the Installer Remote to access the interactive menus. i PORTAL CH MUTE MENU • Ticketing services 3 6 9 GUIDE CC P A G E Note: Interactive menu options may vary, depending on Pro:Centric features enabled for the site. The following are default interactive menus. Channel Guide Shows available TV networks and channels. When available, electronic program guide (EPG) data indicates the channel and the program start and finish times. ENTER Information RETURN SAP EXIT EJECT Typically displays hotel information, for example, photos of guest rooms, dining rooms, business centers, facilities, etc., as well as information on local weather and attractions. Information may also include resources, such as local school programs, run in cooperation with the hotel. RATIO Help Provides help for navigating the interactive menus. Watch TV Removes the interactive menu from the screen and returns to the previously tuned TV channel. 206-4185 7 LD330H/LD333H Rear Jack Panel AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) Audio connection for RGB or DVI device. UPDATE Restricted to software updates. REMOTE CONTROL OUT IR output for controlling an auxiliary device. RESET Initiates a hardware reset and switches the TV to standby. RS-232C IN (SERVICE ONLY) RESET UPDATE HDMI 2 .......... HDMI /DVI IN 1 .......... REMOTE CONTROL OUT ..... ..... ..... ..... .... RS-232C IN Use for downloading software updates, etc. AV IN 1 VIDEO L/MONO-AUDIO-R AUDIO IN (RGB/DVI) AUDIO/VIDEO IN 1 Connection for composite audio/video output from external device. MPI RGB IN (PC) SPEAKER OUT ( 8 ) Y PB VIDEO PR L AUDIO R COMPONENT IN HDMI/DVI IN Connection for HDMI/DVI output from external device. RGB IN (PC) Connection for RGB output from PC. COMPONENT IN Connection for component output from external device. MPI Enables an external MPI control device (i.e., clone programmer, VOD/PPV STB, etc.) to control the TV. SPEAKER OUT (8Ω) * Connect to 8 ohm self-powered speaker input. Intended for special applications, such as a powered bathroom speaker with volume control. * This stereo jack provides a mono speaker fixed-level, 1 watt output (audio +, audio -, w/ground shield). Do NOT plug in a mono connector, as this may damage the TV. 8 206-4185 Side Connections Panel / RF Antenna Connection A/V 2 Input L/MONO-AUDIO-R IN Connect to audio output jacks on external device. For only mono audio output, connect to Left audio input. VIDEO L/MONO -AUDIO- R USB IN Insert USB memory device for software updates, cloning purposes, or picture/music entertainment, as applicable. USB IN Side Connections Panel VIDEO IN Connect to video output port on external device (see Reference section, “TV Camport Auto Sense Operation,” for further information). AV IN 2 RF Antenna Connection Antenna or CATV ANTENNA IN 206-4185 ANTENNA IN Connect to Antenna/ CATV. 9 Installer Overview This is the Commercial Mode Setup Guide only. Installer Menu / Commercial Mode Setup xxLD330H PTC INSTALLER MENU To set up a Master TV for cloning purposes, you will need to know how to enter the TV Installer Menu and make changes to the default values as required. Similarly, to configure a TV’s Installer Menu settings in FTG Mode, you will need to know how to access and use the FTG Configuration Application utilities. If necessary, familiarize yourself with the Installer Menu and how to make and save changes. Refer to page 14 for information on accessing the Installer Menu in Pass-through Mode. Pages 15 to 20 describe Installer Menu items in detail. Refer to pages 29 to 37 for information on entering FTG Mode and using the FTG Configuration Application utilities. 000 INSTALLER SEQ 000 UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.06.00 Typical Installer Menu Installer Remote The LG Installer Remote is supplied with and dedicated to operate the TV. See next page for typical key functions. Some DVD and VCR controls may be available for selected LG DVD/VCR products. Cloning Cloning refers to the process of capturing a Master TV Setup and transferring it to a Target TV. The Master TV’s clonable features need to be configured as part of the Commercial Mode Setup. This is a critical step. If the Master TV’s clonable features—channel icons or labels, digital font options, etc.—are not set up correctly, the cloned TVs will all have problems. Pages 23 to 28 provide detailed information on cloning requirements and procedures. ALARM TIMER INPUT TV 1 4 7 2 5 8 0 INFO VOL 3 6 9 FLASHBK i PORTAL CH P A G E MUTE MENU GUIDE CC ENTER + A AA A AA + RETURN Installing Batteries in Installer Remote • Open the battery compartment cover on the back side of the remote. • Install two high-quality alkaline 1.5V AAA batteries. Never mix old or used batteries with new ones. Install batteries matching correct polarity as shown (+ with + and - with -). • Replace the battery compartment cover. 10 SAP EXIT EJECT RATIO 206-4185 Installer Remote Control Typical Key Functions The LG Installer Remote illustrated below and throughout this document shows typical remote control functions and is provided for reference only. This Installer Remote may vary from the Installer Remote supplied with the TV. POWER Turns TV ON or OFF. ALARM Sets the time when the TV will automatically turn itself ON. TIMER Sets the amount of time before the TV automatically turns itself OFF. INPUT Selects RGB, HDMI/DVI1, HDMI2, Component Input, AV1, and AV2 sources. TV Returns to the last TV channel (from an Aux input). ALARM TIMER PORTAL Displays and removes the interactive menu. MUTE Switches sound ON or OFF. NUMBER Buttons (0 - 9) & DASH Use to enter a program number or channel. Dash is used for sub-channel numbers such as 2-1, 2-2, 9-1, 9-2, 100-3, 100-4, etc. TV 1 4 7 VOLUME UP/DOWN Increases/decreases sound level. INFO Displays channel information. INPUT 2 5 8 0 INFO VOL 3 6 9 FLASHBK (FLASHBACK) Returns to the previously tuned channel. Arrows (Up/Down/Left/Right) & ENTER Use to navigate on-screen menus and adjust TV settings to your requirements. MENU Displays the TV setup menus on the screen. Also exits the on-screen menu system and returns to TV viewing. FLASHBK GUIDE Displays and removes the electronic program guide. i PORTAL CH P A G E MUTE MENU CHANNEL/PAGE UP/DOWN Changes the channel. Moves from one full set of screen information to the next. GUIDE CC Press to activate subtitles. CC RETURN Returns one level to the previous menu/ display. ENTER RETURN SAP SAP Analog Mode: Selects MTS sound (Mono, Stereo, or SAP). DTV Mode: Changes audio language, if additional languages are available. * EXIT EXIT Clears all on-screen displays and returns to TV viewing. Color buttons access special functions in some menus. DVD/VCR BUTTONS Controls some DVD players or video cassette recorders. EJECT Ejects a USB memory device, CD, DVD, VHS tape, as applicable. RATIO Adjusts the picture aspect ratio. EJECT RATIO * SAP notes: • • • 206-4185 If SAP is selected and no SAP is provided, sound may not be heard on channel. Each analog channel may have its own SAP setting. Digital channels will reset to default audio language with a power off/on. 11 Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV This section describes how to set up a Master TV for cloning purposes when the TV is in Pass-through Mode. Note: Disconnect all Aux inputs. Under certain conditions, Auto Tuning (Channel Search) is disabled if there is an Aux input active. Note: Refer to FTG Mode information on pages 29 to 37 for information on entering FTG Mode and configuring/editing FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings using the FTG Configuration Application. 1. Set Installer Menu items. This step provides specific instruction only on the Installer Menu items that should be set on a Master TV. Refer to pages 14 to 20 for detailed information on all Installer Menu items. a) Make sure the TV is ON. Then, use the Installer Remote to enter the TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. b) Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001 and press ENTER on the Installer Remote. This clears all Installer Menu custom settings, the channel lineup, etc. and reloads the factory default settings. The value will change back to 0 after the internal TV controller (Protocol Translator Card [PTC]) has been restored to factory default condition. This step ensures that the TV Channel Memory will be the active channel lineup. c) Set Installer Menu item 003 BAND/AFC, as appropriate. • Broadcast: Set to 000. • HRC: Set to 002. • CATV: Set to 001 (default). • IRC: Set to 003. xxLD330H PTC INSTALLER MENU 000 INSTALLER SEQ UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 2. Set up TV features. On-screen setup menus control the features of the TV (see page 21). Press MENU on the Installer Remote to access the setup menus, and then set Channel, Picture, Audio, Lock, Time, etc. options to the desired configurations. See also the Clonable Menu Features list on page 23. Note: If desired, you can run Auto Tuning (see step 3) prior to completing this step. ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.06.00 Typical TV Installer Menu Note: The Installer Menu header will vary depending on the TV you are setting up. 117 FACT DEFAULT 001 003 BAND/AFC 00X Adjust the settings for these Installer Menu items. d) Set any other Installer Menu items that affect your TV programming network to the required configuration. For example, enable/ disable Aux sources, set a Start Channel, etc. e) After you have adjusted all required Installer Menu item settings, press ENTER once on the Installer Remote to save your changes; then, press ENTER again to exit the menu. 000 CHANNEL PICTURE AUDIO TIME LOCK OPTION INPUT MY MEDIA Set the TV features to the desired configuration for the end user. 3. Run Auto Tuning (Channel Search). a) Search for all available analog and digital channels: Go to the Channel Menu, select the Auto Tuning option, and follow the on-screen instructions. (Continued on next page) 12 206-4185 Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV (Cont.) (Continued from previous page) 3. Run Auto Tuning (Channel Search). (continued) b) Use the Channel Edit option in the Channel Menu to edit the channel lineup, as necessary, to include free to guest channels only. • Add/delete channels per your system requirements. Note that if Installer Menu item 103 ATSC TUNE MODE is set for Physical Channel tuning (default and recommended setting), channels with minor channel numbers higher than 255 will not transfer correctly in step 4. If it is set for Virtual Channel tuning and either the major or minor channel numbers are higher than 255, the channel(s) will not transfer correctly in step 4. • Use the Channel Label option in the Channel Menu to add familiar channel trademarks/logos such as ABC, CBS, NBC, etc. to the Channel-Time on-screen display. Identifiable labels (logos) should enable the end user to readily know what common networks are available. (You can add the channel labels in this step, or you can add channel labels or logos for channels without icons in step 5.) 4. Transfer the TV Setup to the internal TV Controller (PTC): 2-5-5 + MENU Mode After the TV channel lineup has been edited and channel label icons added, enter the Installer Menu. Once in the Installer Menu, press 2-5-5 + MENU on the Installer Remote to initiate the transfer of the Master TV Setup to the PTC. The TV exits the Installer Menu and then tunes through the channels in the channel lineup during the transfer. When the transfer is complete, the TV tunes back to the channel that was tuned before the transfer began. Note: The maximum number of active channels that can be transferred is 141. An attempt to transfer more than 141 channels will result in erratic TV tuning operation. 5. Add Custom Channel and Aux Source Labels for Analog Channels: 2-5-4 + MENU Mode Enter the Installer Menu, and press 2-5-4 + MENU on the Installer Remote. Add/edit custom text labels to channel on-screen displays. Note that digital channels often have a broadcaster generated label (see 2-5-4 + MENU procedural information on page 22). When you are finished, press MENU to exit 2-5-4 + MENU Mode. CHANNEL Move Enter Auto Tuning Manual Tuning Channel Edit Channel Label Run Auto Tuning, edit channels, and select familiar channel trademarks/logos using Channel Menu options. 19-3 DIGITAL MONO STEREO SAP WXYZ Custom Text Label “WXYZ” created in 2-5-4 + MENU (Add Channel Label) Mode. 028 CH. OVERIDE 000 After verifying the TV Setup, set Installer Menu item 028 CH. OVERIDE to 000.* * This step prevents end users from accessing channel settings (i.e., the Channel Menu will be inaccessible/ grayed out). 6. Verify the TV setup. At this point, verify that the channel lineup, channel icons, and custom labels are correct. Make sure the TV features are set per your requirements. 7. Lock the channel lineup. Enter the Installer Menu. Set item 028 CH. OVERIDE to 000 and press ENTER to lock the channel lineup and restrict access to the TV setup menus. Press ENTER again to save your changes and exit the Installer Menu.* The Master TV Setup is now ready to be copied to a USB memory device or a clone programmer (see cloning information in this document). 206-4185 13 Installer Menu Use the Installer Menu to set up or change operational settings. Refer to the table starting on the next page for brief descriptions of Installer Menu items. More detailed descriptions follow the table listing. Accessing the Installer Menu 1. Make sure the TV is ON. 2. Using an Installer Remote, press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER to access the Installer Menu. The Installer Menu opens with item 000 INSTALLER SEQ 000. Using the Installer Menu Items 000 ~ 119 are accessible only upon entering the Installer Menu. Refer to the table on pages 15 and 16 for an overview of Installer Menu items, including item numbers, functions, ranges, and default values. Installer Menu items not relevant to this TV series are not present on the Installer Menu; therefore, some numbers are missing. For example, item 006 will not appear. xxLD330H PTC INSTALLER MENU 000 INSTALLER SEQ UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 000 ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.06.00 Typical TV Installer Menu Navigation within the Installer Menu Use the Up/Down arrow keys on the Installer Remote to sequence through the available menu items, or access an item directly by keying in the line number and then pressing MENU. For example, to access the SLEEP TIMER option, which is item 015, press 0-1-5 + MENU. Changing Installer Menu Settings To change an Installer Menu item setting, use the Left/Right arrow keys on the Installer Remote, or enter a value directly. Press ENTER to save the new setting, or use the Up/Down arrow keys to navigate to a new Installer Menu item if you have additional items to edit. Exiting the Installer Menu and Activating Updates After you have adjusted all required Installer Menu item settings, press ENTER once on the Installer Remote to save your changes; then, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. Any changes you make will be stored in non-volatile memory. Note: Each time you exit the Installer Menu, all V-Chip (Parental Control) settings in the TV are reset to their default values; that is, the Lock System, if previously enabled from the Lock setup menu (see the Owner’s Manual for additional information), will now be disabled, and the individual Parental Control settings will be restored to default values. 14 206-4185 Installer Menu (Cont.) Installer Menu Items 000 through 071 Menu Item Function Value Range Default Value Brief Description of Function and Comments 000 INSTALLER SEQ 0~3 0 Leave default set to 0. 001 POWER MANAGE 0~7 0 Sets number of hours of no activity before automatic shutoff. 002 AC ON 0/1 0 Set to 1 to enable Auto Turn ON when AC power is applied. 003 BAND/AFC 0~3 1 Selects Tuning Band: 0=Broadcast, 1=CATV, 2=HRC, 3=IRC 0 ~ 127, 255 255 Channel tuned when TV is turned ON. (Set to 255 to tune to channel tuned before TV turned OFF.) 0/1 0 If set to 1, cannot tune from current channel. 0 ~ 63, 255 255 Volume level when TV is turned ON. (Set to 255 to use volume level before TV turned OFF.) 004 STRT CHANNEL 005 CHAN LOCK 007 STRT VOLUME 008 MIN VOLUME 0 ~ 63 0 Sets minimum allowable volume setting. 009 MAX VOLUME 0 ~ 63 63 Sets maximum allowable volume setting. 010 MUTE DISABLE 0/1 0 Set to 1 to disable Mute Function. 011 KEY DEFEAT 0/1 0 Set to 1 to disable menu navigation keys on display panel. 015 SLEEP TIMER 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable Sleep Timer. 016 EN TIMER 0/1 0 Set to 1 to enable On/Off Timers. 017 ALARM 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable Alarm. 020 FEATURE LEVEL 0 ~ 1, 16 ~ 24 1 Determines an additional IR code scheme to which the TV will respond. 021 V-CHIP 022 MAX BLK HRS 023 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable V-Chip (Parental Control) functions. 0 ~ 99 12 Sets number of V-Chip blocking hours. CAPTION LOCK 0/1 0 Set to 1 to retain caption setting set before TV turned OFF. 028 CH. OVERIDE 0/1 1 If set to 0, limits direct access to favorite channels. 029 OLD OCV 0/1 0 Set to 1 to change MPI operation to OCV. 030 ACK MASK 0/1 0 If set to 1, changes MPI for some OCV boxes. 031 POLL RATE 20 ~ 169 94 Selects poll rate for MPI. 032 TIMING PULSE 186 ~ 227 207 Sets baud rate for MPI. 034 CAMPORT EN 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable Video 2 input. 035 COMPPORT EN. 0/1 1 Set to 0 to disable HDMI 1. Set to 1 enable HDMI 1. 038 YPrPb EN. 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable display panel Component Video 1 input jacks. 039 REAR AUX EN 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable display panel Video 1 input jack. 040 AUTO CAMPORT 0/1 1 Set to 1 to automatically switch to Camport. If set to 1, STRT AUX SRCE cannot be set to 2. 046 STRT AUX SRCE 1 ~ 6, 255 6 Sets the starting Aux source (if item 004 STRT CHANNEL is set to 0). 047 AUX STATUS 0/1 0 Set to 1 for MPI Aux source to be reported as a channel number instead of Channel 0. 053 DIS. CH-TIME 0/1 0 Set to 1 to disable Channel-Time display. 069 EN. CH-T COL. 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable custom color for the Channel-Time display. 070 FOR. CH-TIME 0~7 2 Chooses custom foreground color for the Channel-Time display. 071 BCK. CH-TIME 0~7 2 Chooses custom background color for the Channel-Time display. 206-4185 15 Installer Menu (Cont.) Installer Menu Items 073 through 119 Menu Item 16 Function Value Range Default Value Brief Description of Function and Comments 073 CH NOT AVBLE 0/1 0 If set to 1 and Channel Override is 0, “NOT AVAILABLE” message is displayed when directly accessing a channel not in the favorite Channel List. 075 REVERT CH 0/1 0 If set to 1 and loss of MPI communication occurs, TV tunes to Start Channel. 078 UPN MSB 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, most significant byte. 079 UPN MSB-1 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, most significant byte - 1. 080 UPN MSB-2 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, most significant byte - 2. 081 UPN LSB 0 ~ 255 0 User programmable number, least significant byte. 082 CHKSM ERROR 0/1 1 Enforces rigid MPI checksum. 083 HANDSHK TIME 0~5 5 Relaxes MPI timing to be compatible with PC-based Windowscontrolled systems. 084 PERMANENT BLK 0/1 0 Removes block hours setting for Parental Control and makes block permanent. 087 REAR RGB EN. 0 / 1 / 17 1 Set to 0 to disable RGB input. Set to 1 to enable RGB input. Set to 17 for Auto Configure. 088 EN NOISE MUTE 0/1 1 If set to 1, audio is muted if no signal is present. 090 KEY LOCK 0/1 0 If set to 1, keyboard is locked out, IR is still functional. 091 YPrPb2 EN 0/1 1 Set to 1 to enable HDMI 2 input. 094 SAP MENU EN 0/1 1 Set to 0 to disable feature on Function Menu. Set to 1 to enable feature on Function Menu. 096 DEF. ASP. RATIO 0~4 2 Sets default aspect ratio at power up. See detailed descriptions and item 106. 098 PRO:CENTRIC 0~2 0 Set to 0 to disable Pro:Centric operation. Set to 1 for Flash Mode. Set to 2 for GEM (Java Application) Mode. 099 BACK LIGHTING 1 ~ 100, 101 ~ 200, 255 100 Sets the level of the TV picture back lighting. (See detailed descriptions.) 102 ATSC BAND 0~4 4 Selects ATSC band. 103 ATSC TUNE MODE 0/1 1 Set to 1 (default) for Physical Channel scan. Set to 0 for Virtual Channel scan. 104 START MINOR CH 0 ~ 255 0 Selects Minor Start Channel. Set to 0 for NTSC. To retain set aspect ratio on power cycle, set to 1. Set to 0 for default ratio on power cycle. 106 ASP RATIO LOCK 0/1 0 116 VIDEO MUTE EN 0/1 0 Set to 0 for Normal. Set to 1 for Blank. 117 FACT DEFAULT 0/1 0 Set to 0 for Normal. Set to 1 to load presets for all Installer Menu settings. 119 DATA CHANNEL 0 ~ 135 0 Set to 0 to disable. Set to the RF channel number of the Data Channel for Pro:Centric or E-Z Installation data. (See detailed descriptions.) 206-4185 Installer Menu (Cont.) Detailed Descriptions of Installer Menu Items 000 - INSTALLER SEQUENCE Specifies entry sequence to the Installer Menu. 0 = 9876 2 = 1478 To translate a TV volume level to the Installer Menu value, use the following formula: 1 = 4321 3 = 3698 001 - POWER MANAGE (Power Management) Determines hours of no activity before automatic shutoff. The Power Management function is for saving energy. If set to 0, Power Manage is Off. Settings range from 0 ~ 7, with 1 ~ 7 representing the hours that the unit will remain ON, unless there has been activity from either the control panel or remote control. 002 - AC ON (AC Power Switchable) If set to 1, this allows the TV to turn ON when AC power is applied. Pressing the ON button is not necessary. This is desirable if the TV is plugged into a cable box or a power outlet controlled by a wall switch. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to choose 0 or 1, where 0 is the default (OFF), and 1 is ON. Note: If set to 1 (ON), the TV does not respond to On/Off commands from either the remote or the display control panel, and the SLEEP TIMER is also nonfunctional. 003 - BAND/AFC (Band/Automatic Frequency Control) There are four possible settings for this option: 0 = Broadcast 2 = HRC NOTE: For items 007, 008, and 009 For legacy reasons, the scale used is 0 – 63. The PTC software will translate this to the 0 – 100 scale used by the TV. 1 = CATV (default) 3 = IRC If some channels were not found by Auto Tuning (Channel Search), select the appropriate Band setting here, and add the channels using the Channel Edit option in the Channel Menu. 004 - STRT CHANNEL (Start Channel) If active, this function allows you to determine the initial Major Start Channel number when the TV is turned ON. This feature is useful for an in-house information channel, since the TV would always select that channel when it is turned ON. Setting this item to 255 causes the last channel viewed when the TV was turned OFF, to be the tuned to channel when the TV is turned ON again. Installer Value = TV Value x 63 100 Enter only the whole number (disregard fractions). 007 - STRT VOLUME (Start Volume) This function allows the Installer to determine the initial volume level setting when the TV is turned ON. This feature is useful for an in-house information channel, since the TV would always select that volume level when it is turned ON. The range of values are 0 - 63, 255. If 255 is selected, the current volume level will be retained in memory when the TV is turned OFF; at turn ON, the volume level will be automatically set at the previous or last level. 008 - MIN VOLUME (Minimum Volume) This function determines the minimum volume level allowable with the Volume (VOL) Up/Down control. In this way, for example, someone cannot set the volume too low to hear. The value range is from 0 to 63. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to change values. The factory default is 0, which provides the full range of volume control, if item 009 MAX VOLUME is also set to 63. It may be best to set the same value on every TV. Note: The minimum volume level cannot have a value setting higher than the maximum volume level (described below). 009 - MAX VOLUME (Maximum Volume) This function determines the maximum volume level allowable with the Volume (VOL) Up/Down control. In this way, for example, someone cannot set the volume level high enough to disturb others. The value range is 0 to 63, with 63 as the default, which gives the user the full range of volume control, if item 008 MIN VOLUME is also set at 0. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to change values. It may be best to set the same value on every TV. Note: For a digital Start Channel, always remember to set item 104 to the Minor Start Channel number. Note: The maximum volume level cannot have a value setting lower than the minimum volume level (described above). 255 = Last channel 126 = Map to Channel 3 010 - MUTE DISABLE Enables or disables sound mute function. If set to 1, sound cannot be muted. If set to 0, sound can be muted. 1 ~ 125 = Major Ch. # 127 = Map to Channel 4 0 = Aux 005 - CHAN LOCK (Channel Lock) Channel Lock is ideal if the system must always be on the same channel. Changing channels with the Channel Up/Down or keypad numbers is impossible. Channel Lock is inactive if set to 0 (default). Generally, this feature is used in connection with STRT CHANNEL (Installer Menu item 004) where the Start Channel may, for example, be set to 3 or 4. If the Start Channel is 3, then the TV will remain locked on channel 3. 206-4185 011 - KEY DEFEAT (Keyboard Defeat) If set to 1, KEY DEFEAT prevents the end user from accessing the on-screen menus from the display panel—MENU, ENTER, and menu navigation keys do not function. If set to 0, those keys do function. Note: Users can always access the menus by pressing MENU on the remote. 17 Installer Menu (Cont.) 015 - SLEEP TIMER If set to 1, the Sleep Timer feature may be used. If set to 0, the Sleep Timer is not available. 016 - EN TIMER (Enable On/Off Timers) * If set to 1, the Timer function is available to the end user and enabled continuously. Set to 0 to disable On/Off timers. Note: Clock must be set in order to use timers. 017 - ALARM * Gives the installer the option of making the Alarm function available to the end user. If set to 1, the Alarm function is available to the end user. Set to 0 to disable the Alarm function. Note: Clock must be set before the Alarm function will work. 020 - FEATURE LEVEL Determines an additional IR code scheme to which the TV will respond, allowing for the use of unique IR codes based on “bed number” in a multi-TV single room installation. First determine the IR mode; then select the bed number. Bed # Values Legacy (Hospital) IR Mode 1–2 0–1 Multi-code Remote 1–9 16 – 24 Note: Multi-code remotes are not available for the current release. For additional information, contact your LG representative. 021 - V-CHIP (Parental Control) * Set to 1 to activate V-Chip (Parental Control) and have it available to the end user to filter and control or otherwise restrict programming content that can appear. Set to 0 to turn the V-Chip feature Off (not available to user); no programming restrictions can be set. 022 - MAX BLK HRS (Maximum Block Hours) * Sets hours from 0 to 99 for the maximum V-Chip (Parental Control) block hours. Default setting is for 12 blocking hours. 023 - CAPTION LOCK If set to 0, captions are OFF when the TV is turned ON. Set to 1 to use the caption setting configured before the TV was turned OFF when the TV is turned ON. 028 - CH. OVERIDE (Channel Override) If set to 1, the user can select channels with either Channel Up/ Down or by direct keypad entry. If set to 0, only those channels that are active in the TV’s memory can be selected. 029 - OLD OCV (On Command Video™) Set to 1 for operation with systems from On Command Corporation. 030 - ACK MASK MPI Communication Parameter. Leave at default setting unless changed by PPV provider. When set to 1, changes MPI for some OCV boxes. 031 - POLL RATE MPI Communication Parameter. Selects Poll Rate for MPI. Leave at default setting unless changed by Pay-Per-View provider. Step size of 16 ms. 032 - TIMING PULSE MPI Communication Parameter. Leave at default setting unless changed by Pay-Per-View provider. Sets baud rate. Step size of 4.3 uS. 034 - CAMPORT EN. (Camera Port Enable) Set to 1 to enable Video 2 input on display panel. If set to 0, Video 2 input on display panel is not functional. 035 - COMPPORT EN. (Computer Port Enable) Enable/disable TV display panel HDMI 1 input jack. Set to 0 to disable HDMI1. Set to 1 to enable HDMI1. 038 - YPrPb EN. (Rear Component Video Enable) Set to 1 to enable display panel rear Component Video input jacks. Set to 0 to disable display panel rear Component Video input jacks. 039 - REAR AUX EN. (Rear Aux Enable) Set to 1 to enable display panel rear Aux (Video 1) input. Set to 0 to disable display panel rear Aux (Video 1) input. 040 - AUTO CAMPORT Set to 1 to automatically switch to Camport when equipment is connected to side Video input. Set to 0 to disable side Video automatic source selection. If set to 1, STRT AUX SRCE cannot be set to 2. 046 - STRT AUX SRCE (Start Aux Source) Sets the starting Aux source. When turned ON, the TV will tune to starting Aux source if item 004 STRT CHANNEL is set to 0. If item 040 AUTO CAMPORT is set to 0: 1 = Video 1 4 = RGB 255 = Last Aux 2 = Video 2 5 = HDMI 2 3 = HDMI 1 6 = Component If item 040 AUTO CAMPORT is set to 1: 1 = Video 1 4 = RGB 6 = Component 3 = HDMI 1 5 = HDMI 2 047 - AUX STATUS Set to 1 for MPI Aux source to be reported as a channel number instead of channel 0. Set to 0 to disable Aux identification change. Controls MPI status channel response for Aux inputs. * Only affects Function Menu if enabled by some PPV providers. 18 206-4185 Installer Menu (Cont.) 053 - DIS. CH-TIME (Disable Channel-Time) Set to 1 to disable the Channel-Time display; Channel-Time display will not appear. Set to 0 to enable the Channel-Time display. 069 - EN. CH-T COL. (Enable Channel-Time Custom Color) Set to 1 to enable custom color for the Channel-Time display. Set to 0 to disable custom color for the Channel-Time display. 070 - FOR. CH-TIME (Channel-Time Display Foreground Color) Set according to Color Chart: 0 = Black 3 = Cyan 6 = Yellow 1 = Blue 4 = Red 7 = White 2 = Green 5 = Violet Note: Applies only to “Channel Not Available” message if item 073 is set to 1 (enabled). If foreground color and background color are the same, the menu background will be transparent. 071 - BCK. CH-TIME (Channel-Time Display Background Color) Set according to Color Chart: 0 = Black 3 = Cyan 6 = Yellow 1 = Blue 4 = Red 7 = White 2 = Green 5 = Violet Note: Applies only to “Channel Not Available” message if item 073 is set to 1 (enabled). If foreground color and background color are the same, the menu background will be transparent. 073 - CH NOT AVBLE (Channel Not Available) If set to 1 and item 028 CH. OVERIDE is set to 0, a “NOT AVAILABLE” message is displayed when directly accessing a channel not in the channel scan list available in memory. 075 - REVERT CH (Revert to Start Channel) If set to 1 and loss of MPI communication occurs, TV automatically tunes to the specified Start Channel. 078 - UPN MSB (UPN Most Significant Byte) User programmable number, most significant byte readable by MPI command. Note: Not linked to serial number. 079 - UPN MSB-1 (UPN Most Significant Byte-1) User programmable number, most significant byte-1 readable by MPI command. Note: Not linked to serial number. 080 - UPN MSB-2 (UPN Most Significant Byte-2) User programmable number, most significant byte-2 readable by MPI command. Note: Not linked to serial number. 081 - UPN LSB (UPN Least Significant Byte) User programmable number, least significant byte readable by MPI command. Note: Not linked to serial number. 206-4185 082 - CHKSM ERROR (Checksum Error) Enforces rigid MPI checksum validation. Set to 1 for validation. Set to 0 to disable (does not check checksum on MPI async port). SPI is always checked. 083 - HANDSHK TIME (Handshake Time) Adds an additional delay to the handshake time which is 64 msec, thus relaxing MPI timing requirements to be compatible with PCbased Windows controlled systems. Range is 0 - 5. (Timeout = 25.5MS + [25.5 MS* Handshake time].) 084 - PERMANENT BLK (Permanent Block) Allows Lock (Parental Control) blocking schemes to be permanent by disabling the blocking hours function. Set to 1 to install Parental Control restrictions permanently. Set to 0 for user-specified hours control of blocking schemes. 087 - REAR RGB EN. (Rear RGB Enable) Controls access to rear RGB input on TV. Set to 0 to disable RGB input. Set to 1 to enable RGB input. Set to 17 to initiate a onetime automatic configuration after an AC power cycle; otherwise, automatic adjustment will be performed each time the RGB input is accessed. 088 - EN NOISE MUTE (Enable Noise Mute) If set to 1, audio mutes if no signal is present. 090 - KEY LOCK If set to 1, display panel Channel, Volume, and Captions buttons are disabled, Power button remains enabled. If set to 0, the Channel, Volume, Captions, and Power buttons are all enabled. 091 - YPrPb2 EN. (HDMI2 Enable) Set to 0 to disable display panel HDMI2 input. Set to 1 to enable DTV mode. Set to 2 to enable PC mode. 094 - SAP MENU EN (2nd Audio Program) Set to 1 to enable SAP feature on Function Menu, if Function Menu is available. Set to 0 to disable SAP feature on Function Menu, if Function Menu is available. 096 - DEF. ASP. RATIO (Default Aspect Ratio) Selects default aspect ratio at power up. • • • • • Set to 0 for Set By System. Set to 1 for 4:3. Set to 2 for 16:9 (Factory Default). Set to 3 for Just Scan. Set to 4 for Zoom. Note: Only applies if item 106 ASP RATIO LOCK is disabled, set to 0. 19 Installer Menu (Cont.) 098 - PRO:CENTRIC Selects the Pro:Centric Mode. Set to 0 (default) to disable Pro:Centric operation. Set to 1 for Flash Mode. Set to 2 for GEM (Java Application) Mode. 106 - ASP RATIO LOCK (Aspect Ratio Lock) Set to 1 to retain previous aspect ratio with power off. Set to 0 to retain default aspect ratio with power off. See item 096 DEF. ASP. RATIO above. 099 - BACK LIGHTING Sets the TV screen brightness at power up. Default setting is 100. 116 - VIDEO MUTE EN (Video Mute Enable) Set to 0 for Normal. Set to 1 for Blank. • 1 - 100 Static Back Lighting (1 = Dimmest picture, 100 = Brightest picture) • 101 - 200 Dynamic Back Lighting (101 = Dimmest picture, 200 = Brightest picture) If set between 101 and 200, the TV automatically controls back lighting depending upon the picture level of the current program. If set to 255, back lighting is controlled via the Picture settings in the TV’s setup menus. 102 - ATSC BAND Sets up TV to receive different types of incoming signals: 0 = Broadcast, 1 = CATV, 2 = HRC, 3 = IRC, 4 = Same as NTSC. 103 - ATSC TUNE MODE Sets ATSC tuning mode. Default set to 1 for Physical Channel scan. Set to 0 for Virtual Channel scan. 104 - START MINOR CHANNEL Sets Minor Start Channel number at power up. 0 = NTSC. If not 0, number selected is the digital channel’s Minor Start Channel number. 20 117 - FACT DEFAULT (Factory Default) Set to 0 for normal. Set to 1 to load presets of all Installer Menu item settings. Warning: If set to 1, this will reload the factory defaults and clear the channel lineup, including any assigned channel icons and custom channel labels. 119 - DATA CHANNEL Set to 0 (default) to disable. Set to the RF channel number of the Data Channel for Pro:Centric or E-Z Installation (splash screen, configuration, or firmware) data. Note: Pro:Centric updates are downloaded from the Pro:Centric server to the TV when the TV is turned OFF. Also, while Pro:Centric updates are in progress, it is not possible to turn the TV ON. The TV may take several minutes to load EPG data after the initial download of the Pro:Centric application. Subsequent updates generally will take less than one minute. 206-4185 TV Setup Menus Overview On-screen setup menus control the features of the TV. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to access the TV setup menus, and set the TV features to the desired configuration for the end user. CHANNEL PICTURE AUDIO TIME LOCK OPTION INPUT MY MEDIA Refer to the Owner’s Manual for further information on the TV setup menus. 206-4185 21 Adding Channel Icons / Custom Channel Labels (2-5-4 + MENU Mode) Editing/Adding Channel Icons and/or Labels If there is no pre-assigned icon, you can make a custom channel label of up to seven (7) characters to help identify a channel or network. If desired, channel labels can also be added in addition to a pre-assigned icon. You may also add labels for the Aux input sources to clearly identify the devices that are connected to the Aux inputs. (Icon) XYZ XYZ XYZ NETWORK 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 (Label) Editing and adding the labels can only be done if there are channels entered into the TV’s Channel Map either during Commercial Mode Setup (see pages 12 to 13), by cloning, or by using some PPV providers’ master remote controls. Note: A blank letter space is available between “Z” and “!”. To perform channel editing/labeling: 1. Enter the TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 2. Press 2-5-4 + MENU on the Installer Remote to enter the Channel Label Editing Mode. 3. Add channel icons and channel labels as described in the procedures below. (You can do this more than once.) 4. To exit the menu when you are done, press MENU. Changing a Channel’s Icon on the Master TV Changing/Adding Channel Labels on the Master TV Changing Source Labels on the Master TV 1. Use Channel Up/Down to select the desired channel. 1. Use Channel Up/Down to select the desired channel. 2. Use the Left/Right arrow keys to select the thin letter “I” on the Channel ID display. 2. Press the Left or Right arrow repeatedly until the numbers 1 to 7 appear on the display. The number shows the position of the character that can be changed. Number 1 is the first character, number 2 the second character, etc. 1. Press INPUT to select the desired Aux input source: A/V 1, A/V 2, HDMI Component, RGB, etc. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the icon with which you want to identify the channel. (If you know the icon number, enter the number, and press ENTER.) 4. Proceed to change/add channel labels, or go to the next channel. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the desired character. 4. Proceed to the next number position, or use Channel Up/Down to go to the next channel. 2. Press the Left or Right arrow repeatedly until the numbers 0 to 9 appear on the display. The number shows the position of the character that can be changed. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the desired character. 4. Press INPUT for the next Aux source, or use Channel Up/Down to return to channels. Installer Remote Control Key Functions for Master TV Channel Editing/Labeling Menu • Channel Up/Down: Tunes to the next channel in scan. • Left/Right Arrows: Select the item to change. If “I” is shown, the icon can be changed. If a number is shown, it indicates the position of the character that can be changed. • Up/Down Arrows: Select the icon or the character to be displayed. Tip: Arrows can be held down for fast scrolling. 22 • 0 – 9: Use to enter the index number of the icon, if known. • ENTER: Changes the icon after the number has been entered. • INPUT: Changes the Aux input label. • MENU: Exits the editing process. 206-4185 Cloning Overview / Clonable Menu Features IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION There are three options for cloning a Master TV Setup: • Using a USB memory device • Using a TLL-1100A clone programmer • Using a LT2002 clone programmer Each option is described in further detail on the pages that follow. As you perform cloning procedures, be sure to complete each task as indicated. If a procedure or step is omitted or not performed completely, cloning may not work. At each step, pay attention to ensure the TV screen shows the proper message when cloning. If the message indicated does not appear, there is a problem with that step, and cloning may not be successful. Warning: Copying a blank or incorrect memory into a TV will cause the TV to operate erratically or become inoperable. Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs, as this will damage the clone programmer and the PPV card. Before you begin cloning: • Complete the Commercial Mode Setup for Master TV procedure on pages 12 to 13. • All equipment should be connected to power and turned ON. • Both the Master and Target TVs must be in Pass-through Mode. • Ensure Installer Menu items on Target TVs are set/restored to factory default settings (i.e., set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001 on Target TVs) before Teaching is initiated. • Learning and Teaching is only possible between identical model TVs. • If using a USB memory device, ensure the USB device has been formatted with FAT format. • For both Master and Target TVs—If using a clone programmer, ensure the TV signal source is either an Aux or TV (RF) source. If a TV (RF) source, the TV must be tuned to an analog (not a digital) channel. • LT2002 only—Make sure the batteries in the clone programmer are fresh. If batteries are removed, the clone programmer clock time (if set) will be lost (see page 28 for information on the clone programmer clock). • Do not unplug the TV power cord or remove/disconnect the USB memory device/clone programmer while Learning or Teaching, as doing so may cause the TV to malfunction or harm the USB device/ clone programmer, respectively. Clonable Menu Features Installer Menu Installer Menu item settings Channel Auto Tuning (Channel Lineup) Manual Tuning Channel Edit Channel Label Picture Aspect Ratio Picture Mode Audio Auto Volume Clear Voice Sound Mode Balance TV Speaker Option Menu Language Audio Language Caption Set ID Lock Movie Rating TV Rating – Children TV Rating – General Time Auto Clock Auto Off (Sleep Timer) Note: Some menu options vary between analog and digital channels and Aux sources. 206-4185 23 Cloning Procedures Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a USB Memory Device USB Cloning Notes • Read the IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 23 before beginning any cloning procedures. • You may edit a filename as part of the Learning procedure; however, a file with edited contents will not be recognized. • It is not possible to clone a Master TV’s clock using a USB memory device. Either set a Target TV’s clock manually, or use the Auto Clock setting in the TV setup menus. Learn Setup from Master TV 1. Ensure the Master TV is set up completely and in Pass-through Mode. 2. Plug the USB memory device into the USB IN port on the Master TV. 3. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to display the TV setup menus, use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight the Option menu icon, and then press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. USB Download Menu Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Learn From TV (TLL) Learn From TV (FMA) 4. To gain access to the “Learn From TV” option in the USB Download Menu, key in the password used to enter the Installer Menu (Example: Press 9-8-7-6). 7. Remove the USB memory device from the Master TV. Teach Master TV Setup to Target TV 1. Ensure the Target TV is in Pass-through Mode, and then use the Installer Remote to enter the Target TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 2. Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001, and press ENTER. When the value changes back to 0, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. 3. Plug the USB memory device with the Master TV Setup file into the Target TV USB IN port. 4. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to display the TV setup menus, use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight the Option menu icon, and then press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. Learn From TV (TLL) Select the file name and press OK to start xxLD330H-UA00001.TLL ► 6. To identify the profile from others, you can use the Up/Down arrow keys to change the last five digits of the filename. Press ENTER when you are ready to initiate Learning. Learning status will be shown on the progress bar. When the Learning process is complete, the USB Download menu will reappear on screen. Return ! 7. When Teaching is done, remove the USB memory device from the Target TV, turn OFF the TV, and unplug the TV power cord for 15 seconds. 8. Reconnect the TV power cord, and turn ON the TV. The Master TV Setup should be resident on the Target TV. 24 Enter Learn From TV UPDATING... 25% Do not remove the USB from the port! Do not unplug! USB Download Menu Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Return Enter Teach To TV (TLL) 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Teach To TV (TLL), and then press ENTER. 6. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the Master TV Setup you want to install, and then press ENTER. Note: Filenames identify the TV and the TLL version (see example at right). Teaching status will be shown on the progress bar. When the Teaching process is complete, the USB Download menu will reappear on screen. Enter ► 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Learn From TV (TLL), and then press ENTER. Return xxLD330H-UA00001.TLL Return ! Enter Teach To TV UPDATING... 50% Do not remove the USB from the port! Do not unplug! 206-4185 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a TLL-1100A Clone Programmer Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs, as this will damage the clone programmer and the PPV card. TLL-1100A Cloning Notes • Read the IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 23 before beginning any cloning procedures. • Ensure the TLL-1100A is either fully charged or connected to AC power. • Learning and Teaching is only possible between identical model TVs; however, the TLL-1100A clone programmer can store up to eight different Master TV Setups. TLL-1100A Clone Programmer TV Link Loader CHARGE Cloning is accomplished using the TV/ clone programmer MPI ports for communication (see figure). TLL1100A Ready Antenna or CATV MODE CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP MPI Cable MENU ENTER SEND RECEIVE TLL-1100A Learn Setup from Master TV 1. Ensure the Master TV is set up completely and in Pass-through Mode. 2. If an analog channel is not available, direct tune the TV to an Aux source, or select an Aux source, such as AV-1, from the Input Menu. Then, plug one end of the MPI cable into the TV MPI port. 3. Turn ON the TLL-1100A. 4. Use the MODE button on the TLL-1100A to select Clone Mode. 5. Use the Left/Right arrows on the TLL-1100A to select the Memory CBank (1 to 8) in which to store the Master TV Setup. 6. Plug the other end of the MPI cable into the MPI port on the bottom of the TLL-1100A. The Clone Selection Menu will display on the TV screen. 7. Press 1 on the Installer Remote to select LEARN FROM TV from the Clone Selection Menu. Then, press ENTER to transfer the Master TV Setup into CBankX on the TLL-1100A. Learning usually takes about 90 seconds. “LEARNING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen while the TLL-1100A copies the Master Setup. When the Learning process is complete, a “LEARNING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. 8. When Learning is complete, disconnect the MPI cable from the Master TV. 206-4185 CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX THE CLONE IS VERSION VX.X.X - To change menu items, press channel keys or digits. - To execute item, press Enter. 25 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using a TLL-1100A Clone Programmer (Cont.) (Optional) Set the Clock Set the time on a Master TV’s clock. (If the time has already been copied from a TV into the TLL-1100A clone programmer, you can set the Master TV’s clock by copying the time from the clone programmer.) The TLL-1100A can copy the current time to both a Master TV and to the clone’s internal clock— accurate to within one minute. Since the TLL-1100A’s time cannot be set directly, the current time needs to be copied from an LG TV equipped with an enabled MPI port. After the time is copied to the TLL-1100A clone programmer, the current time will be maintained and can then be transferred to another TV. (This can be a Master TV or another TV which has already had the features set up.) Teach Master TV Setup to Target TV CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX THE CLONE IS VERSION VX.X.X - To change menu items, press channel keys or digits. - To execute item, press Enter. 1. Ensure the Target TV is in Pass-through Mode, and then use the Installer Remote to enter the Target TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 2. Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001, and press ENTER. When the value changes back to 0, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. 3. Tune/set the TV to an analog channel or Aux source, and then connect the MPI cable to the MPI port on the Target TV. The Clone Selection Menu will display on the TV screen. 4. Ensure the correct Memory CBank(X) is selected on the TLL-1100A. 5. Press 2 on the Installer Remote to select TEACH TO TV from the Clone Selection Menu. Then, press ENTER to transfer the Master TV Setup to the Target TV. Teaching usually takes 3 to 4 minutes. “TEACHING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen during Teaching. When the Teaching process is complete, a “TEACHING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. 6. When Teaching is done, disconnect the MPI cable from the Target TV, turn OFF the TV, and unplug the TV power cord for 15 seconds. 7. Reconnect the TV power cord, and turn ON the TV. The Master TV Setup should be resident on the Target TV. 26 CLONE SELECTION MENU Selected Bank: CBankX Saved (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) TEACH TO TV (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX THE CLONE IS VERSION VX.X.X - To change menu items, press channel keys or digits. - To execute item, press Enter. 206-4185 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using an LT2002 Clone Programmer Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs, as this will damage the clone programmer and the PPV card. Cloning is accomplished using the TV/clone programmer MPI ports for communication (see figure). LT2002 Cloning Notes • Read the IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 23 before beginning any cloning procedures. • A slow flashing green light indicates that there are communication problems between the TV and the LT2002 clone programmer. If this is the case, check for a damaged cable, poor contacts, or other connection troubles. • If the status indicator is red, the LT2002 batteries are low and should be replaced. Install four (4) high-quality alkaline AA batteries. • Learning and Teaching is only possible between identical model TVs; however, the LT2002 clone programmer can store up to three different Master TV Setups. MPI Cable Antenna or CATV Ferrite Core (TDK, ZCAT 2035-0930) Connect cable to TV MPI Jack and follow on screen instructions Status Indicator MPI Color battery ok battery low • green • red Reset Blink pattern • slow power on no communications • heartbeat power on communications ok THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF THE TV THE CLONE IS VERSION XX THE TV IS VERSION XX THE SW IS REViSION XX CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX ® QuickSet II Programmer LT2002 - PRESS ANY KEY TO CONTINUE LT2002 Clone Programmer ZENITH ELECTRONICS CORPORATION, LINCOLNSHIRE, ILLINOIS, USA Learn Setup from Master TV THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF THE TV 1. Ensure the Master TV is set up completely and in Pass-through Mode. THE CLONE IS VERSION XX THE TV IS VERSION XX THE SW IS REVISION XX 2. If an analog channel is not available, direct tune the TV to an Aux source, or select an Aux source, such as AV-1, from the Input Menu. Then, plug one end of the MPI cable into the TV MPI port. 3. If there is a good connection after the LT2002 is connected to the TV MPI port, “THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF THE TV” message will appear on the TV screen. Press any key on the Installer Remote to access the LT2002 Clone Selection Menu. 4. Press 1 on the Installer Remote to select LEARN FROM TV from the Clone Selection Menu; then press ENTER to proceed to the Memory Bank Selection Menu (see sample screen on next page). 5. Press 1, 2, or 3 on the Installer Remote to select the clone Memory Bank in which to store the Master Setup. Then, press ENTER. Note: If you choose a Memory Bank that already has a Master device’s setup programmed into it, that setup will be overwritten by the new Master TV Setup. (Continued on next page) 206-4185 CLONE CLOCK = XX:XX TV CLOCK = XX:XX - PRESS ANY KEY TO CONTINUE. - DISCONNECT CLONE WHEN DONE. CLONE SELECTION MENU (1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) LEARN FROM TV TEACH TO TV SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE DISPLAY TV SETUP DISPLAY CLONE SETUP - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. 27 Cloning Procedures (Cont.) Learning / Teaching a Master TV Setup using an LT2002 Clone Programmer (Cont.) (Continued from previous page) 6. Verify the Learning setup information on the next screen, and then press POWER to transfer the Master TV Setup into the selected Memory Bank on the LT2002. Learning usually takes about 90 seconds. “LEARNING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen while the LT2002 copies the Master Setup. When the Learning process is complete, a “LEARNING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. 7. When Learning is complete, disconnect the MPI cable from the Master TV. (Optional) Set the Clock Set the time on a Master TV’s clock. (If the time has already been copied from a TV into the LT2002 clone programmer, you can set the Master TV’s clock by copying the time from the clone programmer.) The LT2002 can copy the current time to both a Master TV and to the clone’s internal clock—accurate to within one minute. (Another reason that the LT2002 should be equipped with fresh, high-quality alkaline batteries, is for it to keep the time as accurately as possible.) Since the LT2002’s time cannot be set directly, the current time needs to be copied from an LG TV equipped with an enabled MPI port. After the time is copied to the LT2002 clone programmer, the current time will be maintained and can then be transferred to another TV. (This can be a Master TV or another TV which has already had the features set up.) SAVE TV SETUP IN SELECTED CLONE MEMORY (1) (2) (3) (4) MEMORY 1 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 2 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 3 VER XX REV XX RETURN TO CLONE MENU - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. COPY SELECTED CLONE MEMORY TO TV CLONE SELECTION MENU (1) MEMORY 1 VER XX REV XX (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) MEMORY 2 VER XX REV XX (2) TEACH TO TV (3) MEMORY 3 VER XX REV XX (3) SET CLONE CLOCK FROM TV (4) RETURN TO CLONE MENU (4) SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE (5) DISPLAY TV SETUP (6) DISPLAY CLONE SETUP - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. Teach Master TV Setup to Target TV 1. Ensure the Target TV is in Pass-through Mode, and then use the Installer Remote to enter the Target TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 2. Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001, and press ENTER. When the value changes back to 0, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. 3. Tune/set the TV to an analog channel or Aux source, and then connect the MPI cable to the MPI port on the Target TV. 4. With “THE CLONE HAS CONTROL OF TV” message on display, press 2 on the Installer Remote to select TEACH TO TV from the LT2002 Clone Selection Menu. Then, press ENTER. 5. Select the LT2002 Memory Bank in which the new Master TV Setup is located, and press ENTER. 6. Verify the Teaching setup information on the next screen, and then press POWER to transfer the Master TV Setup to the Target TV. Teaching usually takes 3 to 4 minutes. “TEACHING IN PROGRESS” will be displayed on the screen during Teaching. When the Teaching process is complete, a “TEACHING COMPLETE” message will be displayed. 7. When Teaching is done, disconnect the MPI cable from the Target TV, turn OFF the TV, and unplug the TV power cord for 15 seconds. 8. Reconnect the TV power cord, and turn ON the TV. The Master TV Setup should be resident on the Target TV. 28 CLONE SELECTION MENU SAVE TV SETUP IN SELECTED CLONE MEMORY (1) LEARN FROM TV (2) (1) (3) (2) (4) (3) (5) (4) (6) TEACH TO TV MEMORY 1 CLOCK VER XX FROM REV XX SET CLONE TV MEMORY 2 VER XX REV XX SET TV CLOCK FROM CLONE MEMORYTV 3 VER XX REV XX DISPLAY SETUP RETURN CLONE TO CLONE MENU DISPLAY SETUP - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS - CHANNEL TO CHANGE MENU KEYS OR ITEMS, DIGITS.PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, - POWER, TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, OR ENTER. POWER, OR ENTER. COPY SELECTED CLONE MEMORY TO TV (1) (2) (3) (4) MEMORY 1 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 2 VER XX REV XX MEMORY 3 VER XX REV XX RETURN TO CLONE MENU - TO CHANGE MENU ITEMS, PRESS CHANNEL KEYS OR DIGITS. - TO EXECUTE ITEM, PRESS ON/OFF, POWER, OR ENTER. 206-4185 FTG Mode of Operation FTG Mode Overview FTG Mode enables Pro:Idiom decryption and also allows logical channel mapping of physical channels. This section describes how to configure the TV’s CPU for FTG Mode operation. Use one of the following processes to configure the CPU with FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings: • Configure an individual LD330H/LD333H TV via its USB port using an FMA Configuration (.fma) file on a USB memory device. The “Teach to TV (FMA)” process, along with associated procedures, is described on pages 30 to 33. • Configure all LD330H/LD333H TVs at the site using a Pro:Centric server head end device (Example: PCS150R). Load an FMA Configuration (.fma) file on the Pro:Centric server using the TV E-Z Installation “Configuration” option in the Pro:Centric Server Admin Client. Refer to the Pro:Centric™ Server Admin Client User Guide for further information. While the TV is in FTG Mode: • Users can still access the Installer Menu using an LG Installer Remote; however, all Installer Menu items will be read-only. • Any FTG configuration changes must be made in the FTG Configuration Application. FTG Channel Map Configuration and FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utilities enable you to make changes, respectively, to the FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings as necessary. • If it becomes necessary to reset the TV to Pass-through Mode, there are several options that will enable you to do so. Refer to Reference section, “Resetting a TV to Pass-through Mode,” for further information. Pages 34 to 37 provide overviews of the FTG Channel Map, FTG Installer Menu, and FMA Configuration Utilities that comprise the FTG Configuration Application. Refer to the Free-To-Guest (FTG Configuration Application manual for further information on the FTG Configuration Application. Note: The LD330H/LD333H cannot be configured for FTG Mode if an external MPI device has been implemented as a means of controlling the TV. Determining the TV Operating Mode To determine the operating mode of the TV, press MENU on the Installer Remote. The menu display alternates based on the operating mode. See examples at right. ASPECT RATIO Enter Set By Program 4:3 ABC 16:9 Zoom If the end user Function Menu appears, the TV is in FTG Mode. If the TV setup menus appear, the TV is in Pass-through Mode. 206-4185 Move Just Scan CHANNEL PICTURE AUDIO TIME LOCK OPTION INPUT MY MEDIA Function Menu Indicates the TV CPU is in FTG Mode. While the TV is in FTG Mode, Installer Menu settings can be accessed as read-only using an Installer Remote. To make changes, use the FTG Configuration Application. TV Setup Menus Shows that the TV is in Pass-through Mode. 29 FTG Mode of Operation (Cont.) Creating an FMA Configuration File using the FTG Configuration Application This section describes how to create an FMA Configuration file that can be saved to a USB memory device. In order to enable Pro:Idiom decryption, it is recommended that you create an FMA Configuration file using the FTG Configuration Application. However, if you do not know the RF channels at the site, there is an option to save (Learn) an FMA Configuration file from a TV (see “Learning an FMA Configuration File from a TV” on page 32). The procedure below provides an overview of the steps required to create an FMA Configuration (.fma) file. Refer to the Free-To-Guest (FTG) Configuration Application manual for further information. See also FTG Configuration Application sample screens on pages 34 to 37. Note: FTG Configuration Application software is available online at: www.LGcommercial.com/FTGsoftware. 1. Install (if necessary) and launch the FTG Configuration Application (v5.0.0 or higher) on the PC that will be used to create the FMA Configuration file. 2. Either: • Open an existing FTG Configuration (.rml) file, if applicable, to use its FTG Channel Map. Otherwise, create a new FTG Channel Map using the FTG Channel Map Editor in the FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility. Then, continue with step 3. Note: Up to 141 logical channels can be defined in the FTG Channel Map. • To view and/or base a new FMA Configuration file on an existing LD330H/LD333H FMA Configuration file, click Configure in the FTG Configuration Application menu bar, and select FMA to access the FMA Configuration Utility. Then, click the Open button above the FMA Configuration List, and double-click the desired (.fma) file. A list of the file’s contents will be displayed in the FMA Configuration List window, and you can edit the FMA Configuration List as necessary to create a new file. Proceed to step 4 when you are ready to continue. 3. Click Configure in the FTG Configuration Application menu bar, and select FMA to access the FMA Configuration Utility. 4. To add an FTG Channel Map, click >> under FTG Channel Map to copy the current FTG Channel Map to the FMA Configuration List. Note: If you make any change(s) in the FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility to the current data to be included in the FMA Configuration List, you will need to recopy the FTG Channel Map to the FMA Configuration List. 5. Load default Installer Menu settings for the LD330H/LD333H TV: • Click the down arrow at the right of the Chassis field under Installer Menu Templates, and select LD330H/LD333H from the drop-down list of available models. • Click the Load button. • Use the FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility to modify settings, if necessary. Then, return to the FMA Configuration Utility. • Click >> under FTG Installer Menu Settings to copy the LD330H/LD333H settings to the FMA Configuration List. 6. Click the Save button above the FMA Configuration List to save its contents to an FMA Configuration (.fma) file for later use. 7. Save the FMA Configuration file to a USB memory device, and proceed to “Teaching FMA Configuration to a TV” on the following page to transfer the FMA Configuration file to an LD330H/ LD333H TV. 30 206-4185 FTG Mode of Operation (Cont.) Teaching FMA Configuration to a TV This procedure describes how to “Teach” an FMA Configuration file from a USB memory device to a TV. Ensure you have completed the procedure on the previous page to create the FMA Configuration file before proceeding with the steps below. 1. Plug the USB memory device that contains the FMA Configuration file into the Target LD330H/LD333H TV USB IN port. 2. Press MENU to display the TV setup menus, use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight either the Option (if TV is in Pass-through Mode) or Lock (if TV is already in FTG Mode) menu icon, and then press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. 3. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Teach To TV (FMA), and then press ENTER. 4. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select the FMA Configuration file you want to install, and then press ENTER. The TV will show Teaching completion progress in a new window. Do NOT remove the USB device until Teaching is complete. When Teaching is complete, the TV will tune to the first logical channel in the FTG Channel Map. 5. When Teaching is done, remove the USB memory device. The FMA Configuration should be resident on the Target TV. Also, the Target TV CPU is now in FTG Mode (if it was previously in Pass-through Mode). 206-4185 USB Download Menu Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Return Enter Teach To TV (FMA) xx0BAL-PLAT200001.FMA Return ! Enter Teach To TV UPDATING... 50% Do not unplug! 31 FTG Mode of Operation (Cont.) Learning an FMA Configuration File from a TV To ensure that Pro:Idiom decryption is enabled, it is recommended that you create an FMA Configuration file using the FTG Configuration Application as described on page 30. However, if necessary, this option enables you to save (Learn) an FMA Configuration file from an LD330H/LD333H TV to a USB memory device. 1. Plug a USB memory device into the USB IN port on the TV. 2. Press MENU to display the TV setup menus, use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight either the Option (if TV is in Pass-through Mode) or Lock (if TV is already in FTG Mode) menu icon, and then press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. 3. To gain access to the Learn From TV options in the USB Download Menu, key in the password used to enter the Installer Menu (Example: Press 9-8-7-6). 5. To identify the file from others, you can use the Up/Down arrow keys to change the last five digits of the filename. Press ENTER when you are ready to initiate Learning. The TV will show Learning completion progress in a new window. Do NOT remove the USB device until Learning is complete. When Learning is complete, the USB Download Menu will reappear on screen. Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Learn From TV (TLL) Learn From TV (FMA) Return Enter Learn From TV (FMA) Select the file name and press OK to start xx0BAL-PLAT200001.FMA ► 4. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Learn From TV (FMA), and then press ENTER. USB Download Menu ► Note: If the LD330H/LD333H TV is NOT already in FTG Mode, you may need to perform some manual configuration on the TV before you start this procedure (see “Optional Manual Configuration / Setup for a TV” on following page). Return ! Enter Learn From TV UPDATING... 25% Do not unplug! 6. When you are finished, remove the USB memory device. Note: It is highly recommended that you open this FMA Configuration file in the FTG Configuration Application—BEFORE transferring (Teaching) the file to any TVs—to verify FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings and enable Pro:Idiom decryption by marking Encrypted channels. This will also enable you to confirm and add channel attributes, labels, etc. 32 206-4185 FTG Mode of Operation (Cont.) Optional Manual Configuration / Setup for a TV The manual configuration procedures below should only be performed if you do not know the RF channels at the site and need to “Learn” the FMA Configuration file from an LD330H/LD333H TV as described on the previous page. Ensure the TV is in Pass-through Mode before you begin. Set Installer Menu Items These steps provide specific instruction only on the Installer Menu items that should be set on an LD330H/LD333H TV. Refer to pages 14 to 20 for detailed information on all Installer Menu items. 1. Make sure the TV is ON. Then, use the Installer Remote to enter the TV Installer Menu: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. 2. Set Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT to 001 and press ENTER on the Installer Remote. This clears all Installer Menu custom settings, the channel lineup, etc. and reloads the factory default settings. The value will change back to 0 after the internal TV controller (PTC) has been restored to factory default condition. This step ensures that the TV Channel Memory will be the active channel lineup. 3. Set Installer Menu item 003 BAND/AFC, as appropriate. • Broadcast: Set to 000. • HRC: Set to 002. • CATV: Set to 001 (default). • IRC: Set to 003. 4. Set any other Installer Menu items that affect your TV programming network to the required configuration. For example, enable/disable Aux sources, set a Start Channel, etc. 5. After you have adjusted all required Installer Menu item settings, press ENTER once on the Installer Remote to save your changes; then, press ENTER again to exit the menu. Run Auto Tuning (Channel Search) Note: In the FMA Configuration file, Logical Channel numbers will automatically be assigned in ascending order, starting with 0 (zero), to the Physical Channels from the TV Channel Map. Note: Pro:Idiom decryption for encrypted channels will not be enabled unless you use the FTG Configuration Application to set the channel attributes. 1. Search for all available analog and digital channels: Use the Installer Remote to go to the Channel Menu, select the Auto Tuning option, and follow the on-screen instructions. 2. Use the Channel Edit option in the Channel Menu to edit the channel lineup, as necessary, to include free to guest channels only. Add/delete channels per your system requirements. * Once you have completed these procedures, return to “Learning an FMA Configuration File from a TV” on the previous page to complete the Learn sequence. 206-4185 xxLD330H PTC INSTALLER MENU 000 INSTALLER SEQ UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 000 ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.06.00 Typical TV Installer Menu Note: The Installer Menu header will vary depending on the TV you are setting up. 117 FACT DEFAULT 001 003 BAND/AFC 00X Adjust the settings for these Installer Menu items. CHANNEL Move Enter Auto Tuning Manual Tuning Channel Edit Channel Label Run Auto Tuning and edit the channel lineup, as necessary. * If Installer Menu item 103 ATSC TUNE MODE is set for Physical Channel tuning (default and recommended setting), minor channel numbers cannot be higher than 255. If set for Virtual Channel tuning, neither major nor minor channel numbers can be higher than 255. Note also that the FTG Configuration Application does not support major or minor channel numbers higher than 255. 33 FTG Configuration Application Utilities Overview FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility The FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility enables you to build a Channel Map with logical channel numbers. Note: Write, Read, and Learn functions in the FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility are used for local FTG configuration of TVs that support a direct connection to a PC. These functions are not applicable to the process of creating an FMA Configuration file to be used with LD330H/LD333H TVs. EDIT/ADD MAP Click to open the FTG Channel Map Editor to create or edit an FTG Channel Map (see next page). PRINT MAP Click to display a printable FTG Channel Map Report. The report can also be exported as an HTML or Text file. 34 206-4185 FTG Configuration Application Utilities Overview (Cont.) FTG Channel Map Editor The FTG Channel Map Editor shows a single Logical Channel’s Data and the FTG Channel Map. LOGICAL CHANNEL MAPPING Select a Logical Channel number, then assign it the RF, Major, and Minor channel numbers to complete the mapping. * CUSTOM CHANNEL LABELS/ICONS Enter custom labels and select icons by name on menu or by number. DELETE Click to remove highlighted channel from FTG Channel Map. UPDATE After editing an existing Logical Channel’s data, click to commit the changes in the FTG Channel Map. SET CHANNEL ATTRIBUTES Check/select Encrypted, OSD, or Blank Video. EXIT Click to exit editor and return to FTG Channel Map Configuration Utility. ADD After defining a new Logical Channel, click to add channel to the FTG Channel Map. * The FTG Configuration Application does not support major or minor channel numbers higher than 255. 206-4185 35 FTG Configuration Application Utilities Overview (Cont.) FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility Note: Write, Read, Learn, and IR Remote Access functions in the FTG Installer Menu Configuration Utility are used for local FTG configuration of TVs that support a direct connection to a PC. These functions are not applicable to the process of creating an FMA Configuration file to be used with LD330H /LD333H TVs. CONFIGURATION SETTINGS Select tabs for categories of Installer Menu items to set up TV. HOSPITAL-GRADE TV ONLY Set Hospital items on Installer Menu for hospital-grade TVs. INSTALLER DEFAULTS Click to reset FTG Installer Menu items shown in the FTG Configuration Application to defaults. 36 206-4185 FTG Configuration Application Utilities Overview (Cont.) FMA Configuration Utility Note: FMA Write, Read, Clock, Broadcast, Firmware, and IP Communication functions in the FMA Configuration Utility are used to configure control equipment (Example: FMA-LG101) at the hotel/institution head end. These functions are not applicable to the process of creating an FMA Configuration file to be used with LD330H/LD333H TVs. Filename of opened FTG Configuration file (if applicable) FMA CONFIGURATION LIST (data to be saved or already saved in FMA Configuration file) NEW/OPEN/SAVE FMA File options Copy FTG Channel Map to and from FMA Configuration List. Copy FTG Installer Menu settings to and from FMA Configuration List. Load default FTG Installer Menu for LD330H/LD333H. Note: The data referenced in the FMA Configuration List is only a snapshot of the current FTG Channel Map and FTG Installer Menu settings when copied to the list. If you make any change(s) to the current data to be included in the FMA Configuration List, you will need to recopy Channel Map and Installer Menu settings to the FMA Configuration List. 206-4185 37 Reference: Upgrading TV/PTC Software using a USB Memory Device Checking the Software Versions You can check the software versions of the TV by accessing the Installer Menu with the Installer Remote: Press MENU repeatedly until the on-screen setup menus lock up, and then press 9-8-7-6 + ENTER. When you are finished, press ENTER again to exit the Installer Menu. xxLD330H PTC INSTALLER MENU Typical TV Installer Menu 000 INSTALLER SEQ UPN 000-000-000-000 PTC V1.00.001 PTC Version Upgrading TV/PTC Software Before you begin, note that the software upgrade files must be stored in a folder named “LG_DTV” in the root directory of the USB memory device. Also, ensure the USB device has been formatted with FAT format. Note for TV Software Upgrade only: If the TV detects a later version of software on the USB device, it will automatically display a dialog from which you can start the software upgrade immediately. Otherwise, you can close the dialog, and access the USB Download Menu as described below. TV Software Update (Expert) 1. Turn the TV ON. 2. Plug the USB memory device into the USB IN port on the TV. following update files are found in the USB device. 3. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to display the TV setupThe menus. Select the file you want to apply to update this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. 4. Use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight either the Option (if TV is in Pass-through Mode) or Lock (if TV is in FTG or LodgeNet PPV Mode) menu icon; then, press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the Update USB TV Software Download Menu. LOGO Image Download 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Upgrade TV Software or Upgrade PTC Software, as applicable, and then press ENTER. 6. Select the appropriate option(s), depending on the type of upgrade you are TV Software Update (Expert) performing: • TV Software Upgrade: (See screen samples at right.) Select TV Software Update from the first TV Software Update window. In the second TV Software Update window, select the update file to install and press The followingENTER. update files are found in the USB device. Select the file you want to apply to update this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. Note: Do not select Forced Update options unless you have been specifically instructed to do so or have previous experience with Expert Software Updates. • PTC Software Upgrade: In the PTC Software Update window, select the TV Software Update update file to install and press ENTER. LOGO Image Download Note: The PTC Software Update window is similar to the second TV Software Update window, though there are no Forced Update options. Current software version information is shown at the top and update files on the USB device are listed at the bottom of the window. 000 ASIC 20E7 CPU V3.06.00 CPU Version USB Download Menu Upgrade TV Software Upgrade PTC Software Teach To TV (TLL) Teach To TV (FMA) Return Enter TV Software Update (Expert) TV Software Update (Expert) The following software files are found in the memory card. Select the file you want to download to this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. The followin Select the fil or press EXI The following update files are found in the USB device. Select the file you want to apply to update this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. TV Software Update Splash Image 1366 X 768Download ProCentric LOGO Image Splash I TV Software Update (Expert) TV Software Update (Expert) [ Current TV Software Version Information ] TV S EPK : 03.23.00 [ Current T The following software files are found in the memory card. Select the file update you want to are download thisUSB TV device. The following files found intothe or press to cancel theapply update. Select theEXIT file you want to to update this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. EPK : 03.25.00 The follow Select the or press E EPK : 03. [ Forced Update Option ] Ext. MICOM EPK : 03. [ Forced U SPI Boot TV Software Update LOGO Image Ext. M LOG xxLD330H_v1_11_RevNo1000_USB LOGO Image Download xxLD330 The TV will show update completion progress in a new window. Do NOT remove the USB deviceUpgrade PTC Software until the software upgrade is complete. When a TV software upgrade is complete, the TV will reset [ Current PTC Software Version Information ] itself with an automatic restart. When a PTC upgrade is complete, the TV will turn OFF. TXT : V1.00.00 38 TV S Upg [ Current TXT : V1. 206-4185 The following software files are found in the memory card. The follow Reference: Downloading a Splash Screen using a USB Memory Device TV S TV Software Update (Expert) The followin Select the fi or press EX The following update files are found in the USB device. Select the file you want to apply to update this TV Splash Screen Image File Guidelines USB Download Menu or press EXIT to cancel the update. • The splash screen image must be a baseline (not progressive) JPEG. Upgrade TV Software • The image should be no larger than 1 MB. • The ideal size for the image is 1366 x 768 pixels or under. • The image file must be stored in a folder named “LG_DTV” in the root directory of USB memory device. • Ensure the USB device has been formatted with FAT format. Upgrade PTC Software TV Software Update Teach To TV (TLL) LOGO Image Download Teach To TV (FMA) Return Splash I Enter TV Software Update (Expert) TV S Downloading a Splash Screen Image [ Current EPK : 03. 1. Turn the TV ON. The follow Select the or press E The following update files are found in the USB device. Select the file you want to apply to update this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. 2. Plug the USB memory device into the USB IN port on the TV. 3. Press MENU on the Installer Remote to display the TV setup menus. 4. Use the arrow navigation keys to select/highlight either the Option (if TV is in Pass-through Mode) or Lock (if TV is in FTG or LodgeNet PPV Mode) menu icon; then, press the number “7” key a total of seven times to display the USB Download Menu. 5. Use the Up/Down arrow keys to select Upgrade TV Software, and then TV Software Update (Expert) press ENTER. 6. Select LOGO Image Download from the first TV Software Update window. 7. In the second TV Software Update window, select the image file to download The following update files are found in the USB device. and press ENTER. Select the file you want to apply to update this TV EPK : 03. [ Forced U TV Software Update Ext. LOG LOGO Image Download xxLD33 TV Software Update (Expert) Upg The following software files are found in the memory card. Select the file you want to download to this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. [ Current TXT : V1 or press EXIT to cancel the update. The TV will show download completion progress in a new window. Do NOT remove the USB device until the image download is complete. When the image TV Software Update download is complete, the TV will reset itself with an automatic restart. Upon the restart, you should see the new splash screen. LOGO Image Download The follo Splash Image 1366 X 768 ProCentric xxLD33 TV Software Update (Expert) TV Software Update (Expert) [ Current TV Software Version Information ] EPK : 03.23.00 The following update files are found in the USB device. Select the file you want to apply to update this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. The following software files are found in the memory card. Select the file you want to download to this TV or press EXIT to cancel the update. EPK : 03.25.00 [ Forced Update Option ] TV Software Update LOGO Image Download Ext. MICOM SPI Boot LOGO Image xxLD330H_v1_11_RevNo1000_USB Upgrade PTC Software [ Current PTC Software Version Information ] TXT : V1.00.00 206-4185 The following software files are found in the memory card. 39 Reference: Power Consumption Settings The following tables assume Installer Menu item 099 BACK LIGHTING is set as shown below (default value is 100). Item 099 Back Lighting (Static) 32LD330H 32LD333H Power Consumption (Watts) 37LD330H 37LD333H Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) Percent Savings 100 72.97 0.00% 88.92 0.00% 90 80 70 60 50 40 30 20 10 1 63.82 58.53 53.58 44.24 41.27 38.71 36.20 33.51 31.01 28.55 12.54% 19.78% 26.57% 39.38% 43.45% 46.95% 50.39% 54.07% 57.51% 60.87% 84.19 77.84 72.19 66.28 60.90 56.58 52.35 47.75 43.68 39.62 5.32% 12.46% 18.81% 25.46% 31.51% 36.37% 41.13% 46.30% 50.88% 55.44% Item 099 Back Lighting (Dynamic) 32LD330H 32LD333H 37LD330H 37LD333H Power Consumption (Watts) Percent Savings Power Consumption (Watts) Percent Savings 200 75.45 0.00% 110.86 0.00% 190 180 170 160 150 140 130 120 110 101 69.23 65.26 60.72 56.29 51.82 46.62 41.67 36.14 31.11 26.41 8.25% 13.51% 19.53% 25.40% 31.33% 38.21% 44.78% 52.10% 58.76% 65.00% 99.05 92.33 85.39 78.61 71.70 63.53 55.65 47.34 39.90 33.00 10.65% 16.72% 22.98% 29.10% 35.32% 42.69% 49.80% 57.30% 64.01% 70.24% Note: Values are results of controlled experiments under laboratory conditions. 40 206-4185 Reference: TV Camport Auto Sense Operation The Camport Auto Sense function is enabled when: 1. Installer Menu item 034 CAMPORT EN is set to 1 AND 2. Installer Menu item 040 AUTO CAMPORT is enabled (1). Selectable: Can be accessed with INPUT key, direct access, etc. Auto Sense: TV switches to this input when connector is inserted. The Camport (Side [AV IN 2] Video) has the highest priority and will override any commands including tuning to the Start Channel. Camport Operation (Stand-alone) When Camport Auto Sense is enabled as above, the TV’s source will switch to the Side (AV IN 2) Video Aux source whenever a plug is inserted into the AV IN 2 Video input. When the plug is removed, the TV will switch back to the previous channel or input source that was being displayed before the plug was inserted. However, if any direct access to an RF channel or Aux channel is requested while the Camport is active, then, when the video plug is removed, the TV will switch to the last requested channel. Source changes using any Source keys (INPUT) are ignored. Channel Up/Down and Flashback commands are not direct access tuning commands, and they are also ignored. Camport Operation (FTG or PPV) The operation will be similar to that of the Stand-alone Mode. However, when the Channel Map is maintained external to the PTC (i.e., FTG and PPV), Channel Up/ Down or Flashback keys are sent as Direct Access tuning commands to the PTC/TV. 206-4185 CAMPORT (Side Video) Functionality Control Item 034 CAMPORT EN Item 040 AUTO CAMPORT Side (AV IN 2) Video Operation 0 0 Disabled 0 1 Disabled 1 0 Selectable 1 1 Auto Sense Previous State Before Inserting CAMPORT Operation While CAMPORT is Active State Upon Removal of CAMPORT Aux or RF Channel None Previous Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Direct Access Last Requested Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Ch Up/Down, Flashback, and Input Keys Previous Aux or RF Channel Previous State Before Inserting CAMPORT Operation While CAMPORT is Active State Upon Removal of CAMPORT Aux or RF Channel None Previous Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Direct Access Last Requested Aux or RF Channel Aux or RF Channel Ch Up/Down, Flashback, and Input Keys Last Requested Aux or RF Channel 41 Reference: TV Aux Input Configuration ENABLE DIRECT ACCESS Tuning TV Installer Menu MPI DATA MPI DATA STATUS TYPE 0x41 SOURCES ENABLED (R/W) DATA STATUS TYPE 0xD2 CURRENT AV SOURCE (R) DATA STATUS TYPE 0x0D AUX SOURCE (R) START AUX SOURCE ASSIGNMENT OLD_ OCV = 0 OLD_ OCV = 1 Source Input Source Mode Number Labeling Value Labeling Value Labeling 130 90 Video2 (Side) CV 34 CAMPORT_EN 0x01 Video Front (Camport) 0 Video Front (Camport) 0 (VIDEO) 2 131 91 Video1 (Rear) CV 39 REAR_AUX_EN 0x02 Rear Video (Aux) 1 Rear Video (Aux) 0 (VIDEO) 1 132 92 HDMI2 DTV/PC 91 YPrPb2 EN = 1 0x04 S-Video Rear 2 S-Video Rear 0 (VIDEO) 5 133 93 HDMI1/DVI DTV/PC 35 COMPPORT_EN =1 0x08 Front Computer 3 Front Computer 0 (VIDEO) 3 134 94 RGB PC 87 REAR RGB EN =2 0x10 SVGA Rear Computer 4 SVGA Rear Computer 2 (COMPUTER) 4 136 96 Component 38 YPrPb EN 0x40 Y/UV Component 6 Rear Y/PrPb Component Video 0 (VIDEO) 6 42 206-4185 Reference: Resetting a TV to Pass-through Mode This section describes how you can reset a TV that is currently in FTG Mode to Pass-through Mode. Note that the reset to Pass-through Mode will also restore all factory default settings on the TV. There are three options for resetting Pass-through Mode on TVs that are in FTG Mode. The first and second options enable you to reset a single TV to Pass-through Mode, while the third option enables you to reset multiple TVs to Pass-through Mode at one time. • A predefined value for Installer Menu item 117 FACT DEFAULT enables access to initiate a factory “INSTOP” process that will reset the TV to Pass-through Mode. Contact technical support for the required value for Installer Menu item 117 and for additional information on performing the IN-STOP from the Installer Menu. • Using a USB memory device, “Teach” an FMA Configuration file that only contains a “0 Mapped Channels” FTG Channel Map to the TV. Refer to “Creating an FMA Configuration File using the FTG Configuration Application” and “Teaching FMA Configuration to a TV” on pages 30 and 31, respectively, for further information. • If your system uses a Pro:Centric server for configuration, use the Pro:Centric Admin Client to load an FMA Configuration file that only contains a “0 Mapped Channels” FTG Channel Map on the Pro:Centric server. Refer to the Pro:Centric™ Server Admin Client User Guide for further information. 206-4185 43 Troubleshooting General Troubleshooting Some Quick and Easy Tips for Resolving Problems Symptom Possible Cause(s) Possible Solution(s) (TV in Stand-alone Mode) Installer Menu item 028 CH. OVERIDE is set to 0, i.e., disabled (recommended setting). If Installer Menu item 028 CH. OVERIDE is set to 0, only channels that are active in the TV’s channel lineup can be selected. Set CH. OVERIDE to 1 to allow access for direct keypad entry to all channels. (TV in FTG Mode) The channel entered is not part of the FTG Channel Map. Channel access is restricted to channels included in the FTG Channel Map. If necessary, make changes to the FTG Channel Map using the FTG Configuration Application. Installation Cannot direct enter channel number. Power No power. Display Panel Picture No picture. See troubleshooting flow chart on following page. Display panel is turned off. • Turn TV ON. • Power failure? Antenna/cable not connected. Connect antenna/cable signal to TV Connections incorrect. Check connections on TV MPI not connected. If applicable, connect MPI cable to MPI device. Encrypted program. Try another channel. Wrong tuning band. Adjust Installer Menu settings. Wrong Installer Menu settings. Adjust Installer Menu settings as required. Remote not in TV Mode. Use MODE key to select “TV”; puts remote into TV Mode. Not aimed at IR remote sensor. Point remote at IR receiver on TV. Remote too far from IR sensor. Move remote closer to IR receiver on TV or darken room. Erratic Operation Installer Menu setup. Installer Remote Remote doesn’t work. MPI not connected. If applicable, connect MPI cable to MPI device. IR path to TV’s receiver obstructed. Remove obstructions. Weak batteries. Replace batteries. Wrong battery polarity. Check that “+” and “-” match in battery compartment. Too much light in room. Dim room light. Wrong Installer Remote. Requires compatible Installer Remote. Contact your LG dealer. Audio muted. Press MUTE or use Volume Up key to increase sound level. Broadcast problem. Try a different channel. Picture Reception Normal picture, poor or no sound. Note: For other problems not caused by the TV, refer to the other devices’ operating guide(s). 44 206-4185 Troubleshooting (Cont.) Troubleshooting Flow Chart Controller Quick Check STATUS LED on PTC Board blinking? No TV connected to AC Power? No Plug into AC Power outlet. Yes Yes Bad TV Cycle the power by removing and reconnecting the AC Power cord. Then, observe POWER LED on front of TV. POWER LED lit? No Bad Analog or Digital Board Yes No Bad TV No Bad PPV Card Yes Press POWER on Installer Remote. TV turned ON? TV responded? Press VOLUME UP/ DOWN or MUTE key on User-supplied Remote. No Bad TV TV responded? Yes Yes Press VOLUME UP/ DOWN or MUTE key on Installer Remote. 206-4185 End 45 Troubleshooting (Cont.) Commercial Mode Check / FTG Operation Troubleshooting Commercial Mode Check Press POWER on Installer Remote. TV responded? No Bad TV Yes Leave the TV set ON. Go to Installer Menu by pressing MENU until the on-screen setup menus lock up (i.e., stop responding). TV stopped responding or continued to respond? Stopped responding TV is in Commercial Mode. Continued to respond TV is not in Commercial Mode. Call Technical Support for assistance. FTG Operation Troubleshooting The following table provides troubleshooting information for when the TV is configured in the FTG Mode of operation. Symptom Possible Cause(s) Solution(s) Communication Error (“Communications Timeout”) TV not powered. Check/connect the TV power cord. TV not turned ON. TV needs to be turned ON (default FTG Mode). 46 206-4185 Troubleshooting (Cont.) Clone Programmer Troubleshooting Warning: Do not connect a clone programmer to a PPV card installed in the Master or Target TVs, as this will damage the clone programmer and the PPV card. Reset Clone Programmer After Static Shock After replacing exhausted batteries (LT2002 only), or if the clone programmer behaves strangely after a static shock: • TLL-1100A: Turn the TLL-1100A OFF and then ON. • LT2002: Use a paper clip or similar instrument inserted through the small hole marked RESET to activate the internal reset switch and restore normal operation. After a reset, check the real-time clock setting. It may be necessary to set the clone programmer clock from a TV containing the correct time. Note: Both the Master and Target TVs must be in Pass-through Mode for cloning purposes. See also IMPORTANT CLONING INFORMATION on page 23. Clone Programmer Symptom Possible Cause(s) Possible Solution(s) Clone copies setup in less than 30 seconds. Not enough time to copy entire TV setup. TLL-1100A: Turn the TLL-1100A OFF and then ON. LT2002: Press RESET on clone programmer. Then redo Learn/Teach. (Learning usually takes about 90 seconds; Teaching usually takes 3 to 4 minutes.) Remote does not operate clone programmer. Wrong Installer Remote. Only use an LG Installer Remote to operate clone programmer with TV. Clone menu does not display on TV screen, TLL1100A shows error message, or LT2002 LED does not blink. MPI cord not connected. Connect MPI cord properly, and ensure good connection. TV not turned ON. TV must be powered ON for clone programmer to work. (LT2002 only) Weak batteries. Install four (4) fresh AA high-quality alkaline batteries. (TLL-1100A only) No charge. Ensure the TLL-1100A is fully charged or connected to AC power. Clone menu hard to read. Weak signal. Connect TV to a reliable analog channel signal source. No time set. Time not available. Set time on a TV, and copy time to clone programmer. Clone not working. Clone programmer problem. • Try a different clone programmer. • Reset the clone programmer. Clone scans channels more than once. Clone should only scan channels Ensure TV is set up correctly, and try cloning again. once. Master and Target TVs Symptom Possible Cause(s) Possible Solution(s) Cloning did not work. Procedure interrupted. Wait until procedure complete message is displayed. Different TV models. Cloning is only possible with identical model TVs. Step(s) omitted or not performed. Refer to the applicable cloning procedure(s), and make sure all tasks were performed. (LT2002 only) Clone time disappeared. Batteries were removed. Batteries must remain installed to retain time settings. New setup not present. Target TV not reset. Disconnect Target TV from AC power for 15 seconds. • After cloning operations are complete, unplug the TLL-1100A/LT2002 from the TV. • If the TV does not display a picture (blank screen) after a few seconds, just change channels. 206-4185 47 Glossary of Terms A list of definitions for some of the words found in this guide. 75 OHM RF CABLE The wire that comes from an off-air antenna or cable service provider. The end looks like a hex-shaped nut with a wire through the middle. It screws onto the Antenna/Cable threaded jack on the back of the TV. 300 TO 75 OHM ADAPTER A small device that connects a 2-wire 300 ohm antenna to a 75 ohm RF jack. It is usually about an inch long with two screws on one end and a round opening with a wire extending out the other end. A/V CABLES Audio/Video cables. Three cables bunched together—right audio (red), left audio (white), and video (yellow). A/V cables are used for stereo playback of videocassettes and for higher quality picture and sound from other A/V devices. COMPOSITE VIDEO Typical video jack, uses one wire for transporting three-color video signals. DELETE Lets you remove channels from the list that the end user can scroll through using Channel Up/Down. DIGITAL TELEVISION High-resolution, cinema-quality television signals transmitted digitally. DVI Digital Video Interface. Accommodates analog and digital interfaces with a single connector. HDMI High-definition multi-media interface. A/V DEVICE Any device that produces video or sound (VCR, DVD, cable box, or television). HDSTB High-definition set top box. Refers to a tuner device that receives high-definition television signals which have higher resolution than ordinary analog TV signals. AMPLIFIER An electronic device that amplifies sound from a television, CD player, VCR, DVD player, or other Audio/Video device. HDTV High-definition television. Refers to television signals that have higher resolution than ordinary analog TV signals. ANTENNA The physical receiver of television signals sent over the air. A large metal piece of equipment does not always have to be visible to be using an antenna. INPUT Refers to the input jack that receives a signal from a TV, VCR, DVD Player, or other Audio/Video device. CABLE Cable service box. Refers to the descrambler box cable subscribers use to receive cable programming signals. JACK An input or output connector on the back of a TV, VCR, DVD Player, or other Audio/Video device. CATV Programming provided by a cable service. MONO SOUND Mono (monaural) sound is one channel of sound. On more than one speaker, all the speakers play the same audio. COMPONENT VIDEO Uses three wires for transporting threecolor video signals. The end result is usually better video quality. OUTPUT Refers to the output jack that sends a signal out of a VCR, DVD, or other A/V device. 48 PHYSICAL CHANNEL NUMBER The actual channel number. Analog channels use the Physical Channel number and digital channels can use a Virtual Channel number. RGB (RED, GREEN, BLUE) Connection input or output port available for producing a video image using three separate colors: Red, Green, and Blue. RS-232 Serial communication port through which firmware is downloaded. 2ND AUDIO PROGRAMMING/SAP Second Audio Programming (SAP) is another, separate audio channel available with some programming. Choosing SAP often refers to listening to audio in another language, such as Spanish or French. SIGNAL Picture and sound traveling through a cable, or over the air, to the TV. STEREO SOUND Stereo (Stereophonic) sound refers to audio that’s divided into right and left sides. TUNER Device that picks up the broadcast signal and turns it into picture and sound. VIRTUAL CHANNEL NUMBER A re-mapped channel number. Analog channels use the Physical Channel number; however digital channels use a Virtual (or false) Channel number. XDS Extended Data Service. Additional program information included on the signal provided at the discretion of the broadcaster. Note: Refer to www.atsc.org for further information. 206-4185 Document Revision History / Notes Document Revision History Date Description May 2011 Revision A: New document Product documentation is available online at: www.LGsolutions.com/products. From the Products page, select TVs, Systems & Solutions, then LCD TVs, then the applicable TV. Click the Literature & Downloads tab at the bottom of the TV page, and select the required document(s) from the Downloads list. Notes 206-4185 49 For Customer Support/Service, please call: 1-888-865-3026 www.LGsolutions.com Pro:Idiom is a registered trademark of Zenith Electronics LLC. Pro:Centric is a trademark of LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. All other trademarks or registered trademarks are the property of their respective owners. © Copyright 2011, LG Electronics U.S.A., Inc. 206-4185 Revision A
Source Exif Data:
File Type : PDF File Type Extension : pdf MIME Type : application/pdf PDF Version : 1.7 Linearized : No Tagged PDF : No Page Mode : UseOutlines XMP Toolkit : Adobe XMP Core 4.0-c316 44.253921, Sun Oct 01 2006 17:14:39 Create Date : 2011:04:27 11:11:56+09:00 Metadata Date : 2012:03:01 15:28+09:00 Modify Date : 2012:03:01 15:28+09:00 Creator Tool : Adobe InDesign CS4 (6.0.6) Thumbnail Format : JPEG Thumbnail Width : 256 Thumbnail Height : 256 Thumbnail Image : (Binary data 4394 bytes, use -b option to extract) Instance ID : uuid:9e9f92fa-4c03-4aaf-a776-2841a3cdf14b Document ID : xmp.did:8F4E7BA9F7A8DF11AD678AD57091BD13 Original Document ID : xmp.did:8CAED473E9ABDE118B16D4310236FB20 Rendition Class : proof:pdf History Action : created, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved, saved History Instance ID : xmp.iid:8CAED473E9ABDE118B16D4310236FB20, xmp.iid:8DAED473E9ABDE118B16D4310236FB20, xmp.iid:8EAED473E9ABDE118B16D4310236FB20, xmp.iid:8FAED473E9ABDE118B16D4310236FB20, xmp.iid:6626E40102ACDE118B16D4310236FB20, xmp.iid:6826E40102ACDE118B16D4310236FB20, xmp.iid:6926E40102ACDE118B16D4310236FB20, xmp.iid:6A26E40102ACDE118B16D4310236FB20, xmp.iid:6B26E40102ACDE118B16D4310236FB20, xmp.iid:6C26E40102ACDE118B16D4310236FB20, xmp.iid:C6E7B73B35B3DE118EB2D495D388A499, xmp.iid:110965C1A1B3DE11ACEADA9389CD371A, xmp.iid:120965C1A1B3DE11ACEADA9389CD371A, xmp.iid:0A55E900B2B3DE11A725DE4DD9FFBD69, xmp.iid:0B55E900B2B3DE11A725DE4DD9FFBD69, xmp.iid:0C55E900B2B3DE11A725DE4DD9FFBD69, xmp.iid:0D55E900B2B3DE11A725DE4DD9FFBD69, xmp.iid:0E55E900B2B3DE11A725DE4DD9FFBD69, xmp.iid:D667D073F3B3DE11A945CD243CE896E4, xmp.iid:6399641860B4DE11B2E3D27A0678B70B, xmp.iid:6499641860B4DE11B2E3D27A0678B70B, xmp.iid:6699641860B4DE11B2E3D27A0678B70B, xmp.iid:6799641860B4DE11B2E3D27A0678B70B, xmp.iid:6999641860B4DE11B2E3D27A0678B70B, xmp.iid:6A99641860B4DE11B2E3D27A0678B70B, xmp.iid:6B99641860B4DE11B2E3D27A0678B70B, xmp.iid:6C99641860B4DE11B2E3D27A0678B70B, xmp.iid:ACAC18DA82B4DE11B2E3D27A0678B70B, xmp.iid:ADAC18DA82B4DE11B2E3D27A0678B70B, xmp.iid:D4BCAECF8EB4DE11A3B6A83160C7578A, xmp.iid:D5BCAECF8EB4DE11A3B6A83160C7578A, xmp.iid:D6BCAECF8EB4DE11A3B6A83160C7578A, xmp.iid:D7BCAECF8EB4DE11A3B6A83160C7578A, xmp.iid:D8BCAECF8EB4DE11A3B6A83160C7578A, xmp.iid:DABCAECF8EB4DE11A3B6A83160C7578A, xmp.iid:DBBCAECF8EB4DE11A3B6A83160C7578A, xmp.iid:DCBCAECF8EB4DE11A3B6A83160C7578A, xmp.iid:DDBCAECF8EB4DE11A3B6A83160C7578A, xmp.iid:E8DB9653A1B4DE11A3B6A83160C7578A, xmp.iid:E9DB9653A1B4DE11A3B6A83160C7578A, xmp.iid:EADB9653A1B4DE11A3B6A83160C7578A, xmp.iid:EBDB9653A1B4DE11A3B6A83160C7578A, xmp.iid:F7AC70B8A7B4DE11BC92B88E1B70583B, xmp.iid:D5F69A76ABB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:D6F69A76ABB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:D7F69A76ABB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:D8F69A76ABB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:D9F69A76ABB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:DAF69A76ABB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:DBF69A76ABB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:DCF69A76ABB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:DDF69A76ABB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:DEF69A76ABB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:55742671B2B4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:56742671B2B4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:57742671B2B4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:58742671B2B4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:59742671B2B4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:5A742671B2B4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:5B742671B2B4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:5C742671B2B4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:5D742671B2B4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:5E742671B2B4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:5F742671B2B4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:E38614E0BEB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:E48614E0BEB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:E58614E0BEB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:E68614E0BEB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:E88614E0BEB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:E98614E0BEB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:EA8614E0BEB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:EC8614E0BEB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:ED8614E0BEB4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:58BDCC7BC2B4DE11BF74F23ED7024AD2, xmp.iid:6F550062C5B4DE1194BF9F7921597039, xmp.iid:71550062C5B4DE1194BF9F7921597039, xmp.iid:72550062C5B4DE1194BF9F7921597039, xmp.iid:73550062C5B4DE1194BF9F7921597039, xmp.iid:0C184FA4BCB6DE11B5F2D82056257F39, xmp.iid:0D184FA4BCB6DE11B5F2D82056257F39, xmp.iid:0E184FA4BCB6DE11B5F2D82056257F39, xmp.iid:0F184FA4BCB6DE11B5F2D82056257F39, xmp.iid:10184FA4BCB6DE11B5F2D82056257F39, xmp.iid:11184FA4BCB6DE11B5F2D82056257F39, xmp.iid:12184FA4BCB6DE11B5F2D82056257F39, xmp.iid:13184FA4BCB6DE11B5F2D82056257F39, xmp.iid:14184FA4BCB6DE11B5F2D82056257F39, xmp.iid:19C3F0C0C8B6DE118BAADD4A777DC6B6, xmp.iid:1AC3F0C0C8B6DE118BAADD4A777DC6B6, xmp.iid:1BC3F0C0C8B6DE118BAADD4A777DC6B6, xmp.iid:1CC3F0C0C8B6DE118BAADD4A777DC6B6, xmp.iid:6EE7562EF7B6DE118BAADD4A777DC6B6, xmp.iid:6FE7562EF7B6DE118BAADD4A777DC6B6, xmp.iid:D7B9962EFAB6DE1186CC979CEECF4FAB, xmp.iid:D8B9962EFAB6DE1186CC979CEECF4FAB, xmp.iid:D9B9962EFAB6DE1186CC979CEECF4FAB, xmp.iid:95B4D743FDB6DE11A8B6BC129B362605, xmp.iid:96B4D743FDB6DE11A8B6BC129B362605, xmp.iid:97B4D743FDB6DE11A8B6BC129B362605, xmp.iid:98B4D743FDB6DE11A8B6BC129B362605, xmp.iid:9AB4D743FDB6DE11A8B6BC129B362605, xmp.iid:9BB4D743FDB6DE11A8B6BC129B362605, xmp.iid:9CB4D743FDB6DE11A8B6BC129B362605, xmp.iid:9DB4D743FDB6DE11A8B6BC129B362605, xmp.iid:06B1215007B7DE119B12D79AC73B96C4, xmp.iid:07B1215007B7DE119B12D79AC73B96C4, xmp.iid:08B1215007B7DE119B12D79AC73B96C4, xmp.iid:5C24BD1E14B7DE11A568911F49EFED84, xmp.iid:864537BF17B7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:874537BF17B7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:884537BF17B7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:894537BF17B7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:8A4537BF17B7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:8B4537BF17B7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:8C4537BF17B7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:8D4537BF17B7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:8E4537BF17B7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:8F4537BF17B7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:BE6F1C631BB7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:BF6F1C631BB7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:C06F1C631BB7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:C16F1C631BB7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:C26F1C631BB7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:C36F1C631BB7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:C46F1C631BB7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:C66F1C631BB7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:C76F1C631BB7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:C86F1C631BB7DE11A0C1D41E173EE85A, xmp.iid:C3C87DA486B7DE11BD16D553EC6155C4, xmp.iid:2F91CFBCB0B7DE11BD6ABBC4DB8666DC, xmp.iid:3091CFBCB0B7DE11BD6ABBC4DB8666DC, xmp.iid:3191CFBCB0B7DE11BD6ABBC4DB8666DC, xmp.iid:3291CFBCB0B7DE11BD6ABBC4DB8666DC, xmp.iid:3391CFBCB0B7DE11BD6ABBC4DB8666DC, xmp.iid:3491CFBCB0B7DE11BD6ABBC4DB8666DC, xmp.iid:3591CFBCB0B7DE11BD6ABBC4DB8666DC, xmp.iid:7D9641B1C4B7DE11BD6ABBC4DB8666DC, xmp.iid:7E9641B1C4B7DE11BD6ABBC4DB8666DC, xmp.iid:51E1396762B8DE11A2B6A620A78BDCF0, xmp.iid:52E1396762B8DE11A2B6A620A78BDCF0, xmp.iid:29AA089A6FB8DE11A2B6A620A78BDCF0, xmp.iid:EDD333A7E8BDDE11ABE78EFC515AA669, xmp.iid:D9054568F9BEDE11BB22C5CE6F1F7BFE, xmp.iid:DA054568F9BEDE11BB22C5CE6F1F7BFE, xmp.iid:DB054568F9BEDE11BB22C5CE6F1F7BFE, xmp.iid:DF054568F9BEDE11BB22C5CE6F1F7BFE, xmp.iid:91B90A4B6CBFDE11B3D885F87B618F2C, xmp.iid:92B90A4B6CBFDE11B3D885F87B618F2C, xmp.iid:94B90A4B6CBFDE11B3D885F87B618F2C, xmp.iid:95B90A4B6CBFDE11B3D885F87B618F2C, xmp.iid:96B90A4B6CBFDE11B3D885F87B618F2C, xmp.iid:98B90A4B6CBFDE11B3D885F87B618F2C, xmp.iid:A3EAF44FA4BFDE11BBA0F6A3ACDA2CA3, xmp.iid:A4EAF44FA4BFDE11BBA0F6A3ACDA2CA3, xmp.iid:A5EAF44FA4BFDE11BBA0F6A3ACDA2CA3, xmp.iid:A6EAF44FA4BFDE11BBA0F6A3ACDA2CA3, xmp.iid:A7EAF44FA4BFDE11BBA0F6A3ACDA2CA3, xmp.iid:A8EAF44FA4BFDE11BBA0F6A3ACDA2CA3, xmp.iid:A9EAF44FA4BFDE11BBA0F6A3ACDA2CA3, xmp.iid:AAEAF44FA4BFDE11BBA0F6A3ACDA2CA3, xmp.iid:ABEAF44FA4BFDE11BBA0F6A3ACDA2CA3, xmp.iid:ACEAF44FA4BFDE11BBA0F6A3ACDA2CA3, xmp.iid:6F2D0E2DB9BFDE11BBA0F6A3ACDA2CA3, xmp.iid:702D0E2DB9BFDE11BBA0F6A3ACDA2CA3, xmp.iid:712D0E2DB9BFDE11BBA0F6A3ACDA2CA3, xmp.iid:722D0E2DB9BFDE11BBA0F6A3ACDA2CA3, xmp.iid:E21BCDBE2EC0DE11B6DD845465EC9641, xmp.iid:E51BCDBE2EC0DE11B6DD845465EC9641, xmp.iid:E5D3AC3248C0DE119E24B24DE6463AA9, xmp.iid:2ADE186C85C0DE1188E6D15BD8845815, xmp.iid:DACC935087C0DE11AD30AB9F1283E72D, xmp.iid:DBCC935087C0DE11AD30AB9F1283E72D, xmp.iid:DCCC935087C0DE11AD30AB9F1283E72D, xmp.iid:DDCC935087C0DE11AD30AB9F1283E72D, xmp.iid:DECC935087C0DE11AD30AB9F1283E72D, xmp.iid:DFCC935087C0DE11AD30AB9F1283E72D, xmp.iid:E0CC935087C0DE11AD30AB9F1283E72D, xmp.iid:8D00F238EAC1DE11B9FBB59F331762F7, xmp.iid:653CE4970FC2DE11B9FBB59F331762F7, xmp.iid:FF9E71112EC4DE11ABBAA868D0A16597, xmp.iid:009F71112EC4DE11ABBAA868D0A16597, xmp.iid:019F71112EC4DE11ABBAA868D0A16597, xmp.iid:029F71112EC4DE11ABBAA868D0A16597, xmp.iid:039F71112EC4DE11ABBAA868D0A16597, xmp.iid:049F71112EC4DE11ABBAA868D0A16597, xmp.iid:059F71112EC4DE11ABBAA868D0A16597, xmp.iid:069F71112EC4DE11ABBAA868D0A16597, xmp.iid:079F71112EC4DE11ABBAA868D0A16597, xmp.iid:72E324934CC4DE118513803DDBE8D78E, xmp.iid:73E324934CC4DE118513803DDBE8D78E, xmp.iid:77E324934CC4DE118513803DDBE8D78E, xmp.iid:78E324934CC4DE118513803DDBE8D78E, xmp.iid:0748E55261C4DE118513803DDBE8D78E, xmp.iid:0848E55261C4DE118513803DDBE8D78E, xmp.iid:0948E55261C4DE118513803DDBE8D78E, xmp.iid:0A48E55261C4DE118513803DDBE8D78E, xmp.iid:0B48E55261C4DE118513803DDBE8D78E, xmp.iid:0C48E55261C4DE118513803DDBE8D78E, xmp.iid:2BBD61B6E2C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:2CBD61B6E2C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:2DBD61B6E2C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:2EBD61B6E2C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:2FBD61B6E2C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:30BD61B6E2C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:31BD61B6E2C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:32BD61B6E2C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:15C92A89F7C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:16C92A89F7C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:17C92A89F7C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:18C92A89F7C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:1BC92A89F7C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:1CC92A89F7C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:1DC92A89F7C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:1EC92A89F7C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:1FC92A89F7C4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:2C0A7BD1FFC4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:2D0A7BD1FFC4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:2E0A7BD1FFC4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:2F0A7BD1FFC4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:300A7BD1FFC4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:310A7BD1FFC4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:320A7BD1FFC4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:330A7BD1FFC4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:340A7BD1FFC4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:350A7BD1FFC4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:360A7BD1FFC4DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:7384183703C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:7484183703C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:7584183703C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:7684183703C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:7784183703C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:7884183703C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:7984183703C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:7A84183703C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:7B84183703C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:7C84183703C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:7D84183703C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:9E10D8AA13C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:9F10D8AA13C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:A110D8AA13C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:A210D8AA13C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:A310D8AA13C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:A410D8AA13C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:A510D8AA13C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:A610D8AA13C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:A710D8AA13C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:A810D8AA13C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:669D930C16C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:679D930C16C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:689D930C16C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:6A9D930C16C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:709D930C16C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:6E174FF721C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:6F174FF721C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:70174FF721C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:71174FF721C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:72174FF721C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:73174FF721C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:74174FF721C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:75174FF721C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:76174FF721C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:77174FF721C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:78174FF721C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:AADE6DA426C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:ABDE6DA426C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:ACDE6DA426C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:ADDE6DA426C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:AEDE6DA426C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:AFDE6DA426C5DE11A824C2FD8246DD5F, xmp.iid:5C7DA285ADC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:5D7DA285ADC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:5E7DA285ADC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:5F7DA285ADC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:607DA285ADC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:617DA285ADC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:627DA285ADC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:637DA285ADC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:647DA285ADC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:657DA285ADC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:8EAFB38DBDC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:8FAFB38DBDC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:90AFB38DBDC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:91AFB38DBDC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:92AFB38DBDC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:93AFB38DBDC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:94AFB38DBDC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:95AFB38DBDC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:96AFB38DBDC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:97AFB38DBDC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:98AFB38DBDC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:2C9F290DC5C5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:2D9F290DC5C5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:2E9F290DC5C5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:2F9F290DC5C5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:309F290DC5C5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:319F290DC5C5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:329F290DC5C5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:339F290DC5C5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:349F290DC5C5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:359F290DC5C5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:369F290DC5C5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:37F2B867CBC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:38F2B867CBC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:39F2B867CBC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:3AF2B867CBC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:3BF2B867CBC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:3CF2B867CBC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:3DF2B867CBC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:3EF2B867CBC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:3FF2B867CBC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:40F2B867CBC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:41F2B867CBC5DE1186B8D0B3B09C6F8B, xmp.iid:3E614BFDD4C5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:3F614BFDD4C5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:40614BFDD4C5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:41614BFDD4C5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:42614BFDD4C5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:43614BFDD4C5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:44614BFDD4C5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:45614BFDD4C5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:46614BFDD4C5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:47614BFDD4C5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:0D76DB2FDAC5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:0E76DB2FDAC5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:0F76DB2FDAC5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:1076DB2FDAC5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:1176DB2FDAC5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:1276DB2FDAC5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:1376DB2FDAC5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:1476DB2FDAC5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:1576DB2FDAC5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:1676DB2FDAC5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:1776DB2FDAC5DE1191A1C9E013170317, xmp.iid:9DC635A2E9C5DE11B374DDA4A7F93874, xmp.iid:024D012F03C6DE11BE0A89D4A432F1FF, xmp.iid:7A16D82A09C6DE11BE0A89D4A432F1FF, xmp.iid:7C16D82A09C6DE11BE0A89D4A432F1FF, xmp.iid:7F16D82A09C6DE11BE0A89D4A432F1FF, xmp.iid:8016D82A09C6DE11BE0A89D4A432F1FF, xmp.iid:A9FB916B58C7DE11B4BAD450ABAD892D, xmp.iid:2C1071576BC7DE11B4BAD450ABAD892D, xmp.iid:A29CCF8FAAC7DE11B4BAD450ABAD892D, xmp.iid:B6926E7228C8DE11A41DE4A4F71FE42C, xmp.iid:4B4B496839C8DE11A41DE4A4F71FE42C, xmp.iid:2D5B1CB872C8DE118F34DA2C4049EC0F, xmp.iid:54EE1071D9C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:55EE1071D9C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:56EE1071D9C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:57EE1071D9C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:58EE1071D9C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:59EE1071D9C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:5AEE1071D9C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:5BEE1071D9C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:5CEE1071D9C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:B0F8BCD7E1C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:B1F8BCD7E1C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:B3F8BCD7E1C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:B4F8BCD7E1C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:B6F8BCD7E1C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:B7F8BCD7E1C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:B8F8BCD7E1C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:BAF8BCD7E1C8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:E338FD10EEC8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:E438FD10EEC8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:E538FD10EEC8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:E638FD10EEC8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:E738FD10EEC8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:E838FD10EEC8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:E938FD10EEC8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:EA38FD10EEC8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:EB38FD10EEC8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:ED38FD10EEC8DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:CC49BCC523C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:CD49BCC523C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:CE49BCC523C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:CF49BCC523C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:D049BCC523C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:D249BCC523C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:D349BCC523C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:D449BCC523C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:D549BCC523C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:D649BCC523C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:48B4DDDB32C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:49B4DDDB32C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:4AB4DDDB32C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:4BB4DDDB32C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:4CB4DDDB32C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:4DB4DDDB32C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:4EB4DDDB32C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:4FB4DDDB32C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:50B4DDDB32C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:51B4DDDB32C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:52B4DDDB32C9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:2CE21C343EC9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:2DE21C343EC9DE11A8BED356D09D54C0, xmp.iid:8976DB4B97C9DE118E0FAADEFA43452A, xmp.iid:8A76DB4B97C9DE118E0FAADEFA43452A, xmp.iid:74136F8B07CADE11BBCD909B3453E08E, xmp.iid:E37F2E316ACADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:E47F2E316ACADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:E57F2E316ACADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:E67F2E316ACADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:E77F2E316ACADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:E87F2E316ACADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:E97F2E316ACADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:EA7F2E316ACADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:EB7F2E316ACADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:EC7F2E316ACADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:31AFF9947CCADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:32AFF9947CCADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:33AFF9947CCADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:34AFF9947CCADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:35AFF9947CCADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:36AFF9947CCADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:37AFF9947CCADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:38AFF9947CCADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:39AFF9947CCADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:3AAFF9947CCADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:3BAFF9947CCADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:99D2CB7B84CADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:9AD2CB7B84CADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:9BD2CB7B84CADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:9CD2CB7B84CADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:9DD2CB7B84CADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:9ED2CB7B84CADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:9FD2CB7B84CADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:A0D2CB7B84CADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:A1D2CB7B84CADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:A2D2CB7B84CADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:A3D2CB7B84CADE11B957D7C29B57880D, xmp.iid:10B403E3B4CADE11A41BF4F12A29F5E7, xmp.iid:AB93D1122ECBDE118E6F89703CD257A9, xmp.iid:AC93D1122ECBDE118E6F89703CD257A9, xmp.iid:7E22A32733CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:7F22A32733CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:8022A32733CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:8122A32733CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:8222A32733CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:8322A32733CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:8422A32733CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:8522A32733CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:8622A32733CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:8722A32733CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:A9249A8440CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:AA249A8440CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:AB249A8440CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:AC249A8440CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:AD249A8440CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:AE249A8440CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:AF249A8440CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:B0249A8440CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:B1249A8440CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:B2249A8440CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:B3249A8440CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:C5B76A7F44CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:C8B76A7F44CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:EA8DA0154CCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:EB8DA0154CCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:EC8DA0154CCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:EE8DA0154CCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:D9CC897F63CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:DACC897F63CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:DCCC897F63CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:DDCC897F63CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:DECC897F63CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:DFCC897F63CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:E0CC897F63CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:E2CC897F63CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:E3CC897F63CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:F3967EAE6DCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:F5967EAE6DCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:F6967EAE6DCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:F7967EAE6DCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:F8967EAE6DCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:F9967EAE6DCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:FA967EAE6DCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:FB967EAE6DCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:FC967EAE6DCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:FD967EAE6DCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:9FB4259C72CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:A0B4259C72CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:A1B4259C72CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:A2B4259C72CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:A3B4259C72CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:A4B4259C72CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:A5B4259C72CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:A6B4259C72CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:A8B4259C72CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:A9B4259C72CBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:54E914247FCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:55E914247FCBDE118FBEB38F091B6E19, xmp.iid:2E9F461185CBDE11B133D5DCD5FD2ABD, xmp.iid:2F9F461185CBDE11B133D5DCD5FD2ABD, xmp.iid:CD0764288FCBDE11B133D5DCD5FD2ABD, xmp.iid:CE0764288FCBDE11B133D5DCD5FD2ABD, xmp.iid:92110CE1FACCDE119015F43EE7EE8D75, xmp.iid:F9143B7088CDDE11AF38BD176F5F84D1, xmp.iid:FA143B7088CDDE11AF38BD176F5F84D1, xmp.iid:FB143B7088CDDE11AF38BD176F5F84D1, xmp.iid:728F4B5F96CDDE1189BA90A26A63E759, xmp.iid:E19D5ABDA1CDDE1189BA90A26A63E759, xmp.iid:9417B38268CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:9517B38268CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:9617B38268CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:9717B38268CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:9817B38268CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:9917B38268CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:58C4A056A1CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:59C4A056A1CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:5AC4A056A1CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:5BC4A056A1CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:5CC4A056A1CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:5DC4A056A1CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:5EC4A056A1CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:5FC4A056A1CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:60C4A056A1CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:61C4A056A1CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:62C4A056A1CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:04ABF44AAACEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:05ABF44AAACEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:06ABF44AAACEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:07ABF44AAACEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:08ABF44AAACEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:09ABF44AAACEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:0AABF44AAACEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:0BABF44AAACEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:0CABF44AAACEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:0DABF44AAACEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:0EABF44AAACEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:73F415EBB0CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:74F415EBB0CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:75F415EBB0CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:76F415EBB0CEDE11A051D3B85E92BC0B, xmp.iid:6AF9AC83BDCEDE11A4C380D19E2D08B2, xmp.iid:8A18FF84E8CFDE119D958F87D7129856, xmp.iid:8B18FF84E8CFDE119D958F87D7129856, xmp.iid:E081BEE7EFCFDE119D958F87D7129856, xmp.iid:929505BC1DD0DE119206FD5F90957F14, xmp.iid:DFFD7ACFFBD0DE11AC99C9D7C71E78F8, xmp.iid:E2FD7ACFFBD0DE11AC99C9D7C71E78F8, xmp.iid:E4FD7ACFFBD0DE11AC99C9D7C71E78F8, xmp.iid:E5FD7ACFFBD0DE11AC99C9D7C71E78F8, xmp.iid:E6FD7ACFFBD0DE11AC99C9D7C71E78F8, xmp.iid:E7FD7ACFFBD0DE11AC99C9D7C71E78F8, xmp.iid:F17E47ED0ED1DE11AC99C9D7C71E78F8, xmp.iid:56560C6D87D2DE11B7DDFF095F24FA55, xmp.iid:BC1ED48396D2DE11B7DDFF095F24FA55, xmp.iid:BF1ED48396D2DE11B7DDFF095F24FA55, xmp.iid:C01ED48396D2DE11B7DDFF095F24FA55, xmp.iid:0168DAB506D3DE11A435EF8E3F8DF32B, xmp.iid:0268DAB506D3DE11A435EF8E3F8DF32B, xmp.iid:0368DAB506D3DE11A435EF8E3F8DF32B, xmp.iid:0468DAB506D3DE11A435EF8E3F8DF32B, xmp.iid:0568DAB506D3DE11A435EF8E3F8DF32B, xmp.iid:0768DAB506D3DE11A435EF8E3F8DF32B, xmp.iid:0868DAB506D3DE11A435EF8E3F8DF32B, xmp.iid:0968DAB506D3DE11A435EF8E3F8DF32B, xmp.iid:6C95349D0AD3DE11A435EF8E3F8DF32B, xmp.iid:5160C6A4D1D3DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:5260C6A4D1D3DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:5360C6A4D1D3DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:5460C6A4D1D3DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:5560C6A4D1D3DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:5760C6A4D1D3DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:5860C6A4D1D3DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:5960C6A4D1D3DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:5A60C6A4D1D3DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:57306A38F2D3DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:58306A38F2D3DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:59306A38F2D3DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:5A306A38F2D3DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:5B306A38F2D3DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:FCC3FC7D23D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:FDC3FC7D23D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:FEC3FC7D23D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:FFC3FC7D23D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:00C4FC7D23D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:01C4FC7D23D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:02C4FC7D23D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:03C4FC7D23D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:04C4FC7D23D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:05C4FC7D23D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:06C4FC7D23D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:F20FFB9130D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:F30FFB9130D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:F40FFB9130D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:F50FFB9130D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:F60FFB9130D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:F70FFB9130D4DE11BEB1C60C279677C0, xmp.iid:25DF916D9BD4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:26DF916D9BD4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:27DF916D9BD4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:28DF916D9BD4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:29DF916D9BD4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:2ADF916D9BD4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:2BDF916D9BD4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:2CDF916D9BD4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:2EDF916D9BD4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:6B73D195A2D4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:6C73D195A2D4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:6D73D195A2D4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:6E73D195A2D4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:6F73D195A2D4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:7073D195A2D4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:7173D195A2D4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:7273D195A2D4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:7373D195A2D4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:7473D195A2D4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:34EE3873A7D4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:83C7E955C9D4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:87C7E955C9D4DE11AFE9CC6824C02B05, xmp.iid:D4D7380F80D5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:D5D7380F80D5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:D6D7380F80D5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:D7D7380F80D5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:F4FD4DF98ED5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:F5FD4DF98ED5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:F6FD4DF98ED5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:F7FD4DF98ED5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:F8FD4DF98ED5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:F9FD4DF98ED5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:FAFD4DF98ED5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:FBFD4DF98ED5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:FEFD4DF98ED5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:FB9B40249BD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:FD9B40249BD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:FE9B40249BD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:FF9B40249BD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:009C40249BD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:019C40249BD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:029C40249BD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:039C40249BD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:049C40249BD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:059C40249BD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:4360AD499FD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:4460AD499FD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:4560AD499FD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:4660AD499FD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:4760AD499FD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:4860AD499FD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:4960AD499FD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:4A60AD499FD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:4B60AD499FD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:4C60AD499FD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:4D60AD499FD5DE11A74A8889B81B7C72, xmp.iid:963A3573C6D7DE1182BAB9EE6A34C543, xmp.iid:973A3573C6D7DE1182BAB9EE6A34C543, xmp.iid:983A3573C6D7DE1182BAB9EE6A34C543, xmp.iid:F9008C3268D9DE118633C16628FA8288, xmp.iid:58F5124513DEDE1184F8E791EF643D43, xmp.iid:59F5124513DEDE1184F8E791EF643D43, xmp.iid:5AF5124513DEDE1184F8E791EF643D43, xmp.iid:5BF5124513DEDE1184F8E791EF643D43, xmp.iid:5CF5124513DEDE1184F8E791EF643D43, xmp.iid:5DF5124513DEDE1184F8E791EF643D43, xmp.iid:5EF5124513DEDE1184F8E791EF643D43, xmp.iid:5FF5124513DEDE1184F8E791EF643D43, xmp.iid:6C9E5CBC33DEDE1184F8E791EF643D43, xmp.iid:6D9E5CBC33DEDE1184F8E791EF643D43, xmp.iid:0DA745C550DEDE1184F8E791EF643D43, xmp.iid:0EA745C550DEDE1184F8E791EF643D43, xmp.iid:C0F99427CEDEDE11818697FD975E7B57, xmp.iid:682F023166E0DE118A17DBD59E563E70, xmp.iid:692F023166E0DE118A17DBD59E563E70, xmp.iid:6A2F023166E0DE118A17DBD59E563E70, xmp.iid:4F4A51AF2FE1DE11A1D09CCDC3CA3143, xmp.iid:504A51AF2FE1DE11A1D09CCDC3CA3143, xmp.iid:514A51AF2FE1DE11A1D09CCDC3CA3143, xmp.iid:524A51AF2FE1DE11A1D09CCDC3CA3143, xmp.iid:534A51AF2FE1DE11A1D09CCDC3CA3143, xmp.iid:544A51AF2FE1DE11A1D09CCDC3CA3143, xmp.iid:564A51AF2FE1DE11A1D09CCDC3CA3143, xmp.iid:139C83C574E1DE11A3B9A44B9FCCC2C3, xmp.iid:D86F822707E3DE11A7D1C07E4900B43D, xmp.iid:9D873E0123E3DE11BC92FACEFE345497, xmp.iid:9E873E0123E3DE11BC92FACEFE345497, xmp.iid:9F873E0123E3DE11BC92FACEFE345497, xmp.iid:3ED23517CAE3DE11AD23CA5E06DEA7F4, xmp.iid:3FD23517CAE3DE11AD23CA5E06DEA7F4, xmp.iid:40D23517CAE3DE11AD23CA5E06DEA7F4, xmp.iid:44D23517CAE3DE11AD23CA5E06DEA7F4, xmp.iid:47D23517CAE3DE11AD23CA5E06DEA7F4, xmp.iid:F5627A0F52E4DE11A9C7C1BC28D919F2, xmp.iid:F6627A0F52E4DE11A9C7C1BC28D919F2, xmp.iid:F7627A0F52E4DE11A9C7C1BC28D919F2, xmp.iid:F8627A0F52E4DE11A9C7C1BC28D919F2, xmp.iid:F9627A0F52E4DE11A9C7C1BC28D919F2, xmp.iid:FA627A0F52E4DE11A9C7C1BC28D919F2, xmp.iid:174B16155AE4DE11A9C7C1BC28D919F2, xmp.iid:710760CA81E4DE11A6B898C80A551E6C, xmp.iid:720760CA81E4DE11A6B898C80A551E6C, xmp.iid:770760CA81E4DE11A6B898C80A551E6C, xmp.iid:998E603FF7E5DE11BFCDD933B44A153D, xmp.iid:9E8E603FF7E5DE11BFCDD933B44A153D, xmp.iid:C5F22235B8E6DE118849FE4CBDB57886, xmp.iid:C6F22235B8E6DE118849FE4CBDB57886, xmp.iid:C7F22235B8E6DE118849FE4CBDB57886, xmp.iid:32F52609C6E6DE11B5FCFBC16BD24D18, xmp.iid:33F52609C6E6DE11B5FCFBC16BD24D18, xmp.iid:890A76518BE8DE118CD2C4F835AA1DA2, xmp.iid:8A0A76518BE8DE118CD2C4F835AA1DA2, xmp.iid:8C0A76518BE8DE118CD2C4F835AA1DA2, xmp.iid:C0C32CB80BE9DE119B6CA99ACF9D8C5C, xmp.iid:C1C32CB80BE9DE119B6CA99ACF9D8C5C, xmp.iid:C3C32CB80BE9DE119B6CA99ACF9D8C5C, xmp.iid:C5C32CB80BE9DE119B6CA99ACF9D8C5C, xmp.iid:C6C32CB80BE9DE119B6CA99ACF9D8C5C, xmp.iid:C7C32CB80BE9DE119B6CA99ACF9D8C5C, xmp.iid:91072D1260E9DE11A474C60705FB35C1, xmp.iid:92072D1260E9DE11A474C60705FB35C1, xmp.iid:6B640B5567E9DE11A474C60705FB35C1, xmp.iid:9C93CD0E2AEADE11878CAB21E6D55565, xmp.iid:9D93CD0E2AEADE11878CAB21E6D55565, xmp.iid:A093CD0E2AEADE11878CAB21E6D55565, xmp.iid:8F29AD0146EADE11878CAB21E6D55565, xmp.iid:9529AD0146EADE11878CAB21E6D55565, xmp.iid:BD490C629AEADE1196C0812A1A6219EA, xmp.iid:C1490C629AEADE1196C0812A1A6219EA, xmp.iid:C2490C629AEADE1196C0812A1A6219EA, xmp.iid:2C0311B2D9EADE1196C0812A1A6219EA, xmp.iid:2E0311B2D9EADE1196C0812A1A6219EA, xmp.iid:8AA544DCEAEADE118CACE7E026A76F1A, xmp.iid:8BA544DCEAEADE118CACE7E026A76F1A, xmp.iid:8EA544DCEAEADE118CACE7E026A76F1A, xmp.iid:51D2979D7BEBDE118FF396061127D773, xmp.iid:53D2979D7BEBDE118FF396061127D773, xmp.iid:B6CB22CC83EBDE118FF396061127D773, xmp.iid:B7CB22CC83EBDE118FF396061127D773, xmp.iid:B8CB22CC83EBDE118FF396061127D773, xmp.iid:BF5947B372ECDE11996BF41365430BDA, xmp.iid:BF0A32E5B5F1DE1195B1E060965039E6, xmp.iid:D824F84376F2DE118F82DC0BC6F6400A, xmp.iid:3D11202760F3DE119996E1BAAC7EF6C5, xmp.iid:7582B43343F4DE11A730B59F2EA502BF, xmp.iid:7782B43343F4DE11A730B59F2EA502BF, xmp.iid:7982B43343F4DE11A730B59F2EA502BF, xmp.iid:CF250D5050F4DE118B23806482C97C77, xmp.iid:9CFF60C9D3F4DE119300B0D891A331D9, xmp.iid:9DFF60C9D3F4DE119300B0D891A331D9, xmp.iid:510A5E1904F5DE11A34EEBCFF7F2C8DC, xmp.iid:530A5E1904F5DE11A34EEBCFF7F2C8DC, xmp.iid:180A29C619F5DE11B022A34EA758ED00, xmp.iid:190A29C619F5DE11B022A34EA758ED00, xmp.iid:F26D705224F5DE1185C7AFDB3513FFA5, xmp.iid:778B68E094F5DE119D4380440D2C0718, xmp.iid:7A8B68E094F5DE119D4380440D2C0718, xmp.iid:D23DF4C9A1F5DE119D4380440D2C0718, xmp.iid:D33DF4C9A1F5DE119D4380440D2C0718, xmp.iid:95EA54E6AAF5DE119D4380440D2C0718, xmp.iid:C8A9840BCFF5DE119D4380440D2C0718, xmp.iid:CBA9840BCFF5DE119D4380440D2C0718, xmp.iid:590C51B7D7F5DE119D4380440D2C0718, xmp.iid:F90879AE0EF8DE118B85A99CEBFB1F7E, xmp.iid:EEBC728C15F8DE118B85A99CEBFB1F7E, xmp.iid:EFBC728C15F8DE118B85A99CEBFB1F7E, xmp.iid:F0BC728C15F8DE118B85A99CEBFB1F7E, xmp.iid:F1BC728C15F8DE118B85A99CEBFB1F7E, xmp.iid:F2BC728C15F8DE118B85A99CEBFB1F7E, xmp.iid:F5BC728C15F8DE118B85A99CEBFB1F7E, xmp.iid:7A16EC3D16F8DE118B85A99CEBFB1F7E, xmp.iid:75840719E8F8DE11AF6FEB254C19B804, xmp.iid:8B0C285355FADE11A77CE4444E4ABC1E, xmp.iid:8C0C285355FADE11A77CE4444E4ABC1E, xmp.iid:DC009871D0FADE11B842DE36062273E9, xmp.iid:607ABD6B18FBDE11B8FDE5BB5BC32BB1, xmp.iid:617ABD6B18FBDE11B8FDE5BB5BC32BB1, xmp.iid:657ABD6B18FBDE11B8FDE5BB5BC32BB1, xmp.iid:667ABD6B18FBDE11B8FDE5BB5BC32BB1, xmp.iid:E6094DC91AFBDE11B8FDE5BB5BC32BB1, xmp.iid:E9094DC91AFBDE11B8FDE5BB5BC32BB1, xmp.iid:5BB434D358FBDE11B8FDE5BB5BC32BB1, xmp.iid:5EB434D358FBDE11B8FDE5BB5BC32BB1, xmp.iid:E2F3AF0362FBDE11B8FDE5BB5BC32BB1, xmp.iid:E5F3AF0362FBDE11B8FDE5BB5BC32BB1, xmp.iid:D32773E594FBDE11AB34DB19E7C09EE4, xmp.iid:220C176C32FDDE11B50D98385D8634C1, xmp.iid:230C176C32FDDE11B50D98385D8634C1, xmp.iid:240C176C32FDDE11B50D98385D8634C1, xmp.iid:250C176C32FDDE11B50D98385D8634C1, xmp.iid:260C176C32FDDE11B50D98385D8634C1, xmp.iid:270C176C32FDDE11B50D98385D8634C1, xmp.iid:280C176C32FDDE11B50D98385D8634C1, xmp.iid:290C176C32FDDE11B50D98385D8634C1, xmp.iid:2527F96A35FDDE11B50D98385D8634C1, xmp.iid:65622F463CFDDE11B50D98385D8634C1, xmp.iid:90FFE526A3FDDE119388EBC0A9FE31B0, xmp.iid:96FFE526A3FDDE119388EBC0A9FE31B0, xmp.iid:F3F7EA7E59FEDE11B466DA3373392A30, xmp.iid:3A0F2FBC7FFEDE11BAD3B24891C82A99, xmp.iid:F3B92A6CA2FEDE11933DD4DBE845F31E, xmp.iid:B6A1B095DEFFDE11A490C8C1DAAE6A73, xmp.iid:B7A1B095DEFFDE11A490C8C1DAAE6A73, xmp.iid:B8A1B095DEFFDE11A490C8C1DAAE6A73, xmp.iid:B9A1B095DEFFDE11A490C8C1DAAE6A73, xmp.iid:D91C34B52600DF118DF9F9A280717EC3, xmp.iid:F75665333000DF119997ABB07B99009E, xmp.iid:F95665333000DF119997ABB07B99009E, xmp.iid:FA5665333000DF119997ABB07B99009E, xmp.iid:FB5665333000DF119997ABB07B99009E, xmp.iid:94E8E228E704DF119D0EACB5EB37E2F0, xmp.iid:95E8E228E704DF119D0EACB5EB37E2F0, xmp.iid:96E8E228E704DF119D0EACB5EB37E2F0, xmp.iid:0824AE0AB217DF119F76A7F7B7A63A9E, xmp.iid:05604E757E1CDF118983E35A33B9E4DE, xmp.iid:06604E757E1CDF118983E35A33B9E4DE, xmp.iid:07604E757E1CDF118983E35A33B9E4DE, xmp.iid:08604E757E1CDF118983E35A33B9E4DE, xmp.iid:09604E757E1CDF118983E35A33B9E4DE, xmp.iid:0A604E757E1CDF118983E35A33B9E4DE, xmp.iid:0B604E757E1CDF118983E35A33B9E4DE, xmp.iid:0C604E757E1CDF118983E35A33B9E4DE, xmp.iid:0D604E757E1CDF118983E35A33B9E4DE, xmp.iid:0E604E757E1CDF118983E35A33B9E4DE, xmp.iid:089F56D3921CDF118983E35A33B9E4DE, xmp.iid:099F56D3921CDF118983E35A33B9E4DE, xmp.iid:BBF2B997CA1DDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:C0F2B997CA1DDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:6BED6CB2F71DDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:6CED6CB2F71DDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:6DED6CB2F71DDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:6EED6CB2F71DDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:6FED6CB2F71DDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:90DFB5E4011EDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:91DFB5E4011EDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:92DFB5E4011EDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:93DFB5E4011EDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:95DFB5E4011EDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:4ECAB202091EDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:634262851C1EDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:6B4262851C1EDF11A2E7D45383DBA789, xmp.iid:340C8F3F4D1FDF11B9DEB6DC5DA5CB95, xmp.iid:390C8F3F4D1FDF11B9DEB6DC5DA5CB95, xmp.iid:3A0C8F3F4D1FDF11B9DEB6DC5DA5CB95, xmp.iid:59CE17A85F1FDF11B9DEB6DC5DA5CB95, xmp.iid:5ECE17A85F1FDF11B9DEB6DC5DA5CB95, xmp.iid:96E10F329D1FDF11AD50B5722F8D9515, xmp.iid:97E10F329D1FDF11AD50B5722F8D9515, xmp.iid:99E10F329D1FDF11AD50B5722F8D9515, xmp.iid:9BE10F329D1FDF11AD50B5722F8D9515, xmp.iid:2D572406AB1FDF119A0FD408C1671260, xmp.iid:2E572406AB1FDF119A0FD408C1671260, xmp.iid:2F572406AB1FDF119A0FD408C1671260, xmp.iid:30572406AB1FDF119A0FD408C1671260, xmp.iid:DB89FB2C0322DF11A075AA456D04E50D, xmp.iid:56C32A036D2ADF118B24A3821AA060C7, xmp.iid:57C32A036D2ADF118B24A3821AA060C7, xmp.iid:DC346213852ADF118B24A3821AA060C7, xmp.iid:7FB74101932ADF118B24A3821AA060C7, xmp.iid:A3D4CD51192BDF1184BAA476141C14C6, xmp.iid:9B05850C572BDF119E74B59AC078E019, xmp.iid:9C05850C572BDF119E74B59AC078E019, xmp.iid:A005850C572BDF119E74B59AC078E019, xmp.iid:F99A0C8A092CDF119AD9E0F737C50DE1, xmp.iid:FA9A0C8A092CDF119AD9E0F737C50DE1, xmp.iid:FC9A0C8A092CDF119AD9E0F737C50DE1, xmp.iid:A8511711162CDF119AD9E0F737C50DE1, xmp.iid:AB511711162CDF119AD9E0F737C50DE1, xmp.iid:AC511711162CDF119AD9E0F737C50DE1, xmp.iid:E1AF68EB2F2CDF118E7CB3A78E7663E8, xmp.iid:B81564B02E32DF11AB799DE341567DEC, xmp.iid:9285617D3632DF11A56FDFBF2AC50691, xmp.iid:9385617D3632DF11A56FDFBF2AC50691, xmp.iid:DC295A384E32DF11BFC0FEF3BFB4EF55, xmp.iid:DD295A384E32DF11BFC0FEF3BFB4EF55, xmp.iid:F78692975C32DF119DD5ECABBD8A4AEE, xmp.iid:290E1DEA7832DF11BFCD9CCF569D06EF, xmp.iid:2A0E1DEA7832DF11BFCD9CCF569D06EF, xmp.iid:2B0E1DEA7832DF11BFCD9CCF569D06EF, xmp.iid:2C0E1DEA7832DF11BFCD9CCF569D06EF, xmp.iid:2D0E1DEA7832DF11BFCD9CCF569D06EF, xmp.iid:2E0E1DEA7832DF11BFCD9CCF569D06EF, xmp.iid:686C34DAE732DF11931C8AF9A567CF4E, xmp.iid:696C34DAE732DF11931C8AF9A567CF4E, xmp.iid:F68CA3B0F132DF1188D0B58540EA1B41, xmp.iid:F78CA3B0F132DF1188D0B58540EA1B41, xmp.iid:F88CA3B0F132DF1188D0B58540EA1B41, xmp.iid:F98CA3B0F132DF1188D0B58540EA1B41, xmp.iid:4276E180F732DF11ABB5A61C9957AFEE, xmp.iid:C34447061D33DF1184CBC59D4ABFBC73, xmp.iid:C44447061D33DF1184CBC59D4ABFBC73, xmp.iid:C54447061D33DF1184CBC59D4ABFBC73, xmp.iid:C64447061D33DF1184CBC59D4ABFBC73, xmp.iid:EFB459632733DF11AF7D9B1AF716923B, xmp.iid:F1B459632733DF11AF7D9B1AF716923B, xmp.iid:F2B459632733DF11AF7D9B1AF716923B, xmp.iid:F4B459632733DF11AF7D9B1AF716923B, xmp.iid:A9550916DE36DF11B8C7FAB40CC0EE79, xmp.iid:AA550916DE36DF11B8C7FAB40CC0EE79, xmp.iid:845E6D0DB137DF1193178E7906A4D677, xmp.iid:A110C0D7B237DF11B82BC6A7678194EB, xmp.iid:A6B2051EE637DF11A8C3CC96E18D5F3C, xmp.iid:A8B2051EE637DF11A8C3CC96E18D5F3C, xmp.iid:A9B2051EE637DF11A8C3CC96E18D5F3C, xmp.iid:80147485F737DF11BB8AAB6F2206F755, xmp.iid:94CD0B6F6938DF11818AE395370CBE34, xmp.iid:95CD0B6F6938DF11818AE395370CBE34, xmp.iid:BA0AF5707138DF11B7C5DBBF8B47BB43, xmp.iid:BB0AF5707138DF11B7C5DBBF8B47BB43, xmp.iid:64525A287538DF11A698931849A56D1A, xmp.iid:9CA5EBB7983BDF11B747FDDAA56DF20F, xmp.iid:ECE619AB993BDF11A4B8E6E463156905, xmp.iid:23823D2F9F3BDF11A2D6BCA045B1AEB2, xmp.iid:24823D2F9F3BDF11A2D6BCA045B1AEB2, xmp.iid:0DA00A60BA3BDF11B88398B9010BD1DD, xmp.iid:12A00A60BA3BDF11B88398B9010BD1DD, xmp.iid:7D27C236C73BDF11BD75BCAB72FC98AE, xmp.iid:763FD9D5CC3BDF11BD75BCAB72FC98AE, xmp.iid:97B3D71B743CDF119A7BA1F40AFD7D2A, xmp.iid:98B3D71B743CDF119A7BA1F40AFD7D2A, xmp.iid:99B3D71B743CDF119A7BA1F40AFD7D2A, xmp.iid:9EB3D71B743CDF119A7BA1F40AFD7D2A, xmp.iid:36320ADB813CDF119A7BA1F40AFD7D2A, xmp.iid:38320ADB813CDF119A7BA1F40AFD7D2A, xmp.iid:7189CA2C873CDF119A7BA1F40AFD7D2A, xmp.iid:1001DD618B3CDF119A7BA1F40AFD7D2A, xmp.iid:F61C28EA113EDF11BD6FD49C3BF7D117, xmp.iid:F71C28EA113EDF11BD6FD49C3BF7D117, xmp.iid:D940AA83173EDF119C0494DCCB617249, xmp.iid:DA40AA83173EDF119C0494DCCB617249, xmp.iid:DB40AA83173EDF119C0494DCCB617249, xmp.iid:50EB77266847DF119292B557E8298E1A, xmp.iid:211224268647DF11985EC7C6E57D631E, xmp.iid:221224268647DF11985EC7C6E57D631E, xmp.iid:231224268647DF11985EC7C6E57D631E, xmp.iid:FE9057732149DF1188EEE1997AA26332, xmp.iid:991EDACD974BDF11BEA6A0572452BB0D, xmp.iid:B0B563D74D4CDF11B4798DE86BB077AE, xmp.iid:B3B563D74D4CDF11B4798DE86BB077AE, xmp.iid:6E50F9FF554CDF118218A178EFBEF290, xmp.iid:766E68A11D53DF11BD55AE7EBFF4E1E6, xmp.iid:776E68A11D53DF11BD55AE7EBFF4E1E6, xmp.iid:786E68A11D53DF11BD55AE7EBFF4E1E6, xmp.iid:796E68A11D53DF11BD55AE7EBFF4E1E6, xmp.iid:7A6E68A11D53DF11BD55AE7EBFF4E1E6, xmp.iid:FAD3C7BDF05BDF11A2F990A52AAB2629, xmp.iid:FBD3C7BDF05BDF11A2F990A52AAB2629, xmp.iid:A904F9D7FD5BDF11A2F990A52AAB2629, xmp.iid:A498BA4A005CDF11B928B526E6A89163, xmp.iid:A598BA4A005CDF11B928B526E6A89163, xmp.iid:20123932015CDF118CEFC3CF6EE603E0, xmp.iid:E7CB4BD40C62DF1199BB8BFFFC7E54F8, xmp.iid:D08265841462DF1199BB8BFFFC7E54F8, xmp.iid:4DB3478B4C62DF11BE3FC8FB64C71F0D, xmp.iid:4EB3478B4C62DF11BE3FC8FB64C71F0D, xmp.iid:4FB3478B4C62DF11BE3FC8FB64C71F0D, xmp.iid:50B3478B4C62DF11BE3FC8FB64C71F0D, xmp.iid:53B3478B4C62DF11BE3FC8FB64C71F0D, xmp.iid:B1CDD98D5562DF11BE3FC8FB64C71F0D, xmp.iid:B2CDD98D5562DF11BE3FC8FB64C71F0D, xmp.iid:B6CDD98D5562DF11BE3FC8FB64C71F0D, xmp.iid:3AA1E8296062DF11BE3FC8FB64C71F0D, xmp.iid:3DA1E8296062DF11BE3FC8FB64C71F0D, xmp.iid:8D1329B42063DF118FE593AC40EEDFE0, xmp.iid:8E1329B42063DF118FE593AC40EEDFE0, xmp.iid:2563D24F0067DF11A2CBF97C5EBDA10A, xmp.iid:2663D24F0067DF11A2CBF97C5EBDA10A, xmp.iid:41F6CA215667DF119F72C19897749E7D, xmp.iid:42F6CA215667DF119F72C19897749E7D, xmp.iid:43F6CA215667DF119F72C19897749E7D, xmp.iid:0124021E2E69DF11B9AE90F9F00ED1E7, xmp.iid:0224021E2E69DF11B9AE90F9F00ED1E7, xmp.iid:0324021E2E69DF11B9AE90F9F00ED1E7, xmp.iid:0424021E2E69DF11B9AE90F9F00ED1E7, xmp.iid:0524021E2E69DF11B9AE90F9F00ED1E7, xmp.iid:0624021E2E69DF11B9AE90F9F00ED1E7, xmp.iid:0724021E2E69DF11B9AE90F9F00ED1E7, xmp.iid:0824021E2E69DF11B9AE90F9F00ED1E7, xmp.iid:0924021E2E69DF11B9AE90F9F00ED1E7, xmp.iid:0A24021E2E69DF11B9AE90F9F00ED1E7, xmp.iid:365BC2BC4B69DF11B9AE90F9F00ED1E7, xmp.iid:375BC2BC4B69DF11B9AE90F9F00ED1E7, xmp.iid:385BC2BC4B69DF11B9AE90F9F00ED1E7, xmp.iid:B79E9B2E5C69DF1182A5C5B5DBEE4AA4, xmp.iid:BC9E9B2E5C69DF1182A5C5B5DBEE4AA4, xmp.iid:7A9908246469DF1182A5C5B5DBEE4AA4, xmp.iid:BF0EEACC156ADF1194D1FFAF0ABBF932, xmp.iid:D3E1B235256ADF1194D1FFAF0ABBF932, xmp.iid:D8E1B235256ADF1194D1FFAF0ABBF932, xmp.iid:033D12587E6CDF118046953C529FB349, xmp.iid:043D12587E6CDF118046953C529FB349, xmp.iid:063D12587E6CDF118046953C529FB349, xmp.iid:8D28316F846CDF118046953C529FB349, xmp.iid:7F8EEF16D971DF11A9D28F987BFEF176, xmp.iid:808EEF16D971DF11A9D28F987BFEF176, xmp.iid:848EEF16D971DF11A9D28F987BFEF176, xmp.iid:B38FEBD15177DF11A3C6DFFF862A5539, xmp.iid:B48FEBD15177DF11A3C6DFFF862A5539, xmp.iid:A3500246237FDF11825FC46C9A1FF3BB, xmp.iid:E69C3587267FDF11825FC46C9A1FF3BB, xmp.iid:E79C3587267FDF11825FC46C9A1FF3BB, xmp.iid:EE9C3587267FDF11825FC46C9A1FF3BB, xmp.iid:EF9C3587267FDF11825FC46C9A1FF3BB, xmp.iid:62270438297FDF11825FC46C9A1FF3BB, xmp.iid:A713916D307FDF11825FC46C9A1FF3BB, xmp.iid:A813916D307FDF11825FC46C9A1FF3BB, xmp.iid:0D2B95A7327FDF11B0DD9452AB58C392, xmp.iid:C48F2CC85183DF11B83AC921FB27C1AE, xmp.iid:C58F2CC85183DF11B83AC921FB27C1AE, xmp.iid:6982B0108D89DF119F4AC702F6A70AB5, xmp.iid:6A82B0108D89DF119F4AC702F6A70AB5 History When : 2009:09:28 14:22:48+09:00, 2009:09:28 14:24:19+09:00, 2009:09:28 14:24:20+09:00, 2009:09:28 16:24:11+09:00, 2009:09:28 16:39:08+09:00, 2009:09:28 17:30:37+09:00, 2009:09:28 18:24:28+09:00, 2009:09:28 19:10:14+09:00, 2009:09:28 19:27:25+09:00, 2009:09:28 19:28:56+09:00, 2009:10:07 20:33:28+09:00, 2009:10:08 09:30:18+09:00, 2009:10:08 10:31:01+09:00, 2009:10:08 11:26:36+09:00, 2009:10:08 11:29:42+09:00, 2009:10:08 12:03:56+09:00, 2009:10:08 12:29:37+09:00, 2009:10:08 17:42:20+09:00, 2009:10:08 19:31:40+09:00, 2009:10:09 08:12:48+09:00, 2009:10:09 08:48:08+09:00, 2009:10:09 09:25:41+09:00, 2009:10:09 09:32:43+09:00, 2009:10:09 10:13:11+09:00, 2009:10:09 11:09:37+09:00, 2009:10:09 12:10:05+09:00, 2009:10:09 12:15:57+09:00, 2009:10:09 12:21:36+09:00, 2009:10:09 12:22:02+09:00, 2009:10:09 13:47:13+09:00, 2009:10:09 13:56:37+09:00, 2009:10:09 13:59:40+09:00, 2009:10:09 14:16:47+09:00, 2009:10:09 14:34:13+09:00, 2009:10:09 14:43:50+09:00, 2009:10:09 14:45:47+09:00, 2009:10:09 15:13:13+09:00, 2009:10:09 15:56:51+09:00, 2009:10:09 15:59:45+09:00, 2009:10:09 16:04:24+09:00, 2009:10:09 16:30:37+09:00, 2009:10:09 16:35:59+09:00, 2009:10:09 16:45:31+09:00, 2009:10:09 17:12:18+09:00, 2009:10:09 17:24:41+09:00, 2009:10:09 17:26:03+09:00, 2009:10:09 17:34:30+09:00, 2009:10:09 17:35:25+09:00, 2009:10:09 17:38:45+09:00, 2009:10:09 17:41:32+09:00, 2009:10:09 17:43:30+09:00, 2009:10:09 17:48:55+09:00, 2009:10:09 17:56:43+09:00, 2009:10:09 18:02:16+09:00, 2009:10:09 18:08+09:00, 2009:10:09 18:20:59+09:00, 2009:10:09 18:25:16+09:00, 2009:10:09 18:25:50+09:00, 2009:10:09 18:30:07+09:00, 2009:10:09 18:35:55+09:00, 2009:10:09 18:37:58+09:00, 2009:10:09 18:40:34+09:00, 2009:10:09 18:54:22+09:00, 2009:10:09 18:55:10+09:00, 2009:10:09 19:31:16+09:00, 2009:10:09 19:31:54+09:00, 2009:10:09 19:33:40+09:00, 2009:10:09 19:34:09+09:00, 2009:10:09 19:46:05+09:00, 2009:10:09 19:50:05+09:00, 2009:10:09 19:50:30+09:00, 2009:10:09 19:54:30+09:00, 2009:10:09 19:54:41+09:00, 2009:10:09 19:57:06+09:00, 2009:10:09 20:17:51+09:00, 2009:10:09 20:30:07+09:00, 2009:10:09 20:30:54+09:00, 2009:10:09 20:31:45+09:00, 2009:10:12 08:20:19+09:00, 2009:10:12 08:27:30+09:00, 2009:10:12 08:32:05+09:00, 2009:10:12 08:40:33+09:00, 2009:10:12 08:47:23+09:00, 2009:10:12 08:52:25+09:00, 2009:10:12 08:52:38+09:00, 2009:10:12 08:53:53+09:00, 2009:10:12 08:54:50+09:00, 2009:10:12 11:17:46+09:00, 2009:10:12 12:02:47+09:00, 2009:10:12 13:39:05+09:00, 2009:10:12 14:26:13+09:00, 2009:10:12 15:19:21+09:00, 2009:10:12 15:22:15+09:00, 2009:10:12 15:40:50+09:00, 2009:10:12 15:44:48+09:00, 2009:10:12 15:46:26+09:00, 2009:10:12 16:02:54+09:00, 2009:10:12 16:03:09+09:00, 2009:10:12 16:05:36+09:00, 2009:10:12 16:12:21+09:00, 2009:10:12 16:19:35+09:00, 2009:10:12 16:36:11+09:00, 2009:10:12 16:50:31+09:00, 2009:10:12 17:02:26+09:00, 2009:10:12 17:14:50+09:00, 2009:10:12 17:26:40+09:00, 2009:10:12 17:27:08+09:00, 2009:10:12 18:46:31+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:12:28+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:17:37+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:21:42+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:22:27+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:27:59+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:35:30+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:36:34+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:36:42+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:37:28+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:37:37+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:38:32+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:39:01+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:53:36+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:53:49+09:00, 2009:10:12 19:54:49+09:00, 2009:10:12 20:03:09+09:00, 2009:10:12 20:08:22+09:00, 2009:10:12 20:27:05+09:00, 2009:10:12 20:31:36+09:00, 2009:10:12 20:31:47+09:00, 2009:10:13 08:26:18+09:00, 2009:10:13 13:27:37+09:00, 2009:10:13 13:31:28+09:00, 2009:10:13 13:38:24+09:00, 2009:10:13 14:04:16+09:00, 2009:10:13 14:32:16+09:00, 2009:10:13 14:32:54+09:00, 2009:10:13 14:41:06+09:00, 2009:10:13 15:50:28+09:00, 2009:10:13 15:52:21+09:00, 2009:10:14 10:40:55+09:00, 2009:10:14 10:42:51+09:00, 2009:10:14 13:51:47+09:00, 2009:10:21 17:29:14+09:00, 2009:10:22 19:55:27+09:00, 2009:10:22 20:01:56+09:00, 2009:10:22 20:25:19+09:00, 2009:10:22 20:32:13+09:00, 2009:10:23 09:37:50+09:00, 2009:10:23 09:47:33+09:00, 2009:10:23 14:22:23+09:00, 2009:10:23 14:40:56+09:00, 2009:10:23 15:07:37+09:00, 2009:10:23 15:56:32+09:00, 2009:10:23 16:18:50+09:00, 2009:10:23 16:19:55+09:00, 2009:10:23 16:27:48+09:00, 2009:10:23 16:38:43+09:00, 2009:10:23 16:39:09+09:00, 2009:10:23 16:41:32+09:00, 2009:10:23 16:43:42+09:00, 2009:10:23 17:00:44+09:00, 2009:10:23 17:01:52+09:00, 2009:10:23 17:02:11+09:00, 2009:10:23 18:48:11+09:00, 2009:10:23 18:58:45+09:00, 2009:10:23 19:11:49+09:00, 2009:10:23 19:14:35+09:00, 2009:10:24 09:18:40+09:00, 2009:10:24 09:33:40+09:00, 2009:10:24 11:52:01+09:00, 2009:10:24 19:12:21+09:00, 2009:10:24 19:23:47+09:00, 2009:10:24 19:24:18+09:00, 2009:10:24 19:26:02+09:00, 2009:10:24 19:37:31+09:00, 2009:10:24 19:37:52+09:00, 2009:10:24 19:43:57+09:00, 2009:10:24 19:45:58+09:00, 2009:10:26 13:44:18+09:00, 2009:10:26 18:11:49+09:00, 2009:10:29 10:55+09:00, 2009:10:29 10:55:37+09:00, 2009:10:29 10:57:36+09:00, 2009:10:29 10:59:02+09:00, 2009:10:29 10:59:15+09:00, 2009:10:29 10:59:34+09:00, 2009:10:29 10:59:39+09:00, 2009:10:29 10:59:45+09:00, 2009:10:29 10:59:53+09:00, 2009:10:29 14:36:06+09:00, 2009:10:29 14:38:22+09:00, 2009:10:29 14:57:24+09:00, 2009:10:29 15:42:11+09:00, 2009:10:29 17:01:54+09:00, 2009:10:29 17:03:57+09:00, 2009:10:29 17:18:18+09:00, 2009:10:29 17:19:23+09:00, 2009:10:29 17:31:25+09:00, 2009:10:29 17:32:32+09:00, 2009:10:30 09:26:24+09:00, 2009:10:30 09:28:25+09:00, 2009:10:30 09:28:44+09:00, 2009:10:30 09:34:58+09:00, 2009:10:30 10:35:31+09:00, 2009:10:30 10:41:41+09:00, 2009:10:30 10:56:40+09:00, 2009:10:30 10:56:47+09:00, 2009:10:30 10:57:10+09:00, 2009:10:30 10:58:19+09:00, 2009:10:30 10:58:35+09:00, 2009:10:30 10:58:59+09:00, 2009:10:30 11:17:04+09:00, 2009:10:30 11:22:23+09:00, 2009:10:30 11:24+09:00, 2009:10:30 11:55:18+09:00, 2009:10:30 11:55:29+09:00, 2009:10:30 11:56:27+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:03:59+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:04:08+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:04:20+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:14:29+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:17:17+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:18:35+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:18:59+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:19:28+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:20:29+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:20:37+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:20:46+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:25+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:28:07+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:29:16+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:29:48+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:30:04+09:00, 2009:10:30 12:30:34+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:09:36+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:10:02+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:11:16+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:11:40+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:18:32+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:18:40+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:22:59+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:23:14+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:25:16+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:26:52+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:29:23+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:31:13+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:33:46+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:35:19+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:35:35+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:38:39+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:38:47+09:00, 2009:10:30 14:40:20+09:00, 2009:10:30 15:59:40+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:00:54+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:10:16+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:12:30+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:12:40+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:16:04+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:16:23+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:22:32+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:25:35+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:29:40+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:30:25+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:30:54+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:34:22+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:34:57+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:48:33+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:55:59+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:57:12+09:00, 2009:10:30 16:57:17+09:00, 2009:10:31 08:39:52+09:00, 2009:10:31 08:41:03+09:00, 2009:10:31 08:42:25+09:00, 2009:10:31 08:42:56+09:00, 2009:10:31 08:43:30+09:00, 2009:10:31 09:13:39+09:00, 2009:10:31 09:49:07+09:00, 2009:10:31 10:23:49+09:00, 2009:10:31 10:24:23+09:00, 2009:10:31 10:28:46+09:00, 2009:10:31 10:34:38+09:00, 2009:10:31 10:38:54+09:00, 2009:10:31 10:39:19+09:00, 2009:10:31 10:39:42+09:00, 2009:10:31 10:39:48+09:00, 2009:10:31 10:54:22+09:00, 2009:10:31 11:07:03+09:00, 2009:10:31 11:07:08+09:00, 2009:10:31 11:08:42+09:00, 2009:10:31 11:18:45+09:00, 2009:10:31 11:22:21+09:00, 2009:10:31 11:28:18+09:00, 2009:10:31 11:53:01+09:00, 2009:10:31 11:59:25+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:00:58+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:08:30+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:08:35+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:08:54+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:09:33+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:10:21+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:13:01+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:13:29+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:13:47+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:20:27+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:26:32+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:26:51+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:27:09+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:30:01+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:30:11+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:31+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:31:16+09:00, 2009:10:31 12:31:27+09:00, 2009:10:31 13:11:51+09:00, 2009:10:31 13:22:24+09:00, 2009:10:31 13:28:08+09:00, 2009:10:31 13:38:39+09:00, 2009:10:31 13:38:58+09:00, 2009:10:31 13:39:54+09:00, 2009:10:31 13:40:06+09:00, 2009:10:31 13:43:17+09:00, 2009:10:31 13:43:29+09:00, 2009:10:31 13:49:28+09:00, 2009:10:31 13:54:31+09:00, 2009:10:31 13:59:36+09:00, 2009:10:31 14:00:04+09:00, 2009:10:31 14:01:47+09:00, 2009:10:31 14:06:19+09:00, 2009:10:31 14:06:31+09:00, 2009:10:31 14:06:40+09:00, 2009:10:31 14:07:06+09:00, 2009:10:31 14:07:58+09:00, 2009:10:31 14:08:12+09:00, 2009:10:31 14:08:29+09:00, 2009:10:31 14:12:56+09:00, 2009:10:31 16:08:51+09:00, 2009:10:31 19:11:13+09:00, 2009:10:31 19:35:54+09:00, 2009:10:31 19:40:10+09:00, 2009:10:31 19:47:27+09:00, 2009:10:31 19:49:07+09:00, 2009:11:02 11:36:50+09:00, 2009:11:02 14:30:39+09:00, 2009:11:02 21:32:52+09:00, 2009:11:03 13:53:04+09:00, 2009:11:03 14:28:56+09:00, 2009:11:03 21:16:30+09:00, 2009:11:04 09:31:58+09:00, 2009:11:04 09:34:11+09:00, 2009:11:04 09:36:43+09:00, 2009:11:04 09:38:14+09:00, 2009:11:04 09:59:52+09:00, 2009:11:04 10:01:50+09:00, 2009:11:04 10:09:45+09:00, 2009:11:04 10:10:27+09:00, 2009:11:04 10:29:30+09:00, 2009:11:04 10:31:58+09:00, 2009:11:04 10:42:45+09:00, 2009:11:04 10:44:49+09:00, 2009:11:04 10:53:34+09:00, 2009:11:04 11:26:13+09:00, 2009:11:04 11:26:34+09:00, 2009:11:04 11:26:40+09:00, 2009:11:04 11:46:41+09:00, 2009:11:04 11:59:28+09:00, 2009:11:04 12:00:08+09:00, 2009:11:04 12:00:22+09:00, 2009:11:04 13:57:58+09:00, 2009:11:04 14:35:51+09:00, 2009:11:04 14:36:03+09:00, 2009:11:04 16:48:53+09:00, 2009:11:04 17:12:05+09:00, 2009:11:04 17:13:41+09:00, 2009:11:04 18:13:29+09:00, 2009:11:04 18:23:54+09:00, 2009:11:04 18:24:48+09:00, 2009:11:04 18:50:14+09:00, 2009:11:04 18:54:56+09:00, 2009:11:04 19:16:06+09:00, 2009:11:04 19:21:59+09:00, 2009:11:04 19:29+09:00, 2009:11:04 19:30:19+09:00, 2009:11:04 19:30:34+09:00, 2009:11:04 19:39:40+09:00, 2009:11:04 20:11:54+09:00, 2009:11:04 20:20:19+09:00, 2009:11:04 20:20:31+09:00, 2009:11:04 20:21:44+09:00, 2009:11:04 20:21:59+09:00, 2009:11:04 20:22:50+09:00, 2009:11:04 20:23:59+09:00, 2009:11:04 20:45:53+09:00, 2009:11:04 21:19:40+09:00, 2009:11:04 21:20:34+09:00, 2009:11:04 21:25:14+09:00, 2009:11:04 21:33:06+09:00, 2009:11:04 21:33:42+09:00, 2009:11:05 08:10:51+09:00, 2009:11:05 08:18:12+09:00, 2009:11:05 21:34:22+09:00, 2009:11:06 09:20:30+09:00, 2009:11:06 09:21:41+09:00, 2009:11:06 09:21:52+09:00, 2009:11:06 09:24:42+09:00, 2009:11:06 09:25:49+09:00, 2009:11:06 11:06:29+09:00, 2009:11:06 11:08:13+09:00, 2009:11:06 11:16:09+09:00, 2009:11:06 11:30:26+09:00, 2009:11:06 11:30:52+09:00, 2009:11:06 11:32:09+09:00, 2009:11:06 11:32:13+09:00, 2009:11:06 11:59:40+09:00, 2009:11:06 12:01:50+09:00, 2009:11:06 12:07:12+09:00, 2009:11:06 12:09:12+09:00, 2009:11:06 12:13:05+09:00, 2009:11:06 12:13:35+09:00, 2009:11:06 12:14:19+09:00, 2009:11:06 12:23:50+09:00, 2009:11:06 12:28:28+09:00, 2009:11:06 12:28:42+09:00, 2009:11:06 13:43:09+09:00, 2009:11:06 14:56:06+09:00, 2009:11:06 15:02:54+09:00, 2009:11:06 15:04:05+09:00, 2009:11:06 15:04:25+09:00, 2009:11:06 15:38:35+09:00, 2009:11:06 16:05:30+09:00, 2009:11:06 18:07:53+09:00, 2009:11:06 18:08:08+09:00, 2009:11:06 18:10:39+09:00, 2009:11:06 18:15:11+09:00, 2009:11:07 08:42:41+09:00, 2009:11:07 08:43:15+09:00, 2009:11:07 09:19:03+09:00, 2009:11:07 09:21:03+09:00, 2009:11:07 09:45:15+09:00, 2009:11:07 10:32:42+09:00, 2009:11:07 10:35:32+09:00, 2009:11:07 10:39:07+09:00, 2009:11:07 10:47:34+09:00, 2009:11:07 10:48:12+09:00, 2009:11:07 10:52:44+09:00, 2009:11:07 10:53:57+09:00, 2009:11:07 10:54:43+09:00, 2009:11:07 10:54:45+09:00, 2009:11:07 10:58:54+09:00, 2009:11:07 10:59:02+09:00, 2009:11:07 10:59:13+09:00, 2009:11:07 10:59:36+09:00, 2009:11:07 11:04:12+09:00, 2009:11:07 11:06:06+09:00, 2009:11:07 11:13:29+09:00, 2009:11:07 11:14:14+09:00, 2009:11:07 11:14:35+09:00, 2009:11:07 11:23:12+09:00, 2009:11:07 11:41:35+09:00, 2009:11:07 14:15:49+09:00, 2009:11:07 14:16:14+09:00, 2009:11:07 14:16:41+09:00, 2009:11:07 14:43:46+09:00, 2009:11:07 15:05:06+09:00, 2009:11:07 15:13:39+09:00, 2009:11:07 15:18:16+09:00, 2009:11:07 15:18:21+09:00, 2009:11:07 15:18:52+09:00, 2009:11:07 15:18:58+09:00, 2009:11:07 15:19:05+09:00, 2009:11:07 15:56:12+09:00, 2009:11:07 15:59:49+09:00, 2009:11:07 16:18+09:00, 2009:11:07 16:27:45+09:00, 2009:11:07 16:32:06+09:00, 2009:11:07 16:32:41+09:00, 2009:11:07 16:37:17+09:00, 2009:11:07 16:41:41+09:00, 2009:11:07 16:42:53+09:00, 2009:11:07 16:45:38+09:00, 2009:11:07 16:46:49+09:00, 2009:11:07 16:47:29+09:00, 2009:11:07 16:53:17+09:00, 2009:11:07 16:58:46+09:00, 2009:11:07 17:02:33+09:00, 2009:11:07 17:03:13+09:00, 2009:11:07 17:03:52+09:00, 2009:11:07 17:07:32+09:00, 2009:11:07 17:07:42+09:00, 2009:11:07 17:07:59+09:00, 2009:11:07 18:02:24+09:00, 2009:11:07 18:03:16+09:00, 2009:11:07 18:29:18+09:00, 2009:11:07 18:29:59+09:00, 2009:11:07 19:46:46+09:00, 2009:11:07 20:07:26+09:00, 2009:11:07 20:21:41+09:00, 2009:11:07 20:21:52+09:00, 2009:11:09 16:17:13+09:00, 2009:11:10 08:46:55+09:00, 2009:11:10 08:47:28+09:00, 2009:11:10 08:47:33+09:00, 2009:11:10 11:05:55+09:00, 2009:11:10 12:29:26+09:00, 2009:11:11 17:23:56+09:00, 2009:11:11 18:00:37+09:00, 2009:11:11 18:01:33+09:00, 2009:11:11 18:03:23+09:00, 2009:11:11 18:04:04+09:00, 2009:11:11 18:05:03+09:00, 2009:11:11 18:05:20+09:00, 2009:11:11 18:14:11+09:00, 2009:11:11 18:14:50+09:00, 2009:11:11 18:17:18+09:00, 2009:11:11 18:22:54+09:00, 2009:11:11 18:35:05+09:00, 2009:11:11 18:48:05+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:02:05+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:04:23+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:04:52+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:07:33+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:09:26+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:10:03+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:13:02+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:18:13+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:21:35+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:36:24+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:37:53+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:49:43+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:53:52+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:55+09:00, 2009:11:11 19:55:30+09:00, 2009:11:11 20:06:42+09:00, 2009:11:11 20:08:19+09:00, 2009:11:11 20:08:33+09:00, 2009:11:11 20:08:45+09:00, 2009:11:11 21:27:02+09:00, 2009:11:13 09:14:15+09:00, 2009:11:13 09:14:39+09:00, 2009:11:13 10:02:04+09:00, 2009:11:13 17:36:57+09:00, 2009:11:14 18:09:06+09:00, 2009:11:14 18:19:27+09:00, 2009:11:14 19:23:08+09:00, 2009:11:14 20:13:40+09:00, 2009:11:14 20:14:12+09:00, 2009:11:14 20:14:30+09:00, 2009:11:14 20:14:50+09:00, 2009:11:16 18:54:53+09:00, 2009:11:16 18:57:56+09:00, 2009:11:16 19:23:43+09:00, 2009:11:16 19:35:14+09:00, 2009:11:17 08:27:54+09:00, 2009:11:17 08:32:17+09:00, 2009:11:17 08:37:07+09:00, 2009:11:17 08:37:45+09:00, 2009:11:17 08:38:39+09:00, 2009:11:17 08:43:59+09:00, 2009:11:17 08:44:10+09:00, 2009:11:17 08:48:10+09:00, 2009:11:17 08:49+09:00, 2009:11:18 08:33:43+09:00, 2009:11:18 08:41:11+09:00, 2009:11:18 08:41:41+09:00, 2009:11:18 08:57:05+09:00, 2009:11:18 08:58:20+09:00, 2009:11:18 09:00:20+09:00, 2009:11:18 09:00:41+09:00, 2009:11:18 09:00:58+09:00, 2009:11:18 12:22:36+09:00, 2009:11:18 12:26:54+09:00, 2009:11:18 12:27:39+09:00, 2009:11:18 13:54:36+09:00, 2009:11:18 14:08:42+09:00, 2009:11:18 14:13:06+09:00, 2009:11:18 18:19:37+09:00, 2009:11:18 18:19:58+09:00, 2009:11:18 18:20:02+09:00, 2009:11:18 19:15:07+09:00, 2009:11:18 19:16:31+09:00, 2009:11:18 19:17:27+09:00, 2009:11:18 19:18:49+09:00, 2009:11:18 19:51:12+09:00, 2009:11:18 19:52:07+09:00, 2009:11:18 19:52:21+09:00, 2009:11:18 19:53:02+09:00, 2009:11:18 19:53:14+09:00, 2009:11:18 19:57:48+09:00, 2009:11:18 19:58:04+09:00, 2009:11:18 20:27:39+09:00, 2009:11:18 20:31:46+09:00, 2009:11:18 20:32:55+09:00, 2009:11:19 08:38:09+09:00, 2009:11:19 08:39:28+09:00, 2009:11:19 08:39:33+09:00, 2009:11:19 08:40:03+09:00, 2009:11:19 08:45:26+09:00, 2009:11:19 08:57:19+09:00, 2009:11:19 09:12:01+09:00, 2009:11:19 09:19:01+09:00, 2009:11:19 09:28:41+09:00, 2009:11:19 09:29:23+09:00, 2009:11:19 09:33:04+09:00, 2009:11:19 09:33:14+09:00, 2009:11:19 09:34:08+09:00, 2009:11:19 09:34:36+09:00, 2009:11:19 09:41:51+09:00, 2009:11:19 09:42:04+09:00, 2009:11:19 09:44:14+09:00, 2009:11:19 09:45:11+09:00, 2009:11:19 09:51:18+09:00, 2009:11:19 11:57:01+09:00, 2009:11:19 14:23:42+09:00, 2009:11:19 18:21:41+09:00, 2009:11:20 12:09:57+09:00, 2009:11:20 13:38:58+09:00, 2009:11:20 13:40:16+09:00, 2009:11:20 13:41:26+09:00, 2009:11:20 13:41:31+09:00, 2009:11:20 13:51:35+09:00, 2009:11:20 14:00:06+09:00, 2009:11:20 14:28:30+09:00, 2009:11:20 14:29:31+09:00, 2009:11:20 14:35:03+09:00, 2009:11:20 14:37:32+09:00, 2009:11:20 14:37:57+09:00, 2009:11:20 15:06:45+09:00, 2009:11:20 15:08:37+09:00, 2009:11:20 15:11:48+09:00, 2009:11:20 15:12:45+09:00, 2009:11:20 15:17:05+09:00, 2009:11:20 15:17:57+09:00, 2009:11:20 15:18:28+09:00, 2009:11:20 15:27:17+09:00, 2009:11:20 15:32:22+09:00, 2009:11:20 15:32:49+09:00, 2009:11:20 15:33:18+09:00, 2009:11:20 15:38:18+09:00, 2009:11:20 15:56:41+09:00, 2009:11:20 16:07:34+09:00, 2009:11:20 16:11:06+09:00, 2009:11:20 16:22:42+09:00, 2009:11:20 16:27:04+09:00, 2009:11:20 16:35:46+09:00, 2009:11:20 16:39:07+09:00, 2009:11:20 16:47:32+09:00, 2009:11:20 17:30:23+09:00, 2009:11:20 18:07:22+09:00, 2009:11:23 10:08:08+09:00, 2009:11:23 10:09:17+09:00, 2009:11:23 10:14:27+09:00, 2009:11:25 20:32:01+09:00, 2009:12:01 09:48:41+09:00, 2009:12:01 09:52:20+09:00, 2009:12:01 09:54:33+09:00, 2009:12:01 10:10:11+09:00, 2009:12:01 10:17:46+09:00, 2009:12:01 10:18:23+09:00, 2009:12:01 10:18:55+09:00, 2009:12:01 10:40:26+09:00, 2009:12:01 14:47:12+09:00, 2009:12:01 14:53:10+09:00, 2009:12:01 17:49:15+09:00, 2009:12:01 17:50:16+09:00, 2009:12:02 08:52:50+09:00, 2009:12:04 12:15:12+09:00, 2009:12:04 12:18:05+09:00, 2009:12:04 13:39:13+09:00, 2009:12:05 08:49:38+09:00, 2009:12:05 09:14:23+09:00, 2009:12:05 09:48:44+09:00, 2009:12:05 09:50:34+09:00, 2009:12:05 10:42:57+09:00, 2009:12:05 11:03:18+09:00, 2009:12:05 11:41:50+09:00, 2009:12:05 17:04:33+09:00, 2009:12:07 17:04:33+09:00, 2009:12:07 20:23:55+09:00, 2009:12:07 20:26:13+09:00, 2009:12:07 20:29:16+09:00, 2009:12:08 18:45:18+09:00, 2009:12:08 18:47:58+09:00, 2009:12:08 19:06:29+09:00, 2009:12:08 20:01:57+09:00, 2009:12:08 21:33:44+09:00, 2009:12:09 08:33:16+09:00, 2009:12:09 08:34:10+09:00, 2009:12:09 08:34:17+09:00, 2009:12:09 08:35:53+09:00, 2009:12:09 08:47:39+09:00, 2009:12:09 08:49:35+09:00, 2009:12:09 14:06:46+09:00, 2009:12:09 16:20:55+09:00, 2009:12:09 16:46:32+09:00, 2009:12:09 19:38:12+09:00, 2009:12:11 11:27:38+09:00, 2009:12:11 15:51:21+09:00, 2009:12:12 09:49:30+09:00, 2009:12:12 09:51:12+09:00, 2009:12:12 09:51:44+09:00, 2009:12:12 11:42:26+09:00, 2009:12:12 11:44:52+09:00, 2009:12:14 20:04:33+09:00, 2009:12:14 20:06:31+09:00, 2009:12:14 20:26:23+09:00, 2009:12:15 08:52:21+09:00, 2009:12:15 09:06:09+09:00, 2009:12:15 11:37:20+09:00, 2009:12:15 11:46:43+09:00, 2009:12:15 12:31:08+09:00, 2009:12:15 13:55:50+09:00, 2009:12:15 19:41:44+09:00, 2009:12:15 19:44:16+09:00, 2009:12:15 19:49:32+09:00, 2009:12:16 21:52:14+09:00, 2009:12:16 21:55:45+09:00, 2009:12:16 22:03:36+09:00, 2009:12:16 22:22:06+09:00, 2009:12:16 23:06:48+09:00, 2009:12:17 10:20:09+09:00, 2009:12:17 15:06:38+09:00, 2009:12:17 15:24:24+09:00, 2009:12:17 16:22:46+09:00, 2009:12:17 17:44:07+09:00, 2009:12:17 18:02:10+09:00, 2009:12:17 18:05:46+09:00, 2009:12:17 18:17:35+09:00, 2009:12:18 11:59:41+09:00, 2009:12:18 12:04:52+09:00, 2009:12:18 14:05:49+09:00, 2009:12:18 14:15:43+09:00, 2009:12:18 14:55:21+09:00, 2009:12:19 16:47:04+09:00, 2009:12:26 09:30:40+09:00, 2009:12:27 09:03:15+09:00, 2009:12:28 12:31:22+09:00, 2009:12:29 15:30:20+09:00, 2009:12:29 15:43:35+09:00, 2009:12:29 16:24:22+09:00, 2009:12:29 17:01:04+09:00, 2009:12:30 08:42:12+09:00, 2009:12:30 09:18:04+09:00, 2009:12:30 15:50:18+09:00, 2009:12:30 16:53:27+09:00, 2009:12:30 17:03:11+09:00, 2009:12:30 17:04:16+09:00, 2009:12:30 18:18:41+09:00, 2009:12:31 07:44:23+09:00, 2009:12:31 07:45:01+09:00, 2009:12:31 10:21:01+09:00, 2009:12:31 10:21:11+09:00, 2009:12:31 10:38:24+09:00, 2009:12:31 14:55:24+09:00, 2009:12:31 15:07:27+09:00, 2009:12:31 15:48:40+09:00, 2010:01:03 12:04:02+09:00, 2010:01:03 12:11:08+09:00, 2010:01:03 12:11:14+09:00, 2010:01:03 12:11:19+09:00, 2010:01:03 12:11:56+09:00, 2010:01:03 12:12:23+09:00, 2010:01:03 12:13:53+09:00, 2010:01:03 17:03:47+09:00, 2010:01:04 16:02:19+09:00, 2010:01:06 08:59:58+09:00, 2010:01:06 09:00:33+09:00, 2010:01:06 23:50:40+09:00, 2010:01:07 08:15:29+09:00, 2010:01:07 08:17:21+09:00, 2010:01:07 08:20:22+09:00, 2010:01:07 08:25+09:00, 2010:01:07 09:16:26+09:00, 2010:01:07 09:25:11+09:00, 2010:01:07 16:11:53+09:00, 2010:01:07 16:24:34+09:00, 2010:01:07 16:55:25+09:00, 2010:01:07 17:09:03+09:00, 2010:01:08 00:20:14+09:00, 2010:01:10 00:28:31+09:00, 2010:01:10 00:29:22+09:00, 2010:01:10 00:29:47+09:00, 2010:01:10 00:30:34+09:00, 2010:01:10 00:35:16+09:00, 2010:01:10 00:35:56+09:00, 2010:01:10 00:36:53+09:00, 2010:01:10 00:39:01+09:00, 2010:01:10 00:41:13+09:00, 2010:01:10 01:39:37+09:00, 2010:01:10 13:54:12+09:00, 2010:01:10 14:45:05+09:00, 2010:01:11 11:32:08+09:00, 2010:01:11 16:05:51+09:00, 2010:01:11 20:16:19+09:00, 2010:01:13 10:02:34+09:00, 2010:01:13 10:07:05+09:00, 2010:01:13 10:07:55+09:00, 2010:01:13 10:09:12+09:00, 2010:01:13 18:33:29+09:00, 2010:01:13 19:44:18+09:00, 2010:01:13 19:49:51+09:00, 2010:01:13 19:53:52+09:00, 2010:01:13 19:59:24+09:00, 2010:01:19 20:03:30+09:00, 2010:01:19 20:04:47+09:00, 2010:01:19 20:05:14+09:00, 2010:02:12 17:44:27+09:00, 2010:02:18 20:40:50+09:00, 2010:02:18 20:59:55+09:00, 2010:02:18 21:01:11+09:00, 2010:02:18 21:54:11+09:00, 2010:02:18 22:20:29+09:00, 2010:02:18 22:20:35+09:00, 2010:02:18 22:21:06+09:00, 2010:02:18 22:26:26+09:00, 2010:02:18 22:27:55+09:00, 2010:02:18 22:36:15+09:00, 2010:02:18 22:37:58+09:00, 2010:02:18 22:59:35+09:00, 2010:02:20 11:49:41+09:00, 2010:02:20 13:43:51+09:00, 2010:02:20 18:06:39+09:00, 2010:02:20 18:08:39+09:00, 2010:02:20 18:08:43+09:00, 2010:02:20 18:10:26+09:00, 2010:02:20 18:12:08+09:00, 2010:02:20 18:37:52+09:00, 2010:02:20 18:47:22+09:00, 2010:02:20 18:47:36+09:00, 2010:02:20 18:49:29+09:00, 2010:02:20 19:08:42+09:00, 2010:02:20 19:46:31+09:00, 2010:02:20 21:50:11+09:00, 2010:02:20 22:04:04+09:00, 2010:02:22 11:36:05+09:00, 2010:02:22 11:53:09+09:00, 2010:02:22 11:54:54+09:00, 2010:02:22 12:09:50+09:00, 2010:02:22 12:27:30+09:00, 2010:02:22 19:29:45+09:00, 2010:02:22 19:32:02+09:00, 2010:02:22 19:37:45+09:00, 2010:02:22 19:41:21+09:00, 2010:02:22 21:13:16+09:00, 2010:02:22 21:13:43+09:00, 2010:02:22 21:29:43+09:00, 2010:02:22 21:30:17+09:00, 2010:02:25 20:58:04+09:00, 2010:03:08 16:06:33+09:00, 2010:03:08 16:07:38+09:00, 2010:03:08 16:34:48+09:00, 2010:03:08 18:22:53+09:00, 2010:03:09 12:10:22+09:00, 2010:03:09 18:22:36+09:00, 2010:03:09 18:23:15+09:00, 2010:03:09 18:28:45+09:00, 2010:03:10 14:55:32+09:00, 2010:03:10 15:15:33+09:00, 2010:03:10 16:06+09:00, 2010:03:10 16:55:16+09:00, 2010:03:10 18:20:31+09:00, 2010:03:10 18:24:39+09:00, 2010:03:10 19:30:16+09:00, 2010:03:18 10:36:35+09:00, 2010:03:18 11:32:25+09:00, 2010:03:18 11:32:28+09:00, 2010:03:18 14:22:17+09:00, 2010:03:18 14:38:41+09:00, 2010:03:18 16:05:10+09:00, 2010:03:18 19:27:54+09:00, 2010:03:18 19:27:55+09:00, 2010:03:18 19:28:17+09:00, 2010:03:18 19:28:17+09:00, 2010:03:18 19:28:38+09:00, 2010:03:18 19:28:38+09:00, 2010:03:19 08:42:02+09:00, 2010:03:19 08:45:11+09:00, 2010:03:19 09:52:27+09:00, 2010:03:19 10:03:37+09:00, 2010:03:19 10:19:08+09:00, 2010:03:19 10:19:23+09:00, 2010:03:19 10:34:04+09:00, 2010:03:19 15:02:39+09:00, 2010:03:19 15:28:30+09:00, 2010:03:19 15:44:06+09:00, 2010:03:19 15:45:05+09:00, 2010:03:19 16:16:50+09:00, 2010:03:19 17:22:28+09:00, 2010:03:19 17:23:43+09:00, 2010:03:19 18:17:26+09:00, 2010:03:24 09:42:37+09:00, 2010:03:24 09:57:32+09:00, 2010:03:25 10:52:21+09:00, 2010:03:25 11:05:10+09:00, 2010:03:25 17:12:13+09:00, 2010:03:25 17:20:01+09:00, 2010:03:25 17:21:03+09:00, 2010:03:25 19:18:48+09:00, 2010:03:26 08:52:13+09:00, 2010:03:26 09:14:35+09:00, 2010:03:26 09:49:32+09:00, 2010:03:26 09:52:53+09:00, 2010:03:26 10:16:08+09:00, 2010:03:30 10:08:15+09:00, 2010:03:30 10:15:03+09:00, 2010:03:30 10:54:32+09:00, 2010:03:30 11:42:26+09:00, 2010:03:30 14:17:27+09:00, 2010:03:30 14:29:13+09:00, 2010:03:30 15:56:23+09:00, 2010:03:30 16:49:51+09:00, 2010:03:31 12:22:35+09:00, 2010:03:31 12:27:48+09:00, 2010:03:31 13:34:29+09:00, 2010:03:31 13:52:10+09:00, 2010:03:31 14:06:56+09:00, 2010:03:31 14:09:39+09:00, 2010:03:31 14:53:17+09:00, 2010:03:31 15:12:30+09:00, 2010:04:02 13:40:50+09:00, 2010:04:02 13:48:08+09:00, 2010:04:02 14:20:55+09:00, 2010:04:02 14:26:40+09:00, 2010:04:02 14:29:21+09:00, 2010:04:14 10:50:49+09:00, 2010:04:14 14:25:33+09:00, 2010:04:14 14:39:55+09:00, 2010:04:14 14:41:10+09:00, 2010:04:16 15:51:32+09:00, 2010:04:19 18:56:04+09:00, 2010:04:20 16:30:54+09:00, 2010:04:20 16:32:30+09:00, 2010:04:20 19:05:57+09:00, 2010:04:29 08:27:37+09:00, 2010:04:29 08:37:19+09:00, 2010:04:29 08:38:16+09:00, 2010:04:29 09:00:35+09:00, 2010:04:29 09:02:07+09:00, 2010:05:10 15:22:22+09:00, 2010:05:10 15:31+09:00, 2010:05:10 15:33:14+09:00, 2010:05:10 15:50:16+09:00, 2010:05:10 15:53:39+09:00, 2010:05:10 16:04:14+09:00, 2010:05:18 09:26+09:00, 2010:05:18 09:37:21+09:00, 2010:05:18 16:39:33+09:00, 2010:05:18 16:54+09:00, 2010:05:18 16:55:18+09:00, 2010:05:18 16:59:29+09:00, 2010:05:18 17:10:50+09:00, 2010:05:18 17:56:17+09:00, 2010:05:18 18:03:53+09:00, 2010:05:18 18:11:56+09:00, 2010:05:18 18:31:49+09:00, 2010:05:18 18:57:19+09:00, 2010:05:19 17:53:59+09:00, 2010:05:19 17:55:16+09:00, 2010:05:24 15:48:08+09:00, 2010:05:24 15:51:59+09:00, 2010:05:25 02:02:27+09:00, 2010:05:25 02:05:14+09:00, 2010:05:25 02:49:39+09:00, 2010:05:27 10:21:03+09:00, 2010:05:27 10:25:06+09:00, 2010:05:27 10:27:10+09:00, 2010:05:27 10:55:07+09:00, 2010:05:27 10:58:07+09:00, 2010:05:27 10:59:06+09:00, 2010:05:27 11:03:03+09:00, 2010:05:27 11:07:16+09:00, 2010:05:27 11:08:45+09:00, 2010:05:27 11:58:19+09:00, 2010:05:27 13:53:05+09:00, 2010:05:27 13:55:52+09:00, 2010:05:27 14:19:18+09:00, 2010:05:27 15:50:48+09:00, 2010:05:27 16:40:24+09:00, 2010:05:27 17:08:23+09:00, 2010:05:28 15:43:39+09:00, 2010:05:28 15:56:29+09:00, 2010:05:28 16:15:02+09:00, 2010:05:31 15:54:21+09:00, 2010:05:31 15:55:12+09:00, 2010:05:31 16:04:25+09:00, 2010:05:31 16:31:35+09:00, 2010:06:07 11:05:05+09:00, 2010:06:07 11:05:48+09:00, 2010:06:07 11:10:08+09:00, 2010:06:14 10:11:54+09:00, 2010:06:14 10:17:50+09:00, 2010:06:24 09:21:37+09:00, 2010:06:24 09:22:09+09:00, 2010:06:24 09:25:17+09:00, 2010:06:24 09:38:05+09:00, 2010:06:24 09:38:33+09:00, 2010:06:24 10:32:11+09:00, 2010:06:24 10:33:01+09:00, 2010:06:24 10:33:21+09:00, 2010:06:24 11:06:40+09:00, 2010:06:29 16:41:51+09:00, 2010:06:29 16:42:17+09:00, 2010:07:07 15:01:20+09:00, 2010:07:07 15:02:50+09:00 History Software Agent : Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0, Adobe InDesign 6.0 History Changed : /, /metadata, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /metadata, /;/metadata, /, /, /, /metadata, /;/metadata, /metadata, /;/metadata, /metadata, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, /, / Warning : [Minor] Extracted only 1000 xmpMM:History items. Ignore minor errors to extract all Derived From Instance ID : xmp.iid:8E4E7BA9F7A8DF11AD678AD57091BD13 Derived From Document ID : xmp.did:2E0E1DEA7832DF11BFCD9CCF569D06EF Derived From Original Document ID: xmp.did:8CAED473E9ABDE118B16D4310236FB20 Derived From Rendition Class : default Manifest Link Form : ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream, ReferenceStream Manifest Placed X Resolution : 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00 Manifest Placed Y Resolution : 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00, 72.00 Manifest Placed Resolution Unit : Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches, Inches Manifest Reference Instance ID : uuid:30BE8A6293CBDE118DC4A544E24F11E3, uuid:30BE8A6293CBDE118DC4A544E24F11E3, uuid:30BE8A6293CBDE118DC4A544E24F11E3, uuid:7E7BB9EBA6CEDE1191788B456429B625, uuid:7E7BB9EBA6CEDE1191788B456429B625, uuid:7E7BB9EBA6CEDE1191788B456429B625, uuid:7E7BB9EBA6CEDE1191788B456429B625, uuid:7E7BB9EBA6CEDE1191788B456429B625, uuid:7E7BB9EBA6CEDE1191788B456429B625, uuid:7E7BB9EBA6CEDE1191788B456429B625, uuid:7E7BB9EBA6CEDE1191788B456429B625, uuid:B3C2B8046AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:7E7BB9EBA6CEDE1191788B456429B625, uuid:7E7BB9EBA6CEDE1191788B456429B625, uuid:7E7BB9EBA6CEDE1191788B456429B625, uuid:7E7BB9EBA6CEDE1191788B456429B625, uuid:7E7BB9EBA6CEDE1191788B456429B625, uuid:7E7BB9EBA6CEDE1191788B456429B625, uuid:193F486994C9DE11A566B850422AFFDA, uuid:AFC2B8046AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:7573715269C8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:30BE8A6293CBDE118DC4A544E24F11E3, uuid:B7C2B8046AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:666FD73C7070E01199F6C5D43393CB0C, uuid:7B6269BA88C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:37BE8A6293CBDE118DC4A544E24F11E3, uuid:7F6269BA88C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:7F6269BA88C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:1B3F486994C9DE11A566B850422AFFDA, uuid:F9F7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A37CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:1D3F486994C9DE11A566B850422AFFDA, uuid:A37CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:DAF4E5993421DF11BFD5DAB53DFF387D, uuid:271518D78FD5DE119DA0C3148F82A627, uuid:A37CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:7373715269C8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:7440A8811C33DF11A7709F71438F537C, uuid:F9F7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, xmp.iid:AF49D117E488DF118F99CADC5E9AAE89, xmp.iid:AF49D117E488DF118F99CADC5E9AAE89, xmp.iid:AF49D117E488DF118F99CADC5E9AAE89, xmp.iid:8A864882528EDF118E0EFBDDD7C4112A, uuid:AB7CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A37CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:1B3F486994C9DE11A566B850422AFFDA, xmp.iid:81F694F33E49E011B2359DE8D549B93D, uuid:CE49D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:CF49D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, xmp.iid:C26ED491BA46E011AA2080DDC7921C37, xmp.iid:B61AE44A6655E0118F59B2D107ED329A, xmp.iid:8C4B5E79D755E0119937A04AB2589823, xmp.iid:651CACC01FFDDF11AA3D920E14FF0297, xmp.iid:C26ED491BA46E011AA2080DDC7921C37, xmp.iid:B61AE44A6655E0118F59B2D107ED329A, xmp.iid:B51AE44A6655E0118F59B2D107ED329A, xmp.iid:82F694F33E49E011B2359DE8D549B93D, uuid:47A25FDE4AC7DE11BFD3DCDF8E447736, uuid:9E41E000E6C8DE118ECFE22C9C849A74, uuid:F9F7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:F9F7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:5A473DA5B1BBDF119F13CCB6A4179419, uuid:9E41E000E6C8DE118ECFE22C9C849A74, uuid:4C589B210EDEDE11ACAEAD690399785E, uuid:4C589B210EDEDE11ACAEAD690399785E, uuid:F9F7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:19B0B1DBA0D4DE11AB7CFA633F54B366, uuid:19B0B1DBA0D4DE11AB7CFA633F54B366, uuid:19B0B1DBA0D4DE11AB7CFA633F54B366, uuid:7173715269C8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A5C58F4A9CFADE11950DA1155E3BBDF2, uuid:3DBAE58A9CFADE118A45C4438542CCD9, uuid:47A25FDE4AC7DE11BFD3DCDF8E447736, uuid:47A25FDE4AC7DE11BFD3DCDF8E447736, uuid:D349D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:D349D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:D349D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:D349D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:D349D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:D349D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:6F73715269C8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:816269BA88C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:816269BA88C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:47A25FDE4AC7DE11BFD3DCDF8E447736, uuid:32BE8A6293CBDE118DC4A544E24F11E3, uuid:A57CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A57CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A57CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, xmp.iid:3078E8622196DF11BD57B01348C63074, xmp.iid:5789A9102996DF119A20A72139390DD4, uuid:01D07530D3D1DF118260B24B0F861A28, xmp.iid:3078E8622196DF11BD57B01348C63074, uuid:47A25FDE4AC7DE11BFD3DCDF8E447736, uuid:9EED310088C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:A2ED310088C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:A0ED310088C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:47A25FDE4AC7DE11BFD3DCDF8E447736, uuid:A77CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A77CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:63641B864EFADE11A0F4AEAA8AA24173, uuid:63641B864EFADE11A0F4AEAA8AA24173, uuid:A97CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A97CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, xmp.iid:9702B06CA548E0118FAAEC436B40E591, uuid:47A25FDE4AC7DE11BFD3DCDF8E447736, xmp.iid:9702B06CA548E0118FAAEC436B40E591, uuid:47A25FDE4AC7DE11BFD3DCDF8E447736, xmp.iid:9702B06CA548E0118FAAEC436B40E591, xmp.iid:9702B06CA548E0118FAAEC436B40E591, uuid:47A25FDE4AC7DE11BFD3DCDF8E447736, xmp.iid:CEFCE3A8F146E011A580FC1C7E30C80C, xmp.iid:9702B06CA548E0118FAAEC436B40E591, uuid:47A25FDE4AC7DE11BFD3DCDF8E447736, xmp.iid:CBFCE3A8F146E011A580FC1C7E30C80C, xmp.iid:CDFCE3A8F146E011A580FC1C7E30C80C, xmp.iid:9702B06CA548E0118FAAEC436B40E591, uuid:47A25FDE4AC7DE11BFD3DCDF8E447736, uuid:D47418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E9E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4ED1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:098280A603E6DE1188ACF0518ABECBFF, uuid:D47418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E9E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4ED1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6D9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:098280A603E6DE1188ACF0518ABECBFF, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D47418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E9E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4ED1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4ED1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:098280A603E6DE1188ACF0518ABECBFF, uuid:D47418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E9E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4ED1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6D9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D7DB9AB7A5C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:098280A603E6DE1188ACF0518ABECBFF, xmp.iid:1F6CD434F707E011B4829314947EA86B, uuid:1DB0B1DBA0D4DE11AB7CFA633F54B366, uuid:47A25FDE4AC7DE11BFD3DCDF8E447736, uuid:E9E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4ED1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:A9AEC64FE6DBDE11BDFD8DA13BDEF20C, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:1BDE3AF4FBBEDE11A577E1FA52F6E3D4, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:5A4D25DB491CDF11A15F979B46DEAA40, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:A6E7F6C436CBDE11A894F8B6521E7A2C, uuid:A6E7F6C436CBDE11A894F8B6521E7A2C, xmp.iid:C36ED491BA46E011AA2080DDC7921C37, uuid:A6E7F6C436CBDE11A894F8B6521E7A2C, uuid:A6E7F6C436CBDE11A894F8B6521E7A2C, xmp.iid:6CFADDEC836CE01188B0DDC82723C8C7, uuid:D47418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E9E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:EB918DA1FCC4DE119D5ED77BA6DA9D2B, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6D9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:D47418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, xmp.iid:206CD434F707E011B4829314947EA86B, uuid:A9AEC64FE6DBDE11BDFD8DA13BDEF20C, uuid:E9E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:EB918DA1FCC4DE119D5ED77BA6DA9D2B, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, xmp.iid:206CD434F707E011B4829314947EA86B, uuid:A9AEC64FE6DBDE11BDFD8DA13BDEF20C, uuid:E9E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4ED1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:D47418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:B50A9AA4F8E2DE11B101DCA8849717F3, xmp.iid:206CD434F707E011B4829314947EA86B, uuid:A9AEC64FE6DBDE11BDFD8DA13BDEF20C, uuid:E9E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4ED1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6D9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6D9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FC41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FC41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:D47418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, xmp.iid:206CD434F707E011B4829314947EA86B, uuid:A9AEC64FE6DBDE11BDFD8DA13BDEF20C, uuid:E9E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4ED1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4ED1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:EB918DA1FCC4DE119D5ED77BA6DA9D2B, uuid:EB918DA1FCC4DE119D5ED77BA6DA9D2B, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:ECEC2A72E5DADE118493A6FE76DAABB6, uuid:D47418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:D549D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, xmp.iid:206CD434F707E011B4829314947EA86B, uuid:A9AEC64FE6DBDE11BDFD8DA13BDEF20C, uuid:6B9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4ED1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:D2D3ED5BEEB6DE11988DCF2FE38751AF, uuid:371FB9E3E6D0DE11A835DE905279580A, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:E9E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4ED1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6D9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6D9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:D47418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, xmp.iid:206CD434F707E011B4829314947EA86B, uuid:A9AEC64FE6DBDE11BDFD8DA13BDEF20C, uuid:E9E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4ED1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FE41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6964A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:A9AEC64FE6DBDE11BDFD8DA13BDEF20C, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:D07418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:E7C505F96ABCDE1188568430F543D3BC, uuid:D47418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288 Manifest Reference Document ID : uuid:2EBE8A6293CBDE118DC4A544E24F11E3, uuid:2EBE8A6293CBDE118DC4A544E24F11E3, uuid:2EBE8A6293CBDE118DC4A544E24F11E3, uuid:FAF7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:FAF7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:FAF7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:FAF7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:FAF7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:FAF7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:FAF7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:FAF7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:B2C2B8046AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:FAF7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:FAF7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:FAF7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:FAF7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:FAF7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:FAF7ED4E6BC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:183F486994C9DE11A566B850422AFFDA, uuid:7673715269C8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:7473715269C8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:2EBE8A6293CBDE118DC4A544E24F11E3, uuid:B6C2B8046AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:656FD73C7070E01199F6C5D43393CB0C, uuid:A3ED310088C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:5357247E95C9DE11A566B850422AFFDA, uuid:7E6269BA88C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:7E6269BA88C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:1A3F486994C9DE11A566B850422AFFDA, uuid:AC7CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A27CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:1C3F486994C9DE11A566B850422AFFDA, uuid:A27CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:D9F4E5993421DF11BFD5DAB53DFF387D, uuid:261518D78FD5DE119DA0C3148F82A627, uuid:A27CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:7273715269C8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:7340A8811C33DF11A7709F71438F537C, uuid:AC7CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, xmp.did:AF49D117E488DF118F99CADC5E9AAE89, xmp.did:AF49D117E488DF118F99CADC5E9AAE89, xmp.did:AF49D117E488DF118F99CADC5E9AAE89, xmp.did:8A864882528EDF118E0EFBDDD7C4112A, uuid:AA7CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A27CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:1A3F486994C9DE11A566B850422AFFDA, xmp.did:81F694F33E49E011B2359DE8D549B93D, uuid:2A1518D78FD5DE119DA0C3148F82A627, uuid:CD509DB0E6E3DE11BAAFE3CD863B3023, xmp.did:C26ED491BA46E011AA2080DDC7921C37, xmp.did:B61AE44A6655E0118F59B2D107ED329A, xmp.did:8C4B5E79D755E0119937A04AB2589823, xmp.did:651CACC01FFDDF11AA3D920E14FF0297, xmp.did:C26ED491BA46E011AA2080DDC7921C37, xmp.did:B61AE44A6655E0118F59B2D107ED329A, xmp.did:B51AE44A6655E0118F59B2D107ED329A, xmp.did:82F694F33E49E011B2359DE8D549B93D, uuid:DBBC7D817EC0DE118F8D845C0BEDF77F, uuid:9D41E000E6C8DE118ECFE22C9C849A74, uuid:AC7CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:AC7CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:D049D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:9D41E000E6C8DE118ECFE22C9C849A74, uuid:279F809156C8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:279F809156C8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:AC7CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A041E000E6C8DE118ECFE22C9C849A74, uuid:A041E000E6C8DE118ECFE22C9C849A74, uuid:A041E000E6C8DE118ECFE22C9C849A74, uuid:7073715269C8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A4C58F4A9CFADE11950DA1155E3BBDF2, uuid:3CBAE58A9CFADE118A45C4438542CCD9, uuid:DBBC7D817EC0DE118F8D845C0BEDF77F, uuid:DBBC7D817EC0DE118F8D845C0BEDF77F, uuid:D249D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:D249D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:D249D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:D249D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:D249D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:D249D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:6E73715269C8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:806269BA88C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:806269BA88C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:DBBC7D817EC0DE118F8D845C0BEDF77F, uuid:31BE8A6293CBDE118DC4A544E24F11E3, uuid:A47CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A47CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A47CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, xmp.did:3078E8622196DF11BD57B01348C63074, xmp.did:5789A9102996DF119A20A72139390DD4, uuid:00D07530D3D1DF118260B24B0F861A28, xmp.did:3078E8622196DF11BD57B01348C63074, uuid:DBBC7D817EC0DE118F8D845C0BEDF77F, uuid:9DED310088C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:A1ED310088C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:9FED310088C0DE11BE52A6BF01D72759, uuid:DBBC7D817EC0DE118F8D845C0BEDF77F, uuid:A67CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A67CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:D7AF5CD5CEC8DE1186DCB3845576DCC7, uuid:D7AF5CD5CEC8DE1186DCB3845576DCC7, uuid:A87CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, uuid:A87CF8D56AC8DE11A9DBFDAA798485D3, xmp.did:9702B06CA548E0118FAAEC436B40E591, uuid:DBBC7D817EC0DE118F8D845C0BEDF77F, xmp.did:9702B06CA548E0118FAAEC436B40E591, uuid:DBBC7D817EC0DE118F8D845C0BEDF77F, xmp.did:9702B06CA548E0118FAAEC436B40E591, xmp.did:9702B06CA548E0118FAAEC436B40E591, uuid:DBBC7D817EC0DE118F8D845C0BEDF77F, xmp.did:CEFCE3A8F146E011A580FC1C7E30C80C, xmp.did:9702B06CA548E0118FAAEC436B40E591, uuid:DBBC7D817EC0DE118F8D845C0BEDF77F, xmp.did:CBFCE3A8F146E011A580FC1C7E30C80C, xmp.did:CDFCE3A8F146E011A580FC1C7E30C80C, xmp.did:9702B06CA548E0118FAAEC436B40E591, uuid:DBBC7D817EC0DE118F8D845C0BEDF77F, uuid:D37418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E8E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4DD1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:088280A603E6DE1188ACF0518ABECBFF, uuid:D37418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E8E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4DD1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6C9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:088280A603E6DE1188ACF0518ABECBFF, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:D37418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E8E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4DD1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4DD1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:088280A603E6DE1188ACF0518ABECBFF, uuid:D37418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E8E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4DD1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6C9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:24198BF099C7DE11A546B1790820F57D, uuid:088280A603E6DE1188ACF0518ABECBFF, xmp.did:1F6CD434F707E011B4829314947EA86B, uuid:A5B311F33FD3DE119942D87A69815367, uuid:DBBC7D817EC0DE118F8D845C0BEDF77F, uuid:E8E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4DD1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:F741EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:19DE3AF4FBBEDE11A577E1FA52F6E3D4, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:C89699B61EC8DE1185A4BDF0DCC60331, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:A4E7F6C436CBDE11A894F8B6521E7A2C, uuid:A4E7F6C436CBDE11A894F8B6521E7A2C, xmp.did:C36ED491BA46E011AA2080DDC7921C37, uuid:A4E7F6C436CBDE11A894F8B6521E7A2C, uuid:A4E7F6C436CBDE11A894F8B6521E7A2C, xmp.did:6BFADDEC836CE01188B0DDC82723C8C7, uuid:D37418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:E8E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:EA918DA1FCC4DE119D5ED77BA6DA9D2B, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6C9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:D37418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, xmp.did:206CD434F707E011B4829314947EA86B, uuid:F741EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:E8E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:EA918DA1FCC4DE119D5ED77BA6DA9D2B, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, xmp.did:206CD434F707E011B4829314947EA86B, uuid:F741EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:E8E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4DD1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:D37418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:B40A9AA4F8E2DE11B101DCA8849717F3, xmp.did:206CD434F707E011B4829314947EA86B, uuid:F741EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:E8E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4DD1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6C9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6C9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FB41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FB41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:D37418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, xmp.did:206CD434F707E011B4829314947EA86B, uuid:F741EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:E8E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4DD1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4DD1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:EA918DA1FCC4DE119D5ED77BA6DA9D2B, uuid:EA918DA1FCC4DE119D5ED77BA6DA9D2B, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:F941EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:D37418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:D449D544F4BADF11B0F3AB806C69E160, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, xmp.did:206CD434F707E011B4829314947EA86B, uuid:F741EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6A9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4DD1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:1833C339EBB6DE11A3E5BC349B3F6787, uuid:361FB9E3E6D0DE11A835DE905279580A, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:E8E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4DD1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6C9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6C9AEDD85CC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:D37418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, xmp.did:206CD434F707E011B4829314947EA86B, uuid:F741EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:E8E8721949C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:4DD1A4545DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:FD41EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:6864A8E95DC4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:F741EECE58C4DE11AA82A4F638E424DC, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:09582208C2B6DE11888CE5312A170B3A, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:CBCDF447F3B9DE11BE9DC4083811CF9B, uuid:D37418E46BB8DE1180CD90029246B288 Doc Change Count : 42467 Format : application/pdf Producer : Adobe PDF Library 9.0 Trapped : False Has XFA : No Page Count : 317 Page Layout : SinglePage Creator : Adobe InDesign CS4 (6.0.6)EXIF Metadata provided by EXIF.tools